summaryrefslogtreecommitdiff
diff options
context:
space:
mode:
-rw-r--r--.gitattributes4
-rw-r--r--LICENSE.txt11
-rw-r--r--README.md2
-rw-r--r--old/53396-0.txt5530
-rw-r--r--old/53396-0.zipbin102128 -> 0 bytes
-rw-r--r--old/53396-h.zipbin703320 -> 0 bytes
-rw-r--r--old/53396-h/53396-h.htm7051
-rw-r--r--old/53396-h/images/cover.jpgbin69222 -> 0 bytes
-rw-r--r--old/53396-h/images/i_026fp.jpgbin39418 -> 0 bytes
-rw-r--r--old/53396-h/images/i_028fp.jpgbin85157 -> 0 bytes
-rw-r--r--old/53396-h/images/i_034fp.jpgbin43646 -> 0 bytes
-rw-r--r--old/53396-h/images/i_072.jpgbin21513 -> 0 bytes
-rw-r--r--old/53396-h/images/i_073.jpgbin5952 -> 0 bytes
-rw-r--r--old/53396-h/images/i_076.jpgbin38571 -> 0 bytes
-rw-r--r--old/53396-h/images/i_084fp.jpgbin118323 -> 0 bytes
-rw-r--r--old/53396-h/images/i_108fp.jpgbin29570 -> 0 bytes
-rw-r--r--old/53396-h/images/i_170fp.jpgbin68241 -> 0 bytes
-rw-r--r--old/53396-h/images/i_176fp.jpgbin28940 -> 0 bytes
-rw-r--r--old/53396-h/images/i_frontis.jpgbin56145 -> 0 bytes
19 files changed, 17 insertions, 12581 deletions
diff --git a/.gitattributes b/.gitattributes
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..d7b82bc
--- /dev/null
+++ b/.gitattributes
@@ -0,0 +1,4 @@
+*.txt text eol=lf
+*.htm text eol=lf
+*.html text eol=lf
+*.md text eol=lf
diff --git a/LICENSE.txt b/LICENSE.txt
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..6312041
--- /dev/null
+++ b/LICENSE.txt
@@ -0,0 +1,11 @@
+This eBook, including all associated images, markup, improvements,
+metadata, and any other content or labor, has been confirmed to be
+in the PUBLIC DOMAIN IN THE UNITED STATES.
+
+Procedures for determining public domain status are described in
+the "Copyright How-To" at https://www.gutenberg.org.
+
+No investigation has been made concerning possible copyrights in
+jurisdictions other than the United States. Anyone seeking to utilize
+this eBook outside of the United States should confirm copyright
+status under the laws that apply to them.
diff --git a/README.md b/README.md
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..92c2150
--- /dev/null
+++ b/README.md
@@ -0,0 +1,2 @@
+Project Gutenberg (https://www.gutenberg.org) public repository for
+eBook #53396 (https://www.gutenberg.org/ebooks/53396)
diff --git a/old/53396-0.txt b/old/53396-0.txt
deleted file mode 100644
index 70c7321..0000000
--- a/old/53396-0.txt
+++ /dev/null
@@ -1,5530 +0,0 @@
-Project Gutenberg's Practical Talks by an Astronomer, by Harold Jacoby
-
-This eBook is for the use of anyone anywhere in the United States and most
-other parts of the world at no cost and with almost no restrictions
-whatsoever. You may copy it, give it away or re-use it under the terms of
-the Project Gutenberg License included with this eBook or online at
-www.gutenberg.org. If you are not located in the United States, you'll have
-to check the laws of the country where you are located before using this ebook.
-
-
-
-Title: Practical Talks by an Astronomer
-
-Author: Harold Jacoby
-
-Release Date: October 29, 2016 [EBook #53396]
-
-Language: English
-
-Character set encoding: UTF-8
-
-*** START OF THIS PROJECT GUTENBERG EBOOK PRACTICAL TALKS BY AN ASTRONOMER ***
-
-
-
-
-Produced by Chris Curnow, John Campbell and the Online
-Distributed Proofreading Team at http://www.pgdp.net (This
-file was produced from images generously made available
-by The Internet Archive)
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
- TRANSCRIBER'S NOTE
-
- Italic text is denoted by _underscores_.
-
- Obvious typographical errors and punctuation errors have been
- corrected after careful comparison with other occurrences within
- the text and consultation of external sources.
-
- More detail can be found at the end of the book.
-
-
-
-
- PRACTICAL TALKS BY AN ASTRONOMER
-
-[Illustration: The Moon. First Quarter.
-
-Photographed by Loewy and Puiseux, February 13, 1894.]
-
-
-
-
- PRACTICAL TALKS BY AN ASTRONOMER
-
- BY
- HAROLD JACOBY
-
- ADJUNCT PROFESSOR OF ASTRONOMY IN
- COLUMBIA UNIVERSITY
-
- ILLUSTRATED
-
- NEW YORK
- CHARLES SCRIBNER'S SONS
- 1902
-
-
-
-
- COPYRIGHT, 1902, BY
- CHARLES SCRIBNER'S SONS
-
- Published, April, 1902
-
- TROW DIRECTORY
- PRINTING AND BOOKBINDING COMPANY
- NEW YORK
-
-
-
-
-PREFACE
-
-
-The present volume has not been designed as a systematic treatise
-on astronomy. There are many excellent books of that kind, suitable
-for serious students as well as the general reader; but they are
-necessarily somewhat dry and unattractive, because they must aim at
-completeness. Completeness means detail, and detail means dryness.
-
-But the science of astronomy contains subjects that admit of
-detached treatment; and as many of these are precisely the ones of
-greatest general interest, it has seemed well to select several,
-and describe them in language free from technicalities. It is hoped
-that the book will thus prove useful to persons who do not wish to
-give the time required for a study of astronomy as a whole, but
-who may take pleasure in devoting a half-hour now and then to a
-detached essay on some special topic.
-
-Preparation of the book in this form has made it suitable for prior
-publication in periodicals; and the several essays have in fact
-all been printed before. But the intention of collecting them into
-a book was kept in mind from the first; and while no attempt has
-been made at consecutiveness, it is hoped that nothing of merely
-ephemeral value has been included.
-
-
-
-
-CONTENTS
-
-
- PAGE
-
- NAVIGATION AT SEA 1
-
- THE PLEIADES 10
-
- THE POLE-STAR 18
-
- NEBULÆ 27
-
- TEMPORARY STARS 37
-
- GALILEO 47
-
- THE PLANET OF 1898 58
-
- HOW TO MAKE A SUN-DIAL 69
-
- PHOTOGRAPHY IN ASTRONOMY 81
-
- TIME STANDARDS OF THE WORLD 111
-
- MOTIONS OF THE EARTH'S POLE 131
-
- SATURN'S RINGS 140
-
- THE HELIOMETER 152
-
- OCCULTATIONS 161
-
- MOUNTING GREAT TELESCOPES 170
-
- THE ASTRONOMER'S POLE 184
-
- THE MOON HOAX 199
-
- THE SUN'S DESTINATION 210
-
-
-
-
-ILLUSTRATIONS
-
-
- THE MOON. FIRST QUARTER _Frontispiece_
- _Photographed by Loewy and Puiseux,
- February 13, 1894._
-
- FACING
- PAGE
-
- SPIRAL NEBULA IN CONSTELLATION LEO 26
- _Photographed by Keeler,
- February 24, 1900._
-
- NEBULA IN ANDROMEDA 28
- _Photographed by Barnard,
- November 21, 1892._
-
- THE "DUMB-BELL" NEBULA 34
- _Photographed by Keeler,
- July 31, 1899._
-
- STAR-FIELD IN CONSTELLATION MONOCEROS 84
- _Photographed by Barnard,
- February 1, 1894._
-
- SOLAR CORONA. TOTAL ECLIPSE 108
- _Photographed by Campbell,
- January 22, 1898; Jeur, India._
-
- FORTY-INCH TELESCOPE, YERKES OBSERVATORY 170
-
- YERKES OBSERVATORY, UNIVERSITY OF CHICAGO 176
-
-
-
-
-PRACTICAL TALKS BY AN ASTRONOMER
-
-
-
-
-NAVIGATION AT SEA
-
-
-A short time ago the writer had occasion to rummage among the
-archives of the Royal Astronomical Society in London, to consult,
-if possible, the original manuscripts left by one Stephen
-Groombridge, an English astronomer of the good old days, who
-died in 1832. It was known that they had been filed away about a
-generation ago, by the late Sir George Airy, who was Astronomer
-Royal of England between the years 1835 and 1881. After a long
-search, a large and dusty box was found and opened. It was filled
-with documents, of which the topmost was in Sir George's own
-handwriting, and began substantially as follows:
-
- "List of articles within this box.
- "No. 1, This list,
- "No. 2, etc., etc."
-
-Astronomical precision can no further go: he had listed even the
-list itself. Truly, Airy was rightly styled "prince of precisians."
-A worthy Astronomer Royal was he, to act under the royal warrant
-of Charles II., who established the office in 1675. Down to this
-present day that warrant still makes it the duty of His Majesty's
-Astronomer "to apply himself with the most exact care and diligence
-to the rectifying of the tables of the motions of the heavens and
-the places of the fixed stars, in order to find out the so much
-desired longitude at sea, for the perfecting the art of navigation."
-
-The "so much desired longitude at sea" is, indeed, a vastly
-important thing to a maritime nation like England. And only in
-comparatively recent years has it become possible and easy for
-vessels to be navigated with safety and convenience upon long
-voyages. The writer was well acquainted with an old sea-captain
-of New York, who had commanded one of the earliest transatlantic
-steamers, and who died only a few years ago. He had a goodly store
-of ocean yarn, fit and ready for the spinning, if he could but
-find someone who, like himself, had known and loved the ocean. In
-his early sea-going days, only the wealthiest of captains owned
-chronometers. This instrument is now considered indispensable in
-navigation, but at that time it was a new invention, very rare and
-costly. Upon a certain voyage from England to Rio Janeiro, in South
-America, the old captain could remember the following odd method of
-navigation: The ship was steered by compass to the southward and
-westward, more or less, until the skipper's antique quadrant showed
-that they had about reached the latitude of Rio. Then they swung
-her on a course due west by compass, and away she went for Rio,
-relying on the lookout man forward to keep the ship from running
-ashore. For after a certain lapse of time, being ignorant of the
-longitude, they could not know whether they would "raise" the land
-within an hour or in six weeks. We are glad of an opportunity to
-put this story on record, for the time is not far distant when
-there will be no man left among the living who can remember how
-ships were taken across the seas in the good old days before
-chronometers.
-
-Anyone who has ever been a passenger on a great transatlantic
-liner of to-day knows what an important, imposing personage is
-the brass-bound skipper. A very different creature is he on the
-deck of his ship from the modest seafaring man we meet on land,
-clad for the time being in his shore-going togs. But the captain's
-dignity is not all brass buttons and gold braid. He has behind
-him the powerful support of a deep, delightful mystery. He it is
-who "takes the sun" at noon, and finds out the ship's path at
-sea. And in truth, regarded merely as a scientific experiment,
-the guiding of a vessel across the unmarked trackless ocean has
-few equals within the whole range of human knowledge. It is our
-purpose here to explain quite briefly the manner in which this
-seeming impossibility is accomplished. We shall not be able to
-go sufficiently into details to enable him who reads to run and
-navigate a magnificent steamer. But we hope to diminish somewhat
-that small part of the captain's vast dignity which depends upon
-his mysterious operations with the sextant.
-
-To begin, then, with the sextant itself. It is nothing but an
-instrument with which we can measure how high up the sun is in the
-sky. Now, everyone knows that the sun slowly climbs the sky in
-the morning, reaches its greatest height at noon, and then slowly
-sinks again in the afternoon. The captain simply begins to watch
-the sun through the sextant shortly before noon, and keeps at it
-until he discovers that the sun is just beginning to descend. That
-is the instant of noon on the ship. The captain quickly glances
-at the chronometer, or calls out "noon" to an officer who is near
-that instrument. And so the error of the chronometer becomes known
-then and there without any further astronomical calculations
-whatever. Navigators can also find the chronometer error by sextant
-observations when the sun is a long way from noon. The methods of
-doing this are somewhat less simple than for the noon observation;
-they belong to the details of navigation, into which we cannot
-enter here.
-
-Incidentally, the captain also notes with the sextant how high
-the sun was in the sky at the noon observation. He has in his
-mysterious "chart-room" some printed astronomical tables,
-which tell him in what terrestrial latitude the sun will have
-precisely that height on that particular day of the year. Thus the
-terrestrial latitude becomes known easily enough, and if only the
-captain could get his longitude too, he would know just where his
-ship was that day at noon.
-
-We have seen that the sextant observations furnish the error of
-the chronometer according to ship's time. In other words, the
-captain is in possession of the correct local time in the place
-where the ship actually is. Now, if he also had the correct time
-at that moment of some well-known place on shore, he would know
-the difference in time between that place on shore and the ship.
-But every traveller by land or sea is aware that there are always
-differences of time between different places on the earth. If a
-watch be right on leaving New York, for instance, it will be much
-too fast on arriving at Chicago or San Francisco; the farther you
-go the larger becomes the error of your watch. In fact, if you
-could find out how much your watch had gone into error, you would
-in a sense know how far east or west you had travelled.
-
-Now the captain's chronometer is set to correct "Greenwich time"
-on shore before the ship leaves port. His observations having then
-told him how much this is wrong on that particular day, and in
-that particular spot where the ship is, he knows at once just how
-far he has travelled east or west from Greenwich. In other words,
-he knows his "longitude from Greenwich," for longitude is nothing
-more than distance from Greenwich in an east-and-west direction,
-just as latitude is only distance from the equator measured in
-a north-and-south direction. Greenwich observatory is usually
-selected as the beginning of things for measuring longitudes,
-because it is almost the oldest of existing astronomical
-establishments, and belongs to the most prominent maritime nation,
-England.
-
-One of the most interesting bits of astronomical history was
-enacted in connection with this matter of longitude. From what has
-been said, it is clear that the ship's longitude will be obtained
-correctly only if the chronometer has kept exact time since the
-departure of the ship from port. Even a very small error of the
-chronometer will throw out the longitude a good many miles, and we
-can understand readily that it must be difficult in the extreme to
-construct a mechanical contrivance capable of keeping exact time
-when subjected to the rolling and pitching of a vessel at sea.
-
-It was as recently as the year 1736 that the first instrument
-capable of keeping anything like accurate time at sea was
-successfully completed. It was the work of an English watchmaker
-named John Harrison, and is one of the few great improvements in
-matters scientific which the world owes to a desire for winning a
-money prize. It appears that in 1714 a committee was appointed by
-the House of Commons, with no less a person than Sir Isaac Newton
-himself as one of its members, to consider the desirability of
-offering governmental encouragement for the invention of some means
-of finding the longitude at sea. Finally, the British Government
-offered a reward of $50,000 for an instrument which would find
-the longitude within sixty miles; $75,000, if within forty miles,
-and $100,000, if within thirty miles. Harrison's chronometer was
-finished in 1736, but he did not receive the final payment of his
-prize until 1764.
-
-We shall not enter into a detailed account of the vexatious delays
-and official procedures to which he was forced to submit during
-those twenty-eight long years. It is a matter of satisfaction that
-Harrison lived to receive the money which he had earned. He had the
-genius to plan and master intricate mechanical details, but perhaps
-he lacked in some degree the ability of tongue and pen to bring
-them home to others. This may be the reason he is so little known,
-though it was his fortune to contribute so large and essential
-a part to the perfection of modern navigation. Let us hope this
-brief mention may serve to recall his memory from oblivion even for
-a fleeting moment; that we may not have written in vain of that
-longitude to which his life was given.
-
-
-
-
-THE PLEIADES
-
-
-Famed in legend; sung by early minstrels of Persia and Hindustan;
-
- "--like a swarm of fire-flies tangled in a silver braid";
-
-yonder distant misty little cloud of Pleiades has always won
-and held the imagination of men. But it was not only for the
-inspiration of poets, for quickening fancy into song, that the
-seven daughters of Atlas were fixed upon the firmament. The
-problems presented by this group of stars to the unobtrusive
-scientific investigator are among the most interesting known to
-astronomy. Their solution is still very incomplete, but what we
-have already learned may be counted justly among the richest spoils
-brought back by science from the stored treasure-house of Nature's
-secrets.
-
-The true student of astronomy is animated by no mere vulgar
-curiosity to pry into things hidden. If he seeks the concealed
-springs that move the complex visible mechanism of the heavens, he
-does so because his imagination is roused by the grandeur of what
-he sees; and deep down within him stirs the true love of the artist
-for his art. For it is indeed a fine art, that science of astronomy.
-
-It can have been no mere chance that has massed the Pleiades
-from among their fellow stars. Men of ordinary eyesight see but
-a half-dozen distinct objects in the cluster; those of acuter
-vision can count fourteen; but it is not until we apply the
-space-penetrating power of the telescope that we realize the
-extraordinary scale upon which the system of the Pleiades is
-constructed. With the Paris instrument Wolf in 1876 catalogued 625
-stars in the group; and the searching photographic survey of Henry
-in 1887 revealed no less than 2,326 distinct stars within and near
-the filmy gauze of nebulous matter always so conspicuous a feature
-of the Pleiades.
-
-The means at our disposal for the study of stellar distances are
-but feeble. Only in the case of a very small number of stars have
-we been able to obtain even so much as an approximate estimate
-of distance. The most powerful observational machinery, though
-directed by the tried skill of experience, has not sufficed to
-sound the profounder depths of space. The Pleiad stars are among
-those for which no measurement of distance has yet been made, so
-that we do not know whether they are all equally far away from
-us. We see them projected on the dark background of the celestial
-vault; but we cannot tell from actual measurement whether they are
-all situated near the same point in space. It may be that some
-are immeasurably closer to us than are the great mass of their
-companions; possibly we look through the cluster at others far
-behind it, clinging, as it were, to the very fringe of the visible
-universe.
-
-Farther on we shall find evidence that something like this really
-is the case. But under no circumstances is it reasonable to suppose
-that the whole body of stars can be strung out at all sorts of
-distances near a straight line pointing in the direction of the
-visible cluster. Such a distribution may perhaps remain among the
-possibilities, so long as we cannot measure directly the actual
-distances of the individual stars. But science never accepts a mere
-possibility against which we can marshal strong circumstantial
-evidence. We may conclude on general principles that the gathering
-of these many objects into a single close assemblage denotes
-community of origin and interests.
-
-The Pleiades then really belong to one another. What is the nature
-of their mutual tie? What is their mystery, and can we solve it?
-The most obvious theory is, of course, suggested by what we know
-to be true within our own solar system. We owe to Newton the
-beautiful conception of gravitation, that unique law by means of
-which astronomers have been enabled to reduce to perfect order the
-seeming tangle of planetary evolutions. The law really amounts, in
-effect, to this: All objects suspended within the vacancy of space
-attract or pull one another. How they can do this without a visible
-connecting link between them is a mystery which may always remain
-unsolved. But mystery as it is, we must accept it as an ascertained
-fact. It is this pull of gravitation that holds together the sun
-and planets, forcing them all to follow out their due and proper
-paths, and so to continue throughout an unbroken cycle until the
-great survivor, Time, shall be no more.
-
-This same gravitational attraction must be at work among the
-Pleiades. They, too, like ourselves, must have bounds and orbits
-set and interwoven, revolutions and gyrations far more complex
-than the solar system knows. The visual discovery of such motion
-of rotation among the Pleiades may be called one of the pressing
-problems of astronomy to-day. We feel sure that the time is ripe,
-and that the discovery is actually being made at the present
-moment: for a generation of men is not too great a period to call a
-moment, when we have to deal with cosmic time.
-
-It is indeed the lack of observations extending through sufficient
-centuries that stays our hand from grasping the coveted result. The
-Pleiades are so far from us that we cannot be sure of changes among
-them. Magnitudes are always relative. It matters not how large the
-actual movements may be; if they are extremely small in comparison
-with our distance, they must shrink to nothingness in our eyes.
-Trembling on the verge of invisibility, elusive, they are in that
-borderland where science as yet but feels her way, though certain
-that the way is there.
-
-The foundations of exact modern knowledge of the group were laid
-by Bessel about 1840. With the modesty characteristic of the
-great, he says quite simply that he has made a number of measures
-of the Pleiades, thinking that the time may come when astronomers
-will be able to find some evidence of motion. In this unassuming
-way he prefaces what is still the classic model of precision and
-thoroughness in work of this kind. Bessel cleared the ground for a
-study of inter-stellar motion within the close star-clusters; and
-it is probable that only by such study may we hope to demonstrate
-the universality of the law of gravitation in cosmic space.
-
-Bessel's acuteness in forecasting the direction of coming research
-was amply verified by the work of Elkin in 1885 at Yale College.
-Provided with a more modern instrument, but similar to Bessel's,
-Elkin was able to repeat his observations with a slight increase
-of precision. Motions in the interval of forty-five years,
-sufficiently great to hint at coming possibilities, were shown
-conclusively to exist. Six stars at all events have been fairly
-excluded from the group on account of their peculiar motions shown
-by Elkin's research. It is possible that they are merely seen in
-the background through the interstices of the cluster itself,
-or they may be suspended between us and the Pleiades, in either
-case having no real connection with the group. Finally, these
-observations make it reasonably certain that many of the remaining
-mass of stars really constitute a unit aggregation in space.
-Astronomers of a coming generation will again repeat the Besselian
-work. At present we have been able to use his method only for the
-separation from the true Pleiades of chance stars that happen to
-lie in the same direction. Let us hope that man shall exist long
-enough upon this earth to see the clustered stars themselves begin
-and carry out such gyrations as gravitation imposes.
-
-These will doubtless be of a kind not even suggested by the
-lesser complexities of our solar system. For the most wonderful
-thing of all about the Pleiades seems to point to an intricacy of
-structure whose details may be destined to shake the confidence of
-the profoundest mathematician. There is an extraordinary nebulous
-condensation that seems to pervade the entire space occupied by
-the stellar constituents of the group. The stars are swimming in a
-veritable sea of luminous cloud. There are filmy tenuous places,
-and again condensing whirls of material doubtless still in the
-gaseous or plastic stage. Most noticeable of all are certain almost
-straight lines of nebula that connect series of stars. In one case,
-shown upon a photograph made by Henry at Paris, six stars are
-strung out upon such a hazy line. We might give play to fancy, and
-see in this the result of some vast eruption of gaseous matter that
-has already begun to solidify here and there into stellar nuclei.
-But sound science gives not too great freedom to mere speculative
-theories. Her duty has been found in quiet research, and her
-greatest rewards have flowed from imaginative speculation, only
-when tempered by pure reason.
-
-
-
-
-THE POLE-STAR
-
-
-One of the most brilliant observations of the last few years
-is Campbell's recent discovery of the triple character of this
-star. Centuries and centuries ago, when astronomy, that venerable
-ancient among the sciences, was but an infant, the pole-star must
-have been considered the very oldest of observed heavenly bodies.
-In the beginning it was the only sure guide of the navigator at
-night, just as to this day it is the foundation-stone for all
-observational stellar astronomy of precision. There has never been
-a time in the history of astronomy when the pole-star might not
-have been called the most frequently measured object in the sky of
-night. So it is indeed strange that we should find out something
-altogether new about it after all these ages of study.
-
-But the importance of the discovery rests upon a surer foundation
-than this. The method by which it has been made is almost a new
-one in the science. A generation ago, men thought the "perfect
-science," for so we love to call astronomy, could advance only by
-increasing a little the exact precision of observation. The citadel
-of perfect truth might be more closely invested; the forces of
-science might push forward step by step; the machinery of research
-might be strengthened, but that a new engine of investigation
-would be discovered capable of penetrating where no telescope can
-ever reach, this, indeed, seemed far beyond the liveliest hope
-of science. Even the discoverer of the spectroscope could never
-have dreamed of its possibilities, could never have foreseen its
-successes, its triumphs.
-
-The very name of this instrument suggests mystery to the popular
-mind. It is set down at once among the things too difficult, too
-intricate, too abstruse to understand. Yet in its essentials there
-is nothing about the spectroscope that cannot be made clear in a
-few words. Even the modern "undulatory theory" of light itself is
-terrible only in the length of its name. Anyone who has seen the
-waves of ocean roll, roll, and ever again roll in upon the shore,
-can form a very good notion of how light moves. 'Tis just such
-a series of rolling waves; started perhaps from some brilliant
-constellation far out upon the confining bounds of the visible
-universe, or perhaps coming from a humble light upon the student's
-table; yet it is never anything but a succession of rolling waves.
-Only, unlike the waves of the sea, light waves are all excessively
-small. We should call one whose length was a twenty-thousandth of
-an inch a big one!
-
-Now the human eye possesses the property of receiving and
-understanding these little waves. The process is an unconscious
-one. Let but a set of these tiny waves roll up, as it were, out
-of the vast ocean of space and impinge upon the eye, and all the
-phenomena of light and color become what we call "visible." We see
-the light.
-
-And how does all this find an application in astronomy? Not
-to enter too much into technical details, we may say that the
-spectroscope is an instrument which enables us to measure the
-length of these light waves, though their length is so exceedingly
-small. The day has indeed gone by when that which poets love to
-call the Book of Nature was printed in type that could be read
-by the eye unaided. Telescope, microscope, and spectroscope are
-essential now to him who would penetrate any of Nature's secrets.
-But measurements with a telescope, like eye observations, are
-limited strictly to determining the directions in which we see
-the heavenly bodies. Ever since the beginning of things, when
-old Hipparchus and Ulugh Beg made the first rude but successful
-attempts to catalogue the stars, the eye and telescope have been
-able to measure only such directions. We aim the telescope at a
-star, and record the direction in which it was pointed. Distances
-in astronomy can never be measured directly. All that we know of
-them has been obtained by calculations based upon the Newtonian law
-of gravitation and observations of directions.
-
-Now the spectroscope seems to offer a sort of exception to this
-rule. Suppose we can measure the wave-lengths of the light sent us
-from a star. Suppose again that the star is itself moving swiftly
-toward us through space, while continually setting in motion the
-waves of light that are ultimately to reach the waiting astronomer.
-Evidently the light waves will be crowded together somewhat on
-account of the star's motion. More waves per second will reach us
-than would be received from a star at rest. It is as though the
-light waves were compressed or shortened a little. And if the star
-is leaving us, instead of coming nearer, opposite effects will
-occur. We have then but to compare spectroscopically starlight with
-some artificial source of light in the observatory in order to find
-out whether the star is approaching us or receding from us. And by
-a simple process of calculation this stellar motion can be obtained
-in miles per second. Thus we can now actually measure directly, in
-a certain sense, linear speed in stellar space, though we are still
-without the means of getting directly at stellar distances.
-
-But the most wonderful thing of all about these spectroscopic
-measures is the fact that it makes no difference whatever how far
-away is the star under observation. What we learn through the
-spectroscope comes from a study of the waves themselves, and it
-is of no consequence how far they have travelled, or how long
-they have been a-coming. For it must not be supposed that these
-waves consume no time in passing from a distant star to our own
-solar system. It is true that they move exceeding fast; certainly
-180,000 miles per second may be called rapid motion. But if
-this cosmic velocity of light is tremendous, so also are cosmic
-distances correspondingly vast. Light needs to move quickly coming
-from a star, for even at the rate of motion we have mentioned it
-requires many years to reach us from some of the more distant
-constellations. It has been well said that an observer on some
-far-away star, if endowed with the power to see at any distance,
-however great, might at this moment be looking on the Crusaders
-proceeding from Europe against the Saracen at Jerusalem. For it is
-quite possible that not until now has the light which would make
-the earth visible had time to reach him. Yet distant as such an
-observer might be, light from the star on which he stood could be
-measured in the spectroscope, and would infallibly tell us whether
-the earth and star are approaching in space or gradually drawing
-farther asunder.
-
-The pole-star is not one of the more distant stellar systems. We do
-not know how far it is from us very exactly, but certainly not less
-than forty or fifty years are necessary for its light to reach us.
-The star might have gone out of existence twenty years ago, and we
-not yet know of it, for we would still be receiving the light which
-began its long journey to us about 1850 or 1860. But no matter
-what may be its distance, Campbell found by careful observations,
-made in the latter part of 1896, that the pole-star was then
-approaching the earth at the rate of about twelve miles per second.
-So far there was nothing especially remarkable. But in August and
-September of the present year twenty-six careful determinations
-were made, and these showed that now the rate of approach varied
-between about five and nine miles per second. More astonishing
-still, there was a uniform period in the changes of velocity. In
-about four days the rate of motion changed from about five to
-nine miles and back again. And this variation kept on with great
-regularity. Every successive period of four days saw a complete
-cycle of velocity change forward and back between the same limits.
-There can be but one reasonable explanation. This star must be a
-double, or "binary" star. The two components, under the influence
-of powerful mutual gravitational attraction, must be revolving
-in a mighty orbit. Yet this vast orbit, as a whole, with the two
-great stars in it, must be approaching our part of the universe
-all the time. For the spectroscope shows the velocity of approach
-to increase and diminish, indeed, but it is always present. Here,
-then, is this great stellar system, having a four-day revolution of
-its own, and yet swinging rapidly through space in our direction.
-Nor is this all. One of the component stars must be nearly or
-quite dark; else its presence would infallibly be detected by our
-instruments.
-
-And now we come to the most astonishing thing of all. How comes it
-that the average rate of approach of the "four-day system," as a
-whole, changed between 1896 and 1899? In 1896 only this velocity
-of the whole system was determined, the four-day period remaining
-undiscovered until the more numerous observations of 1899.
-But even without considering the four-day period, the changing
-velocity of the entire system offers one of those problems that
-exact science can treat only by the help of the imagination. There
-must be some other great centre of attraction, some cosmic giant,
-holding the visible double pole-star under its control. Thus, that
-which we see, and call the pole-star, is in reality threading its
-path about the third and greatest member of the system, itself
-situated in space, we know not where.
-
-[Illustration: Spiral Nebula in Constellation Leo.
-
-Photographed by Keeler, February 24, 1900.
-
-Exposure, three hours, fifty minutes.]
-
-
-
-
-NEBULÆ
-
-
-Scattered about here and there among the stars are certain patches
-of faint luminosity called by astronomers Nebulæ. These "little
-clouds" of filmy light are among the most fascinating of all the
-kaleidoscopic phenomena of the heavens; for it needs but a glance
-at one of them to give the impression that here before us is the
-stuff of which worlds are made. All our knowledge of Nature leads
-us to expect in her finished work the result of a series of gradual
-processes of development. Highly organized phenomena such as those
-existing in our solar system did not spring into perfection in
-an instant. Influential forces, easy to imagine, but difficult
-to define, must have directed the slow, sure transformation of
-elemental matter into sun and planets, things and men. Therefore
-a study of those forces and of their probable action upon nebular
-material has always exerted a strong attraction upon the acutest
-thinkers among men of exact science.
-
-Our knowledge of the nebulæ is of two kinds--that which has
-been ascertained from observation as to their appearance, size,
-distribution, and distance; and that which is based upon hypotheses
-and theoretical reasoning about the condensation of stellar systems
-out of nebular masses. It so happens that our observational
-material has received a very important addition quite recently
-through the application of photography to the delineation of
-nebulæ, and this we shall describe farther on.
-
-Two nebulæ only are visible to the unaided eye. The brighter
-of these is in the constellation Andromeda; it is of oval or
-elliptical shape, and has a distinct central condensation or
-nucleus. Upon a photograph by Roberts it appears to have several
-concentric rings surrounding the nebula proper, and gives the
-general impression of a flat round disk foreshortened into an oval
-shape on account of the observer's position not being square to
-the surface of the disk. Very recent photographs of this nebula,
-made with the three-foot reflecting telescope of the Lick
-Observatory, bring out the fact that it is really spiral in form,
-and that the outlying nebulous rings are only parts of the spires
-in a great cosmic whorl.
-
-[Illustration: Nebula in Andromeda.
-
-Lower object in the photograph is a Comet.
-
-Photographed by Barnard, November 21, 1892.]
-
-This Andromeda nebula is the one in which the temporary star of
-1885 appeared. It blazed up quite suddenly near the apparent
-centre of the nebula, and continued in view for six months, fading
-finally beyond the reach of our most powerful telescopes. There
-can be little doubt that the star was actually in the nebula,
-and not merely seen through it, though in reality situated in
-the extreme outlying part of space at a distance immeasurably
-greater than that separating us from the nebula itself. Such an
-accidental superposition of nebula and star might even be due to
-sudden incandescence of a new star between us and the nebula. In
-such a case we should see the star projected upon the surface of
-the nebula, so that the superposition would be identical with that
-actually observed. Therefore, while it is, indeed, possible that
-the star may have been either far behind the nebula or in front of
-it, we must accept as more probable the supposition that there was
-a real connection between the two. In that case there is little
-doubt that we have actually observed one of those cataclysms that
-mark successive steps of cosmic evolution. We have no thoroughly
-satisfactory theory to account for such an explosive catastrophe
-within the body of the nebula itself.
-
-The other naked-eye nebula is in the constellation Orion. In
-the telescope it is a more striking object, perhaps, than the
-Andromeda nebula; for it has no well-defined geometrical form,
-but consists of an immense odd-shaped mass of light enclosing and
-surrounding a number of stars. It is unquestionably of a very
-complicated structure, and is, therefore, less easily studied and
-explained than the nebulæ of simpler form. There is no doubt that
-the Orion nebula is composed of luminous gas, and is not merely a
-cluster of small stars too numerous and too near together to be
-separated from each other, even in our most powerful telescopes.
-It was, indeed, supposed, until about forty years ago, that all
-the nebulæ are simply irresolvable star-clusters; but we now have
-indisputable evidence, derived from the spectroscope, that many
-nebulæ are composed of true gases, similar to those with which
-we experiment in chemical laboratories. This spectroscopic proof
-of the gaseous character of nebulæ is one of the most important
-discoveries contributed by that instrument to our small stock of
-facts concerning the structure of the sidereal universe.
-
-Coming now to the smaller nebulæ, we find a great diversity of
-form and appearance. Some are ring-shaped, perhaps having a
-less brilliant nebulosity within the ring. Many show a central
-condensation of disk-like appearance (planetary nebulæ), or have
-simply a star at the centre (nebulous stars). Altogether about
-ten thousand such objects have been catalogued by successive
-generations of astronomers since the invention of the telescope,
-and most of these have been reported as oval in form. Now we have
-already referred to the important addition to our knowledge of
-the nebulæ obtained by recent photographic observations; and this
-addition consists in the discovery that most of these oval nebulæ
-are in reality spirals. Indeed, it appears that the spiral type is
-the normal type, and that nebulæ of irregular or other forms are
-exceptions to the general rule. Even the great Andromeda nebula, as
-we have seen, is now recognized as a spiral.
-
-The instrument with which its convolute structure was discovered
-is a three-foot reflecting telescope, made by Common of England,
-and now mounted at the Lick Observatory, in California. The late
-Professor Keeler devoted much of his time to photographing nebulæ
-during the last year or two. He was able to establish the important
-fact just mentioned, that most nebulæ formerly thought to be mere
-ovals, turn out to be spiral when brought under the more searching
-scrutiny of the photographic plate applied at the focus of a
-telescope of great size, and with an exposure to the feeble nebular
-light extending through three or four consecutive hours.
-
-Many of the spirals have more than a single volute. It is as though
-one were to attach a number of very flexible rods to an axle,
-like spokes of a wheel without a rim and then revolve the axle
-rapidly. The flexible rods would bend under the rapid rotation, and
-form a series of spiral curves not unlike many of these nebulæ.
-Indeed, it is impossible to escape the conviction that these great
-celestial whorls are whirling around an axis. And it is most
-important in the study of the growth of worlds, to recognize that
-the type specimen is a revolving spiral. Therefore, the rotating
-flattened globe of incandescent matter postulated by Laplace's
-nebular hypothesis would make of our solar system an exceptional
-world, and not a type of stellar evolution in general.
-
-Keeler's photographs have taught us one thing more. Scarcely is
-there a single one of his negatives that does not show nebulæ
-previously uncatalogued. It is estimated that if this process of
-photography could be extended so as to cover the entire sky, the
-whole number of nebulæ would add up to the stupendous total of
-120,000; and of these the great majority would be spiral.
-
-When we approach the question of the distribution of nebulæ in
-different parts of the sky, as shown by their catalogued positions,
-we are met by a curious fact. It appears that the region in the
-neighborhood of the Milky Way is especially poor in nebulæ,
-whereas these objects seem to cluster in much larger numbers about
-those points in the sky that are farthest from the Milky Way.
-But we know that the Milky Way is richer in stars than any other
-part of the sky, since it is, in fact, made up of stellar bodies
-clustered so closely that it is wellnigh impossible to see between
-them in the denser portions. Now, it cannot be the result of chance
-that the stars should tend to congregate in the Milky Way, while
-the nebulæ tend to seek a position as far from it as possible.
-Whatever may be the cause, we must conclude that the sidereal
-system, as we see it, is in general constructed upon a single plan,
-and does not consist of a series of universes scattered at random
-throughout space. If we are to suppose that nebulæ turn into stars
-as a result of condensation or any other change, then it is not
-astonishing to find a minimum of nebulæ where there is a maximum of
-stars, since the nebulæ will have been consumed, as it were, in the
-formation of the stars.
-
-[Illustration: The "Dumb-Bell" Nebula.
-
-Photographed by Keeler, July 31, 1899.
-
-Exposure, three hours.]
-
-It is never advisable to push philosophical speculation very
-far when supported by too slender a basis of fact. But if we
-are to regard the visible universe as made up on the whole of a
-single system of bodies, we may well ask one or two questions to
-be answered by speculative theory. We have said the stars are not
-uniformly distributed in space. Their concentration in the Milky
-Way, forming a narrow band dividing the sky into two very nearly
-equal parts, must be due to their being actually massed in a
-thin disk or ring of space within which our solar system is also
-situated. This thin disk projected upon the sky would then appear
-as the narrow star-band of the Milky Way. Now, suppose this disk
-has an axis perpendicular to itself, and let us imagine a rotation
-of the whole sidereal system about that axis. Then the fact that
-the visible nebulæ are congregated far from the Milky Way means
-that they are actually near the imaginary axis.
-
-Possibly the diminished velocity of motion near the axis may have
-something to do with the presence of the nebulæ there. Possibly
-the nebulæ themselves have axes perpendicular to the plane of
-the Milky Way. If so, we should see the spiral nebulæ near the
-Milky Way edgewise, and those far from it without foreshortening.
-Thus, the paucity of nebulæ near the Milky Way may be due in
-part to the increased difficulty of seeing them when looked at
-edgewise. Indeed, there is no limit to the possibilities of
-hypothetical reasoning about the nebular structure of our universe;
-unfortunately, the whole question must be placed for the present
-among those intensely interesting cosmic problems awaiting
-elucidation, let us hope, in this new century.
-
-
-
-
-TEMPORARY STARS
-
-
-Nothing can be more erroneous than to suppose that the stellar
-multitude has continued unchanged throughout all generations of
-men. "Eternal fires" poets have called the stars; yet they burn
-like any little conflagration on the earth; now flashing with
-energy, brilliant, incandescent, and again sinking into the dull
-glow of smouldering half-burned ashes. It is even probable that
-space contains many darkened orbs, stars that may have risen in
-constellations to adorn the skies of prehistoric time--now cold,
-unseen, unknown. So far from dealing with an unvarying universe,
-it is safe to say that sidereal astronomy can advance only by the
-discovery of change. Observational science watches with untiring
-industry, and night hides few celestial events from the ardent
-scrutiny of astronomers. Old theories are tested and newer ones
-often perfected by the detection of some slight and previously
-unsuspected alteration upon the face of the sky. The interpretation
-of such changes is the most difficult task of science; it has taxed
-the acutest intellects among men throughout all time.
-
-If, then, changes can be seen among the stars, what are we to think
-of the most important change of all, the blazing into life of a
-new stellar system? Fifteen times since men began to write their
-records of the skies has the birth of a star been seen. Surely
-we may use this term when we speak of the sudden appearance of a
-brilliant luminary where nothing visible existed before. But we
-shall see further on that scientific considerations make it highly
-probable that the phenomenon in question does not really involve
-the creation of new matter. It is old material becoming suddenly
-luminous for some hidden reason. In fact, whenever a new object of
-great brilliancy has been discovered, it has been found to lose its
-light again quite soon, ending either in total extinction or at
-least in comparative darkness. It is for this reason that the name
-"temporary star" has been applied to cases of this kind.
-
-The first authenticated instance dates from the year 134 B.C.,
-when a new star appeared in the constellation Scorpio. It was this
-star that led Hipparchus to construct his stellar catalogue, the
-first ever made. It occurred to him, of course, that there could
-be but one way to make sure in the future that any given object
-discovered in the sky was new; it was necessary to make a complete
-list of everything visible in his day. Later astronomers need then
-only compare Hipparchus's catalogue with the heavens from time to
-time in order to find out whether anything unknown had appeared.
-This work of Hipparchus became the foundation of sidereal study,
-and led to most important discoveries of various kinds.
-
-But no records remain concerning his new star except the bare fact
-of its appearance in Scorpio. Hipparchus's published works are all
-lost. We do not even know the exact place of his birth, and as for
-those two dates of entry and exit that history attaches to great
-names--we have them not. Yet he was easily the first astronomer of
-antiquity, one of the first of all time; and we know of him only
-from the writings of Ptolemy, who lived three hundred years after
-him.
-
-More than five centuries elapsed before another temporary star was
-entered in the records of astronomy. This happened in the year 389
-A.D., when a star appeared in Aquila; and of this one also we know
-nothing further. But about twelve centuries later, in November,
-1572, a new and brilliant object was found in the constellation
-Cassiopeia. It is known as Tycho's star, since it was the means
-of winning for astronomy a man who will always take high rank in
-her annals, Tycho Brahe, of Denmark. When he first saw this star,
-it was already very bright, equalling even Venus at her best; and
-he continued a careful series of observations for sixteen months,
-when it faded finally from his view. The position of the new star
-was measured with reference to other stars in the constellation
-Cassiopeia, and the results of Tycho's observations were finally
-published by him in the year 1573. It appears that much urging on
-the part of friends was necessary to induce him to consent to this
-publication, not because of a modest reluctance to rush into print,
-but for the reason that he considered it undignified for a nobleman
-of Denmark to be the author of a book!
-
-An important question in cosmic astronomy is opened by Tycho's
-star. Did it really disappear from the heavens when he saw it
-no more, or had its lustre simply been reduced below the visual
-power of the unaided eye? Unfortunately, Tycho's observations of
-the star's position in the constellation were necessarily crude.
-He possessed no instruments of precision such as we now have
-at our disposal, and so his work gives us only a rather rough
-approximation of the true place of the star. A small circle might
-be imagined on the sky of a size comparable with the possible
-errors of Tycho's observations. We could then say with certainty
-that his star must have been situated somewhere within that little
-circle, but it is impossible to know exactly where.
-
-It happens that our modern telescopes reveal the existence of
-several faint stars within the space covered by such a circle.
-Any one of these would have been too small for Tycho to see, and,
-therefore, any one of them may be his once brilliant luminary
-reduced to a state of permanent or temporary semi-darkness. These
-considerations are, indeed, of great importance in explaining the
-phenomena of temporary stars. If Tycho had been able to leave us a
-more exact determination of his star's place in the sky, and even
-if our most powerful instruments could not show anything in that
-place to-day, we might nevertheless theorize on the supposition
-that the object still exists, but has reached a condition almost
-entirely dark.
-
-Indeed, the latest theory classes temporary stars among those known
-as variable. For many stars are known to undergo quite decided
-changes in brilliancy; possibly inconstancy of light is the rule
-rather than the exception. But while such changes, when they
-exist, are too small to be perceptible in most cases, there is
-certainly a large number of observable variables, subject to easily
-measurable alterations of light. Astronomers prefer to see in the
-phenomena of temporary stars simple cases of variation in which the
-increase of light is sudden, and followed by a gradual diminution.
-Possibly there is then a long period of comparative or even
-complete darkness, to be followed as before by a sudden blazing up
-and extinction. No temporary star, however, has been observed to
-reappear in the same celestial place where once had glowed its
-sudden outburst. But cases are not wanting where incandescence has
-been both preceded and followed by a continued existence, visible
-though not brilliant.
-
-For such cases as these it is necessary to come down to modern
-records. We cannot be sure that some faint star has been
-temporarily brilliant, unless we actually see the conflagration
-itself, or are able to make the identity of the object's precise
-location in the sky before and after the event perfectly certain
-by the aid of modern instruments of precision. But no one has
-ever seen the smouldering fires break out. Temporary stars have
-always been first noticed only after having been active for hours
-if not for days. So we must perforce fall back on instrumental
-identification by determinations of the star's exact position upon
-the celestial vault.
-
-Some time between May 10th and 12th in the year 1866 the ninth star
-in the list of known "temporaries" appeared. It possessed very
-great light-giving power, being surpassed in brilliancy by only
-about a score of stars in all the heavens. It retained a maximum
-luminosity only three or four days, and in less than two months
-had diminished to a point somewhere between the ninth and tenth
-"magnitudes." In other words, from a conspicuous star, visible to
-the naked eye, it had passed beyond the power of anything less than
-a good telescope. Fortunately, we had excellent star-catalogues
-before 1866. These were at once searched, and it was possible to
-settle quite definitely that a star of about the ninth or tenth
-magnitude had really existed before 1866 at precisely the same
-point occupied by the new one. Needless to say, observations were
-made of the new star itself, and afterward compared with later
-observations of the faint one that still occupies its place. These
-render quite certain the identity of the temporary bright star with
-the faint ones that preceded and followed it.
-
-Such results, on the one hand, offer an excellent vindication
-of the painstaking labor expended on the construction of
-star-catalogues, and, on the other, serve to elucidate the mystery
-of temporary stars. Nothing can be more plausible than to explain
-by analogy those cases in which no previous or subsequent existence
-has been observed. It is merely necessary to suppose that, instead
-of varying from the ninth or tenth magnitude, other temporary
-objects have begun and ended with the twentieth; for the twentieth
-magnitude would be beyond the power of our best instruments.
-
-Nor is the star of 1866 an isolated instance. Ten years later, in
-1876, a temporary star blazed up to about the second magnitude, and
-returned to invisibility, so far as the naked eye is concerned,
-within a month, having retained its greatest brilliancy only one
-or two days. This star is still visible as a tiny point of light,
-estimated to be of the fifteenth magnitude. Whether it existed
-prior to its sudden outburst can never be known, because we do not
-possess catalogues including the generality of stars as faint as
-this one must have been. But at all events, the continued existence
-of the object helps to place the temporary stars in the class of
-variables.
-
-The next star, already mentioned under "nebula," was first seen
-in 1885. It was in one respect the most remarkable of all, for
-it appeared almost in the centre of the great nebula in the
-constellation Andromeda. It was never very bright, reaching only
-the sixth magnitude or thereabouts, was observed during a period of
-only six months, and at the end of that time had faded beyond the
-reach of our most powerful glasses. It is a most impressive fact
-that this event occurred within the nebula. Whatever may be the
-nature of the explosive catastrophe to which the temporary stars
-owe their origin, we can now say with certainty that not even those
-vast elemental luminous clouds men call nebulæ are free from danger.
-
-The last outburst on our records was first noticed February 22,
-1901. The star appeared in the constellation Perseus, and soon
-reached the first magnitude, surpassing almost every other star
-in the sky. It has been especially remarkable in that it has
-become surrounded by a nebulous mass in which are several bright
-condensations or nuclei; and these seem to be in very rapid motion.
-The star is still under observation (January, 1902).
-
-
-
-
-GALILEO
-
-
-Among the figures that stand out sharply upon the dim background
-of old-time science, there is none that excites a keener interest
-than Galileo. Most people know him only as a distinguished man
-of learning; one who carried on a vigorous controversy with the
-Church on matters scientific. It requires some little study, some
-careful reading between the lines of astronomical history, to gain
-acquaintance with the man himself. He had a brilliant, incisive
-wit; was a genuine humorist; knew well and loved the amusing side
-of things; and could not often forego a sarcastic pleasantry, or
-deny himself the pleasure of argument. Yet it is more than doubtful
-if he ever intended impertinence, or gave willingly any cause of
-quarrel to the Church.
-
-His acute understanding must have seen that there exists no real
-conflict between science and religion; for time, in passing, has
-made common knowledge of this truth, as it has of many things once
-hidden. When we consider events that occurred three centuries
-ago, it is easy to replace excited argument with cool judgment;
-to remember that those were days of violence and cruelty; that
-public ignorance was of a density difficult to imagine to-day;
-and that it was universally considered the duty of the Church to
-assume an authoritative attitude upon many questions with which she
-is not now required to concern herself in the least. Charlatans,
-unbalanced theorists, purveyors of scientific marvels, were all
-liable to be passed upon definitely by the Church, not in a spirit
-of impertinent interference, but simply as part of her regular
-duties.
-
-If the Church's judgment in such matters was sometimes erroneous;
-if her interference now and again was cruel, the cause must be
-sought in the manners and customs of the time, when persecution
-rioted in company with ignorance, and violence was the law. Perhaps
-even to-day it would not be amiss to have a modern scientific board
-pass authoritatively upon novel discoveries and inventions, so as
-to protect the public against impostors as the Church tried to do
-of old.
-
-Galileo was born at Pisa in 1564, and his long life lasted
-until 1642, the very year of Newton's birth. His most important
-scientific discoveries may be summed up in a few words; he was the
-first to use a telescope for examining the heavenly bodies; he
-discovered mountains on the moon; the satellites of Jupiter; the
-peculiar appearance of Saturn which Huygens afterward explained as
-a ring surrounding the ball of the planet; and, finally, he found
-black spots on the sun's disk. These discoveries, together with his
-remarkable researches in mechanical science, constitute Galileo's
-claim to immortality as an investigator. But, as we have said, it
-is not our intention to consider his work as a series of scientific
-discoveries. We shall take a more interesting point of view, and
-deal with him rather as a human being who had contracted the habit
-of making scientific researches.
-
-What must have been his feelings when he first found with his "new"
-telescope the satellites of Jupiter? They were seen on the night
-of January 7, 1610. He had already viewed the planet through his
-earlier and less powerful glass, and was aware that it possessed
-a round disk like the moon, only smaller. Now he saw also three
-objects that he took to be little stars near the planet. But on the
-following night, as he says, "drawn by what fate I know not," the
-tube was again turned upon the planet. The three small stars had
-changed their positions, and were now all situated to the west of
-Jupiter, whereas on the previous night two had been on the eastern
-side. He could not explain this phenomenon, but he recognized that
-there was something peculiar at work. Long afterward, in one of
-his later works, translated into quaint old English by Salusbury,
-he declared that "one sole experiment sufficeth to batter to the
-ground a thousand probable Arguments." This was already the guiding
-principle of his scientific activity, a principle of incomparable
-importance, and generally credited to Bacon. Needless to say,
-Jupiter was now examined every night.
-
-The 9th was cloudy, but on the 10th he again saw his little stars,
-their number now reduced to two. He guessed that the third was
-behind the planet's disk. The position of the two visible ones was
-altogether different from either of the previous observations. On
-the 11th he became sure that what he saw was really a series of
-satellites accompanying Jupiter on his journey through space, and
-at the same time revolving around him. On the 12th, at 3 A.M.,
-he actually saw one of the small objects emerge from behind the
-planet; and on the 13th he finally saw four satellites. Two hundred
-and eighty-two years were destined to pass away before any human
-eye should see a fifth. It was Barnard in 1892 who followed Galileo.
-
-To understand the effect of this discovery upon Galileo requires
-a person who has himself watched the stars, not, as a dilettante,
-seeking recreation or amusement, but with that deep reverence
-that comes only to him who feels--nay, knows--that in the moment
-of observation just passed he too has added his mite to the great
-fund of human knowledge. Galileo's mummied forefinger still points
-toward the stars from its little pedestal of wood in the _Museo_
-at Florence, a sign to all men that he is unforgotten. But Galileo
-knew on that 11th of January, 1610, that the memory of him would
-never fade; that the very music of the spheres would thenceforward
-be attuned to a truer note, if any would but hearken to the Jovian
-harmony. For he recognized at once that the visible revolution of
-these moons around Jupiter, while that planet was himself visibly
-travelling through space, must deal its death-blow to the old
-Ptolemaic system of the universe. Here was a great planet, the
-centre of a system of satellites, and yet not the centre of the
-universe. Surely, then, the earth, too, might be a mere planet like
-Jupiter, and not the supposed motionless centre of all things.
-
-The satellite discovery was published in 1610 in a little book
-called "Sidereus Nuncius," usually translated "The Sidereal
-Messenger." It seems to us, however, that the word "messenger" is
-not strong enough; surely in Papal Italy a _nuncius_ was more than
-a mere messenger. He was clothed with the very highest authority,
-and we think it probable that Galileo's choice of this word in
-the title of his book means that he claimed for himself similar
-authority in science. At all events, the book made him at once a
-great reputation and numerous enemies.
-
-But it was not until 1616 that the Holy Office (Inquisition) issued
-an edict ordering Galileo to abandon his opinion that the earth
-moved, and at the same time placed Copernicus's _De Revolutionibus_
-and two other books advocating that doctrine on the "Index Librorum
-Prohibitorum," or list of books forbidden by the Church. These
-volumes remained in subsequent editions of the "Index" down to
-1821, but they no longer appear in the edition in force to-day.
-
-Galileo's most characteristic work is entitled the "Dialogue on the
-Two Chief Systems of the World." It was not published until 1632,
-although the idea of the book was conceived many years earlier.
-In it he gave full play to his extraordinary powers as a true
-humorist, a _fine lame_ among controversialists, and a genuine man
-of science, valuing naked truth above all other things. As may
-be imagined, it was no small matter to obtain the authorities'
-consent to this publication. Galileo was already known to hold
-heretical opinions, and it was suspected that he had not laid them
-aside when commanded to do so by the edict of 1616. But perhaps
-Galileo's introduction to the "Dialogue" secured the censor's
-_imprimatur_; it is even suspected that the Roman authorities
-helped in the preparation of this introduction. Fortunately, we
-have a delightful contemporary translation into English, by Thomas
-Salusbury, printed at London by Leybourne in 1661. We have already
-quoted from this translation, and now add from the same work part
-of Galileo's masterly preface to the "Dialogue":
-
-"Judicious reader, there was published some years since in _Rome_
-a salutiferous Edict, that, for the obviating of the dangerous
-Scandals of the Present Age, imposed a reasonable Silence upon the
-Pythagorean (Copernican) opinion of the Mobility of the Earth.
-There want not such as unadvisedly affirm, that the Decree was not
-the production of a sober Scrutiny, but of an ill-formed passion;
-and one may hear some mutter that Consultors altogether ignorant
-of Astronomical observations ought not to clipp the wings of
-speculative wits with rash prohibitions."
-
-Galileo first states his own views, and then pretends that he will
-oppose them. He goes on to say that he believes in the earth's
-immobility, and takes "the contrary only for a mathematical
-_Capriccio_," as he calls it; something to be considered, because
-possessing an academical interest, but on no account having a real
-existence. Of course any one (even a censor) ought to be able to
-see that it is the Capriccio, and not its opposite, that Galileo
-really advocates. Three persons appear in the "Dialogue": Salviati,
-who believes in the Copernican system; Simplicio, of suggestive
-name, who thinks the earth cannot move; and, finally, Sagredus,
-a neutral gentleman of humorous propensities, who usually begins
-by opposing Salviati, but ends by being convinced. He then helps
-to punish poor Simplicio, who is one of those persons apparently
-incapable of comprehending a reasonable argument. Here is an
-interesting specimen of the "Dialogue" taken from Salusbury's
-translation: Salviati refers to the argument, then well known, that
-the earth cannot rotate on its axis, "because of the impossibility
-of its moving long without wearinesse." Sagredus replies: "There
-are some kinds of animals which refresh themselves after wearinesse
-by rowling on the earth; and that therefore there is no need
-to fear that the Terrestrial Globe should tire, nay, it may be
-reasonably affirmed that it enjoyeth a perpetual and most tranquil
-repose, keeping itself in an eternal rowling." Salviati's comment
-on this sally is, "You are too tart and satyrical, Sagredus."
-
-There is no doubt that the "Dialogue" finished the Ptolemaic
-theory, and made that of Copernicus the only possible one. At
-all events, it brought about the well-known attack upon Galileo
-from the authorities of the Holy Office. We shall not recount
-the often-told tale of his recantation. He was convicted (very
-rightly) of being a Copernican, and was forced to abjure that
-doctrine. Galileo's life may be summed up as one of those through
-which the world has been made richer. A clean-cutting analytic
-wit, never becoming dull: heated again and again in the fierce
-blaze of controversy, it was allowed to cool only that it might
-acquire a finer temper, to pierce with fatal certainty the smallest
-imperfections in the armor of his adversaries.
-
-
-
-
-THE PLANET OF 1898
-
-
-The discovery of a new and important planet usually receives
-more immediate popular attention and applause than any other
-astronomical event. Philosophers are fond of referring to our
-solar system as a mere atom among the countless universes that
-seem to be suspended within the profound depths of space. They are
-wont to point out that this solar system, small and insignificant
-as a whole in comparison with many of the stellar worlds, is,
-nevertheless, made up of a large number of constituent planets; and
-these in turn are often accompanied with still smaller satellites,
-or moons. Thus does Nature provide worlds within worlds, and it is
-not surprising that public attention should be at once attracted
-by any new member of our sun's own special family of planets. The
-ancients were acquainted with only five of the bodies now counted
-as planets, viz.: Mercury, Venus, Mars, Jupiter, and Saturn. The
-dates of their discovery are lost in antiquity. To these Uranus was
-added in 1781 by a brilliant effort of the elder Herschel. We are
-told that intense popular excitement followed the announcement of
-Herschel's first observation: he was knighted and otherwise honored
-by the English King, and was enabled to lay a secure foundation for
-the future distinguished astronomical reputation of his family.
-
-Herschel's discovery quickened the restless activity of
-astronomers. Persistent efforts were made to sift the heavens
-more and more closely, with the strengthened hope of adding still
-further to our planetary knowledge. An association of twenty-four
-enthusiastic German astronomers was formed for the express purpose
-of hunting planets. But it fell to the lot of an Italian, Piazzi,
-of Palermo, to find the first of that series of small bodies now
-known as the asteroids or minor planets. He made the discovery at
-the very beginning of our century, January 1, 1801.
-
-But news travelled slowly in those days, and it was not until
-nearly April that the German observers heard from Piazzi. In the
-meantime, he had himself been prevented by illness from continuing
-his observations. Unfortunately, the planet had by this time moved
-so near the sun, on account of its own motions and those of the
-earth, that it could no longer be observed. The bright light of
-the sun made observations of the new body impossible; and it was
-feared that, owing to lack of knowledge of the planet's orbit,
-astronomers would be unable to trace it. So there seemed, indeed,
-to be danger of an almost irreparable loss to science. But in
-scientific, as in other human emergencies, someone always appears
-at the proper moment. A very young mathematician at Göttingen,
-named Gauss, attacked the problem, and was able to devise a method
-of predicting the future course of the planet on the sky, using
-only the few observations made by Piazzi himself. Up to that time
-no one had attempted to compute a planetary orbit, unless he had
-at his disposal a series of observations extending throughout the
-whole period of the planet's revolution around the sun. But the
-Piazzi planet offered a new problem in astronomy. It had become
-imperatively necessary to obtain an orbit from a few observations
-made at nearly the same date. Gauss's work was signally triumphant,
-for the planet was actually found in the position predicted by him,
-as soon as a change in the relative places of the planet and earth
-permitted suitable observations to be made.
-
-But after all, Piazzi's planet belongs to a class of quite small
-bodies, and is by no means as interesting as Herschel's discovery,
-Uranus. Yet even this must be relegated to second rank among
-planetary discoveries. On September 23, 1846, the telescope of the
-Berlin Observatory was directed to a certain point on the sky for a
-very special reason. Galle, the astronomer of Berlin, had received
-a letter from Leverrier, of Paris, telling him that if he would
-look in a certain direction he would detect a new and large planet.
-
-Leverrier's information was based upon a mathematical calculation.
-Seated in his study, with no instruments but pen and paper, he
-had slowly figured out the history of a world as yet unseen.
-Tiny discrepancies existed in the observed motions of Herschel's
-planet Uranus. No man had explained their cause. To Leverrier's
-acute understanding they slowly shaped themselves into the
-possible effects of attraction emanating from some unknown planet
-exterior to Uranus. Was it conceivable that these slight tremulous
-imperfections in the motion of a planet could be explained in this
-way? Leverrier was able to say confidently, "Yes." But we may rest
-assured that Galle had but small hopes that upon his eye first, of
-all the myriad eyes of men, would fall a ray of the new planet's
-light. Careful and methodical, he would neglect no chance of
-advancing his beloved science. He would look.
-
-Only one who has himself often seen the morning's sunrise put an
-end to a night's observation of the stars can hope to appreciate
-what Galle's feelings must have been when he saw the planet. To his
-trained eye it was certainly recognizable at once. And then the
-good news was sent on to Paris. We can imagine Leverrier, the cool
-calculator, saying to himself: "Of course he found it. It was a
-mathematical certainty." Nevertheless, his satisfaction must have
-been of the keenest. No triumphs give a pleasure higher than those
-of the intellect. Let no one imagine that men who make researches
-in the domain of pure science are under-paid. They find their
-reward in pleasure that is beyond any price.
-
-The Leverrier planet was found to be the last of the so-called
-major planets, so far as we can say in the present state of
-science. It received the name Neptune. Observers have found no
-other member of the solar system comparable in size with such
-bodies as Uranus and Neptune. More than one eager mathematician has
-tried to repeat Leverrier's achievement, but the supposed planet
-was not found. It has been said that figures never lie; yet such is
-the case only when the computations are correctly made. People are
-prone to give to the work of careless or incompetent mathematicians
-the same degree of credence that is really due only to masters of
-the craft. It requires the test of time to affix to any man's work
-the stamp of true genius.
-
-While, then, we have found no more large planets, quite a group of
-companions to Piazzi's little one have been discovered. They are
-all small, probably never exceeding about 400 miles in diameter.
-All travel around the sun in orbits that lie wholly within that
-of Jupiter and are exterior to that of Mars. The introduction of
-astronomical photography has given a tremendous impetus to the
-discovery of these minor planets, as they are called. It is quite
-interesting to examine the photographic process by which such
-discoveries are made possible and even easy. The matter will not
-be difficult to understand if we remember that all the planets are
-continually changing their places among the other stars. For the
-planets travel around the sun at a comparatively small distance.
-The great majority of the stars, on the contrary, are separated
-from the sun by an almost immeasurable space. As a result, they do
-not seem to move at all among themselves, and so we call them fixed
-stars: they may, indeed, be in motion, but their great distance
-prevents our detecting it in a short period of time.
-
-Now, stellar photographs are made in much the same way as ordinary
-portraits. Only, instead of using a simple camera, the astronomer
-exposes his photographic plate at the eye-end of a telescope. The
-sensitive surface of the plate is substituted for the human eye. We
-then find on the picture a little dot corresponding to every star
-within the photographed region of the sky. But, as everyone knows,
-the turning of the earth on its axis makes the whole heavens,
-including the sun, moon, and stars, rise and set every day. So the
-stars, when we photograph them, are sure to be either climbing up
-in the eastern sky or else slowly creeping down in the western. And
-that makes astronomical photography very different from ordinary
-portrait work.
-
-The stars correspond to the sitter, but they don't sit still.
-For this reason it is necessary to connect the telescope with a
-mechanical contrivance which makes it turn round like the hour-hand
-of an ordinary clock. The arrangement is so adjusted that the
-telescope, once aimed at the proper object in the sky, will move
-so as to remain pointed exactly the same during the whole time of
-the photographic exposure. Thus, while the light of any star is
-acting on the plate, such action will be continuous at a single
-point. Consequently, the finished picture will show the star as a
-little dot; while without this arrangement, the star would trail
-out into a line instead of a dot. Now we have seen that the planets
-are all moving slowly among the fixed stars. So if we make a star
-photograph in a part of the sky where a planet happens to be, the
-planet will make a short line on the plate; whereas, if the planet
-remained quite unmoved relatively to the stars it would give a dot
-like the star dots. The presence of a line, therefore, at once
-indicates a planet.
-
-This method of planet-hunting has proved most useful. More than 400
-small planets similar to Piazzi's have been found, though never
-another one like Uranus and Neptune. As we have said, all these
-little bodies lie between Mars and Jupiter. They evidently belong
-to a group or family, and many astronomers have been led to believe
-that they are but fragments of a former large planet.
-
-In August, 1898, however, one was found by Witt, of Berlin, which
-will probably occupy a very prominent place in the annals of
-astronomy. For this planet goes well within the orbit of Mars,
-and this will bring it at times very close to the earth. In fact,
-when the motions of the new planet and the earth combine to bring
-them to their positions of greatest proximity, the new planet will
-approach us closer than any other celestial body except our own
-moon. Witt named his new planet Eros. Its size, though small, may
-prove to be sufficient to bring it within the possibilities of
-naked-eye observation at the time of closest approach to the earth.
-
-To astronomers the great importance of this new planet is due to
-the following circumstance: For certain reasons too technical to be
-stated here in detail, the distance from the earth to any planet
-can be determined with a degree of precision which is greatest for
-planets that are near us. Thus in time we shall learn the distance
-of Eros more accurately than we know any other celestial distance.
-From this, by a process of calculation, the solar distance from the
-earth is determinable. But the distance from earth to sun is the
-fundamental astronomical unit of measure; so that Witt's discovery,
-through its effect on the unit of measure, will doubtless
-influence every part of the science of astronomy. Here we have
-once more a striking instance of the reward sure to overtake
-the diligent worker in science--a whole generation of men will
-doubtless pass away before we shall have exhausted the scientific
-advantages to be drawn from Witt's remarkable observation of 1898.
-
-
-
-
-HOW TO MAKE A SUN-DIAL[A]
-
-
-Long before clocks and watches had been invented, people began to
-measure time with sun-dials. Nowadays, when almost everyone has a
-watch in his pocket, and can have a clock, too, on the mantel-piece
-of every room in the house, the sun-dial has ceased to be needed
-in ordinary life. But it is still just as interesting as ever to
-anyone who would like to have the means of getting time direct
-from the sun, the great hour-hand or timekeeper of the sky. Any
-person who is handy with tools can make a sun-dial quite easily, by
-following the directions given below.
-
-In the first place, you must know that the sun-dial gives the time
-by means of the sun's shadow. If you stick a walking-cane up in the
-sand on a bright, sunshiny day, the cane has a long shadow that
-looks like a dark line on the ground. Now if you watch this shadow
-carefully, you will see that it does not stay in the same place all
-day. Slowly but surely, as the sun climbs up in the sky, the shadow
-creeps around the cane. You can see quite easily that if the cane
-were fastened in a board floor, and if we could mark on the floor
-the places where the shadow was at different hours of the day, we
-could make the shadow tell us the time just like the hour-hand of a
-clock. A sun-dial is just such an arrangement as this, and I will
-show you how to mark the shadow places exactly, so as to tell the
-right time without any trouble whenever the sun shines.
-
-If you were to watch very carefully such an arrangement as a cane
-standing in a board floor, you would not find the creeping shadow
-in just the same place at the same time every day. If you marked
-the place of the shadow at exactly ten o'clock by your watch some
-morning, and then went back another day at ten, you would not find
-the shadow on the old mark. It would not get very far from it in
-a day or two, but in a month or so it would be quite a distance
-away. Now, of course, a sun-dial would be of no use if it did not
-tell the time correctly every day; and in fact, it is not easy to
-make a dial when the shadow is cast by a stick standing straight
-up. But we can get over this difficulty very well by letting the
-shadow be cast by a stick that leans over toward the floor just the
-right amount, as I will explain in a moment. Of course, we should
-not really use the floor for our sun-dial. It is much better to
-mark out the hour-lines, as they are called, on a smooth piece of
-ordinary white board, and then, after the dial is finished, it can
-be screwed down to a piazza floor or railing, or it can be fastened
-on a window-sill. It ought to be put in a place where the sun can
-get at it most of the time, because, of course, you cannot use the
-sun-dial when the sun is not shining on it. If the dial is set on a
-window-sill (of a city house, for instance) you must choose a south
-window if you can, so as to get the sun nearly all day. If you have
-to take an east window, you can use the dial in the morning only,
-and in a west window only in the afternoon. Sometimes it is best
-not to try to fasten the dial to its support with screws, but just
-to mark its place, and then set it out whenever you want to use
-it. For if the dial is made of wood, and not painted, it might be
-injured by rain or snow in bad weather if left out on a window-sill
-or piazza.
-
-[Illustration: Fig. 1.]
-
-It is not quite easy to fasten a little stick to a board so that it
-will lean over just right. So it is better not to use a stick or
-a cane in the way I have described, but instead to use a piece of
-board cut to just the right shape.
-
-Fig. 1 shows what a sun-dial should look like. The lines to show
-the shadow's place at the different hours of the day will be marked
-on the board ABCD, and this will be put flat on the window-sill
-or piazza floor. The three-cornered piece of board _abc_ is
-fastened to the bottom-board ABCD by screws going through ABCD
-from underneath. The edge _ab_ of the three-cornered board _abc_
-then takes the place of the leaning stick or cane, and the time
-is marked by the shadow cast by the edge _ab_. Of course, it is
-important that this edge should be straight and perfectly flat and
-even. If you are handy with tools, you can make it quite easily,
-but if not, you can mark the right shape on a piece of paper very
-carefully, and take it to a carpenter, who can cut the board
-according to the pattern you have marked on the paper.
-
-[Illustration: Fig. 2.]
-
-Now I must tell you how to draw the shape of the three-cornered
-board _abc_. Fig. 2 shows how it is done. The side _ac_ should
-always be just five inches long. The side _bc_ is drawn at right
-angles to _ac_, which you can do with an ordinary carpenter's
-square. The length of _bc_ depends on the place for which the dial
-is made. The following table gives the length of _bc_ for various
-places in the United States, and, after you have marked out the
-length of _bc_, it is only necessary to complete the three-cornered
-piece by drawing the side _ab_ from _a_ to _b_.
-
-
-TABLE SHOWING THE LENGTH OF THE SIDE _bc_.
-
- --------------------------
- Place. _b c_
- Inches.
- --------------------------
- Albany 4-11/16
- Baltimore 4-1/16
- Boston 4-1/2
- Buffalo 4-11/16
- Charleston 3-1/4
- Chicago 4-1/2
- Cincinnati 4-1/16
- Cleveland 4-1/2
- Denver 4-3/16
- Detroit 4-1/2
- Indianapolis 4-1/16
- Kansas City 3-15/16
- Louisville 3-15/16
- Milwaukee 3-11/16
- New Orleans 2-7/8
- New York 4-3/8
- Omaha 4-3/8
- Philadelphia 4-3/16
- Pittsburg 4-3/8
- Portland, Me 4-13/16
- Richmond 3-15/16
- Rochester 4-11/16
- San Diego 3-1/4
- San Francisco 3-15/16
- Savannah 3-1/8
- St. Louis 3-15/16
- St. Paul 5
- Seattle 5-9/16
- Washington, D. C. 4-1/16
- --------------------------
-
-If you wish to make a dial for a place not given in the table,
-it will be near enough to use the distance _bc_ as given for the
-place nearest to you. But in selecting the nearest place from the
-table, please remember to take that one of the cities mentioned
-which is nearest to you in a north-and-south direction. It does
-not matter how far away the place is in an east-and-west direction.
-So, instead of taking the place that is nearest to you on the map
-in a straight line, take the place to which you could travel by
-going principally east or west, and very little north or south. The
-figure drawn is about the right shape for New York. The board used
-for the three-cornered piece should be about one-half inch thick.
-But if you are making a window-sill dial, you may prefer to have it
-smaller than I have described. You can easily have it half as big
-by making all the sizes and lines in half-inches where the table
-calls for inches.
-
-After you have marked out the dimensions for the three-cornered
-piece that is to throw the shadow, you can prepare the dial itself,
-with the lines that mark the place of the shadow for every hour
-of the day. This you can do in the manner shown in Fig. 3. Just
-as in the case of the three-cornered piece, you can draw the dial
-with a pencil directly on a smooth piece of white board, about
-three-quarters of an inch thick, or you can mark it out on a paper
-pattern and transfer it afterward to the board. Perhaps it will be
-as well to begin by drawing on paper, as any mistakes can then be
-corrected before you commence to mark your wood.
-
-[Illustration: Fig. 3.]
-
-In the first place you must draw a couple of lines MN and M′N′,
-eight inches long, and just far enough apart to fit the edge of
-your three-cornered shadow-piece. You will remember I told you
-to make that one-half inch thick, so your two lines will also be
-one-half inch apart. Now draw the two lines NO and N′O′ square
-with MN and M′N′, and make the distances NO and N′O′ just five
-inches each. The lines OK, O′K′, and the other lines forming the
-outer border of the dial, are then drawn just as shown, OK and O′K′
-being just eight inches long, the same as MN and M′N′. The lower
-lines in the figure, which are not very important, are to complete
-the squares. You must mark the lines NO and N′O′ with the figures
-VI, these being the lines reached by the shadow at six o'clock in
-the morning and evening. The points where the VII, VIII, and other
-hour-lines cut the lines OK, O′K′, MK, and M′K′ can be found from
-the table on page 78.
-
-In using the table you will notice that the line IX falls sometimes
-on one side of the corner K, and sometimes on the other. Thus for
-Albany the line passes seven and seven-sixteenth inches from O,
-while for Charleston it passes four and three-eighth inches from M.
-For Baltimore it passes exactly through the corner K.
-
-TABLE SHOWING HOW TO MARK THE HOUR-LINES.
-
- -----------------+-----------------------------+------------------------
- | Distance from O to the line | Distance from M to the
- | marked | line marked
- PLACE. +---------+---------+---------+-------+--------+-------
- | VII. | VIII. | IX. | IX. | X. | XI.
- -----------------+---------+---------+---------+-------+--------+-------
- | Inches. | Inches. | Inches. |Inches.|Inches. |Inches.
- Albany | 1-15/16 | 4-3/16 | 7-7/16 | | 3-1/16 | 1-7/16
- Baltimore | 2-1/8 | 4-11/16 | 8 | | 2-7/8 | 1-7/16
- Boston | 2 | 4-5/16 | 7-7/16 | | 3-1/16 | 1-7/16
- Buffalo | 1-15/16 | 4-3/16 | 7-7/16 | | 3-1/16 | 1-7/16
- Charleston | 2-7/16 | 5-3/8 | | 4-3/8 | 2-1/2 | 1-1/8
- Chicago | 2 | 4-5/16 | 7-7/16 | | 3-1/16 | 1-7/16
- Cincinnati | 2-1/8 | 4-11/16 | 8 | | 2-7/8 | 1-7/16
- Cleveland | 2 | 4-5/16 | 7-7/16 | -- | 3-1/16 | 1-7/16
- Denver | 2-1/8 | 4-1/2 | 7-11/16 | | 2-7/8 | 1-7/16
- Detroit | 2 | 4-5/16 | 7-7/16 | | 3-1/16 | 1-7/16
- Indianapolis | 2-1/8 | 4-11/16 | 8 | | 2-7/8 | 1-7/16
- Kansas City | 2-1/4 | 4-11/16 | 8 | | 2-7/8 | 1-5/16
- Louisville | 2-1/4 | 4-11/16 | 8 | | 2-7/8 | 1-5/16
- Milwaukee | 1-15/16 | 4-3/16 | 7-7/16 | | 3-1/16 | 1-7/16
- New Orleans | 2-11/16 | 5-3/4 | | 4-1/16| 2-5/16 | 1-1/8
- New York | 2 | 4-5/16 | 7-11/16 | | 3-1/16 | 1-7/16
- Omaha | 2 | 4-5/16 | 7-11/16 | | 3-1/16 | 1-7/16
- Philadelphia | 2-1/8 | 4-1/2 | 7-11/16 | | 2-7/8 | 1-7/16
- Pittsburg | 2 | 4-5/16 | 7-11/16 | | 3-1/16 | 1-7/16
- Portland, Me | 1-15/16 | 4-3/16 | 7-1/8 | | 3-3/16 | 1-1/2
- Richmond | 2-1/4 | 4-11/16 | 8 | | 2-7/8 | 1-5/16
- Rochester | 1-15/16 | 4-3/16 | 7-7/16 | | 3-1/16 | 1-7/16
- San Diego | 2-7/16 | 5-3/8 | | 4-3/8 | 2-1/2 | 1-1/8
- San Francisco | 2-1/4 | 4-11/16 | 8 | | 2-7/8 | 1-5/16
- Savannah | 2-9/16 | 5-9/16 | | 4-1/4 | 2-1/2 | 1-1/8
- St. Louis | 2-1/4 | 4-11/16 | 8 | | 2-7/8 | 1-5/16
- St. Paul | 1-15/16 | 4-1/16 | 7-1/8 | | 3-3/16 | 1-1/2
- Seattle | 1-13/16 | 3-15/16 | 6-5/8 | | 3-3/8 | 1-1/2
- Washington, D. C.| 2-1/8 | 4-11/16 | 8 | | 2-7/8 | 1-7/16
- -----------------+---------+---------+---------+-------+--------+-------
-
-The distance for the line marked V from O′ is just the same as the
-distance from O to VII. Similarly, IV corresponds to VIII, III to
-IX, II to X, and I to XI. The number XII is marked at MM′ as shown.
-If you desire to add lines (not shown in Fig. 3 to avoid confusion)
-for hours earlier than six in the morning, it is merely necessary
-to mark off a distance on the line KO, below the point O, and equal
-to the distance from O to VII. This will give the point where the
-5 A.M. shadow line drawn from N cuts the line KO. A corresponding
-line for 7 P.M. can be drawn from N′ on the other side of the
-figure.
-
-After you have marked out the dial very carefully, you must fasten
-the three-cornered shadow-piece to it in such a way that the whole
-instrument will look like Fig. 1. The edge _ac_ (Fig. 2) goes on NM
-(Fig. 3). The point _a_ (Fig. 2) must come exactly on N (Fig. 3);
-and as the lines NM (Fig. 3) and N′M′ (Fig. 3) have been made just
-the right distance apart to fit the thickness of the three-cornered
-piece _abc_ (Fig. 2), everything will go together just right. The
-point _c_ (Fig. 2) will not quite reach to M (Fig. 3), but will
-be on the line NM (Fig. 3) at a distance of three inches from
-M. The two pieces of wood will be fastened together with three
-screws going through the bottom-board ABCD (Figs. 1 and 3) and
-into the edge _ac_ (Fig. 2) of the three-cornered piece. The whole
-instrument will then look something like Fig. 1.
-
-After you have got your sun-dial put together, you need only set
-it in the sun in a level place, on a piazza or window-sill, and
-turn it round until it tells the right time by the shadow. You can
-get your local time from a watch near enough for setting up the
-dial. Once the dial is set right you can screw it down or mark its
-position, and it will continue to give correct solar time every day
-in the year.
-
-If you wish to adjust the dial very closely, you must go out
-some fine day and note the error of the dial by a watch at about
-ten in the morning, and at noon, and again at about two in the
-afternoon. If the error is the same each time, the dial is rightly
-set. If not, you must try, by turning the dial slightly, to get
-it so placed that your three errors will be nearly the same. When
-you have got them as nearly alike as you can, the dial will be
-sufficiently near right. The solar or dial time may, however,
-differ somewhat from ordinary watch time, but the difference will
-never be great enough to matter, when we remember that sun-dials
-are only rough timekeepers after all, and useful principally for
-amusement.
-
-
-FOOTNOTE:
-
-[A] This chapter is especially intended for boys and girls and
-others who like to make things with carpenters' tools.
-
-
-
-
-PHOTOGRAPHY IN ASTRONOMY
-
-
-New highways of science have been monumented now and again by the
-masterful efforts of genius, working single-handed; but more often
-it is slow-moving time that ripens discovery, and, at the proper
-moment, opens some new path to men whose intellectual power is but
-willingness to learn. So the annals of astronomical photography do
-not recount the achievements of extraordinary genius. It would have
-been strange, indeed, if the discovery of photography had not been
-followed by its application to astronomy.
-
-The whole range of chemical science contains no experiment of
-greater inherent interest than the development of a photographic
-plate. Let but the smallest ray of light fall upon its strangely
-sensitive surface, and some subtle invisible change takes place.
-It is then merely necessary to plunge the plate into a properly
-prepared chemical bath, and the gradual process of developing
-the picture begins. Slowly, very slowly, the colorless surface
-darkens wherever light has touched it. Let us imagine that the
-exposure has been made with an ordinary lens and camera, and that
-it is a landscape seeming to grow beneath the experimenter's
-eyes. At first only the most conspicuous objects make their
-appearance. But gradually the process extends, until finally
-every tiny detail is reproduced with marvellous fidelity to the
-original. The photographic plate, when developed in this way, is
-called a "negative." For in Nature luminous points, or sources
-of light, are bright, while the developing negative turns dark
-wherever light has acted. Thus the negative, while true to Nature,
-reproduces everything in a reversed way; bright things are dark,
-and shadows appear light. For ordinary purposes, therefore, the
-negative has to be replaced by a new photograph made by copying it
-again photographically. In this way it is again reversed, giving
-us a picture corresponding correctly to the facts as seen. Such a
-copy from a negative is what is ordinarily called a photograph;
-technically, it is known as a "positive."
-
-One of the remarkable things about the sensitive plate is its
-complete indifference to the distance from which the light comes.
-It is ready to yield obediently to the ray of some distant star
-that may have journeyed, as it were, from the very vanishing
-point of space, or to the bright glow of an electric light upon
-the photographer's table. This quality makes its use especially
-advantageous in astronomy, since we can gain knowledge of remote
-stars only by a study of the light they send us. In such study the
-photographic plate possesses a supreme advantage over the human
-eye. If the conditions of weather and atmosphere are favorable,
-an observer looking through an ordinary telescope will see nearly
-as much at the first glance as he will ever see. Attentive and
-continued study will enable him to fix details upon his memory,
-and to record them by means of drawings and diagrams. Occasional
-moments of especially undisturbed atmospheric conditions will allow
-him to glimpse faint objects seldom visible. But on the whole,
-telescopic astronomers add little to their harvest by continued
-husbandry in the same field of stars. Photography is different.
-The effect of light upon the sensitive surface of the plate is
-strictly cumulative. If a given star can bring about a certain
-result when it has been allowed to act upon the plate for one
-minute, then in two or three minutes it will accomplish much more.
-Perhaps a single minute's exposure would have produced a mark
-scarcely perceptible upon the developed negative. In that case,
-three or four minutes would give us a perfectly well defined black
-image of the star.
-
-[Illustration: Star-Field in Constellation Monoceros.
-
-Photographed by Barnard, February 1, 1894.
-
-Exposure, three hours.]
-
-Thus, by lengthening the exposure we can make the fainter stars
-impress themselves upon the plate. If their light is not able
-to produce the desired effect in minutes, we can let its action
-accumulate for hours. In this manner it becomes possible and
-easy to photograph objects so faint that they have never been
-seen, even with our most powerful telescopes. This achievement
-ranks high among those which make astronomy appeal so strongly
-to the imagination. Scientific men are not given to fancies; nor
-should they be. But the first long-exposure photograph must have
-been an exciting thing. After coming from the observatory,
-the chemical development was, of course, made in a dark room, so
-that no additional light might harm the plate until the process
-was complete. Carrying it out then into the light, that early
-experimenter cannot but have felt a thrill of triumph; for his hand
-held a true picture of dim stars to the eye unlighted, lifted into
-view as if by magic.
-
-Plates have been thus exposed as long as twenty-five hours, and the
-manner of doing it is very interesting. Of course, it is impossible
-to carry on the work continuously for so long a period, since the
-beginning of daylight would surely ruin the photograph. In fact,
-the astronomer must stop before even the faintest streak of dawn
-begins to redden the eastern sky. Moreover, making astronomical
-negatives requires excessively close attention, and this it is
-impossible to give continuously during more than a few hours.
-But the exposure of a single plate can be extended over several
-nights without difficulty. It is merely necessary to close the
-plate-holder with a "light-tight" cover when the first night's
-work is finished. To begin further exposure of the same plate
-on another night, we simply aim the photographic telescope at
-precisely the same point of the sky as before. The light-tight
-plate-holder being again opened, the exposure can go on as if there
-had been no interruption.
-
-Astronomers have invented a most ingenious device for making sure
-that the telescope's aim can be brought back again to the same
-point with great exactness. This is a very important matter;
-for the slightest disturbance of the plate before the second or
-subsequent portions of the exposure would ruin everything. Instead
-of a very complete single picture, we should have two partial ones
-mixed up together in inextricable confusion.
-
-To prevent this, photographic telescopes are made double, not
-altogether unlike an opera-glass. One of the tubes is arranged for
-photography proper, while the other is fitted with lenses suitable
-for an ordinary visual telescope. The two tubes are made parallel.
-Thus the astronomer, by looking through the visual glass, can watch
-objects in the heavens even while they are being photographed. The
-visual half of the instrument is provided with a pair of very fine
-cross-wires movable at will in the field of view. These can be
-made to bisect some little star exactly, before beginning the first
-night's work. Afterward, everything about the instrument having
-been left unchanged, the astronomer can always assure himself of
-coming back to precisely the same point of the sky, by so adjusting
-the instrument that the same little star is again bisected.
-
-It must not be supposed, however, that the entire instrument
-remains unmoved, even during the whole of a single night's
-exposure. For in that case, the apparent motion of the stars as
-they rise or set in the sky would speedily carry them out of the
-telescope's field of view. Consequently, this motion has to be
-counteracted by shifting the telescope so as to follow the stars.
-This can be accomplished accurately and automatically by means
-of clock-work mechanism. Such contrivances have already been
-applied in the past to visual telescopes, because even then they
-facilitated the observer's work. They save him the trouble of
-turning his instrument every few minutes, and allow him to give his
-undivided attention to the actual business of observation.
-
-For photographic purposes the telescope needs to "follow" the
-stars far more accurately than in the older kind of observing with
-the eye. Nor is it possible to make a clock that will drive the
-instrument satisfactorily and quite automatically. But by means of
-the second or visual telescope, astronomers can always ascertain
-whether the clock is working correctly at any given moment.
-It requires only a glance at the little star bisected by the
-cross-wires, and, if there has been the slightest imperfection in
-the following by clock-work, the star will no longer be cut exactly
-by the wires.
-
-The astronomer can at once correct any error by putting in
-operation a very ingenious mechanical device sometimes called
-a "mouse-control." He need only touch an electric button, and
-a signal is sent into the clock-work. Instantly there is a
-shifting of the mechanism. For one of the regular driving wheels
-is substituted, temporarily, another having an _extra tooth_.
-This makes the clock run a little faster so long as the electric
-current passes. In a similar way, by means of another button, the
-clock can be made to run slower temporarily. Thus by watching
-the cross-wires continuously, and manipulating his two electric
-buttons, the photographic astronomer can compel his telescope
-to follow exactly the object under observation, and he can make
-certain of obtaining a perfect negative.
-
-These long-exposure plates are intended especially for what may be
-called descriptive astronomy. With them, as we have seen, advantage
-is taken of cumulative light-effects on the sensitive plate, and
-the telescope's light-gathering and space-penetrating powers are
-vastly increased. We are enabled to carry our researches far
-beyond the confines of the old visible universe. Extremely faint
-objects can be recorded, even down to their minutest details, with
-a fidelity unknown to older visual methods. But at present we
-intend to consider principally applications of photography in the
-astronomy of measurement, rather than the descriptive branch of our
-subject. Instead of describing pictures made simply to see what
-certain objects look like in the sky, we shall consider negatives
-intended for precise measurement, with all that the word precision
-implies in celestial science.
-
-Taking up first the photography of stars, we must begin by
-mentioning the work of Rutherfurd at New York. More than thirty
-years ago he had so far perfected methods of stellar photography
-that he was able to secure excellent pictures of stars as faint as
-the ninth magnitude. In those days the modern process of dry-plate
-photography had not been invented. To-day, plates exposed in the
-photographic telescope are made of glass covered with a perfectly
-dry film of sensitized gelatine. But in the old wet-plate process
-the sensitive film was first wetted with a chemical solution; and
-this solution could not be allowed to dry during the exposure.
-Consequently, Rutherfurd was limited to exposures a few minutes
-in length, while nowadays, as we have said, their duration can be
-prolonged at will.
-
-When we add to this the fact that the old plates were far less
-sensitive to light than those now available, it is easy to see
-what were the difficulties in the way of photographing faint stars
-in Rutherfurd's time. Nor did he possess the modern ingenious
-device of a combined visual and photographic instrument. He had no
-electric controlling apparatus. In fact, the younger generation of
-astronomers can form no adequate idea of the patience and personal
-skill Rutherfurd must have had at his command. For he certainly did
-produce negatives that are but little inferior to the best that can
-be made to-day. His only limitation was that he could not obtain
-images of stars much below the ninth magnitude.
-
-To understand just what is meant here by the ninth magnitude, it
-is necessary to go back in imagination to the time of Hipparchus,
-the father of sidereal astronomy. (See page 39.) He adopted the
-convenient plan of dividing all the stars visible to the naked eye
-(of course, he had no telescope) into six classes, according to
-their brilliancy. The faintest visible stars were put in the sixth
-class, and all the others were assigned somewhat arbitrarily to one
-or the other of the brighter classes.
-
-Modern astronomers have devised a more scientific system, which has
-been made to conform very nearly to that of Hipparchus, just as
-it has come down to us through the ages. We have adopted a certain
-arbitrary degree of luminosity as the standard "first-magnitude";
-compared with sunlight, this may be represented roughly by a
-fraction of which the numerator is 1, and the denominator about
-eighty thousand millions. The standard second-magnitude star is one
-whose light, compared with a first-magnitude, may be represented
-approximately by the fraction ⅖. The third magnitude, in turn, may
-be compared with the second by the same fraction ⅖; and so the
-classification is extended to magnitudes below those visible to the
-unaided eye. Each magnitude compares with the one above it, as the
-light of two candles would compare with the light of five.
-
-Rutherfurd did not stop with mere photographs. He realized very
-clearly the obvious truth that by making a picture of the sky we
-simply change the scene of our operations. Upon the photograph
-we can measure that which we might have studied directly in the
-heavens; but so long as they remain unmeasured, celestial pictures
-have a potential value only. Locked within them may lie hidden
-some secret of our universe. But it will not come forth unsought.
-Patient effort must precede discovery, in photography, as elsewhere
-in science. There is no royal road. Rutherfurd devised an elaborate
-measuring-machine in which his photographs could be examined under
-the microscope with the most minute exactness. With this machine
-he measured a large number of his pictures; and it has been shown
-quite recently that the results obtained from them are comparable
-in accuracy with those coming from the most highly accredited
-methods of direct eye-observation.
-
-And photographs are far superior in ease of manipulation.
-Convenient day-observing under the microscope in a comfortable
-astronomical laboratory is substituted for all the discomforts
-of a midnight vigil under the stars. The work of measurement can
-proceed in all weathers, whereas formerly it was limited strictly
-to perfectly clear nights. Lastly, the negatives form a permanent
-record, to which we can always return to correct errors or
-re-examine doubtful points.
-
-Rutherfurd's stellar work extended down to about 1877, and
-included especially parallax determinations and the photography of
-star-clusters. Each of these subjects is receiving close attention
-from later investigators, and, therefore, merits brief mention
-here. Stellar parallax is in one sense but another name for stellar
-distance. Its measurement has been one of the important problems
-of astronomy for centuries, ever since men recognized that the
-Copernican theory of our universe requires the determination of
-stellar distances for its complete demonstration.
-
-If the earth is swinging around the sun once a year in a mighty
-path or orbit, there must be changes of its position in space
-comparable in size with the orbit itself. And the stars ought to
-shift their apparent places on the sky to correspond with these
-changes in the terrestrial observer's position. The phenomenon is
-analogous to what occurs when we look out of a room, first through
-one window, and then through another. Any object on the opposite
-side of the street will be seen in a changed direction, on account
-of the observer's having shifted his position from one window to
-the other. If the object seemed to be due north when seen from
-the first window, it will, perhaps, appear a little east of north
-from the other. But this change of direction will be comparatively
-small, if the object under observation is very far away, in
-comparison with the distance between the two windows.
-
-This is what occurs with the stars. The earth's orbit, vast as
-it is, shrinks into almost absolute insignificance when compared
-with the profound distances by which we are sundered from even the
-nearest fixed stars. Consequently, the shifting of their positions
-is also very small--so small as to be near the extreme limit
-separating that which is measurable from that which is beyond human
-ken.
-
-Photography lends itself most readily to a study of this matter.
-Suppose a certain star is suspected of "having a parallax." In
-other words, we have reason to believe it near enough to admit of
-a successful measurement of distance. Perhaps it is a very bright
-star; and, other things being equal, it is probably fair to assume
-that brightness signifies nearness. And astronomers have certain
-other indications of proximity that guide them in the selection of
-proper objects for investigation, though such evidence, of course,
-never takes the place of actual measurement.
-
-The star under examination is sure to have near it on the sky a
-number of stars so very small that we may safely take them to be
-immeasurably far away. The parallax star is among them, but not
-of them. We see it projected upon the background of the heavens,
-though it may in reality be quite near us, astronomically speaking.
-If this is really so, and the star, therefore, subject to the
-slight parallactic shifting already mentioned, we can detect it by
-noting the suspected star's position among the surrounding small
-stars. For these, being immeasurably remote, will remain unchanged,
-within the limits of our powers of observation, and thus serve
-as points of reference for marking the apparent shifting of the
-brighter star we are actually considering.
-
-We have merely to photograph the region at various seasons of the
-year. Careful examination of the photographs under the microscope
-will then enable us to measure the slightest displacement of the
-parallax star. From these measures, by a process of calculation,
-astronomers can then obtain the star's distance. It will not
-become known in miles; we shall only ascertain how many times the
-distance between the earth and sun would have to be laid down like
-a measuring-rod, in order to cover the space separating us from the
-star: and the subsequent evaluation of this distance "earth to sun"
-in miles is another important problem in whose solution photography
-promises to be most useful.
-
-The above method of measuring stellar distance is, of course,
-subject to whatever slight uncertainty arises from the assumption
-that the small stars used for comparison are themselves beyond the
-possibility of parallactic shifting. But astronomy possesses no
-better method. Moreover, the number of small stars used in this
-way is, of course, much larger in photography than it ever can be
-in visual work. In the former process, all surrounding stars can
-be photographed at once; in the latter each star must be measured
-separately, and daylight soon intervenes to impose a limit on
-numbers. Usually only two can be used; so that here photography
-has a most important advantage. It minimizes the chance of our
-parallax being rendered erroneous, by the stars of comparison not
-being really infinitely remote. This might happen, perhaps, in the
-case of one or two; but with an average result from a large number
-we know it to be practically impossible.
-
-Cluster work is not altogether unlike "parallax hunting" in its
-preliminary stage of securing the photographic observations. The
-object is to obtain an absolutely faithful picture of a star group,
-just as it exists in the sky. We have every reason to suppose
-that a very large number of stars condensed into one small spot
-upon the heavens means something more than chance aggregation.
-The Pleiades group (page 10) contains thousands of massive stars,
-doubtless held together by the force of their mutual gravitational
-attraction. If this be true, there must be complex orbital motion
-in the cluster; and, as time goes on, we should actually see the
-separate components change their relative positions, as it were,
-before our eyes. The details of such motion upon the great scale
-of cosmic space offer one of the many problems that make astronomy
-the grandest of human sciences.
-
-We have said that time must pass before we can see these things;
-there may be centuries of waiting. But one way exists to hurry on
-the perfection of our knowledge; we must increase the precision of
-observations. Motions that would need the growth of centuries to
-become visible to the older astronomical appliances, might yield
-in a few decades to more delicate observational processes. Here
-photography is most promising. Having once obtained a surpassingly
-accurate picture of a star-cluster, we can subject it easily to
-precise microscopic measurement. The same operations repeated at a
-later date will enable us to compare the two series of measures,
-and thus ascertain the motions that may have occurred in the
-interval. The Rutherfurd photographs furnish a veritable mine of
-information in researches of this kind; for they antedate all other
-celestial photographs of precision by at least a quarter-century,
-and bring just so much nearer the time when definite knowledge
-shall replace information based on reasoning from probabilities.
-
-Rutherfurd's methods showed the advantages of photography as
-applied to individual star-clusters. It required only the attention
-of some astronomer disposing of large observational facilities,
-and accustomed to operations upon a great scale, to apply similar
-methods throughout the whole heavens. In the year 1882 a bright
-comet was very conspicuous in the southern heavens. It was
-extensively observed from the southern hemisphere, and especially
-at the British Royal Observatory at the Cape of Good Hope.
-
-Gill, director of that institution, conceived the idea that this
-comet might be bright enough to photograph. At that time, comet
-photography had been attempted but little, if at all, and it was
-by no means sure that the experiment would be successful. Nor was
-Gill well acquainted with the work of Rutherfurd; for the best
-results of that astronomer had lain dormant many years. He was one
-of those men with whom personal modesty amounts to a fault. Loath
-to put himself forward in any way, and disliking to rush into
-print, Rutherfurd had given but little publicity to his work. This
-peculiarity has, doubtless, delayed his just reputation; but he
-will lose nothing in the end from a brief postponement. Gill must,
-however, be credited with more penetration than would be his due
-if Rutherfurd had made it possible for others to know that he had
-anticipated many of the newer ideas.
-
-However this may be, the comet was photographed with the help of
-a local portrait photographer named Allis. When Gill and Allis
-fastened a simple portrait camera belonging to the latter upon the
-tube of one of the Cape telescopes, and pointed it at the great
-comet, they little thought the experiment would lead to one of the
-greatest astronomical works ever attempted by men. Yet this was
-destined to occur. The negative they obtained showed an excellent
-picture of the comet; but what was more important for the future of
-sidereal astronomy, it was also quite thickly dotted with little
-black points corresponding to stars. The extraordinary ease with
-which the whole heavens could be thus charted photographically
-was brought home to Gill as never before. It was this comet
-picture that interested him in the application of photography
-to star-charting; and without his interest the now famous
-astro-photographic catalogue of the heavens would probably never
-have been made.
-
-After considerable preliminary correspondence, a congress
-of astronomers was finally called to meet at Paris in 1887.
-Representatives of the principal observatories and civilized
-governments were present. They decided that the end of the
-nineteenth century should see the making of a great catalogue
-of all the stars in the sky, upon a scale of completeness and
-precision surpassing anything previously attempted. It is
-impossible to exaggerate the importance of such a work; for upon
-our star-catalogues depends ultimately the entire structure of
-astronomical science.
-
-The work was far too vast for the powers of any observatory alone.
-Therefore, the whole sky, from pole to pole, was divided into
-eighteen belts or zones of approximately equal area; and each of
-these was assigned to a single observatory to be photographed. A
-series of telescopes was specially constructed, so that every
-part of the work should be done with the same type of instrument.
-As far as possible, an attempt was made to secure uniformity of
-methods, and particularly a uniform scale of precision. To cover
-the entire sky upon the plan proposed no less than 44,108 negatives
-are required; and most of these have now been finished. The further
-measurement of the pictures and the drawing up of a vast printed
-star-catalogue are also well under way. One of the participating
-observatories, that at Potsdam, Germany, has published the first
-volume of its part of the catalogue. It is estimated that this
-observatory alone will require twenty quarto volumes to contain
-merely the final results of its work on the catalogue. Altogether
-not less than two million stars will find a place in this, our
-latest directory of the heavens.
-
-Such wholesale methods of attacking problems of observational
-astronomy are particularly characteristic of photography. The great
-catalogue is, perhaps, the best illustration of this tendency; but
-of scarcely smaller interest, though less important in reality, is
-the photographic method of dealing with minor planets. We have
-already said (page 63) that in the space between the orbits of Mars
-and Jupiter several hundred small bodies are moving around the sun
-in ordinary planetary orbits. These bodies are called asteroids,
-or minor planets. The visual method of discovering unknown members
-of this group was painfully tedious; but photography has changed
-matters completely, and has added immensely to our knowledge of the
-asteroids.
-
-Wolf, of Heidelberg, first made use of the new process for
-minor-planet discovery. His method is sufficiently ingenious to
-deserve brief mention again. A photograph of a suitable region
-of the sky was made with an exposure lasting two or three hours.
-Throughout all this time the instrument was manipulated so as
-to follow the motion of the heavens in the way we have already
-explained, so that each star would appear on the negative as a
-small, round, black dot.
-
-But if a minor planet happened to be in the region covered by the
-plate, its photographic image would be very different. For the
-orbital motion of the planet about the sun would make it move a
-little among the stars even in the two or three hours during which
-the plate was exposed. This motion would be faithfully reproduced
-in the picture, so that the planet would appear as a short curved
-line rather than a well-defined dot like a star. Thus the presence
-of such a line-image infallibly denotes an asteroid.
-
-Subsequent calculations are necessary to ascertain whether the
-object is a planet already known or a genuine new discovery. Wolf,
-and others using his method in recent years, have made immense
-additions to our catalogue of asteroids. Indeed, the matter was
-beginning to lose interest on account of the frequency and sameness
-of these discoveries, when the astronomical world was startled by
-the finding of the Planet of 1898. (Page 58.)
-
-On August 27, 1898, Witt, of Berlin, discovered the small body
-that bears the number "433" in the list of minor planets, and has
-received the name Eros. Its important peculiarity consists in the
-exceptional position of the orbit. While all the other asteroids
-are farther from the sun than Mars, and less distant than Jupiter,
-Eros can pass within the orbit of the former. At times, therefore,
-it will approach our earth more closely than any other permanent
-member of the solar system, excepting our own moon. So it is, in
-a sense, our nearest neighbor; and this fact alone makes it the
-most interesting of all the minor planets. The nineteenth century
-was opened by Piazzi's well-known discovery of the first of these
-bodies (page 59); it is, therefore, fitting that we should find
-the most important one at its close. We are almost certain that it
-will be possible to make use of Eros to solve with unprecedented
-accuracy the most important problem in all astronomy. This is
-the determination of our earth's distance from the sun. When
-considering stellar parallax, we have seen how our observations
-enable us to measure some of the stars' distances in terms of the
-distance "earth to sun" as a unit. It is, indeed, the fundamental
-unit for all astronomical measures, and its exact evaluation has
-always been considered the basal problem of astronomy. Astronomers
-know it as the problem of Solar Parallax.
-
-We shall not here enter into the somewhat intricate details of
-this subject, however interesting they may be. The problem offers
-difficulties somewhat analogous to those confronting a surveyor
-who has to determine the distance of some inaccessible terrestrial
-point. To do this, it is necessary first to measure a "base-line,"
-as we call it. Then the measurement of angles with a theodolite
-will make it possible to deduce the required distance of the
-inaccessible point by a process of calculation. To insure accuracy,
-however, as every surveyor knows, the base-line must be made long
-enough; and this is precisely what is impossible in the case of the
-solar parallax.
-
-For we are necessarily limited to marking out our base-line on
-the earth; and the entire planet is too small to furnish one of
-really sufficient size. The best we can do is to use the distance
-between two observatories situated, as near as may be, on opposite
-sides of the earth. But even this base is wofully small. However,
-the smallness loses some of its harmful effect if we operate upon
-a planet that is comparatively near us. We can measure such
-a planet's distance more accurately than any other; and this
-being known, the solar distance can be computed by the aid of
-mathematical considerations based upon Newton's law of gravitation
-and observational determinations of the planetary orbital elements.
-
-Photography is by no means limited to investigations in the older
-departments of astronomical observation. Its powerful arm has
-been stretched out to grasp as well the newer instruments of
-spectroscopic study. Here the sensitive plate has been substituted
-for the human eye with even greater relative advantage. The
-accurate microscopic measurement of difficult lines in stellar
-spectra was indeed possible by older methods; but photography
-has made it comparatively easy; and, above all, has rendered
-practicable series of observations extensive enough in numbers to
-furnish statistical information of real value. Only in this way
-have we been able to determine whether the stars, in their varied
-and unknown orbits, are approaching us or moving farther away. Even
-the speed of this approach or recession has become measurable,
-and has been evaluated in the case of many individual stars. (See
-page 21.)
-
-[Illustration: Solar Corona. Total Eclipse.
-
-Photographed by Campbell, January 22, 1898; Jeur, India.]
-
-The subject of solar physics has become a veritable department of
-astronomy in the hands of photographic investigators. Ingenious
-spectro-photographic methods have been devised, whereby we have
-secured pictures of the sun from which we have learned much that
-must have remained forever unknown to older methods.
-
-Especially useful has photography proved itself in the observation
-of total solar eclipses. It is only when the sun's bright disk
-is completely obscured by the interposed moon that we can see
-the faintly luminous structure of the solar corona, that great
-appendage of our sun, whose exact nature is still unexplained. Only
-during the few minutes of total eclipse in each century can we
-look upon it; and keen is the interest of astronomers when those
-few minutes occur. But it is found that eye observations made in
-hurried excitement have comparatively little value. Half a dozen
-persons might make drawings of the corona during the same eclipse,
-yet they would differ so much from one another as to leave the
-true outline very much in doubt. But with photography we can obtain
-a really correct picture whose details can be studied and discussed
-subsequently at leisure.
-
-If we were asked to sum up in one word what photography has
-accomplished, we should say that observational astronomy has
-been revolutionized. There is to-day scarcely an instrument of
-precision in which the sensitive plate has not been substituted
-for the human eye; scarcely an inquiry possible to the older
-method which cannot now be undertaken upon a grander scale.
-Novel investigations formerly not even possible are now entirely
-practicable by photography; and the end is not yet. Valuable as are
-the achievements already consummated, photography is richest in
-its promise for the future. Astronomy has been called the "perfect
-science"; it is safe to predict that the next generation will
-wonder that the knowledge we have to-day should ever have received
-so proud a title.
-
-
-
-
-TIME STANDARDS OF THE WORLD
-
-
-The question is often asked, "What is the practical use of
-astronomy?" We know, of course, that men would profit greatly from
-a study of that science, even if it could not be turned to any
-immediate bread-and-butter use; for astronomy is essentially the
-science of big things, and it makes men bigger to fix their minds
-on problems that deal with vast distances and seemingly endless
-periods of time. No one can look upon the quietly shining stars
-without being impressed by the thought of how they burned--then
-as now--before he himself was born, and so shall continue after
-he has passed away--aye, even after his latest descendants shall
-have vanished from the earth. Of all the sciences, astronomy is
-at once the most beautiful poetically, and yet the one offering
-the grandest and most difficult problems to the intellect. A study
-of these problems has ever been a labor of love to the greatest
-minds; their solution has been counted justly among man's loftiest
-achievements.
-
-And yet of all the difficult and abstruse sciences, astronomy is,
-perhaps, the one that comes into the ordinary practical daily
-life of the people more definitely and frequently than any other.
-There exist at least three things we owe to astronomy that must
-be regarded as quite indispensable, from a purely practical point
-of view. In the first place, let us consider the maps in a work
-on geography. How many people ever think to ask how these maps
-are made? It is true that the ordinary processes of the surveyor
-would enable us to draw a map showing the outlines of a part of
-the earth's surface. Even the locations of towns and rivers might
-be marked in this way. But one of the most important things of all
-could not be added without the aid of astronomical observations.
-The latitude and longitude lines, which are essential to show the
-relation of the map to the rest of the earth, we owe to astronomy.
-The longitude lines, particularly, as we shall see farther on, play
-a most important part in the subject of time.
-
-The second indispensable application of astronomy to ordinary
-business affairs relates to the subject of navigation. How do ships
-find their way across the ocean? There are no permanent marks on
-the sea, as there are on the land, by which the navigator can guide
-his course. Nevertheless, seamen know their path over the trackless
-ocean with a certainty as unerring as would be possible on shore;
-and it is all done by the help of astronomy. The navigator's
-observations of the sun are astronomical observations; the tables
-he uses in calculating his observations--the tables that tell him
-just where he is and in what direction he must go--are astronomical
-tables. Indeed, it is not too much to say that without astronomy
-there could be no safe ocean navigation.
-
-But the third application of astronomy is of still greater
-importance in our daily life--the furnishing of correct time
-standards for all sorts of purposes. It is to this practical use of
-astronomical science that we would direct particular attention. Few
-persons ever think of the complicated machinery that must be put
-in motion in order to set a clock. A man forgets some evening to
-wind his watch at the accustomed hour. The next morning he finds it
-run down. It must be re-set. Most people simply go to the nearest
-clock, or ask some friend for the time, so as to start the watch
-correctly. More careful persons, perhaps, visit the jeweller's
-and take the time from his "regulator." But the regulator itself
-needs to be regulated. After all, it is nothing more than any other
-clock, except that greater care has been taken in the mechanical
-construction and arrangement of its various parts. Yet it is but
-a machine built by human hands, and, like all human works, it is
-necessarily imperfect. No matter how well it has been constructed,
-it will not run with perfectly rigid accuracy. Every day there will
-be a variation from the true time by a small amount, and in the
-course of days or weeks the accumulation of these successive small
-amounts will lead to a total of quite appreciable size.
-
-Just as the ordinary citizen looks to the jeweller's regulator to
-correct his watch, so the jeweller applies to the astronomer for
-the correction of his regulator. Ever since the dawn of astronomy,
-in the earliest ages of which we have any record, the principal
-duty of the astronomer has been the furnishing of accurate time
-to the people. We shall not here enter into a detailed account,
-however interesting it would be, of the gradual development by
-which the very perfect system at present in use has been reached;
-but shall content ourselves with a description of the methods now
-employed in nearly all the civilized countries of the world.
-
-In the first place, every observatory is, of course, provided with
-what is known as an astronomical clock. This instrument, from the
-astronomer's point of view, is something very different from the
-ordinary popular idea. To the average person an astronomical clock
-is a complicated and elaborate affair, giving the date, day of the
-week, phases of the moon, and other miscellaneous information. But
-in reality the astronomer wants none of these things. His one and
-only requirement is that the clock shall keep as near uniform time
-as may be possible to a machine constructed by human hands. No
-expense is spared in making the standard clock for an observatory.
-Real artists in mechanical construction--men who have attained a
-world-wide celebrity for delicate skill in fashioning the parts of
-a clock--such are the astronomer's clock-makers.
-
-To increase precision of motion in the train of wheels, it is
-necessary that the mechanism be as simple as possible. For this
-reason all complications of date, etc., are left out. We have
-even abandoned the usual convenient plan of having the hour and
-minute hands mounted at the same centre; for this kind of mounting
-makes necessary a slightly more intricate form of wheelwork. The
-astronomer's clock usually has the centres of the second hand,
-minute hand, and hour hand in a straight line, and equally distant
-from each other. Each hand has its own dial; all drawn, of course,
-upon the same clock-face.
-
-Even after such a clock has been made as accurately as possible,
-it will, nevertheless, not give the very best performance unless
-it is taken care of properly. It is necessary to mount it very
-firmly indeed. It should not be fastened to an ordinary wall, but
-a strong pier of masonry or brick must be built for it on a very
-solid foundation. Moreover, this pier is best placed underground
-in a cellar, so that the temperature of the clock can be kept
-nearly uniform all the year round; for we find that clocks do
-not run quite the same in hot weather as they do in cold. Makers
-have, indeed, tried to guard against this effect of temperature,
-by ingenious mechanical contrivances. But these are never quite
-perfect in their action, and it is best not to test them too
-severely by exposing the clock to sharp changes of heat and cold.
-
-Another thing affecting the going of fine clocks, strange as it may
-seem, is the variation of barometric pressure. There is a slight
-but noticeable difference in their running when the barometer is
-high and when it is low. To prevent this, some of our best clocks
-have been enclosed in air-tight cases, so that outside barometric
-changes may not be felt in the least by the clock itself.
-
-But even after all this has been accomplished, and the astronomer
-is in possession of a clock that may be called a masterpiece of
-mechanical construction, he is not any better off than was the
-jeweller with his regulator. After all, even the astronomical clock
-needs to be set, and its error must be determined from time to
-time. A final appeal must then be had to astronomical observations.
-The clock must be set by the stars and sun. For this purpose the
-astronomer uses an instrument called a "transit." This is simply
-a telescope of moderate size, possibly five or six feet long, and
-firmly attached to an axis at right angles to the tube of the
-telescope.
-
-This axis is supported horizontally in such a way that it points
-as nearly as may be exactly east and west. The telescope itself
-being square with the axis, always points in a north-and-south
-direction. It is possible to rotate the telescope about its axis so
-as to reach all parts of the sky that are directly north or south
-of the observatory. In the field of view of the telescope certain
-very fine threads are mounted so as to form a little cross. As the
-telescope is rotated this cross traces out, as it were, a great
-circle on the sky; and this great circle is called the astronomical
-meridian.
-
-Now we are in possession of certain star-tables, computed from
-the combined observations of astronomers in the last 150 years.
-These tables tell us the exact moment of time when any star is
-on the meridian. To discover, therefore, whether our clock is
-right on any given night, it is merely necessary to watch a star
-with the telescope, and note the exact instant by the clock when
-it reaches the little cross in the field of view. Knowing from
-the astronomical tables the time when the star ought to have been
-on the meridian, and having observed the clock time when it is
-actually there, the difference is, of course, the error of the
-clock. The result can be checked by observations of other stars,
-and the slight personal errors of observation can be rendered
-harmless by taking the mean from several stars. By an hour's work
-on a fine night it is possible to fix the clock error quite easily
-within the one-twentieth part of a second.
-
-We have not space to enter into the interesting details of the
-methods by which the astronomical transit is accurately set in
-the right position, and how any slight residual error in its
-setting can be eliminated from our results by certain processes
-of computation. It must suffice to say that practically all time
-determinations in the observatory depend substantially upon the
-procedure outlined above.
-
-The observatory clock having been once set right by observations
-of the sky, its error can be re-determined every few days quite
-easily. Thus even the small irregularities of its nearly perfect
-mechanism can be prevented from accumulating until they might reach
-a harmful magnitude. But we obtain in this way only a correct
-standard of time within the observatory itself. How can this be
-made available for the general public? The problem is quite simple
-with the aid of the electric telegraph. We shall give a brief
-account of the methods now in use in New York City, and these may
-be taken as essentially representative of those employed elsewhere.
-
-Every day, at noon precisely, an electric signal is sent out by
-the United States Naval Observatory in Washington. The signal is
-regulated by the standard clock of the observatory, of course
-taking account of star observations made on the next preceding
-fine night. This signal is received in the central New York office
-of the telegraph company, where it is used to keep correct a
-very fine clock, which may be called the time standard of the
-telegraph company. This clock, in turn, has automatic electric
-connections, by means of which it is made to send out signals
-over what are called "time wires" that go all over the city.
-Jewellers, and others who desire correct time, can arrange to have
-a small electric sounder in their offices connected with the time
-wires. Thus the ticks of the telegraph company's standard clock
-are repeated automatically in the jeweller's shop, and used for
-controlling the exactness of his regulator. This, in brief, is the
-method by which the astronomer's careful determination of correct
-time is transferred and distributed to the people at large.
-
-Having thus outlined the manner of obtaining and distributing
-correct time, we shall now consider the question of time
-differences between different places on the earth. This is a matter
-which many persons find most perplexing, and yet it is essentially
-quite simple in principle. Travellers, of course, are well
-acquainted with the fact that their watches often need to be reset
-when they arrive at their destination. Yet few ever stop to ask the
-cause.
-
-Let us consider for a moment our method of measuring time. We go
-by the sun. If we leave out of account some small irregularities
-of the sun's motion that are of no consequence for our present
-purpose, we may lay down this fundamental principle: When the sun
-reaches its highest position in the sky it is twelve o'clock or
-noon.
-
-The sun, as everyone knows, rises each morning in the east, slowly
-goes up higher and higher in the sky, and at last begins to descend
-again toward the west. But it is clear that as the sun travels
-from east to west, it must pass over the eastern one of any two
-cities sooner than the western one. When it reaches its greatest
-height over a western city it has, therefore, already passed its
-greatest height over an eastern one. In other words, when it is
-noon, or twelve o'clock, in the western city, it is already after
-noon in the eastern city. This is the simple and evident cause of
-time differences in different parts of the country. Of any two
-places the eastern one always has later time than the western.
-When we consider the matter in this way there is not the slightest
-difficulty in understanding how time differences arise. They will,
-of course, be greatest for places that are very far apart in an
-east-and-west direction. And this brings us again to the subject of
-longitude, which, as we have already said, plays an important part
-in all questions relating to time; for longitude is used to measure
-the distance in an east-and-west direction between different parts
-of the earth.
-
-If we consider the earth as a large ball we can imagine a series of
-great circles drawn on its surface and passing directly from the
-North Pole to the South Pole. Such a circle could be drawn through
-any point on the earth. If we imagine a pair of them drawn through
-two cities, such as New York and London, the longitude difference
-of these two cities is defined as the angle at the North Pole
-between the two great circles in question. The size of this angle
-can be expressed in degrees. If we then wish to know the difference
-in time between New York and London in hours, we need only divide
-their longitude difference in degrees by the number 15. In this
-simple way we can get the time difference of any two places. We
-merely measure the longitude difference on a map, and then divide
-by 15 to get the time difference. These time differences can
-sometimes become quite large. Indeed, for two places differing 180
-degrees in longitude, the time difference will evidently be no less
-than twelve hours.
-
-Most civilized nations have agreed informally to adopt some one
-city as the fundamental point from which all longitudes are to
-be counted. Up to the present we have considered only longitude
-differences; but when we speak of the longitude of a city we mean
-its longitude difference from the place chosen by common consent as
-the origin for measuring longitudes. The town almost universally
-used for this purpose is Greenwich, near London, England. Here
-is situated the British Royal Observatory, one of the oldest and
-most important institutions of its kind in the world. The great
-longitude circle passing through the centre of the astronomical
-transit at the Greenwich observatory is the fundamental longitude
-circle of the earth. The longitude of any other town is then simply
-the angle at the pole between the longitude circle through that
-town and the fundamental Greenwich one here described.
-
-Longitudes are counted both eastward and westward from Greenwich.
-Thus New York is in 74 degrees west longitude, while Berlin is in
-14 degrees east longitude. This has led to a rather curious state
-of affairs in those parts of the earth the longitudes of which are
-nearly 180 degrees east or west. There are a number of islands
-in that part of the world, and if we imagine for a moment one
-whose longitude is just 180 degrees, we shall have the following
-remarkable result as to its time difference from Greenwich.
-
-We have seen that of any two places the eastern always has the
-later time. Now, since our imaginary island is exactly 180 degrees
-from Greenwich, we can consider it as being either 180 degrees east
-or 180 degrees west. But if we call it 180 degrees east, its time
-will be twelve hours later than Greenwich, and if we call it 180
-degrees west, its time will be twelve hours earlier than Greenwich.
-Evidently there will be a difference of just twenty-four hours, or
-one whole day, between these two possible ways of reckoning its
-time. This circumstance has actually led to considerable confusion
-in some of the islands of the Pacific Ocean. The navigators who
-discovered the various islands naturally gave them the date which
-they brought from Europe. And as some of these navigators sailed
-eastward, around the Cape of Good Hope, and others westward, around
-Cape Horn, the dates they gave to the several islands differed by
-just one day.
-
-The state of affairs at the present time has been adjusted by a
-sort of informal agreement. An arbitrary line has been drawn on
-the map near the 180th longitude circle, and it has been decided
-that the islands on the east side of this line shall count their
-longitudes west from Greenwich, and those west of the line shall
-count longitude east from Greenwich. Thus Samoa is nearly 180
-degrees west of Greenwich, while the Fiji Islands are nearly 180
-degrees east. Yet the islands are very near each other, though the
-arbitrary line passes between them. As a result, when it is Sunday
-in Samoa it is Monday in the Fiji Islands. The arbitrary line
-described here is sometimes called the International Date-Line.
-
-It does not pass very near the Philippine Islands, which are
-situated in about 120 degrees east longitude, and, therefore, use
-a time about eight hours later than Greenwich. New York, being
-about 74 degrees west of Greenwich, is about five hours earlier in
-time. Consequently, as we may remark in passing, Philippine time is
-about thirteen hours later than New York time. Thus, five o'clock,
-Sunday morning, May 1st, in Manila, would correspond to four
-o'clock, Saturday afternoon, April 30th, in New York.
-
-There is another kind of time which we shall explain briefly--the
-so-called "standard," or railroad time, which came into general
-use in the United States some few years ago, and has since been
-generally adopted throughout the world. It requires but a few
-moments' consideration to see that the accidental situation of
-the different large cities in any country will cause their local
-times to differ by odd numbers of hours, minutes, and seconds.
-Thus a great deal of inconvenience has been caused in the past.
-For instance, a train might leave New York at a certain hour by
-New York time. It would then arrive in Buffalo some hours later by
-New York time. But it would leave Buffalo by Buffalo time, which
-is quite different. Thus there would be a sort of jump in the
-time-table at Buffalo, and it would be a jump of an odd number of
-minutes.
-
-It would be different in different cities, and very hard to
-remember. Indeed, as each railway usually ran its trains by the
-time used in the principal city along its line, it might happen
-that three or four different railroad times would be used in a
-single city where several roads met. This has all been avoided by
-introducing the standard time system. According to this the whole
-country is divided into a series of time zones, fifteen degrees
-wide, and so arranged that the middle line of each zone falls at
-a point whose longitude from Greenwich is 60, 75, 90, 105, or 120
-degrees. The times at these middle lines are, therefore, earlier
-than Greenwich time by an even number of hours. Thus, for instance,
-the 75-degree line is just five even hours earlier than Greenwich
-time. All cities simply use the time of the nearest one of these
-special lines.
-
-This does not result in doing away with time differences
-altogether--that would, of course, be impossible in the nature
-of things--but for the complicated odd differences in hours
-and minutes, we have substituted the infinitely simpler series
-of differences in even hours. The traveller from Chicago to New
-York can reset his watch by putting it just one hour later on
-his arrival--the minute hand is kept unchanged, and no New York
-timepiece need be consulted to set the watch right on arriving.
-There can be no doubt that this standard-time system must be
-considered one of the most important contributions of astronomical
-science to the convenience of man.
-
-Its value has received the widest recognition, and its use has now
-extended to almost all civilized countries--France is the only
-nation of importance still remaining outside the time-zone system.
-In the following table we give the standard time of the various
-parts of the earth as compared with Greenwich, together with the
-date of adopting the new time system. It will be noticed that in
-certain cases even half-hours have been employed to separate the
-time-zones, instead of even hours as used in the United States.
-
-
-TABLE OF THE WORLD'S TIME STANDARDS
-
- ----------------+---------------------++------------------
- When it is Noon | || Date of Adopting
- at Greenwich | In || Standard Time
- it is | || System.
- ----------------+---------------------++------------------
- Noon | Great Britain. ||
- | Belgium. || May, 1892.
- | Holland. || May, 1892.
- | Spain. || January, 1901.
- 1 P.M. | Germany. || April, 1893.
- | Italy. || November, 1893.
- | Denmark. || January, 1894.
- | Switzerland. || June, 1894.
- | Norway. || January, 1895.
- | Austria (railways). ||
- 1.30 P.M. | Cape Colony. || 1892.
- | Orange River Colony.|| 1892.
- | Transvaal. || 1892.
- 2 P.M. | Natal. || September, 1895.
- | Turkey (railways). ||
- | Egypt. || October, 1900.
- 8 P.M. | West Australia. || February, 1895.
- 9 P.M. | Japan. || 1896.
- 9.30 P.M. | South Australia. || May, 1899.
- 10 P.M. | Victoria. || February, 1895.
- | New South Wales. || February, 1895.
- | Queensland. || February, 1895.
- 11 P.M. | New Zealand. ||
- ----------------+---------------------++------------------
-
- In the United States and Canada it is
- 4 A.M. by Pacific Time when it is Noon at Greenwich.
- 5 A.M. " Mountain " " " " " "
- 6 A.M. " Central " " " " " "
- 7 A.M. " Eastern " " " " " "
- 8 A.M. " Colonial " " " " " "
-
-
-
-
-MOTIONS OF THE EARTH'S POLE
-
-
-Students of geology have been puzzled for many years by traces
-remaining from the period when a large part of the earth was
-covered with a heavy cap of ice. These shreds of evidence all seem
-to point to the conclusion that the centre of the ice-covered
-region was quite far away from the present position of the north
-pole of the earth. If we are to regard the pole as very near the
-point of greatest cold, it becomes a matter of much interest to
-examine whether the pole has always occupied its present position,
-or whether it has been subject to slow changes of place upon
-the earth's surface. Therefore, the geologists have appealed to
-astronomers to discover whether they are in possession of any
-observational evidence tending to show that the pole is in motion.
-
-Now we may say at once that astronomical research has not as yet
-revealed the evidence thus expected. Astronomy has been unable to
-come to the rescue of geological theory. From about the year 1750,
-which saw the beginning of precise observation in the modern sense,
-down to very recent times, astronomers were compelled to deny the
-possibility of any appreciable motion of the pole. Observational
-processes, it is true, furnished slightly divergent pole positions
-from time to time. Yet these discrepancies were always so minute as
-to be indistinguishable from those slight personal errors that are
-ever inseparable from results obtained by the fallible human eye.
-
-But in the last few years improved methods of observation, coupled
-with extreme diligence in their application by astronomers
-generally, have brought to light a certain small motion of the pole
-which had never before been demonstrated in a reliable way. This
-motion, it is true, is not of the character demanded by geological
-theory, for the geologists had been led to expect a motion which
-would be continuous in the same direction, no matter how slow might
-be its annual amount; for the vast extent of geologic time would
-give even the slowest of motions an opportunity to produce large
-effects, provided its results could be continuously cumulative.
-Given time enough, and the pole might move anywhere on the earth,
-no matter how slow might be its tortoise speed.
-
-But the small motion we have discovered is neither cumulative nor
-continuous in one direction. It is what we call a periodic motion,
-the pole swinging now to one side, and now to the other, of its
-mean or average position. Thus this new discovery cannot be said
-to unravel the mysterious puzzle of the geologists. Yet it is not
-without the keenest interest, even from their point of view; for
-the proof of any form of motion in a pole previously supposed to be
-absolutely at rest may mean everything. No man can say what results
-will be revealed by the further observations now being continued
-with great diligence.
-
-In the first place, it is important to explain that any such
-motions as we have under consideration will show themselves to
-ordinary observational processes principally in the form of changes
-of terrestrial latitudes. Let us imagine a pair of straight lines
-passing through the centre of the earth and terminating, one at the
-observer's station on the earth's surface, and the other at that
-point of the equator which is nearest the observer. Then, according
-to the ordinary definition of latitude, the angle between these two
-imaginary lines is called the latitude of the point of observation.
-Now we know, of course, that the equator is everywhere just 90
-degrees from the pole. Consequently, if the pole is subject to any
-motion at all, the equator must also partake of the motion.
-
-Thus the angle between our two imaginary lines will be affected
-directly by polar movement, and the latitude obtained by
-astronomical observation will be subject to quite similar changes.
-To clear up the whole question, so far as this can be done by
-the gathering of observational evidence, it is only necessary to
-keep up a continual series of latitude determinations at several
-observatories. These determinations should show small variations
-similar in magnitude to the wabblings of the pole.
-
-Let us now consider for a moment what is meant by the axis of the
-earth. It has long been known that the planet has in general the
-shape of a ball or sphere. That this is so can be seen at once
-from the way ships at sea disappear at the horizon. As they go
-farther and farther from us, we first lose sight of the hull, and
-then slowly and gradually the spars and sails seem to sink down
-into the ocean. This proves that the earth's surface is curved.
-That it is more or less like a sphere is evident from the fact that
-it always casts a round shadow in eclipses. Sometimes the earth
-passes between the sun and eclipsed moon. Then we see the earth's
-black shadow projected on the moon, which would otherwise be quite
-bright. This shadow has been observed in a very large number of
-such eclipses, and it has always been found to have a circular edge.
-
-While, therefore, the earth is nearly a round ball, it must not be
-supposed that it is exactly spherical in form. We may disregard
-the small irregularities of its surface, for even the greatest
-mountains are insignificant in height when compared with the
-entire diameter of the earth itself. But even leaving these out of
-account, the earth is not perfectly spherical. We can describe it
-best as a flattened sphere. It is as though one were to press a
-round rubber ball between two smooth boards. It would be flattened
-at the top and bottom and bulged out in the middle. This is the
-shape of the earth. It is flattened at the poles and bulges out
-near the equator. The shortest straight line that can be drawn
-through the earth's centre and terminated by the flattened parts of
-its surface may be called the earth's axis of figure; and the two
-points where this axis meets the surface are called the poles of
-figure.
-
-But the earth has another axis, called the axis of rotation. This
-is the one about which the planet turns once in a day, giving
-rise to the well-known phenomena called the rising and setting of
-sun, moon, and stars. For these motions of the heavenly bodies
-are really only apparent ones, caused by an actual motion of the
-observer on the earth. The observer turns with the earth on its
-axis, and is thus carried past the sun and stars.
-
-This daily turning of the earth, then, takes place about the axis
-of rotation. Now, it so happens that all kinds of astronomical
-observations for the determination of latitude lead to values based
-on the rotation axis of the earth, and not on its axis of figure.
-We have seen how the earth's equator, from which we count our
-latitudes, is everywhere 90 degrees distant from the pole. But this
-pole is the pole of rotation, or the point at which the rotation
-axis pierces the earth's surface. It is not the pole of figure.
-
-It is clear that the latitude of any observatory will remain
-constant only if the pole of figure and the rotation pole maintain
-absolutely the same positions relatively one to the other. These
-two poles are actually very near together; indeed, it was supposed
-for a very long time that they were absolutely coincident, so that
-there could not be any variations of latitude. But it now appears
-that they are separated slightly.
-
-Strange to say, one of them is revolving about the other in a
-little curve. The pole of figure is travelling around the pole of
-rotation. The distance between them varies a little, never becoming
-greater than about fifty feet, and it takes about fourteen months
-to complete a revolution. There are some slight irregularities in
-the motion, but, in the main, it takes place in the manner here
-stated. In consequence of this rotation of the one pole about the
-other, the pole of figure is now on one side of the rotation pole
-and now on the opposite side, but it never travels continuously
-in one direction. Thus, as we have already seen, the sort of
-continuous motion required to explain the observed geological
-phenomena has not yet been found by astronomers.
-
-Observations for the study of latitude variations have been made
-very extensively within recent years both in Europe and the United
-States. It has been found practically most advantageous to carry
-out simultaneous series of observations at two observatories
-situated in widely different parts of the earth, but having very
-nearly the same latitude. It is then possible to employ the same
-stars for observation in both places, whereas it would be necessary
-to use different sets of stars if there were much difference in the
-latitudes.
-
-There is a special advantage in using the same stars in both
-places. We can then determine the small difference in latitude
-between the two participating observatories in a manner which
-will make it quite free from any uncertainty in our knowledge of
-the positions on the sky of the stars observed; for, strange
-as it may seem, our star-catalogues do not contain absolutely
-accurate numbers. Like all other data depending on fallible
-human observation, they are affected with small errors. But if
-we can determine simply the difference in latitude of the two
-observatories, we can discover from its variation the path in
-which the pole is moving. If, for instance, the observatories are
-separated by one-quarter the circumference of the globe, the pole
-will be moving directly toward one of them, when it is not changing
-its distance from the other one at all.
-
-This method was used for seven years with good effect at the
-observatories of Columbia University in New York, and the Royal
-Observatory at Naples, Italy. For obtaining its most complete
-advantages it is, of course, better to establish several observing
-stations on about the same parallel of latitude. This was done
-in 1899 by the International Geodetic Association. Two stations
-are in the United States, one in Japan, and one in Sicily. We
-can, therefore, hope confidently that our knowledge as to the
-puzzling problem of polar motion will soon receive very material
-advancement.
-
-
-
-
-SATURN'S RINGS
-
-
-The death of James E. Keeler, Director of the Lick Observatory, in
-California (p. 32), recalls to mind one of the most interesting
-and significant of later advances in astronomical science.
-Only seven years have elapsed since Keeler made the remarkable
-spectroscopic observations which gave for the first time an ocular
-demonstration of the true character of those mysterious luminous
-rings surrounding the brilliant planet Saturn. His results have not
-yet been made sufficiently accessible to the public at large, nor
-have they been generally valued at their true worth. We consider
-this work of Keeler's interesting, because the problem of the rings
-has been a classic one for many generations; and we have been
-particular, also, to call it significant, because it is pregnant
-with the possibilities of newer methods of spectroscopic research,
-applied in the older departments of observational astronomy.
-
-The troubles of astronomers with the rings began with the invention
-of the telescope itself. They date back to 1610, when Galileo
-first turned his new instrument to the heavens (p. 49). It may
-be imagined easily that the bright planet Saturn was among the
-very first objects scrutinized by him. His "powerful" instrument
-magnified only about thirty times, and was, doubtless, much
-inferior to our pocket telescopes of to-day. But it showed, at
-all events, that something was wrong with Saturn. Galileo put it,
-"_Ultimam planet am tergeminam observavi_" ("I have observed the
-furthest planet to be triple").
-
-It is easy to understand now how Galileo's eyes deceived him. For
-a round luminous ball like Saturn, surrounded by a thin flat ring
-seen nearly edgewise, really looks as if it had two little attached
-appendages. Strange, indeed, it is to-day to read a scientific
-book so old that the planet Saturn could be called the "furthest"
-planet. But it was the outermost known in Galileo's day, and
-for nearly two centuries afterward. Not until 1781 did William
-Herschel discover Uranus (p. 59); and Neptune was not disclosed by
-the marvellous mathematical perception of Le Verrier until 1846 (p.
-61).
-
-Galileo's further observations of Saturn bothered him more and
-more. The planet's behavior became much worse as time went on.
-"Has Saturn devoured his children, according to the old legend?"
-he inquired soon afterward; for the changed positions of earth
-and planet in the course of their motions around the sun in their
-respective orbits had become such that the ring was seen quite
-edgewise, and was, therefore, perfectly invisible to Galileo's
-"optic tube." The puzzle remained unsolved by Galileo; it was left
-for another great man to find the true answer. Huygens, in 1656,
-first announced that the ring _is_ a ring.
-
-The manner in which this announcement was made is characteristic
-of the time; to-day it seems almost ludicrous. Huygens published a
-little pamphlet in 1656 called "_De Saturni Luna Observatio Nova_"
-or, "A New Observation of Saturn's Moon." He gave the explanation
-of what had been observed by himself and preceding astronomers in
-the form of a puzzle, or "logogriph." Here is what he had to say of
-the phenomenon in question:
-
-"aaaaaaa ccccc d eeeee g h iiiiiii llll mm nnnnnnnnn oooo pp q rr s
-ttttt uuuuu."
-
-It was not until 1659, three years later, in a book entitled
-"_Systema Saturnium_," that Huygens rearranged the above letters in
-their proper order, giving the Latin sentence:
-
-"_Annulo cingitur, tenui plano, nusquam cohaerente, ad eclipticam
-inclinato._" Translated into English, this sentence informs us that
-the planet "is girdled with a thin, flat ring, nowhere touching
-Saturn, and inclined to the ecliptic"!
-
-This was a perfectly correct and wonderfully sagacious explanation
-of those complex and exasperatingly puzzling phenomena that had
-been too difficult for no less a person than Galileo himself. It
-was an explanation that _explained_. The reason for its preliminary
-announcement in the above manner must have been the following:
-Huygens was probably not quite sure of his ground in 1656,
-while three years afterward he had become quite certain. By the
-publication of the logogriph of 1656 he secured for himself the
-credit of what he had done. If any other astronomer had published
-the true explanation after 1656, Huygens could have proved his
-claim to priority by rearranging the letters of his puzzle. On the
-other hand, if further researches showed him that he was wrong,
-he would never have made known the true meaning of his logogriph,
-and would thus have escaped the ignominy of making an erroneous
-explanation. Thus, the method of announcement was comparable in
-ingenuity with the Huygenian explanation itself.
-
-We are compelled to pass over briefly the entertaining history of
-subsequent observations of the ring, in order to explain the new
-work of Keeler and others. Cassini, about 1675, been able to show
-that the ring was double; that there are really two independent
-rings, with a distinct dark space between them. It was a case of
-wheels within wheels. To our own eminent countryman, W. C. Bond,
-of Cambridge, Mass., we owe the further discovery (Harvard College
-Observatory, November, 1850) of the third ring. This is also
-concentric with the other two, and interior to them, but difficult
-to observe, because of its much smaller luminosity.
-
-It is almost transparent, and the brilliant light of the planet's
-central ball is capable of shining directly through it. For this
-reason the inner ring is called the "gauze" or "crape" ring. If we
-add to the above details the fact that our modern large telescopes
-show slight irregularities in the surface of the rings, especially
-when seen edgewise, we have a brief statement of all that the
-telescope has been able to reveal to us since Galileo's time.
-
-But of far greater interest than the mere fact of their existence
-is the important cosmic question as to the constitution, structure,
-and, above all, durability of the ring system. Astronomers often
-use the term "stability" with regard to celestial systems like the
-ring system of Saturn. By this they mean permanent durability. A
-system is stable if its various parts can continue in their present
-relationship to one another, without violating any of the known
-laws of astronomy. Whenever we study any collection of celestial
-objects, and endeavor to explain their motions and peculiarities,
-we always seek some explanation not inconsistent with the continued
-existence of the phenomena in question. For this there is, perhaps,
-no sufficient philosophical basis. Probably much of the great
-celestial procession is but a passing show, to be but for a moment
-in the endless vista of cosmic time.
-
-However this may be, we are bound to assume as a working theory
-that Saturn has always had these rings, and will always have them;
-and it is for us to find out how this is possible. The problem has
-been attacked mathematically by various astronomers, including
-Laplace; but no conclusive mathematical treatment was obtained
-until 1857, when James Clerk Maxwell proved in a masterly manner
-that the rings could be neither solid nor liquid. He showed,
-indeed, that they would not last if they were continuous bodies
-like the planets. A big solid wheel would inevitably be torn
-asunder by any slight disturbance, and then precipitated upon
-the planet's surface. Therefore, the rings must be composed of
-an immense number of small detached particles, revolving around
-Saturn in separate orbits, like so many tiny satellites.
-
-This mathematical theory of the ring system being once established,
-astronomers were more eager than ever to obtain a visual
-confirmation of it. We had, indeed, a sort of analogy in the
-assemblage of so-called "minor planets" (p. 64), which are known
-to be revolving around our sun in orbits situated between Mars and
-Jupiter. Some hundreds of these are known to exist, and probably
-there are countless others too small for us to see. Such a swarm
-of tiny particles of luminous matter would certainly give the
-impression of a continuous solid body, if seen from a distance
-comparable to that separating us from Saturn. But arguments founded
-on analogy are of comparatively little value.
-
-Astronomers need direct and conclusive telescopic evidence, and
-this was lacking until Keeler made his remarkable spectroscopic
-observation in 1895. The spectroscope is a peculiar instrument,
-different in principle from any other used in astronomy; we study
-distant objects with it by analyzing the light they send us, rather
-than by examining and measuring the details of their visible
-surfaces. The reader will recall that according to the modern
-undulatory theory, light consists simply of a series of waves.
-Now, the nature of waves is very far from being understood in the
-popular mind. Most people, for instance, think that the waves of
-ocean consist of great masses of water rolling along the surface.
-
-This notion doubtless arises from the behavior of waves when
-they break upon the shore, forming what we call surf. When a
-wave meets with an immovable body like a sand beach, the wave is
-broken, and the water really does roll upon the beach. But this
-is an exceptional case. Farther away from the shore, where the
-waves are unimpeded, they consist simply of particles of water
-moving straight up and down. None of the water is carried by mere
-wave-action away from the point over which it was situated at first.
-
-Tides or other causes may move the water, but not simple
-wave-motion alone. That this is so can be proved easily. If a chip
-of wood be thrown overboard from a ship at sea it will be seen to
-rise and fall a long time on the waves, but it will not move.
-Similarly, wind-waves are often quite conspicuous on a field of
-grain; but they are caused by the individual grain particles moving
-up and down. The grain certainly cannot travel over the ground,
-since each particle is fast to its own stalk.
-
-But while the particles do not travel, the wave-disturbance
-does. At times it is transmitted to a considerable distance from
-the point where it was first set in motion. Thus, when a stone
-is dropped into still water, the disturbance (though not the
-water) travels in ever-widening circles, until at last it becomes
-too feeble for us to perceive. Light is just such a travelling
-wave-disturbance. Beginning, perhaps, in some distant star, it
-travels through space, and finally the wave impinges on our eyes
-like the ocean-wave breaking on a sand beach. Such a light-wave
-affects the eye in some mysterious way. We call it "seeing."
-
-The spectroscope (p. 21) enables us to measure and count the waves
-reaching us each second from any source of light. No matter how far
-away the origin of stellar light may be, the spectroscope examines
-the character of that light, and tells us the number of waves set
-up every second. It is this characteristic of the instrument that
-has enabled us to make some of the most remarkable observations of
-modern times. If the distant star is approaching us in space, more
-light-waves per second will reach us than we should receive from
-the same star at rest. Thus if we find from the spectroscope that
-there are too many waves, we know that the star is coming nearer;
-and if there are too few, we can conclude with equal certainty that
-the star is receding.
-
-Keeler was able to apply the spectroscope in this way to the planet
-Saturn and to the ring system. The observations required dexterity
-and observational manipulative skill in a superlative degree. These
-Keeler had; and this work of his will always rank as a classic
-observation. He found by examining the light-waves from opposite
-sides of the planet that the luminous ball rotated; for one side
-was approaching us and the other receding. This observation was,
-of course, in accord with the known fact of Saturn's rotation
-on his axis. With regard to the rings, Keeler showed in the same
-way the existence of an axial rotation, which appears not to have
-been satisfactorily proved before, strange as it may seem. But the
-crucial point established by his spectroscope was that the interior
-part of the rings rotates _faster_ than the exterior.
-
-The velocity of rotation diminishes gradually from the inside to
-the outside. This fact is absolutely inconsistent with the motion
-of a solid ring; but it fits in admirably with the theory of a
-ring comprised of a vast assemblage of small separate particles.
-Thus, for the first time, astronomy comes into possession of an
-observational determination of the nature of Saturn's rings, and
-Galileo's puzzle is forever solved.
-
-
-
-
-THE HELIOMETER
-
-
-Astronomical discoveries are always received by the public with
-keen interest. Every new fact read in the great open book of nature
-is written eagerly into the books of men. For there exists a strong
-curiosity to ascertain just how the greater world is built and
-governed; and it must be admitted that astronomers have been able
-to satisfy that curiosity with no small measure of success. But it
-is seldom that we hear of the means by which the latest and most
-refined astronomical observations are effected. Popular imagination
-pictures the astronomer, as he doubtless once was, an aged
-gentleman, usually having a long white beard, and spending entire
-nights staring at the sky through a telescope.
-
-But the facts to-day are very different. The working astronomer
-is an active man in the prime of life, often a young man. He
-wastes no time in star-gazing. His observations consist of
-exact measurements made in a precise, systematic, and almost
-business-like manner. A night's "watch" at the telescope is
-seldom allowed to exceed about three hours, since it is found
-that more continued exertions fatigue the eye and lead to less
-accurate results. To this, of course, there have been many notable
-exceptions, for endurance of sight, like any form of physical
-strength, differs greatly in different individuals. Astronomical
-research does not include "picking out" the constellations, and
-learning the Arabic names of individual stars. These things are not
-without interest; but they belong to astronomy's ancient history,
-and are of little value except to afford amusement and instruction
-to successive generations of amateurs.
-
-Among the instruments for carefully planned measurements of
-precision the heliometer probably takes first rank. It is at
-once the most exquisitely accurate in its results, and the most
-fatiguing to the observer, of all the varied apparatus employed by
-the astronomer. The principle upon which its construction depends
-is very peculiar, and applies to all telescopes, even ordinary
-ones for terrestrial purposes. If part of a telescope lens be
-covered up with the hand, it will still be possible to see through
-the instrument. The glass lens at the end of the tube farthest from
-the observer's eye helps to magnify distant objects and make them
-seem nearer by gathering to a single point, or focus, a greater
-amount of their light than could be brought together by the far
-smaller lens in the unaided eye.
-
-The telescope might very properly be likened to an enlarged eye,
-which can see more than we can, simply because it is bigger. If
-a telescope lens has a surface one hundred times as large as
-that of the lens in our eye, it will gather and bring to a focus
-one hundred times as much light from a distant object. Now, if
-any part of this telescope be covered, the remaining part will,
-nevertheless, gather and focus light just as though the whole lens
-were in action; only, there will be less light collected at the
-focus within the tube. The small lens at the telescope's eye-end is
-simply a magnifier to help our eye examine the image of any distant
-object formed at the focus by the large lens at the farther end of
-the instrument. For of this simple character is the operation of
-any telescope: the large glass lens at one end collects a distant
-planet's light, and brings it to a focus near the other end of the
-tube, where it forms a tiny picture of the planet, which, in turn,
-is examined with the little magnifier at the eye-end.
-
-Having arrived at the fundamental principle that part of a lens
-will act in a manner similar to a whole one, it is easy to explain
-the construction of a heliometer. An ordinary telescope lens is
-sawed in half by means of a thin round metal disk revolved rapidly
-by machinery, and fed continually with emery and water at its
-edge. The cutting effect of emery is sufficient to make such a
-disk enter glass much as an ordinary saw penetrates wood. The two
-"semi-lenses," as they are called, are then mounted separately in
-metal holders. These are attached to one end of the heliometer,
-called the "head," in such a way that the two semi-lenses can slide
-side by side upon metal guides. This head is then fastened to one
-end of a telescope tube mounted in the usual way. The "head" end
-of the instrument is turned toward the sky in observing, and at
-the eye-end is placed the usual little magnifier we have already
-described.
-
-The observer at the eye-end has control of certain rods by means
-of which he can push the semi-lenses on their slides in the head
-at the other end of the tube. Now, if he moves the semi-lenses so
-as to bring them side by side exactly, the whole arrangement will
-act like an ordinary telescope. For the semi-lenses will then fit
-together just as if the original glass had never been cut. But
-if the half-lenses are separated a little on their slides, each
-will act by itself. Being slightly separated, each will cover a
-different part of the sky. The whole affair acts as if the observer
-at the eye-end were looking through two telescopes at once. For
-each semi-lens acts independently, just as if it were a complete
-glass of only half the size.
-
-Now, suppose there were a couple of stars in the sky, one in the
-part covered by the first semi-lens, and one in the part covered
-by the second. The observer would, of course, see both stars at
-once upon looking into the little magnifier at the eye-end of the
-heliometer.
-
-We must remember that these stars will appear in the field of view
-simply as two tiny points of light. The astronomer, as we have
-said, is provided with a simple system of long rods, by means of
-which he can manipulate the semi-lenses while the observation is
-being made. If he slides them very slowly one way or the other, the
-two star-points in the field of view will be seen to approach each
-other. In this way they can at last be brought so near together
-that they will form but a single dot of light. Observation with
-the heliometer consists in thus bringing two star-images together,
-until at last they are superimposed one upon the other, and we see
-one image only. Means are provided by which it is then possible to
-measure the amount of separation of the two half-lenses. Evidently
-the farther asunder on the sky are the two stars under observation,
-the greater will be the separation of the semi-lenses necessary
-to make a single image of their light. Thus, measurement of the
-lenses' separation becomes a means of determining the separation
-of the stars themselves upon the sky.
-
-The two slides in the heliometer head are supplied with a pair of
-very delicate measures or "scales" usually made of silver. These
-can be examined from the eye-end of the instrument by looking
-through a long microscope provided for this special purpose. Thus
-an extremely precise value is obtained both of the separation of
-the sliders and of the distance on the sky between the stars under
-examination. Measures made in this way with the heliometer are
-counted the most precise of astronomical observations.
-
-Having thus described briefly the kind of observations obtained
-with the heliometer, we shall now touch upon their further
-utilization. We shall take as an example but one of their many
-uses--that one which astronomers consider the most important--the
-measurement of stellar distances. (See also p. 94.)
-
-Even the nearest fixed star is almost inconceivably remote from
-us. And astronomers are imprisoned on this little earth; we cannot
-bridge the profound distance separating us from the stars, so as
-to use direct measurement with tape-line or surveyor's chain. We
-are forced to have recourse to some indirect method. Suppose a
-certain star is suspected, on account of its brightness, or for
-some other reason, of being near us in space, and so giving a
-favorable opportunity for a determination of distance. A couple of
-very faint stars are selected close by. These, on account of their
-faintness, the astronomer may regard as quite immeasurably far
-away. He then determines with his heliometer the exact position on
-the sky of the bright star with respect to the pair of faint ones.
-Half a year is then allowed to pass. During that time the earth has
-been swinging along in its annual path or orbit around the sun.
-Half a year will have sufficed to carry the observer on the earth
-to the other side of that path, and he is then 185,000,000 miles
-away from his position at the first observation.
-
-Another determination is made of the bright star's position as
-referred to the two faint ones. Now, if all these stars were
-equally distant, their relative positions at the second observation
-would be just the same as at the former one. But if, as is very
-probable, the bright star is very much nearer us than are the two
-faint ones, we shall obtain a different position from our second
-observation. For the change of 185,000,000 miles in the observer's
-location will, of course, affect the direction in which we see
-the near star, while it will leave the distant ones practically
-unchanged. Without entering into technical details, we may say that
-from a large number of observations of this kind, we can obtain
-the distance of the bright star by a process of calculation. The
-only essential is to have an instrument that can make the actual
-observations of position accurately enough; and in this respect the
-heliometer is still unexcelled.
-
-
-
-
-OCCULTATIONS
-
-
-Scarcely anyone can have watched the sky without noticing how
-different is the behavior of our moon from that of any other object
-we can see. Of course, it has this in common with the sun and stars
-and planets, that it rises in the eastern horizon, slowly climbs
-the dome of the sky, and again goes down and sets in the west.
-This motion of the heavenly bodies is known to be an apparent one
-merely, and caused by the turning of our own earth upon its axis. A
-man standing upon the earth's surface can look up and see above him
-one-half the great celestial vault, gemmed with twinkling stars,
-and bearing, perhaps, within its ample curve one or two serenely
-shining planets and the lustrous moon. But at any given moment the
-observer can see nothing of the other half of the heavenly sphere.
-It is beneath his feet, and concealed by the solid bulk of the
-earth.
-
-The earth, however, is turning on an axis, carrying the observer
-with it. And so it is continually presenting him to a new part of
-the sky. At any moment he sees but a single half-sphere; yet the
-very next instant it is no longer the same; a small portion has
-passed out of sight on one side by going down behind the turning
-earth, while a corresponding new section has come into view on
-the opposite side. It is this coming into view that we call the
-rising of a star; and the corresponding disappearance on the other
-side is called setting. Thus rising and setting are, of course,
-due entirely to a turning of the earth, and not at all to actual
-motions of the stars; and for this reason, all objects in the sky,
-without exception, must rise and set again. But the moon really has
-a motion of its own in addition to this apparent one caused by the
-earth's rotation.
-
-Somewhere in the dawn of time early watchers of the stars thought
-out those fancied constellations that survive even down to our own
-day. They placed the mighty lion, king of beasts, upon the face
-of night, and the great hunter, too, armed with club and dagger,
-to pursue him. Among these constellations the moon threads her
-destined way, night after night, so rapidly that the unaided eye
-can see that she is moving. It needs but little power of fancy's
-magic to recall from the dim past a picture of some aged astronomer
-graving upon his tablets the Records of the Moon. "To-night she is
-near the bright star in the eye of the Bull." And again: "To-night
-she rides full, and near to the heart of the Virgin."
-
-And why does the moon ride thus through the stars of night? Modern
-science has succeeded in disentangling the intricacies of her
-motion, until to-day only one or two of the very minutest details
-of that motion remain unexplained. But it has been a hard problem.
-Someone has well said that lunar theory should be likened to a
-lofty cliff upon whose side the intellectual giants among men can
-mark off their mental stature, but whose height no one of them may
-ever hope to scale.
-
-But for our present purpose it is unnecessary to pursue the subject
-of lunar motion into its abstruser details. To understand why the
-moon moves rapidly among the stars, it is sufficient to remember
-that she is whirling quickly round the earth, so as to complete
-her circuit in a little less than a month. We see her at all times
-projected upon the distant background of the sky on which are set
-the stellar points of light, as though intended for beacons to
-mark the course pursued by moon and planets. The stars themselves
-have no such motions as the moon; situated at a distance almost
-inconceivably great, they may, indeed, be travellers through empty
-space, yet their journeys shrink into insignificance as seen from
-distant earth. It requires the most delicate instruments of the
-astronomer to so magnify the tiny displacements of the stars on the
-celestial vault that they may be measured by human eyes.
-
-Let us again recur to our supposed observer watching the moon night
-after night, so as to record the stars closely approached by her.
-Why should he not some time or other be surprised by an approach so
-close as to amount apparently to actual contact? The moon covers
-quite a large surface on the sky, and when we remember the nearly
-countless numbers of the stars, it would, indeed, be strange if
-there were not some behind the moon as well as all around her.
-
-A moment's consideration shows that this must often be the case;
-and in fact, if the moon's advancing edge be scrutinized carefully
-through a telescope, small stars can be seen frequently to
-disappear behind it. This is a most interesting observation. At
-first we see the moon and star near each other in the telescope's
-field of view. But the distance between them lessens perceptibly,
-even quickly, until at last, with a startling suddenness, the star
-goes out of sight behind the moon. After a time, ranging from a few
-moments to, perhaps, more than an hour, the moon will pass, and we
-can see the star suddenly reappear from behind the other edge.
-
-These interesting observations, while not at all uncommon, can
-be made only very rarely by naked-eye astronomers. The reason is
-simple. The moon's light is so brilliant that it fairly overcomes
-the stars whenever they are at all near, except in the case of
-very bright ones. Small stars that can be followed quite easily
-up to the moon's edge in a good telescope, disappear from a
-naked-eye view while the moon is still a long distance away. But
-the number of very bright stars is comparatively small, so that
-it is quite unusual to find anyone not a professional astronomer
-who has actually seen one of these so-called "occultations."
-Moreover, most people are not informed in advance of the occurrence
-of an opportunity to make such observations, although they can be
-predicted quite easily by the aid of astronomical calculations.
-Sometimes we have occultations of planets, and these are the most
-interesting of all. When the moon passes between us and one of the
-larger planets, it is worth while to observe the phenomenon even
-without a telescope.
-
-Up to this point we have considered occultations chiefly as being
-of interest to the naked-eye astronomer. Yet occultations have a
-real scientific value. It is by their means that we can, perhaps,
-best measure the moon's size. By noting with a telescope the time
-of disappearance and reappearance of known stars, astronomers can
-bring the direct measurement of the moon's diameter within the
-range of their numerical calculations. Sometimes the moon passes
-over a condensed cluster of stars like the Pleiades. The results
-obtainable on these occasions are valuable in a very high degree,
-and contribute largely to making precise our knowledge of the lunar
-diameter.
-
-There is another thing of scientific interest about occultations,
-though it has lost some of its importance in recent years. When
-such an event has been observed, the agreement of the predicted
-time with that actually recorded by the astronomer offers a most
-searching test of the correctness of our theory of lunar motion. We
-have already called attention to the great inherent difficulty of
-this theory. It is easy to see that by noting the exact instant of
-disappearance of a star at a place on the earth the latitude and
-longitude of which are known, we can both check our calculations
-and gather material for improving our theory. The same principle
-can be used also in the converse direction. Within the limits of
-precision imposed by the state of our knowledge of lunar theory,
-we can utilize occultations to help determine the position on
-the earth of places whose longitude is unknown. It is a very
-interesting bit of history that the first determination of the
-longitude of Washington was made by means of occultations, and that
-this early determination led to the founding of the United States
-Naval Observatory.
-
-On March 28, 1810, Mr. Pitkin, of Connecticut, reported to
-the House of Representatives on "laying a foundation for the
-establishment of a first meridian for the United States, by which a
-further dependence on Great Britain or any other foreign nation for
-such meridian may be entirely removed." This report was the result
-of a memorial presented by one William Lambert, who had deduced the
-longitude of the Capitol from an occultation observed October 20,
-1804. Various proceedings were had in Congress and in committee,
-until at last, in 1821, Lambert was appointed "to make astronomical
-observations by lunar occultations of fixed stars, solar eclipses,
-or any approved method adapted to ascertain the longitude of the
-Capitol from Greenwich." Lambert's reports were made in 1822
-and 1823, but ten years passed before the establishment of a
-formal Naval Observatory under Goldsborough, Wilkes, and Gilliss.
-But to Lambert belongs the honor of having marked out the first
-fundamental official meridian of longitude in the United States.
-
-
-
-
-MOUNTING GREAT TELESCOPES
-
-
-There are many interesting practical things about an astronomical
-observatory with which the public seldom has an opportunity to
-become acquainted. Among these, perhaps, the details connected
-with setting up a great telescope take first rank. The writer
-happened to be present at the Cape of Good Hope Observatory when
-the photographic equatorial telescope was being mounted, and the
-operation of putting it in position may be taken as typical of
-similar processes elsewhere. (See also p. 86.)
-
-[Illustration: Forty-Inch Telescope, Yerkes Observatory, University
-of Chicago.]
-
-In the first place, it is necessary to explain what is meant by an
-"equatorial" telescope. One of the chief difficulties in making
-ordinary observations arises from the rising and setting of the
-stars. They are all apparently moving across the face of the sky,
-usually climbing up from the eastern horizon, only to go down again
-and set in the west. If, therefore, we wish to scrutinize any
-given object for a considerable time, we must move the telescope
-continuously so as to keep pace with the motion of the heavens. For
-this purpose, the tube must be attached to axles, so that it can be
-turned easily in any direction. The equatorial mounting is a device
-that permits the telescope to be thus aimed at any part of the sky,
-and at the same time facilitates greatly the operation of keeping
-it pointed correctly after a star has once been brought into the
-field of view.
-
-To understand the equatorial mounting it is necessary to remember
-that the rising and setting motions of the heavenly bodies are
-apparent ones only, and due in reality to the turning of the earth
-on its own axis. As the earth goes around, it carries observer,
-telescope, and observatory past the stars fixed upon the distant
-sky. Consequently, to keep a telescope pointed continuously at a
-given star, it is merely necessary to rotate it steadily backward
-upon a suitable axis just fast enough to neutralize exactly the
-turning of our earth.
-
-By a suitable axis for this purpose we mean one so mounted as
-to be exactly parallel to the earth's own axis of rotation. A
-little reflection shows how simply such an arrangement will work.
-All the heavenly bodies may be regarded, for practical purposes,
-as excessively remote in comparison with the dimensions of our
-earth. The entire planet shrinks into absolute insignificance
-when compared with the distances of the nearest objects brought
-under observation by astronomers. It follows that if we have our
-telescope attached to such a rotation-axis as we have described,
-it will be just the same for purposes of observation as though the
-telescope's axis were not only parallel to the earth's axis, but
-actually coincident with it. The two axes may be separated by a
-distance equal to that between the earth's surface and its centre;
-but, as we have said, this distance is insignificant so far as our
-present object is concerned.
-
-There is another way to arrive at the same result. We know that
-the stars in rising and setting all seem to revolve about the pole
-star, which itself seems to remain immovable. Consequently, if we
-mount our telescope so that it can turn about an axis pointing at
-the pole, we shall be able to neutralize the rotation of the stars
-by simply turning the telescope about the axis at the proper speed
-and in the right direction. Astronomical considerations teach us
-that an axis thus pointing at the pole will be parallel to the
-earth's own axis. Thus we arrive at the same fundamental principle
-for mounting an astronomical telescope from whichever point of view
-we consider the subject.
-
-Every large telescope is provided with such an axis of rotation;
-and for the reason stated it is called the "polar axis." The
-telescope itself is then called an "equatorial." The advantage
-of this method of mounting is very evident. Since we can follow
-the stars' motions by turning the telescope about one axis only,
-it becomes a very simple matter to accomplish this turning
-automatically by means of clock-work.
-
-The "following" of a star being thus provided for by the device
-of a polar axis, it is, of course, also necessary to supply some
-other motion so as to enable us to aim the tube at any point in the
-heavens. For it is obvious that if it were rigidly attached to the
-polar axis, we could, indeed, follow any star that happened to be
-in the field of view, but we could not change this field of view at
-will so as to observe other stars or planets. To accomplish this,
-the telescope is attached to the polar axis by means of a pivot.
-By turning the telescope around its polar axis, and also on this
-pivot, we can find any object in the heavens; and once found, we
-can leave to the polar axis and its automatic clock-work the task
-of keeping that object before the observer's eye.
-
-In setting up the Cape of Good Hope instrument the astronomers were
-obliged to do a large part of the work of adjustment personally.
-Far away from European instrument-makers, the parts of the
-mounting and telescope had to be "assembled," or put together, by
-the astronomers of the Cape Observatory. A heavy pier of brick
-and masonry had been prepared in advance. Upon this was placed a
-massive iron base, intended to support the superstructure of polar
-axis and telescope. This base rested on three points, one of which
-could be screwed in and out, so as to tilt the whole affair a
-little forward or backward. By means of this screw we effected the
-final adjustment of the polar axis to exact parallelism with that
-of the earth. Other screws were provided with which the base could
-be twisted a little horizontally either to the right or left. Once
-set up in a position almost correct, it was easy to perfect the
-adjustment by the aid of these screws.
-
-Afterward the tube and lenses were put in place, and the clock
-properly attached inside the big cast-iron base. This clock-work
-looked more like a piece of heavy machinery than a delicate clock
-mechanism. But it had heavy work to do, carrying the massive
-telescope with its weighty lenses, and needed to be correspondingly
-strong. It had a driving-weight of about 2,000 pounds, and was so
-powerful that turning the telescope affected it no more than the
-hour-hand of an ordinary clock affects the mechanism within its
-case.
-
-The final test of the whole adjustment consisted in noting whether
-stars once brought into the telescopic field of view could be
-maintained there automatically by means of the clock. This object
-having been attained successfully, the instrument stood ready to be
-used in the routine business of the observatory.
-
-Before leaving the subject of telescope-mountings, we must mention
-the giant instrument set up at the Paris Exposition of 1900. The
-project of having a _Grande Lunette_ had been hailed by newspapers
-throughout the world and by the general public in their customary
-excitable way. It was tremendously over-advertised; exaggerated
-notions of the instrument's powers were spread abroad and eagerly
-credited; the moon was to be dragged down, as it were, from its
-customary place in the sky, so near that we should be able almost
-to touch its surface. As to the planets--free license was given to
-the journalistic imagination, and there was no effective limitation
-to the magnificence of astronomical discovery practically within
-our grasp, beyond the necessity for printed space demanded by
-sundry wars, pestilences, and other mundane trifles.
-
-[Illustration: Yerkes Observatory, University of Chicago.]
-
-Now, the present writer is very far from advocating a lessening of
-the attention devoted to astronomy. Rather would he magnify his
-office than diminish it. But let journalistic astronomy be as good
-an imitation of sober scientific truth as can be procured at space
-rates; let editors encourage the public to study those things
-in the science that are ennobling and cultivating to the mind;
-let there be an end to the frenzied effort to fabricate a highly
-colored account of alleged discoveries of yesterday, capable of
-masquerading to-day under heavy head-lines as News.
-
-The manner in which the big telescope came to be built is not
-without interest, and shows that enterprise is far from dead, even
-in the old countries. A stock company was organized--we should
-call it a corporation--under the name _Société de l'Optique_. It
-would appear that shares were regularly put on the market, and
-that a prospectus, more or less alluring, was widely distributed.
-We may say at once that the investing public did not respond
-with obtrusive alacrity; but at all events, the promoters'
-efforts received sufficient encouragement to enable them to begin
-active work. From the very first a vigorous attempt was made to
-utilize both the resources of genuine science and the devices of
-quasi-charlatanry. It was announced that the public were to be
-admitted to look through the big glass (apparently at so much an
-eye), and many, doubtless, expected that the man in the street
-would be able to make personal acquaintance with the man in the
-moon. A telescopic image of the sun was to be projected on a big
-screen, and exhibited to a concourse of spectators assembled in
-rising tiers of seats within a great amphitheatre. And when clouds
-or other circumstances should prevent observing the planets or
-scrutinizing the sun, a powerful stereopticon was to be used.
-Artificial pictures of the wonders of heaven were to be projected
-on the screen, and the public would never be disappointed. It
-was arranged that skilled talkers should be present to explain
-all marvels: and, in short, financial profit was to be combined
-with machinery for advancing scientific discovery. Astronomers
-the world over were "circularized," asked to become shareholders,
-and, in default of that, to send lantern-slides or photographs of
-remarkable celestial objects for exhibition in the magic-lantern
-part of the show.
-
-The project thus brought to the attention of scientific men three
-years ago did not have an attractive air. It savored too much of
-charlatanism. But it soon appeared that effective government
-sanction had been given to the enterprise; and, above all,
-that men of reputation were allowing the use of their names in
-connection with the affair. More important still, we learned that
-the actual construction had been undertaken by Gautier, of Paris,
-that finances were favorable, and that real work on parts of the
-instrument was to commence without delay.
-
-Gautier is a first-class instrument-builder; he has established
-his reputation by constructing successfully several telescopes of
-very large size, including the _equatorial coudé_ of the Paris
-Observatory, a unique instrument of especial complexity. The
-present writer believes that, if sufficient time and money were
-available, the _Grande Lunette_ would stand a reasonable chance of
-success in the hands of such a man. And by a reasonable chance, we
-mean that there is a large enough probability of genuine scientific
-discovery to justify the necessary financial outlay. But the
-project should be divorced from its "popular" features, and every
-kind of advertising and charlatanism excluded with rigor.
-
-As planned originally, and actually constructed, the _Grande
-Lunette_ presents interesting peculiarities, distinguishing it
-from other telescopes. Previous instruments have been built on the
-principle of universal mobility. It is possible to move them in
-all directions, and thus bring any desired star under observation,
-irrespective of its position in the sky. But this general mobility
-offers great difficulties in the case of large and ponderous
-telescopes. Delicacy of adjustment is almost destroyed when the
-object to be adjusted weighs several tons. And the excessive
-weight of telescopes is not due to unavoidably heavy lenses alone.
-It is essential that the tube be long; and great length involves
-appreciable thickness of material, if stiffness and solidity are to
-remain unsacrificed. Length in the tube is necessitated by certain
-peculiar optical defects of all lenses, into the nature of which we
-shall not enter at present. The consequences of these defects can
-be rendered harmless only if the instrument is so arranged that the
-observer's eye is far from the other end of the tube. The length
-of a good telescope should be at least twelve times the diameter
-of its large lens. If the relative length can be still further
-increased, so much the better; for then the optical defects can be
-further reduced.
-
-In the case of the Paris instrument a radical departure consists
-in making the tube of unprecedented length, 197 feet, with a
-lens diameter of 49¼ inches. This great length, while favorable
-optically, precludes the possibility of making the instrument
-movable in the usual sense. In fact, the entire tube is attached
-to a fixed horizontal base, and no attempt is made to change its
-position. Outside the big lens, and disconnected altogether from
-the telescope proper, is mounted a smooth mirror, so arranged that
-it can be turned in any direction, and thus various parts of the
-sky examined by reflection in the telescope.
-
-While this method unquestionably has the advantage of leaving
-the optician quite free as to how long he will make his tube, it
-suffers from the compensating objection that a new optical surface
-is introduced into the combination, viz., the mirror. Any slight
-unavoidable imperfection in the polishing of its surface will
-infallibly be reproduced on a magnified scale in the image of a
-distant star brought before the observer's eye.
-
-But it is not yet possible to pronounce definitely upon the merit
-of this form of instrument, since, as we have said, the maker
-has not been given time enough to try the idea to the complete
-satisfaction of scientific men. In the early part of August, 1900,
-when the informant of the present writer left Paris, after serving
-as a member of the international jury for judging instruments of
-precision at the Exposition, the condition of the _Grande Lunette_
-was as follows: Two sets of lenses had been contemplated, one
-intended for celestial photography, and the other to be used for
-ordinary visual observation. Only the photographic lenses had been
-completed, however, and for this reason the public could not be
-permitted to look through the instrument. The photographic lenses
-were in place in the tube, but at that time their condition was
-such that, though some photographs had been obtained, it was
-not thought advisable to submit them to the jury. Consequently,
-the _Lunette_ did not receive a prize. Since that time various
-newspapers have reported wonderful results from the telescope;
-but, disregarding the fusillade from the sensational press, we may
-sum up the present state of affairs very briefly. Gautier is still
-experimenting; and, given sufficient time and money, he may succeed
-in producing what astronomers hope for--an instrument capable of
-advancing our knowledge, even if that advance be only a small one.
-
-
-
-
-THE ASTRONOMER'S POLE
-
-
-The pole of the frozen North is not the only pole sought with
-determined effort by more than one generation of scientific men. Up
-in the sky astronomers have another pole which they are following
-up just as vigorously as ever Arctic explorer struggled toward
-the difficult goal of his terrestrial journeying. The celestial
-pole is, indeed, a fundamentally important thing in astronomical
-science, and the determination of its exact position upon the
-sky has always engaged the closest attention of astronomers.
-Quite recently new methods of research have been brought to
-bear, promising a degree of success not hitherto attained in the
-astronomers' pursuit of their pole.
-
-In the first place, we must explain what is meant by the celestial
-pole. We have already mentioned the poles of the earth (p. 136).
-Our planet turns once daily upon an axis passing through its
-centre, and it is this rotation that causes all the so-called
-diurnal phenomena of the heavens. Rising and setting of sun, moon,
-and stars are simply results of this turning of the earth. Heavenly
-bodies do not really rise; it is merely the man on the earth who is
-turned round on an axis until he is brought into a position from
-which he can see them. The terrestrial poles are those two points
-on the earth's surface where it is pierced by the rotation axis of
-the planet. Now we can, if we choose, imagine this axis lengthened
-out indefinitely, further and further, until at last it reaches the
-great round vault of the sky. Here it will again pierce out two
-polar points; and these are the celestial poles.
-
-The whole thing is thus quite easy to understand. On the sky the
-poles are marked by the prolongation of the earth's axis, just as
-on the earth the poles are marked by the axis itself. And this
-explains at once why the stars seem nightly to revolve about the
-pole. If the observer is being turned round the earth's axis, of
-course it will appear to him as if the stars were rotating around
-the same axis in the opposite direction, just as houses and fields
-seem to fly past a person sitting in a railway train, unless he
-stops to remember that it is really himself who is in motion, and
-not the trees and houses.
-
-The existence of such a centre of daily motions among the stars
-once recognized, it becomes of interest to ascertain whether the
-centre itself always retains precisely the same position in the
-sky. It was discovered as early as the time of Hipparchus (p. 39)
-that such is not the case, and that the celestial pole is subject
-to a slow motion among the stars on the sky. If a given star were
-to-day situated exactly at the pole, it would no longer be there
-after the lapse of a year's time; for the pole would have moved
-away from it.
-
-This motion of the pole is called precession. It means that certain
-forces are continually at work, compelling the earth's axis to
-change its position, so that the prolongation of that axis must
-pierce the sky at a point which moves as time goes on. These forces
-are produced by the gravitational attractions of the sun, moon,
-and planets upon the matter composing our earth. If the earth
-were perfectly spherical in shape, the attractions of the other
-heavenly bodies would not affect the direction of the earth's
-rotation-axis in the least. But the earth is not quite globular in
-form; it is flattened a little at the poles and bulges out somewhat
-at the equator. (See p. 135.)
-
-This protuberant matter near the equator gives the other bodies
-in the solar system an opportunity to disturb the earth's
-rotation. The general effect of all these attractions is to make
-the celestial pole move upon the sky in a circle having a radius
-of about 23½ degrees; and it requires 25,800 years to complete
-a circuit of this precessional cycle. One of the most striking
-consequences of this motion will be the change of the polar star.
-Just at present the bright star Polaris in the constellation of
-the Little Bear is very close to the pole. But after the lapse of
-sufficient ages the first-magnitude star Vega of the constellation
-Lyra will in its turn become Guardian of the Pole.
-
-It must not be supposed, however, that the motion of the pole
-proceeds quite uniformly, and in an exact circle; the varying
-positions of the heavenly bodies whose attractions cause
-the phenomena in question are such as to produce appreciable
-divergencies from exact circular motion. Sometimes the pole
-deviates a little to one side of the precessional circle, and
-sometimes it deviates on the other side. The final result is a
-sort of wavy line, half on one side and half on the other of an
-average circular curve. It takes only nineteen years to complete
-one of these little waves of polar motion, so that in the
-whole precessional cycle of 25,800 years there are about 1,400
-indentations. This disturbance of the polar motion is called by
-astronomers nutation.
-
-The first step in a study of polar motion is to devise a method of
-finding just where the pole is on any given date. If the astronomer
-can ascertain by observational processes just where the pole is
-among the stars at any moment, and can repeat his observations year
-after year and generation after generation, he will possess in
-time a complete chart of a small portion at least of the celestial
-pole's vast orbit. From this he can obtain necessary data for a
-study of the mathematical theory of attractions, and thus, perhaps,
-arrive at an explanation of the fundamental laws governing the
-universe in which we live.
-
-The instrument which has been used most extensively for the
-study of these problems is the transit (p. 118) or the "meridian
-circle." This latter consists of a telescope firmly attached to a
-metallic axis about which it can turn. The axis itself rests on
-massive stone supports, and is so placed that it points as nearly
-as possible in an east-and-west direction. Consequently, when the
-telescope is turned about its axis, it will trace out on the sky
-a great circle (the meridian) which passes through the north and
-south points of the horizon and the point directly overhead. The
-instrument has also a metallic circle very firmly fastened to
-the telescope and its axis. Let into the surface of this circle
-is a silver disk upon which are engraved a series of lines or
-graduations by means of which it is possible to measure angles.
-
-Observers with the meridian circle begin by noting the exact
-instant when any given star passes the centre of the field of
-view of the telescope. This centre is marked with a cross made
-by fastening into the focus some pieces of ordinary spider's web,
-which give a well-marked, delicate set of lines, even under the
-magnifying power of the telescope's eye-piece. In addition to thus
-noting the time when the star crosses the field of the telescope,
-the astronomer can measure by means of the circle, how high up it
-was in the sky at the instant when it was thus observed.
-
-If the telescope of the meridian circle be turned toward the north,
-and we observe stars close to the pole, it is possible to make two
-different observations of the same star. For the close polar stars
-revolve in such small circles around the pole of the heavens that
-we can observe them when they are on the meridian either above the
-pole or below it. Double observations of this class enable us to
-obtain the elevation of the pole above the horizon, and to fix its
-position with respect to the stars.
-
-Now, there is one very serious objection to this method. In order
-to secure the two necessary observations of the same star, it is
-essential to be stationed at the instrument at two moments of time
-separated by exactly twelve hours; and if one of the observations
-occurs in the night, the other corresponding observation will occur
-in daylight.
-
-It is a fact not generally known that the brighter stars can be
-seen with a telescope, even when the sun is quite high above
-the horizon. Unfortunately, however, there is only one star
-close to the pole which is bright enough to be thus observed in
-daylight--the polar star already mentioned under the name Polaris.
-The fact that we are thus limited to observations of a single
-star has made it difficult even for generations of astronomers
-to accumulate with the meridian circle a very large quantity of
-observational material suitable for the solution of our problem.
-
-The new method of observation to which we have referred above
-consists in an application of photography to the polar problem. If
-we aim at the pole a powerful photographic telescope, and expose a
-photographic plate throughout the entire night, we shall find that
-all stars coming within the range of the plate will mark out little
-circles or "trails" upon the developed negative. It is evident that
-as the stars revolve about the pole on the sky, tracing out their
-daily circular orbits, these same little circles must be reproduced
-faithfully upon the photographic plate. The only condition is that
-the stars shall be bright enough to make their light affect the
-sensitive gelatine surface.
-
-But even if observations of this kind are continued throughout
-all the hours of darkness, we do not obtain complete circles,
-but only those portions of circles traced out on the sky between
-sunset and sunrise. If the night is twelve hours in length, we
-get half-circles on the plate; if it is eighteen hours long, we
-get circles that lack only one-quarter of being complete. In
-other words, we get a series of circular arcs, one corresponding
-to each close polar star. There are no fewer than sixteen stars
-near enough to the pole to come within the range of a photographic
-plate, and bright enough to cause measurable impressions upon
-the sensitive surface. The fact that the circular arcs are not
-complete circles does not in the least prevent our using them for
-ascertaining the position of their common centre; and that centre
-is the pole. Moreover, as the arcs are distributed at all sorts
-of distances from the pole and in all directions, corresponding to
-the accidental positions of the stars on the sky, we have a state
-of affairs extremely favorable to the accurate determination of the
-pole's place among the stars by means of microscopic measurements
-of the plate.
-
-It will be perceived that this method is extremely simple, and,
-therefore, likely to be successful; though its simplicity is
-slightly impaired by the phenomenon known to astronomers as
-"atmospheric refraction." The rays of light coming down to our
-telescopes from a distant star must pass through the earth's
-atmosphere before they reach us; and in passing thus from the
-nothingness of outer space into the denser material of the air,
-they are bent out of their straight course. The phenomenon is
-analogous to what we see when we push a stick down through the
-surface of still water; we notice that the stick appears to be bent
-at the point where it pierces the surface of the water; and in
-just the same way the rays of light are bent when they pierce into
-the air. Fortunately, the mathematical theory of this atmospheric
-bending of light is well understood, so that it is possible to
-remove the effects of refraction from our results by a process of
-calculation. In other words, we can transform our photographic
-measures into what they would have been if no such thing as
-atmospheric refraction existed. This having been done, all the arcs
-on the plate should be exactly circular, and their common centre
-should be the position of the pole among the stars on the night
-when the photograph was made.
-
-It is possible to facilitate the removal of refraction effects
-very much by placing our photographic telescope at some point on
-the earth situated in a very high latitude. The elevation of the
-pole above the horizon is greatest in high latitudes. Indeed, if
-Arctic voyagers could ever reach the pole of the earth they would
-see the pole of the heavens directly overhead. Now, the higher up
-the pole is in the sky, the less will be the effects of atmospheric
-refraction; for the rays of light will then strike the atmosphere
-in a direction nearly perpendicular to its surface, which is
-favorable to diminishing the amount of bending.
-
-There is also another very important advantage in placing the
-telescope in a high latitude; in the middle of winter the nights
-are very long there; if we could get within the Arctic. Circle
-itself, there would be nights when the hours of darkness would
-number twenty-four, and we could substitute complete circles
-for our broken arcs. This would, indeed, be most favorable from
-the astronomical point of view; but the essential condition of
-convenience for the observer renders an expedition to the frozen
-Arctic regions unadvisable.
-
-But it is at least possible to place the telescope as far north
-as is consistent with retaining it within the sphere of civilized
-influences. We can put it in that one of existing observatories
-on the earth which has the highest latitude; and this is the
-observatory of Helsingfors, in Finland, which belongs to a great
-university, is manned by competent astronomers, and has a latitude
-greater than 60 degrees.
-
-Dr. Anders Donner, Director of the Helsingfors Observatory, has
-at its disposal a fine photographic telescope, and with this some
-preliminary experimental "trail" photographs were made in 1895.
-These photographs were sent to Columbia University, New York, and
-were there measured under the writer's direction. Calculations
-based on these measures indicate that the method is promising in
-a very high degree; and it was, therefore, decided to construct a
-special photographic telescope better adapted to the particular
-needs of the problem in hand.
-
-The desirability of a new telescope arises from the fact that we
-wish the instrument to remain absolutely unmoved during all the
-successive hours of the photographic exposure. It is clear that
-if the telescope moves while the stars are tracing out their
-little trails on the plate, the circularity of the curves will
-be disturbed. Now, ordinary astronomical telescopes are always
-mounted upon very stable foundations, well adapted to making the
-telescope stand still; but the polar telescope which we wish to use
-in a research fundamental to the entire science of astronomy ought
-to possess immobility and stability of an order higher than that
-required for ordinary astronomical purposes.
-
-It is a remarkable peculiarity of the instrument needed for the
-new trail photographs that it is never moved at all. Once pointed
-at the pole, it is ready for all the observations of successive
-generations of astronomers. It should have no machinery, no
-pivots, axes, circles, clocks, or other paraphernalia of the usual
-equatorial telescope. All we want is a very heavy stone pier,
-with a telescope tube firmly fastened to it throughout its entire
-length. The top of the pier having been cut to the proper angle of
-the pole's elevation, and the telescope cemented down, everything
-is complete from the instrumental side; and just such an instrument
-as this is now ready for use at Helsingfors.
-
-The late Miss Catharine Wolfe Bruce, of New York, was much
-interested in the writer's proposed polar investigations, and
-in October, 1898, she contributed funds for the construction of
-the new telescope, and the Russian authorities have generously
-undertaken the expense of a building to hold the instrument and the
-granite foundation upon which it rests. Photographs are now being
-secured with the new instrument, and they will be sent to Columbia
-University, New York, for measurement and discussion. It is hoped
-that they will carry out the promise of the preliminary photographs
-made in 1895 with a less suitable telescope of the ordinary form.
-
-
-
-
-THE MOON HOAX
-
-
-The public attitude toward matters scientific is one of the
-mysteries of our time. It can be described best by the single
-word, Credulity; simple, absolute credulity. Perfect confidence
-is the most remarkable characteristic of this unbelieving age.
-No charlatan, necromancer, or astrologer of three centuries ago
-commanded more respectful attention than does his successor of
-to-day.
-
-Any person can be a scientific authority; he has but to call
-himself by that title, and everyone will give him respectful
-attention. Numerous instances can be adduced from the experience
-of very recent years to show how true are these remarks. We have
-had the Keeley motor and the liquid-air power schemes for making
-something out of nothing. Extracting gold from sea-water has been
-duly heralded on scientific authority as an easy source of fabulous
-wealth for the million. Hard-headed business men not only believe
-in such things, but actually invest in them their most valued
-possession, capital. Venders of nostrums and proprietary medicines
-acquire wealth as if by magic, though it needs but a moment's
-reflection to realize that these persons cannot possibly be in
-possession of any drugs, or secret methods of compounding drugs,
-that are unknown to scientific chemists.
-
-If the world, then, will persistently intrust its health and wealth
-into the safe-keeping of charlatans, what can we expect when things
-supposedly of far less value are at stake? The famous Moon Hoax, as
-we now call it, is truly a classic piece of lying. Though it dates
-from as long ago as 1835, it has never had an equal as a piece of
-"modern" journalism. Nothing could be more useful than to recall it
-to public attention at least once every decade; for it teaches an
-important lesson that needs to be iterated again and again.
-
-On November 13, 1833, Sir John Herschel embarked on the Mountstuart
-Elphinstone, bound for the Cape of Good Hope. He took with him a
-collection of astronomical instruments, with which he intended to
-study the heavens of the southern hemisphere, and thus extend his
-father's great work to the south polar stars. An earnest student
-of astronomy, he asked no better than to be left in peace to
-seek the truth in his own fashion. Little did he think that his
-expedition would be made the basis for a fabrication of alleged
-astronomical discoveries destined to startle a hemisphere. Yet that
-is precisely what happened. Some time about the middle of the year
-1835 the New York _Sun_ began the publication of certain articles,
-purporting to give an account of "Great Astronomical Discoveries,
-lately made by Sir John Herschel at the Cape of Good Hope." It was
-alleged that these articles were taken from a supplement to the
-Edinburgh _Journal of Science_; yet there is no doubt that they
-were manufactured entirely in the United States, and probably in
-New York.
-
-The hoax begins at once in a grandiloquent style, calculated to
-attract popular attention, and well fitted to the marvels about
-to be related. Here is an introductory remark, as a specimen:
-"It has been poetically said that the stars of heaven are the
-hereditary regalia of man as the intellectual sovereign of the
-animal creation. He may now fold the zodiac around him with a
-loftier consciousness of his mental supremacy." Then follows a
-circumstantial and highly plausible account of the manner in
-which early and exclusive information was obtained from the Cape.
-This was, of course, important in order to make people believe
-in the genuineness of the whole; but we pass at once to the more
-interesting account of Herschel's supposed instrument.
-
-Nothing could be more skilful than the way in which an air of
-truth is cast over the coming account of marvellous discoveries
-by explaining in detail the construction of the imaginary
-Herschelian instrument. Sir John is supposed to have had an
-interesting conversation in England "with Sir David Brewster,
-upon the merits of some ingenious suggestion by the latter, in
-his article on optics in the Edinburgh Encyclopædia (p. 644), for
-improvements in the Newtonian reflectors." The exact reference to
-a particular page is here quite delightful. After some further
-talk, "the conversation became directed to that all-invincible
-enemy, the paucity of light in powerful magnifiers. After a few
-moments' silent thought, Sir John diffidently inquired whether
-it would not be possible to effect a _transfusion of artificial
-light through the focal object of vision_! Sir David, somewhat
-startled at the originality of the idea, paused awhile, and then
-hesitatingly referred to the refrangibility of rays, and the angle
-of incidence.... Sir John continued, 'Why cannot the illuminated
-microscope, say the hydro-oxygen, be applied to render distinct,
-and, if necessary, even to magnify the focal object?' Sir David
-sprang from his chair in an ecstasy of conviction, and leaping
-half-way to the ceiling, exclaimed, 'Thou art the man.' "This
-absurd imaginary conversation contains nothing but an assemblage
-of optical jargon, put together without the slightest intention of
-conveying any intelligible meaning to scientific people. Yet it was
-well adapted to deceive the public; and we should not be surprised
-if it would be credited by many newspaper readers to-day.
-
-The authors go on to explain how money was raised to build the
-new instrument, and then describe Herschers embarkation and the
-difficulties connected with transporting his gigantic machines
-to the place selected for the observing station. "Sir John
-accomplished the ascent to the plains by means of two relief
-teams of oxen, of eighteen each, in about four days, and, aided
-by several companies of Dutch boors [_sic_], proceeded at once to
-the erecting of his gigantic fabric." The place really selected
-by Herschel cannot be described better than in his own words,
-contained in a genuine letter dated January 21, 1835: "A perfect
-paradise in rich and magnificent mountain scenery, sheltered from
-all winds.... I must reserve for my next all description of the
-gorgeous display of flowers which adorn this splendid country, as
-well as the astonishing brilliancy of the constellations." The
-author of the hoax could have had no knowledge of Herschers real
-location, as described in this letter.
-
-The present writer can bear witness to the correctness of
-Herschel's words. Feldhausen is truly an ideal secluded spot
-for astronomical study. A small obelisk under the sheer cliff
-of far-famed Table Mountain now marks the site of the great
-reflecting telescope. Here Herschel carried on his scrutiny of the
-Southern skies. He observed 1,202 double stars and 1,708 nebulæ
-and clusters, of which only 439 were already known. He studied the
-famous Magellanic clouds, and made the first careful drawings of
-the "keyhole" nebula in the constellation Argo.
-
-Very recent researches of the present royal astronomer at the Cape
-have shown that changes of import have certainly taken place in
-this nebula since Herschel's time, when a sudden blazing up of the
-wonderful star Eta Argus was seen within the nebula. This object
-has, perhaps, undergone more remarkable changes of light than
-any other star in the heavens. It is as though there were some
-vast conflagration at work, now blazing into incandescence, and
-again sinking almost into invisibility. In 1843 Maclear estimated
-the brilliancy of Eta to be about equal to that of Sirius, the
-brightest star in the whole sky. Later it diminished in light,
-and cannot be seen to-day with the naked eye, though the latest
-telescopic observations indicate that it is again beginning to
-brighten.
-
-Such was Herschel's quiet study of his beloved science, in glaring
-contrast to the supposed discoveries of the "Hoax." Here are a few
-things alleged to have been seen on the moon. The first time the
-instrument was turned upon our satellite "the field of view was
-covered throughout its entire area with a beautifully distinct and
-even vivid representation of basaltic rock." There were forests,
-too, and water, "fairer shores never angels coasted on a tour
-of pleasure. A beach of brilliant white sand, girt with wild
-castellated rocks, apparently of green marble."
-
-There was animal life as well; "we beheld continuous herds of
-brown quadrupeds, having all the external characteristics of the
-bison, but more diminutive than any species of the bos genus in our
-natural history." There was a kind of beaver, that "carries its
-young in its arms like a human being," and lives in huts. "From the
-appearance of smoke in nearly all of them, there is no doubt of its
-(the beaver's) being acquainted with the use of fire." Finally,
-as was, of course, unavoidable, human creatures were discovered.
-"Whilst gazing in a perspective of about half a mile, we were
-thrilled with astonishment to perceive four successive flocks of
-large-winged creatures, wholly unlike any kind of birds, descend
-with a slow, even motion from the cliffs on the western side, and
-alight upon the plain.... Certainly they were like human beings,
-and their attitude in walking was both erect and dignified."
-
-We have not space to give more extended extracts from the hoax,
-but we think the above specimens will show how deceptive the whole
-thing was. The rare reprint from which we have extracted our
-quotations contains also some interesting "Opinions of the American
-Press Respecting the Foregoing Discovery." The _Daily Advertiser_
-said: "No article, we believe, has appeared for years, that will
-command so general a perusal and publication. Sir John has added
-a stock of knowledge to the present age that will immortalize his
-name and place it high on the page of science." The _Mercantile
-Advertiser_ said: "Discoveries in the Moon.--We commence to-day
-the publication of an interesting article which is stated to have
-been copied from the Edinburgh _Journal of Science_, and which
-made its first appearance here in a contemporary journal of this
-city. It appears to carry intrinsic evidence of being an authentic
-document." Many other similar extracts are given. The New York
-_Evening Post_ did not fall into the trap. The _Evening Post's_
-remarks were as follows: "It is quite proper that the _Sun_ should
-be the means of shedding so much light on the _Moon_. That there
-should be winged people in the moon does not strike us as more
-wonderful than the existence of such a race of beings on the
-earth; and that there does or did exist such a race rests on the
-evidence of that most veracious of voyagers and circumstantial of
-chroniclers, Peter Wilkins, whose celebrated work not only gives an
-account of the general appearance and habits of a most interesting
-tribe of flying Indians, but also of all those more delicate and
-engaging traits which the author was enabled to discover by reason
-of the conjugal relations he entered into with one of the females
-of the winged tribe."
-
-We shall limit our extracts from the contemporary press to the few
-quotations here given, hoping that enough has been said to direct
-attention once more to that important subject, the Possibility of
-Being Deceived.
-
-
-
-
-THE SUN'S DESTINATION
-
-
-Three generations of men have come and gone since the Marquis
-de Laplace stood before the Academy of France and gave his
-demonstration of the permanent stability of our solar system. There
-was one significant fault in Newton's superbly simple conception of
-an eternal law governing the world in which we live. The labors of
-mathematicians following him had shown that the planets must trace
-out paths in space whose form could be determined in advance with
-unerring certainty by the aid of Newton's law of gravitation. But
-they proved just as conclusively that these planetary orbits, as
-they are called, could not maintain indefinitely the same shapes or
-positions. Slow indeed might be the changes they were destined to
-undergo; slow, but sure, with that sureness belonging to celestial
-science alone. And so men asked: Has this magnificent solar system
-been built upon a scale so grand, been put in operation subject
-to a law sublime in its very simplicity, only to change and change
-until at length it shall lose every semblance of its former self,
-and end, perhaps, in chaos or extinction?
-
-Laplace was able to answer confidently, "No." Nor was his answer
-couched in the enthusiastic language of unbalanced theorists who
-work by the aid of imagination alone. Based upon the irrefragable
-logic of correct mathematical reasoning, and clad in the sober garb
-of mathematical formulæ, his results carried conviction to men of
-science the world over. So was it demonstrated that changes in our
-solar system are surely at work, and shall continue for nearly
-countless ages; yet just as surely will they be reversed at last,
-and the system will tend to return again to its original form and
-condition. The objection that the Newtonian law meant ultimate
-dissolution of the world was thus destroyed by Laplace. From that
-day forward the law of gravitation has been accepted as holding
-sway over all phenomena visible within our planetary world.
-
-The intricacies of our own solar system being thus illumined, the
-restless activity of the human intellect was stimulated to search
-beyond for new problems and new mysteries. Even more fascinating
-than the movements of our sun and planets are all those questions
-that relate to the clustered stellar congeries hanging suspended
-within the deep vault of night. Does the same law of gravitation
-cast its magic spell over that hazy cloud of Pleiades, binding
-them, like ourselves, with bonds indissoluble? Who shall answer,
-yes or no? We can only say that astronomers have as yet but stepped
-upon the threshold of the universe, and fixed the telescope's great
-eye upon that which is within.
-
-Let us then begin by reminding the reader what is meant by the
-Newtonian law of gravitation. It appears all things possess the
-remarkable property of attracting or pulling each other. Newton
-declared that all substances, solid, liquid, or even gaseous--from
-the massive cliff of rock down to the invisible air--all matter can
-no more help pulling than it can help existing. His law further
-formulates certain conditions governing the manner in which this
-gravitational attraction is exerted; but these are mere matters of
-detail; interest centres about the mysterious fact of attraction
-itself. How can one thing pull another with no connecting link
-through which the pull can act? Just here we touch the point
-that has never yet been explained. Nature withholds from science
-her ultimate secrets. They that have pondered longest, that have
-descended farthest of all men into the clear well of knowledge,
-have done so but to sound the depths beyond, never touching bottom.
-
-This inability of ours, to give a good physical explanation of
-gravitation, has led certain makers of paradoxes to doubt or even
-deny that there is any such thing. But, fortunately, we have a
-simple laboratory experiment that helps us. Unexplained it may
-ever remain, but that there can be attraction between physical
-objects connected by no visible link is proved by the behavior
-of an ordinary magnet. Place a small piece of steel or iron near
-a magnetized bar, and it will at once be so strongly attracted
-that it will actually fly to the magnet. Anyone who has seen this
-simple experiment can never again deny the possibility, at least,
-of the law of attraction as stated by Newton. Its possibility
-once admitted, the fact that it can predict the motions of all
-the planets, even down to their minutest details, transforms the
-possibility of its truth into a certainty as strong as any human
-certainty can ever be.
-
-But this demonstration of Newton's law is limited strictly to
-the solar system itself. We may, indeed, reason by analogy, and
-take for granted that a law which holds within our immediate
-neighborhood is extremely likely to be true also of the entire
-visible universe. But men of science are loath to reason thus; and
-hence the fascination of researches in cosmic astronomy. Analogy
-points out the path. The astronomer is not slow to follow; but he
-seeks ever to establish upon incontrovertible evidence those truths
-which at first only his daring imagination had led him to half
-suspect.
-
-If we are to extend the law of gravitation to the utmost, we must
-be careful to consider the law itself in its most complete form.
-A heavenly body like the sun is often said to govern the motions
-of its family of planets; but such a statement is not strictly
-accurate. The governing body is no despot; 'tis an abject slave of
-law and order, as much as the tiniest of attendant planets. The
-action of gravitation is mutual, and no cosmic body can attract
-another without being itself in turn subject to that other's
-gravitational action.
-
-If there were in our solar system but two bodies, sun and planet,
-we should find each one pursuing a path in space under the
-influence of the other's attraction. These two paths or orbits
-would be oval, and if the sun and planet were equally massive, the
-orbits would be exactly alike, both in shape and size. But if the
-sun were far larger than the planet, the orbits would still be
-similar in form, but the one traversed by the larger body would be
-small. For it is not reasonable to expect a little planet to keep
-the big sun moving with a velocity as great as that derived by
-itself from the attraction of the larger orb.
-
-Whenever the preponderance of the larger body is extremely great,
-its orbit will be correspondingly insignificant in size. This is
-in fact the case with our own sun. So massive is it in comparison
-with the planets that the orbit is too small to reveal its actual
-existence without the aid of our most refined instruments. The path
-traced out by the sun's centre would not fill a space as large as
-the sun's own bulk. Nevertheless, true orbital motion is there.
-
-So we may conclude that as a necessary consequence of the law of
-gravitation every object within the solar system is in motion. To
-say that planets revolve about the sun is to neglect as unimportant
-the small orbit of the sun itself. This may be sufficiently
-accurate for ordinary purposes; but it is unquestionably necessary
-to neglect no factor, however small, if we propose to extend our
-reasoning to a consideration of the stellar universe. For we shall
-then have to deal with systems in which the planets are of a size
-comparable with the sun; and in such systems all the orbits will
-also be of comparatively equal importance.
-
-Mathematical analysis has derived another fact from discussion
-of the law of gravitation which, perhaps, transcends in simple
-grandeur everything we have as yet mentioned. It matters not how
-great may be the number of massive orbs threading their countless
-interlacing curved paths in space, there yet must be in every
-cosmic system one single point immovable. This point is called the
-Centre of Gravity. If it should so happen that in the beginning of
-things, some particle of matter were situated at this centre, then
-would that atom ever remain unmoved and imperturbable throughout
-all the successive vicissitudes of cosmic evolution. It is doubtful
-whether the mind of man can form a conception of anything grander
-than such an immovable atom within the mysterious intricacies of
-cosmic motion.
-
-But in general, we cannot suppose that the centres of gravity in
-the various stellar systems are really occupied by actual physical
-bodies. The centre may be a mere mathematical point in space,
-situated among the several bodies composing the system, but,
-nevertheless, endowed, in a certain sense, with the same remarkable
-property of relative immobility.
-
-Having thus defined the centre of gravity in its relation to the
-constituent parts of any cosmic system, we can pass easily to its
-characteristic properties in connection with the inter-relation of
-stellar systems with one another. It can be proved mathematically
-that our solar system will pull upon distant stars just as though
-the sun and all the planets were concentrated into one vast sphere
-having its centre in the centre of gravity of the whole. It is this
-property of the centre of gravity which makes it pre-eminently
-important in cosmic researches. For, while we know that centre to
-be at rest relatively to all the planets in the system, it may,
-nevertheless, in its quality as a sort of concentrated essence of
-them all, be moving swiftly through space under the pull of distant
-stars. In that case, the attendant bodies will go with it--but they
-will pursue their evolutions within the system, all unconscious
-that the centre of gravity is carrying them on a far wider circuit.
-
-What is the nature of that circuit? This question has been for
-many years the subject of earnest study by the clearest minds
-among astronomers. The greatest difficulty in the way is the
-comparatively brief period during which men have been able to
-make astronomical observations of precision. Space and time are
-two conceptions that transcend the powers of definition possessed
-by any man. But we can at least form a notion of how vast is the
-extent of time, if we remember that the period covered by man's
-written records is registered but as a single moment upon the
-great revolving dial of heaven's dome. One hundred and fifty years
-have elapsed since James Bradley built the foundations of modern
-sidereal astronomy upon his masterly series of observations at the
-Royal Observatory of Greenwich, in England. Yet so slowly do the
-movements of the stars unroll themselves upon the firmament, that
-even to this day no one of them has been seen by men to trace out
-more than an infinitesimal fraction of its destined path through
-the voids of space.
-
-Travellers upon a railroad cannot tell at any given moment whether
-they are moving in a straight line, or whether the train is
-turning upon some curve of huge size. The St. Gothard railway
-has several so-called "corkscrew" tunnels, within which the rails
-make a complete turn in a spiral, the train finally emerging from
-the tunnel at a point almost vertically over the entrance. In this
-way the train is lifted to a higher level. Passengers are wont to
-amuse themselves while in these tunnels by watching the needle of
-an ordinary pocket-compass. This needle, of course, always points
-to the north; and as the train turns upon its curve, the needle
-will make a complete revolution. But the passenger could not know
-without the compass that the train was not moving in a perfectly
-straight line. Just so we passengers on the earth are unaware of
-the kind of path we are traversing, until, like the compass, the
-astronomer's instruments shall reveal to us the truth.
-
-But as we have seen, astronomical observations of precision have
-not as yet extended through a period of time corresponding to the
-few minutes during which the St. Gothard traveller watches the
-compass. We are still in the dark, and do not know as yet whether
-mankind shall last long enough upon the earth to see the compass
-needle make its revolution. We are compelled to believe that the
-motion in space of our sun is progressing upon a curved path; but
-so far as precise observations allow us to speak, we can but say
-that we have as yet moved through an infinitesimal element only of
-that mighty curve. However, we know the point upon the sky toward
-which this tiny element of our path is directed, and we have an
-approximate knowledge of the speed at which we move.
-
-More than a century ago Sir William Herschel was able to fix
-roughly what we call the apex of the sun's way in space, or the
-point among the stars toward which that way is for the moment
-directed. We say for the moment, but we mean that moment of which
-Bradley saw the beginning in 1750, and upon whose end no man of
-those now living shall ever look. Herschel found that a comparison
-of old stellar observations seemed to indicate that the stars in a
-certain part of the sky were opening out, as it were, and that the
-constellations in the opposite part of the heavens seemed to be
-drawing in, or becoming smaller. There can be but one reasonable
-explanation of this. We must be moving toward that part of the sky
-where the stars are separating. Just so a man watching a regiment
-of soldiers approaching, will see at first only a confused body of
-men; but as they come nearer, the individual soldiers will seem to
-separate, until at length each one is seen distinct from all the
-others.
-
-Herschel fixed the position of the apex at a point in the
-constellation Hercules. The most recent investigations of Newcomb
-and others have, on the whole, verified Herschel's conclusions.
-With the intuitive power of rare genius, Herschel had been able to
-sift truth out of error. The observational data at his disposal
-would now be called rude, but they disclosed to the scrutiny of
-his acute understanding the germ of truth that was in them. Later
-investigators have increased the precision of our knowledge, until
-we can now say that the present direction of the solar motion is
-known within very narrow limits. A tiny circle might be drawn on
-the sky, to which an astronomer might point his hand and say:
-"Yonder little circle contains the goal toward which the sun and
-planets are hastening to-day." Even the speed of this motion has
-been subjected to measurement, and found to be about ten miles per
-second.
-
-The objective point and the rate of motion thus stated, exact
-science holds her peace. Here genuine knowledge stops; and we can
-proceed further only by the aid of that imagination which men of
-science need to curb at every moment. But let no one think that the
-sun will ever reach the so-called apex. To do so would mean cosmic
-motion upon a straight line, while every consideration of celestial
-mechanics points to motion upon a curve. When shall we turn
-sufficiently upon that curve to detect its bending? 'Tis a problem
-we must leave as a rich heritage to later generations that are to
-follow us. The visionary theorist's notion of a great central sun,
-controlling our own sun's way in space, must be dismissed as far
-too daring. But for such a central sun we may substitute a central
-centre of gravity belonging to a great system of which our sun
-is but an insignificant member. Then we reach a conception that
-has lost nothing in the grandeur of its simplicity, and is yet
-in accord with the probabilities of sober mechanical science. We
-cease to be a lonely world, and stretch out the bonds of a common
-relationship to yonder stars within the firmament.
-
-
-
-
-INDEX
-
- PAGE
-
- Airy, Astronomer Royal, 1
-
- Allis, photographs comet, 101
-
- Andromeda nebula, 28
- temporary star, 28, 29, 45
-
- Apex, of solar motion, explained, 221
-
- Aquila, constellation, temporary star in, 40
-
- Arctic regions, position of pole in, 194
-
- Argo, constellation, variable star in, 205
-
- Association, international geodetic, 139
-
- Asteroids, first discovery by Piazzi, 59, 106
- discovery by photography, 64
- group of, 63
- photography of, invented by Wolf, 104
-
- Astronomer, royal, 1
- working, description of, 152
-
- ASTRONOMER'S POLE, THE, 184
-
- Astronomy, journalistic, 176
- practical uses of, 112
-
- Atmospheric refraction, explained, 193
-
- Axis, of figure of the earth, 136
- of rotation of the earth, 136
- polar, of telescope, 173
-
-
- Barnard, discovers satellite of Jupiter, 51
-
- Bessel, measures Pleiades, 15
-
- Bond, discovers crape ring of Saturn, 144
-
- Bradley, observes at Greenwich, 219
-
- Brahe, Tycho, his temporary star, 40
-
- Bruce, endows polar photography, 197
-
-
- Campbell, observes Pole-star, 18
-
- Cape of Good Hope, observatory, photography at, 101
- telescope, 170, 174
-
- _Capriccio_, Galileo's, 55
-
- Cassini, shows Saturn's rings to be double, 144
-
- Cassiopeia, temporary star in, 40
-
- Celestial pole, 184
-
- Central sun theory, 223
-
- Centre of gravity, 217
-
- Chart-room, on ship-board, 5
-
- Chronometer, invention of, 8
-
- Circle, meridian, explained, 189
-
- Clerk Maxwell, discusses Saturn's rings, 146
-
- Clock, affected by temperature, 117
- affected by barometric pressure, 117
- astronomical, 115
- astronomical, how mounted, 116
- astronomical, its dial, 116
- error of, determined with transit, 118
- jeweller's regulator, 114
- of telescope, 175
-
- Clusters of stars, photography of, 98
-
- Columbia University Observatory, latitude observations, 139
- polar photography, 196
-
- Common, his reflecting telescope, 32
-
- Confusion of dates, in Pacific Ocean, 125
-
- Congress of Astronomers, Paris, 1887, 102
-
- Constellations, 162
-
- Control, "mouse," for photography, 88
-
- Copernican theory of universe, 53, 56
- demonstration, 94
-
- Corkscrew tunnels, 220
-
- Crape ring of Saturn, 144
-
- Cumulative effect, in photography, 84
-
-
- Date, confusion of, in Pacific Ocean, 125
-
- Date-line, international, explained, 126
-
- Development of photograph, 81
-
- Dial, of astronomical clock, 116
-
- "Dialogue" of Galileo, 53
-
- Differences of time, explained, 121
-
- Directions, telescopic measurement of, 21
-
- Directory of the heavens, 103
-
- Distance, of light-source in photography, 83
- of stars, 94, 106, 158
- of Sun, 67, 97, 106
-
- Donner, polar photography, 195
-
- Double telescopes, for photography, 86
-
-
- Earth, motions of its pole, 131
- rotation of, 136, 162, 171, 184
- shape of, 135
-
- Eclipses, photography of, 109
-
- Elkin, measures Pleiades, 15
-
- Equatorial telescope, explained, 170
-
- Eros, discovered by Witt, 66, 105
- its importance, 67
-
- Error of clock, determined by transit, 118
-
- Exposure, length of, in photography, 84
-
-
- Feldhausen, Herschel's observatory near Capetown, 204
-
- Fiji Islands, their date, 126
-
- Fixed polar telescope, 197
-
- "Following" the stars, 88, 173
-
- Four-day cycle of pole-star, 24
-
- France, outside time-zone system, 129
-
- Fundamental longitude meridian, 124
-
-
- GALILEO, 47
- and the Church, 48
- discoveries of, 49
- observes Saturn, 141
-
- Galle, discovers Neptune, 61
-
- Gauss, computes first asteroid orbit, 60
-
- Gautier, Paris, constructs big telescope, 179
-
- Geodetic Association, international, 139
-
- Geography, maps, astronomical side of, 112
-
- Geology, polar motion in, 131
-
- Gill, photographs comet, 100
-
- Gilliss, at Naval Observatory, Washington, 169
-
- Goldsborough, at Naval Observatory, Washington, 169
-
- _Grande Lunette_, Paris, 1900, 176, 180
-
- Gravitation, 13
- in Pleiades, 14, 212
- law of, Newton's, 212
-
- Gravity, centre of, 217
-
- Greenwich, origin of longitudes, 7, 124
- time, 7
-
- Groombridge, English astronomer, 1
-
-
- Harrison, inventor of chronometer, 8
-
- Head, of heliometer, 156
-
- Heidelberg, photography at, 104
-
- HELIOMETER, 152
- head of, 156
- how used, 157
- principle of, 154
- scales of, 158
- semi-lenses of, 155
-
- Helsingfors observatory, polar photography at, 195
-
- Henry, measures Pleiades, 11, 17
-
- Hercules, constellation, solar motion toward, 222
-
- Herschel, discovers apex of solar motion, 221
- discovers Uranus, 59, 141
- John, the moon hoax, 200
-
- Hipparchus, discovers precession, 186
- early star-catalogue, 21, 39
- invents star magnitudes, 91
-
- Huygens, announces rings of Saturn, 142
- his logogriph, 143
-
-
- Ice-cap, of Earth, 131
-
- _Index Librorum Prohibitorum_, 53
-
- International, date-line, explained, 126
- geodetic association, 139
-
- Inter-stellar motion, in clusters, 98
- in Pleiades, 14
-
- Islands of Pacific, their longitude and time, 125
-
-
- Japan, latitude station in, 139
-
- Jewellers' correct time, 121
-
- Journalistic astronomy, 176
-
- Jupiter's satellites, discovered by Galileo, 50
- discovered by Barnard, 51
-
-
- Keeler, observes Saturn's rings, 140, 147, 150
- photographs nebulæ, 32
-
- "Keyhole" nebula, 205
-
-
- Lambert, determines longitude of Washington, 168
-
- Laplace, discusses Saturn's rings, 146
- nebular hypothesis, 33
- stability of solar system, 210
-
- Latitude, changes of, 133, 138
- definition of, 134
- determining the, 6
-
- Leverrier, predicts discovery of Neptune, 61, 142
-
- Lick Observatory, Keeler's observations, 140
-
- Light, undulatory theory of, 19, 148
-
- Light-waves, measuring length of, 20, 149
-
- Logogriph, by Huygens, 143
-
- Long-exposure photography, 85
-
- Longitude, counted East and West, 125
- determining, 6
- determining by occultations, 167
- effect on time differences, 123
- explained, 123
- of Washington, first determined, 168
-
-
- Maclear, observes Eta Argus, 205
-
- Magnitudes, stellar, 91
-
- Manila, its time, 127
-
- Maps, astronomical side of, 112
-
- Meridian circle, explained, 189
-
- Milky-way, poor in nebulæ, 33
-
- Minor Planets, see Asteroids.
-
- MOON, HOAX, 199
- motion among stars, 163
- mountains discovered by Galileo, 49
- size of, measured, 166
-
- Motion of moon, 163
-
- MOTIONS of the EARTH'S Pole, 131
-
- MOUNTING GREAT TELESCOPES, 170
-
-
- Naked-eye nebulæ, 28
-
- Naples, Royal Observatory, latitude observations, 139
-
- Naval Observatory, Washington, noon signal, 120
-
- NAVIGATION, 1
- before chronometers, 3
- use of astronomy in, 113
-
- NEBULÆ, 27
-
- Nebula, in Andromeda, 28
- in Orion, 30
- "keyhole", 205
-
- Nebular, hypothesis, 33
- structure in Pleiades, 17
-
- Nebulous stars, 31
-
- Negative, and positive, in photography, 82
-
- Neptune, discovery predicted by Leverrier, 61, 142
- discovery by Galle, 61
-
- Newcomb, fixes apex of solar motion, 222
-
- Newton, law of gravitation, 212
- longitude commission, 8
-
- New York, its telegraphic time system, 120
-
- Noon Signal, Washington, 120
-
- Number, of nebulæ, 31, 33
- of temporary stars, 38
-
- Nutation, explained, 188
-
-
- Occultations, 161
- explained, 165
-
- Occultations, use of, 166, 167
-
- Orion nebula, 30
-
-
- Pacific islands, their longitude and time, 125
-
- Parallax, solar, 67, 106
- stellar, 94, 106
- measured with heliometer, 158
-
- Paris, congress of astronomers, 1887, 102
- exposition of 1900, 176
-
- Periodic motion of earth's pole, 133
-
- Perseus, constellation, temporary star in, 46
-
- Philippine Islands, their time, 127
-
- Photography, asteroid, invented by Wolf, 104
- congress of astronomical, 102
- cumulative effect of light, 84
- distance of light-source, 83
- double telescopes for, 86
- general star-catalogue, 102
- IN ASTRONOMY, 81
- in discovery of asteroids, 64, 104
- in solar physics, 109
- in spectroscopy, 108
- length of exposure, 84
- measuring-machine, Rutherfurd, 93
- motion of telescope for, 87
- "mouse" control of telescope, 88
- of eclipses, 109
- of inter-stellar motion, 99
- Paris congress, 1877, 102
- polar, 191
- Rutherfurd pioneer in, 90
- star-clusters, 98
- star-distances measured by, 94
- summarized, 110
- wholesale methods in, 103
-
- Piazzi, discovers first asteroid, 59, 106
-
- Pitkin, report to House of Representatives, 168
-
- Planetary nebulæ, 31
-
- PLANET OF 1898, 58
-
- Planetoids, see Asteroids.
-
- Planets known to ancients, 58
-
- PLEIADES, 10
- gravitation among, 212
- motion among, 14, 16, 98
- nebular structure, 17
- number visible, 11
-
- Polar axis, of telescope, 173
-
- Polar photography, 191
- at Helsingfors, 195
-
- Pole, celestial, 184
- of the earth, motions of, 131
- THE ASTRONOMER'S, 184
-
- POLE-STAR, 18
- as a binary, 25
- as a triple, 18, 26
- change of, 187
- its four-day cycle, 24
- motion toward us, 24
-
- Positive, and negative, in photography, 82
-
- Potsdam, observatory, photographic star-catalogue, 103
-
- Practical uses of astronomy, 112
-
- Precession, explained, 186
-
- Prize, for invention of chronometer, 8
-
- Ptolemaic theory of universe, 56
-
- Ptolemy, writes concerning Hipparchus, 39
-
-
- Railroad time, explained, 127
-
- Refraction, atmospheric, explained, 193
-
- "Regulator," the jeweller's clock, 114
-
- Ring-nebulæ, 31
-
- Rings, of Saturn, see Saturn's rings.
-
- Roberts, Andromeda nebula, 28
-
- Rotation, of Earth, 136, 162, 171, 184
- of Saturn, 150
-
- Royal Astronomer, his duties, 2
-
- Royal Observatory, Greenwich, 124
- Greenwich, Bradley's observations, 219
- Naples, latitude observations, 139
-
- Rutherfurd, cluster photography, 99
- invents photographic apparatus, 93
- pioneer in photography, 90
- stellar parallax, 94
-
-
- Sagredus, character in Galileo's Dialogue, 55
-
- Salusbury, Galileo's translator, 50, 54
-
- Salviati, character in Galileo's Dialogue, 55
-
- Samoa, its date, 126
-
- SATURN'S RINGS, 140
- analogy to planetoids, 147
- announced by Huygens, 142
- observed with spectroscope, 147
- shown to be double by Cassini, 144
- structure and stability, 145
-
- Scales, of heliometer, 158
-
- Scorpio, constellation, temporary star in, 39
-
- Semi-lenses of heliometer, 155
-
- Sextant, how used, 4
-
- Sicily, latitude station in, 139
-
- _Sidereus Nuncius_, published by Galileo, 52
-
- Simplicio, character in Galileo's Dialogue, 55
-
- Sirius, brightest star, 205
-
- Size of Moon, measured, 166
-
- _Société de l'Optique_, 177
-
- Solar parallax, see Sun's distance.
- physics, by photography, 109
- system, stability of, 210
-
- Spectroscope, its use explained, 147
- used on pole-star, 19
- to observe Saturn's rings, 147
-
- Spiral nebulæ, 31
-
- Stability, of Saturn's rings, 145
- of Solar System, 210
-
- Standards, time, of the world, 111
- table of, 130
-
- "Standard" time, explained, 127
-
- Star-catalogue, general photographic, 102
-
- Star-clusters, photography of, 98
-
- Star-distances 94, 106
- measured with heliometer, 158
- Rutherfurd, 94
-
- Star magnitudes, 91
-
- Star-motion, toward us, 21
-
- Star-tables, astronomical, 118
-
- Stars, variable, 42
-
- St Gothard railway, tunnels, 220
-
- Sun, newspaper, the moon hoax, 201
-
- SUN-DIAL, HOW TO MAKE A, 69
-
- SUN'S, DESTINATION, 210
- distance, compared with star distance, 97
- measured with Eros, 67, 106
- motion, apex of, 221
-
- Sun-spots, discovered by Galileo, 49
-
- _Systema Saturnium_, Huygens, 143
-
-
- Telescope, clock, 175
- at Paris Exposition, 176, 180
- double, for photography, 86
- equatorial, explained, 170
- first used by Galileo, 49
- motion of, 87
- mounting great, 170
- unmoving, for polar photography, 197
-
- TEMPORARY STARS, 37
- in Andromeda nebula, 28, 29, 45
- in Aquila, 40
- in Cassiopeia, 40
- in Perseus, 46
- in Scorpio, 39
- their number, 38
- theory of, 42
-
- Time, correct, determined astronomically, 113
- differences between different places, 121
-
- TIME STANDARDS OF THE WORLD, 111
- standards of the World, table of, 130
- system, in New York, 120
- zones, explained, 128
-
- Trails, photographic, 191
-
- Transit, for determining clock error, 118
-
- Tycho Brahe, his temporary star, 40
-
-
- Ulugh Beg, early star-catalogue, 21
-
- Undulatory theory, of light, 19, 148
-
- Universe, theories of, 34, 53, 56
-
- Uranus, discovered by Herschel, 59, 142
-
- Use of occultations, 166, 167
-
- Uses of astronomy, practical, 112
-
-
- Variable stars, 42
- in Argo, 205
-
- Vega, future pole-star, 187
-
- Visibility of stars, in day-time, 191
-
- Vision, phenomenon of, 20, 149
-
-
- Washington, its longitude first determined, 168
-
- Waves, explained, 148
- of light, 20, 148
-
- Wilkes, at Naval Observatory, Washington, 169
-
- Wilkins, imaginary voyage of, 208
-
- Witt, discovers Eros, 66, 105
-
- Wolf, M, invents asteroid photography, 104
- measures Pleiades, 11
-
- World's time standards, table of, 130
-
-
- Yale College, Pleiades measured at, 15
-
-
- Zones, time, explained, 128
-
-
-
-
- TRANSCRIBER'S NOTE
-
- Italic text is denoted by _underscores_.
-
- Fractions in the two tables on pg 74 and pg 78 are displayed in the form
- "a-b/c" as 4-1/2 or 2-7/16 for example. The original text in the
- tables used the form "a b-c". A few other basic fractions in the text
- such as ½ and ⅖ are displayed in this same form in the etext.
-
- There is only one Footnote in this book, with its anchor on pg 69.
- It has been placed at the end of the chapter containing the anchor.
-
- Obvious typographical errors and punctuation errors have been
- corrected after careful comparison with other occurrences within
- the text and consultation of external sources.
-
- Except for those changes noted below, all misspellings in the text,
- and inconsistent or archaic usage, have been retained. For example,
- time zone, time-zone; Le Verrier, Leverrier; light wave, light-wave;
- intrust; wabbling; unexcelled; crape; monumented.
-
- Pg 146, 'James Clark-Maxwell' replaced by 'James Clerk Maxwell'.
- Pg 189, 'impossible to measure' replaced by 'possible to measure'.
-
-
-
-
-
-
-End of Project Gutenberg's Practical Talks by an Astronomer, by Harold Jacoby
-
-*** END OF THIS PROJECT GUTENBERG EBOOK PRACTICAL TALKS BY AN ASTRONOMER ***
-
-***** This file should be named 53396-0.txt or 53396-0.zip *****
-This and all associated files of various formats will be found in:
- http://www.gutenberg.org/5/3/3/9/53396/
-
-Produced by Chris Curnow, John Campbell and the Online
-Distributed Proofreading Team at http://www.pgdp.net (This
-file was produced from images generously made available
-by The Internet Archive)
-
-
-Updated editions will replace the previous one--the old editions will
-be renamed.
-
-Creating the works from print editions not protected by U.S. copyright
-law means that no one owns a United States copyright in these works,
-so the Foundation (and you!) can copy and distribute it in the United
-States without permission and without paying copyright
-royalties. Special rules, set forth in the General Terms of Use part
-of this license, apply to copying and distributing Project
-Gutenberg-tm electronic works to protect the PROJECT GUTENBERG-tm
-concept and trademark. Project Gutenberg is a registered trademark,
-and may not be used if you charge for the eBooks, unless you receive
-specific permission. If you do not charge anything for copies of this
-eBook, complying with the rules is very easy. You may use this eBook
-for nearly any purpose such as creation of derivative works, reports,
-performances and research. They may be modified and printed and given
-away--you may do practically ANYTHING in the United States with eBooks
-not protected by U.S. copyright law. Redistribution is subject to the
-trademark license, especially commercial redistribution.
-
-START: FULL LICENSE
-
-THE FULL PROJECT GUTENBERG LICENSE
-PLEASE READ THIS BEFORE YOU DISTRIBUTE OR USE THIS WORK
-
-To protect the Project Gutenberg-tm mission of promoting the free
-distribution of electronic works, by using or distributing this work
-(or any other work associated in any way with the phrase "Project
-Gutenberg"), you agree to comply with all the terms of the Full
-Project Gutenberg-tm License available with this file or online at
-www.gutenberg.org/license.
-
-Section 1. General Terms of Use and Redistributing Project
-Gutenberg-tm electronic works
-
-1.A. By reading or using any part of this Project Gutenberg-tm
-electronic work, you indicate that you have read, understand, agree to
-and accept all the terms of this license and intellectual property
-(trademark/copyright) agreement. If you do not agree to abide by all
-the terms of this agreement, you must cease using and return or
-destroy all copies of Project Gutenberg-tm electronic works in your
-possession. If you paid a fee for obtaining a copy of or access to a
-Project Gutenberg-tm electronic work and you do not agree to be bound
-by the terms of this agreement, you may obtain a refund from the
-person or entity to whom you paid the fee as set forth in paragraph
-1.E.8.
-
-1.B. "Project Gutenberg" is a registered trademark. It may only be
-used on or associated in any way with an electronic work by people who
-agree to be bound by the terms of this agreement. There are a few
-things that you can do with most Project Gutenberg-tm electronic works
-even without complying with the full terms of this agreement. See
-paragraph 1.C below. There are a lot of things you can do with Project
-Gutenberg-tm electronic works if you follow the terms of this
-agreement and help preserve free future access to Project Gutenberg-tm
-electronic works. See paragraph 1.E below.
-
-1.C. The Project Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation ("the
-Foundation" or PGLAF), owns a compilation copyright in the collection
-of Project Gutenberg-tm electronic works. Nearly all the individual
-works in the collection are in the public domain in the United
-States. If an individual work is unprotected by copyright law in the
-United States and you are located in the United States, we do not
-claim a right to prevent you from copying, distributing, performing,
-displaying or creating derivative works based on the work as long as
-all references to Project Gutenberg are removed. Of course, we hope
-that you will support the Project Gutenberg-tm mission of promoting
-free access to electronic works by freely sharing Project Gutenberg-tm
-works in compliance with the terms of this agreement for keeping the
-Project Gutenberg-tm name associated with the work. You can easily
-comply with the terms of this agreement by keeping this work in the
-same format with its attached full Project Gutenberg-tm License when
-you share it without charge with others.
-
-1.D. The copyright laws of the place where you are located also govern
-what you can do with this work. Copyright laws in most countries are
-in a constant state of change. If you are outside the United States,
-check the laws of your country in addition to the terms of this
-agreement before downloading, copying, displaying, performing,
-distributing or creating derivative works based on this work or any
-other Project Gutenberg-tm work. The Foundation makes no
-representations concerning the copyright status of any work in any
-country outside the United States.
-
-1.E. Unless you have removed all references to Project Gutenberg:
-
-1.E.1. The following sentence, with active links to, or other
-immediate access to, the full Project Gutenberg-tm License must appear
-prominently whenever any copy of a Project Gutenberg-tm work (any work
-on which the phrase "Project Gutenberg" appears, or with which the
-phrase "Project Gutenberg" is associated) is accessed, displayed,
-performed, viewed, copied or distributed:
-
- This eBook is for the use of anyone anywhere in the United States and
- most other parts of the world at no cost and with almost no
- restrictions whatsoever. You may copy it, give it away or re-use it
- under the terms of the Project Gutenberg License included with this
- eBook or online at www.gutenberg.org. If you are not located in the
- United States, you'll have to check the laws of the country where you
- are located before using this ebook.
-
-1.E.2. If an individual Project Gutenberg-tm electronic work is
-derived from texts not protected by U.S. copyright law (does not
-contain a notice indicating that it is posted with permission of the
-copyright holder), the work can be copied and distributed to anyone in
-the United States without paying any fees or charges. If you are
-redistributing or providing access to a work with the phrase "Project
-Gutenberg" associated with or appearing on the work, you must comply
-either with the requirements of paragraphs 1.E.1 through 1.E.7 or
-obtain permission for the use of the work and the Project Gutenberg-tm
-trademark as set forth in paragraphs 1.E.8 or 1.E.9.
-
-1.E.3. If an individual Project Gutenberg-tm electronic work is posted
-with the permission of the copyright holder, your use and distribution
-must comply with both paragraphs 1.E.1 through 1.E.7 and any
-additional terms imposed by the copyright holder. Additional terms
-will be linked to the Project Gutenberg-tm License for all works
-posted with the permission of the copyright holder found at the
-beginning of this work.
-
-1.E.4. Do not unlink or detach or remove the full Project Gutenberg-tm
-License terms from this work, or any files containing a part of this
-work or any other work associated with Project Gutenberg-tm.
-
-1.E.5. Do not copy, display, perform, distribute or redistribute this
-electronic work, or any part of this electronic work, without
-prominently displaying the sentence set forth in paragraph 1.E.1 with
-active links or immediate access to the full terms of the Project
-Gutenberg-tm License.
-
-1.E.6. You may convert to and distribute this work in any binary,
-compressed, marked up, nonproprietary or proprietary form, including
-any word processing or hypertext form. However, if you provide access
-to or distribute copies of a Project Gutenberg-tm work in a format
-other than "Plain Vanilla ASCII" or other format used in the official
-version posted on the official Project Gutenberg-tm web site
-(www.gutenberg.org), you must, at no additional cost, fee or expense
-to the user, provide a copy, a means of exporting a copy, or a means
-of obtaining a copy upon request, of the work in its original "Plain
-Vanilla ASCII" or other form. Any alternate format must include the
-full Project Gutenberg-tm License as specified in paragraph 1.E.1.
-
-1.E.7. Do not charge a fee for access to, viewing, displaying,
-performing, copying or distributing any Project Gutenberg-tm works
-unless you comply with paragraph 1.E.8 or 1.E.9.
-
-1.E.8. You may charge a reasonable fee for copies of or providing
-access to or distributing Project Gutenberg-tm electronic works
-provided that
-
-* You pay a royalty fee of 20% of the gross profits you derive from
- the use of Project Gutenberg-tm works calculated using the method
- you already use to calculate your applicable taxes. The fee is owed
- to the owner of the Project Gutenberg-tm trademark, but he has
- agreed to donate royalties under this paragraph to the Project
- Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation. Royalty payments must be paid
- within 60 days following each date on which you prepare (or are
- legally required to prepare) your periodic tax returns. Royalty
- payments should be clearly marked as such and sent to the Project
- Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation at the address specified in
- Section 4, "Information about donations to the Project Gutenberg
- Literary Archive Foundation."
-
-* You provide a full refund of any money paid by a user who notifies
- you in writing (or by e-mail) within 30 days of receipt that s/he
- does not agree to the terms of the full Project Gutenberg-tm
- License. You must require such a user to return or destroy all
- copies of the works possessed in a physical medium and discontinue
- all use of and all access to other copies of Project Gutenberg-tm
- works.
-
-* You provide, in accordance with paragraph 1.F.3, a full refund of
- any money paid for a work or a replacement copy, if a defect in the
- electronic work is discovered and reported to you within 90 days of
- receipt of the work.
-
-* You comply with all other terms of this agreement for free
- distribution of Project Gutenberg-tm works.
-
-1.E.9. If you wish to charge a fee or distribute a Project
-Gutenberg-tm electronic work or group of works on different terms than
-are set forth in this agreement, you must obtain permission in writing
-from both the Project Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation and The
-Project Gutenberg Trademark LLC, the owner of the Project Gutenberg-tm
-trademark. Contact the Foundation as set forth in Section 3 below.
-
-1.F.
-
-1.F.1. Project Gutenberg volunteers and employees expend considerable
-effort to identify, do copyright research on, transcribe and proofread
-works not protected by U.S. copyright law in creating the Project
-Gutenberg-tm collection. Despite these efforts, Project Gutenberg-tm
-electronic works, and the medium on which they may be stored, may
-contain "Defects," such as, but not limited to, incomplete, inaccurate
-or corrupt data, transcription errors, a copyright or other
-intellectual property infringement, a defective or damaged disk or
-other medium, a computer virus, or computer codes that damage or
-cannot be read by your equipment.
-
-1.F.2. LIMITED WARRANTY, DISCLAIMER OF DAMAGES - Except for the "Right
-of Replacement or Refund" described in paragraph 1.F.3, the Project
-Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation, the owner of the Project
-Gutenberg-tm trademark, and any other party distributing a Project
-Gutenberg-tm electronic work under this agreement, disclaim all
-liability to you for damages, costs and expenses, including legal
-fees. YOU AGREE THAT YOU HAVE NO REMEDIES FOR NEGLIGENCE, STRICT
-LIABILITY, BREACH OF WARRANTY OR BREACH OF CONTRACT EXCEPT THOSE
-PROVIDED IN PARAGRAPH 1.F.3. YOU AGREE THAT THE FOUNDATION, THE
-TRADEMARK OWNER, AND ANY DISTRIBUTOR UNDER THIS AGREEMENT WILL NOT BE
-LIABLE TO YOU FOR ACTUAL, DIRECT, INDIRECT, CONSEQUENTIAL, PUNITIVE OR
-INCIDENTAL DAMAGES EVEN IF YOU GIVE NOTICE OF THE POSSIBILITY OF SUCH
-DAMAGE.
-
-1.F.3. LIMITED RIGHT OF REPLACEMENT OR REFUND - If you discover a
-defect in this electronic work within 90 days of receiving it, you can
-receive a refund of the money (if any) you paid for it by sending a
-written explanation to the person you received the work from. If you
-received the work on a physical medium, you must return the medium
-with your written explanation. The person or entity that provided you
-with the defective work may elect to provide a replacement copy in
-lieu of a refund. If you received the work electronically, the person
-or entity providing it to you may choose to give you a second
-opportunity to receive the work electronically in lieu of a refund. If
-the second copy is also defective, you may demand a refund in writing
-without further opportunities to fix the problem.
-
-1.F.4. Except for the limited right of replacement or refund set forth
-in paragraph 1.F.3, this work is provided to you 'AS-IS', WITH NO
-OTHER WARRANTIES OF ANY KIND, EXPRESS OR IMPLIED, INCLUDING BUT NOT
-LIMITED TO WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY OR FITNESS FOR ANY PURPOSE.
-
-1.F.5. Some states do not allow disclaimers of certain implied
-warranties or the exclusion or limitation of certain types of
-damages. If any disclaimer or limitation set forth in this agreement
-violates the law of the state applicable to this agreement, the
-agreement shall be interpreted to make the maximum disclaimer or
-limitation permitted by the applicable state law. The invalidity or
-unenforceability of any provision of this agreement shall not void the
-remaining provisions.
-
-1.F.6. INDEMNITY - You agree to indemnify and hold the Foundation, the
-trademark owner, any agent or employee of the Foundation, anyone
-providing copies of Project Gutenberg-tm electronic works in
-accordance with this agreement, and any volunteers associated with the
-production, promotion and distribution of Project Gutenberg-tm
-electronic works, harmless from all liability, costs and expenses,
-including legal fees, that arise directly or indirectly from any of
-the following which you do or cause to occur: (a) distribution of this
-or any Project Gutenberg-tm work, (b) alteration, modification, or
-additions or deletions to any Project Gutenberg-tm work, and (c) any
-Defect you cause.
-
-Section 2. Information about the Mission of Project Gutenberg-tm
-
-Project Gutenberg-tm is synonymous with the free distribution of
-electronic works in formats readable by the widest variety of
-computers including obsolete, old, middle-aged and new computers. It
-exists because of the efforts of hundreds of volunteers and donations
-from people in all walks of life.
-
-Volunteers and financial support to provide volunteers with the
-assistance they need are critical to reaching Project Gutenberg-tm's
-goals and ensuring that the Project Gutenberg-tm collection will
-remain freely available for generations to come. In 2001, the Project
-Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation was created to provide a secure
-and permanent future for Project Gutenberg-tm and future
-generations. To learn more about the Project Gutenberg Literary
-Archive Foundation and how your efforts and donations can help, see
-Sections 3 and 4 and the Foundation information page at
-www.gutenberg.org Section 3. Information about the Project Gutenberg
-Literary Archive Foundation
-
-The Project Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation is a non profit
-501(c)(3) educational corporation organized under the laws of the
-state of Mississippi and granted tax exempt status by the Internal
-Revenue Service. The Foundation's EIN or federal tax identification
-number is 64-6221541. Contributions to the Project Gutenberg Literary
-Archive Foundation are tax deductible to the full extent permitted by
-U.S. federal laws and your state's laws.
-
-The Foundation's principal office is in Fairbanks, Alaska, with the
-mailing address: PO Box 750175, Fairbanks, AK 99775, but its
-volunteers and employees are scattered throughout numerous
-locations. Its business office is located at 809 North 1500 West, Salt
-Lake City, UT 84116, (801) 596-1887. Email contact links and up to
-date contact information can be found at the Foundation's web site and
-official page at www.gutenberg.org/contact
-
-For additional contact information:
-
- Dr. Gregory B. Newby
- Chief Executive and Director
- gbnewby@pglaf.org
-
-Section 4. Information about Donations to the Project Gutenberg
-Literary Archive Foundation
-
-Project Gutenberg-tm depends upon and cannot survive without wide
-spread public support and donations to carry out its mission of
-increasing the number of public domain and licensed works that can be
-freely distributed in machine readable form accessible by the widest
-array of equipment including outdated equipment. Many small donations
-($1 to $5,000) are particularly important to maintaining tax exempt
-status with the IRS.
-
-The Foundation is committed to complying with the laws regulating
-charities and charitable donations in all 50 states of the United
-States. Compliance requirements are not uniform and it takes a
-considerable effort, much paperwork and many fees to meet and keep up
-with these requirements. We do not solicit donations in locations
-where we have not received written confirmation of compliance. To SEND
-DONATIONS or determine the status of compliance for any particular
-state visit www.gutenberg.org/donate
-
-While we cannot and do not solicit contributions from states where we
-have not met the solicitation requirements, we know of no prohibition
-against accepting unsolicited donations from donors in such states who
-approach us with offers to donate.
-
-International donations are gratefully accepted, but we cannot make
-any statements concerning tax treatment of donations received from
-outside the United States. U.S. laws alone swamp our small staff.
-
-Please check the Project Gutenberg Web pages for current donation
-methods and addresses. Donations are accepted in a number of other
-ways including checks, online payments and credit card donations. To
-donate, please visit: www.gutenberg.org/donate
-
-Section 5. General Information About Project Gutenberg-tm electronic works.
-
-Professor Michael S. Hart was the originator of the Project
-Gutenberg-tm concept of a library of electronic works that could be
-freely shared with anyone. For forty years, he produced and
-distributed Project Gutenberg-tm eBooks with only a loose network of
-volunteer support.
-
-Project Gutenberg-tm eBooks are often created from several printed
-editions, all of which are confirmed as not protected by copyright in
-the U.S. unless a copyright notice is included. Thus, we do not
-necessarily keep eBooks in compliance with any particular paper
-edition.
-
-Most people start at our Web site which has the main PG search
-facility: www.gutenberg.org
-
-This Web site includes information about Project Gutenberg-tm,
-including how to make donations to the Project Gutenberg Literary
-Archive Foundation, how to help produce our new eBooks, and how to
-subscribe to our email newsletter to hear about new eBooks.
-
diff --git a/old/53396-0.zip b/old/53396-0.zip
deleted file mode 100644
index 8072646..0000000
--- a/old/53396-0.zip
+++ /dev/null
Binary files differ
diff --git a/old/53396-h.zip b/old/53396-h.zip
deleted file mode 100644
index ec616b1..0000000
--- a/old/53396-h.zip
+++ /dev/null
Binary files differ
diff --git a/old/53396-h/53396-h.htm b/old/53396-h/53396-h.htm
deleted file mode 100644
index 8336d19..0000000
--- a/old/53396-h/53396-h.htm
+++ /dev/null
@@ -1,7051 +0,0 @@
-<!DOCTYPE html PUBLIC "-//W3C//DTD XHTML 1.0 Strict//EN"
- "http://www.w3.org/TR/xhtml1/DTD/xhtml1-strict.dtd">
-<html xmlns="http://www.w3.org/1999/xhtml" xml:lang="en" lang="en">
- <head>
- <meta http-equiv="Content-Type" content="text/html;charset=utf-8" />
- <meta http-equiv="Content-Style-Type" content="text/css" />
- <title>
- The Project Gutenberg eBook of Practical Talks by An Astronomer, by Harold Jacoby.
- </title>
- <link rel="coverpage" href="images/cover.jpg" />
- <style type="text/css">
-
-body {
- margin-left: 10%;
- margin-right: 10%;
-}
-
- h1,h2,h3 {
- text-align: center; /* all headings centered */
- clear: both;
-}
-
- h1, h2 {
- margin-top: 1.5em;
- margin-bottom: 1em;
- word-spacing: 0.2em;
- letter-spacing: 0.1em;
- line-height: 1.5em;
- font-weight: normal;
-}
-
-h2 {font-size: 135%;}
-
-p {
- margin-top: .5em;
- text-align: justify;
- margin-bottom: .3em;
- text-indent: 1em;
-}
-
-.p2 {margin-top: 2em;}
-.p4 {margin-top: 4em;}
-.p6 {margin-top: 6em;}
-
-div.clear {clear: both;}
-
-.noindent {text-indent: 0em;}
-
-.pfs150 {font-size: 150%; text-align: center; text-indent: 0em; word-spacing: 0.3em;}
-.pfs100 {font-size: 100%; text-align: center; text-indent: 0em; word-spacing: 0.3em;}
-.pfs90 {font-size: 90%; text-align: center; text-indent: 0em; word-spacing: 0.3em;}
-.pfs80 {font-size: 80%; text-align: center; text-indent: 0em; word-spacing: 0.3em;}
-.pfs60 {font-size: 60%; text-align: center; text-indent: 0em; word-spacing: 0.3em;}
-
-
-.xs {font-size: x-small;}
-.small {font-size: small;}
-.medium {font-size: medium;}
-.large {font-size: large;}
-.xxl {font-size: xx-large;}
-
-.fs70 {font-size: 70%; font-style: normal;}
-.fs80 {font-size: 80%; font-style: normal;}
-.fs90 {font-size: 90%; font-style: normal;}
-
-.chapter {page-break-before: always; page-break-inside: avoid; margin-top: 2em;}
-
-div.tpage {
- text-align: center;
- page-break-before: always;
-}
-
-div.tpage p {
- text-align: center;
- text-indent: 0em;
- font-weight: normal;
- line-height: 1em;
- margin-top: 3em;
- margin-bottom: 1em;
- word-spacing: .4em;
-}
-
-hr {
- width: 33%;
- margin-top: 2em;
- margin-bottom: 2em;
- margin-left: 33.5%;
- margin-right: 33.5%;
- clear: both;
-}
-
-hr.chap {width: 65%; margin-left: 17.5%; margin-right: 17.5%;}
-hr.r5a {width: 5%; margin-left: 47.5%; margin-right: 47.5%;
- margin-top: .5em; margin-bottom: 0em;}
-
-@media handheld {
-hr {
- width: 0%;
- margin-top: 2em;
- margin-bottom: 2em;
- margin-left: auto;
- margin-right: auto;
- clear: both;
- }
-
-hr.chap {width: 0%;}
-hr.r5a {width: 0%; margin-top: 0em; margin-bottom: 0em;}
-}
-
-.corr {
- text-decoration: none;
- border-bottom: thin dotted blue;
-}
-
-@media handheld {
- .corr {
- text-decoration: none;
- border-bottom: none;
- }
-}
-
-table {
- margin-left: auto;
- margin-right: auto;
-}
-
-td {padding: .18em .1em 0 .3em;}
-tr {}
-
-.tdpp {padding-top: .5em; padding-bottom: .5em;}
-
-.tdl {text-align: left; padding-left: 2em; text-indent: -1em; word-spacing: .3em;}
-.tdr {text-align: right; vertical-align: top;}
-.tdc {text-align: center; vertical-align: middle; padding-right: .5em;}
-.tdlx {text-align: left; padding-left: 3em; vertical-align: middle;}
-.tdlv {text-align: left; padding-left: 2em; text-indent: -2em;
- word-spacing: .3em; vertical-align: bottom;}
-
-.tdcbl {text-align: center; vertical-align: middle; border-left: solid 1px;}
-
-.tdlbt {text-align: left; vertical-align: top; border-top: solid 1px;}
-.tdlbl {text-align: left; vertical-align: top; border-left: solid 1px;}
-.tdlbr {text-align: left; vertical-align: top; border-right: solid 1px;}
-
-.wd1 {width: 1%;}
-.wd10 {width: 10%;}
-
-.pad1 {padding-left: 1em;}
-.pad3 {padding-left: 3em;}
-.pad4 {padding-left: 4em;}
-.pad6 {padding-left: 6em;}
-
-.pagenum { /* uncomment the next line for invisible page numbers */
- /* visibility: hidden; */
- position: absolute;
- color: #A9A9A9;
- left: 92%;
- font-size: small;
- font-weight: normal;
- font-style: normal;
- text-align: right;
- text-indent: .5em;
-}
-
-.center {text-align: center; text-indent: 0em;}
-
-.smcap {font-variant: small-caps;}
-
-.lsp {letter-spacing: 0.15em;}
-
-.caption {font-weight: normal;
- padding-bottom: 0.50em;}
-
-.pg-brk {page-break-before: always;}
-.no-brk {page-break-before: avoid;}
-
-/* Images */
-img {border: none; max-width: 100%; height: auto;}
-
-.figcenter {
- margin: auto;
- padding-top: 1em;
- padding-bottom: 1em;
- text-align: center;
- page-break-inside: avoid;
-}
-
-.figright {
- float: right;
- clear: right;
- margin: .2em .2em .2em 1em;
-}
-
-@media handheld
-{
- .figright {
- float: right;
- clear: right;
- text-align: center;
- margin-left: 0;
- }
-}
-
-/* Footnotes */
-.footnotes {border: dashed 1px; margin-top: 2em; margin-bottom: 3em;
- padding-bottom: 1em;}
-
-.footnote {margin-left: 10%; margin-right: 10%; font-size: 90%;}
-.footnote p {text-indent: 0em;}
-.footnote .label {position: absolute; right: 84%; text-align: right;}
-
-.fnanchor {
- vertical-align: super;
- font-size: .8em;
- text-decoration:
- none;
-}
-
-
-/* Transcriber's notes */
-.transnote {
- background-color: #E6E6FA;
- color: black;
- font-size:90%;
- padding:0.5em;
- margin-top:5em;
- margin-bottom:5em;
- font-family:sans-serif, serif;
-}
-
-.transnote p {text-indent: 0em;}
-
- </style>
- </head>
-
-<body>
-
-
-<pre>
-
-Project Gutenberg's Practical Talks by an Astronomer, by Harold Jacoby
-
-This eBook is for the use of anyone anywhere in the United States and most
-other parts of the world at no cost and with almost no restrictions
-whatsoever. You may copy it, give it away or re-use it under the terms of
-the Project Gutenberg License included with this eBook or online at
-www.gutenberg.org. If you are not located in the United States, you'll have
-to check the laws of the country where you are located before using this ebook.
-
-
-
-Title: Practical Talks by an Astronomer
-
-Author: Harold Jacoby
-
-Release Date: October 29, 2016 [EBook #53396]
-
-Language: English
-
-Character set encoding: UTF-8
-
-*** START OF THIS PROJECT GUTENBERG EBOOK PRACTICAL TALKS BY AN ASTRONOMER ***
-
-
-
-
-Produced by Chris Curnow, John Campbell and the Online
-Distributed Proofreading Team at http://www.pgdp.net (This
-file was produced from images generously made available
-by The Internet Archive)
-
-
-
-
-
-
-</pre>
-
-
-
-<div class="transnote">
-<p><strong>TRANSCRIBER'S NOTE</strong></p>
-
-<p>Obvious typographical errors and punctuation errors have been
-corrected after careful comparison with other occurrences within
-the text and consultation of external sources.</p>
-
-<p>More detail can be found at <a href="#TN">the end of the book</a>.</p>
-</div>
-
-
-<hr class="chap pg-brk" />
-<p class="p6" />
-
-<h1>PRACTICAL TALKS BY<br />
-AN ASTRONOMER</h1>
-
-<p class="p6" />
-
-<div class="figcenter pg-brk">
-<a name="FP" id="FP"></a>
-<br />
-<img src="images/i_frontis.jpg" width="525" alt="" />
-<div class="caption">
-
-The Moon. &nbsp; First Quarter.<br />
-
-<span class="fs80">Photographed by Loewy and Puiseux, February 13, 1894.</span></div>
-</div>
-
-
-<hr class="chap" />
-
-<div class="tpage">
-<br /><br />
-<p><span class="xxl">PRACTICAL TALKS BY<br /><br />
-AN ASTRONOMER</span></p>
-
-<br /><br />
-<p><span class="small">BY</span><br /><br />
-<span class="large">HAROLD JACOBY</span><br />
-<span class="xs">ADJUNCT PROFESSOR OF ASTRONOMY IN<br />
-COLUMBIA UNIVERSITY</span></p>
-<br /><br />
-<p><span class="small">ILLUSTRATED</span></p>
-<br /><br />
-<p><span class="medium">NEW YORK</span><br /><br />
-<span class="large lsp">CHARLES SCRIBNER'S SONS</span><br /><br />
-<span class="medium">1902</span></p>
-</div>
-
-
-<hr class="chap pg-brk" />
-<p class="p6" />
-
-<p class="pfs90"><span class="smcap">Copyright, 1902, by</span><br />
-CHARLES SCRIBNER'S SONS</p>
-<hr class="r5a" />
-<p class="pfs90">Published, April, 1902</p>
-<p class="p6" />
-
-
-<p class="pfs60">TROW DIRECTORY<br />
-PRINTING AND BOOKBINDING COMPANY<br />
-NEW YORK</p>
-
-
-<hr class="chap" />
-<p><span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_v" id="Page_v">[Pg v]</a></span></p>
-
-<h2><a name="PREFACE" id="PREFACE">PREFACE</a></h2>
-
-
-<p>The present volume has not been designed as
-a systematic treatise on astronomy. There are
-many excellent books of that kind, suitable for
-serious students as well as the general reader;
-but they are necessarily somewhat dry and unattractive,
-because they must aim at completeness.
-Completeness means detail, and detail
-means dryness.</p>
-
-<p>But the science of astronomy contains subjects
-that admit of detached treatment; and as many
-of these are precisely the ones of greatest general
-interest, it has seemed well to select several, and
-describe them in language free from technicalities.
-It is hoped that the book will thus prove useful
-to persons who do not wish to give the time
-required for a study of astronomy as a whole, but
-who may take pleasure in devoting a half-hour<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_vi" id="Page_vi">[vi]</a></span>
-now and then to a detached essay on some special
-topic.</p>
-
-<p>Preparation of the book in this form has made
-it suitable for prior publication in periodicals;
-and the several essays have in fact all been
-printed before. But the intention of collecting
-them into a book was kept in mind from the
-first; and while no attempt has been made at
-consecutiveness, it is hoped that nothing of
-merely ephemeral value has been included.</p>
-
-
-<hr class="chap" />
-<p><span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_vii" id="Page_vii">[vii]</a></span></p>
-<p class="p4" />
-
-<h2><a name="CONTENTS" id="CONTENTS">CONTENTS</a></h2>
-
-
-<div class="center smcap">
-<table border="0" cellpadding="4" cellspacing="2" width="80%" summary="">
-<tr><td class="tdl"></td><td class="tdr xs">PAGE</td></tr>
-<tr><td class="tdl">Navigation at Sea</td><td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_1">1</a></td></tr>
-<tr><td class="tdl">The Pleiades</td><td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_10">10</a></td></tr>
-<tr><td class="tdl">The Pole-Star</td><td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_18">18</a></td></tr>
-<tr><td class="tdl">Nebulæ</td><td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_27">27</a></td></tr>
-<tr><td class="tdl">Temporary Stars</td><td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_37">37</a></td></tr>
-<tr><td class="tdl">Galileo</td><td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_47">47</a></td></tr>
-<tr><td class="tdl">The Planet of 1898</td><td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_58">58</a></td></tr>
-<tr><td class="tdl">How to Make a Sun-Dial</td><td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_69">69</a></td></tr>
-<tr><td class="tdl">Photography in Astronomy</td><td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_81">81</a></td></tr>
-<tr><td class="tdl">Time Standards of the World</td><td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_111">111</a></td></tr>
-<tr><td class="tdl">Motions of the Earth's Pole</td><td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_131">131</a></td></tr>
-<tr><td class="tdl">Saturn's Rings</td><td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_140">140</a></td></tr>
-<tr><td class="tdl">The Heliometer</td><td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_152">152</a></td></tr>
-<tr><td class="tdl">Occultations</td><td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_161">161</a></td></tr>
-<tr><td class="tdl">Mounting Great Telescopes</td><td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_170">170</a></td></tr>
-<tr><td class="tdl">The Astronomer's Pole</td><td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_184">184</a></td></tr>
-<tr><td class="tdl">The Moon Hoax</td><td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_199">199</a></td></tr>
-<tr><td class="tdl">The Sun's Destination</td><td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_210">210</a></td></tr>
-</table></div>
-
-
-<hr class="chap" />
-<p><span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_viii" id="Page_viii">[viii]</a></span><br />
- <span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_ix" id="Page_ix">[ix]</a></span></p>
-<p class="p4" />
-
-<h2><a name="ILLUSTRATIONS" id="ILLUSTRATIONS">ILLUSTRATIONS</a></h2>
-
-<div class="center">
-<table border="0" cellpadding="4" cellspacing="0" summary="">
-<tr><td class="tdlv"><span class="smcap">The Moon. First Quarter</span><br /><em>Photographed by Loewy and Puiseux, February 13, 1894.</em></td><td class="tdr"><a href="#FP"><em>Frontispiece</em></a></td></tr>
-<tr><td class="tdlv"></td><td class="tdr xs">FACING<br />PAGE &nbsp;</td></tr>
-<tr><td class="tdlv"><span class="smcap">Spiral Nebula in Constellation Leo</span><br /><em>Photographed by Keeler, February 24, 1900.</em></td><td class="tdr"><a href="#P_26">26</a></td></tr>
-<tr><td class="tdlv"><span class="smcap">Nebula in Andromeda</span><br /><em>Photographed by Barnard, November 21, 1892.</em></td><td class="tdr"><a href="#P_28">28</a></td></tr>
-<tr><td class="tdlv"><span class="smcap">The "Dumb-Bell" Nebula</span><br /><em>Photographed by Keeler, July 31, 1899.</em></td><td class="tdr"><a href="#P_34">34</a></td></tr>
-<tr><td class="tdlv"><span class="smcap">Star-Field in Constellation Monoceros</span><br /><em>Photographed by Barnard, February 1, 1894.</em></td><td class="tdr"><a href="#P_84">84</a></td></tr>
-<tr><td class="tdlv"><span class="smcap">Solar Corona. Total Eclipse</span><br /><em>Photographed by Campbell, January 22, 1898; Jeur, India.</em></td><td class="tdr"><a href="#P_108">108</a></td></tr>
-<tr><td class="tdlv"><span class="smcap">Forty-Inch Telescope, Yerkes Observatory</span></td><td class="tdr"><a href="#P_170">170</a></td></tr>
-<tr><td class="tdlv"><span class="smcap">Yerkes Observatory, University of Chicago</span></td><td class="tdr"><a href="#P_176">176</a></td></tr>
-</table></div>
-
-
-<hr class="chap pg-brk" />
-<p><span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_1" id="Page_1">[Pg 1]</a></span></p>
-
-<p class="p4" />
-<p class="pfs150">PRACTICAL TALKS<br />
-BY AN ASTRONOMER</p>
-
-<h2 class="no-brk"><a name="NAVIGATION_AT_SEA" id="NAVIGATION_AT_SEA"></a><a href="#CONTENTS">NAVIGATION AT SEA</a></h2>
-
-
-<p>A short time ago the writer had occasion to
-rummage among the archives of the Royal Astronomical
-Society in London, to consult, if possible,
-the original manuscripts left by one Stephen
-Groombridge, an English astronomer of the good
-old days, who died in 1832. It was known that
-they had been filed away about a generation ago,
-by the late Sir George Airy, who was Astronomer
-Royal of England between the years 1835 and
-1881. After a long search, a large and dusty
-box was found and opened. It was filled with
-documents, of which the topmost was in Sir
-George's own handwriting, and began substantially
-as follows:</p>
-
-<p>"List of articles within this box.</p>
-
-<p class="noindent pad6">
-"No. 1, This list,<br />
-"No. 2, etc., etc."</p>
-
-<p><span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_2" id="Page_2">[2]</a></span></p>
-
-<p>Astronomical precision can no further go: he
-had listed even the list itself. Truly, Airy was
-rightly styled "prince of precisians." A worthy
-Astronomer Royal was he, to act under the
-royal warrant of Charles II., who established the
-office in 1675. Down to this present day that
-warrant still makes it the duty of His Majesty's
-Astronomer "to apply himself with the most
-exact care and diligence to the rectifying of the
-tables of the motions of the heavens and the
-places of the fixed stars, in order to find out the
-so much desired longitude at sea, for the perfecting
-the art of navigation."</p>
-
-<p>The "so much desired longitude at sea" is,
-indeed, a vastly important thing to a maritime
-nation like England. And only in comparatively
-recent years has it become possible and easy for
-vessels to be navigated with safety and convenience
-upon long voyages. The writer was well
-acquainted with an old sea-captain of New York,
-who had commanded one of the earliest transatlantic
-steamers, and who died only a few years ago.
-He had a goodly store of ocean yarn, fit and
-ready for the spinning, if he could but find some<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_3" id="Page_3">[3]</a></span>one
-who, like himself, had known and loved the
-ocean. In his early sea-going days, only the
-wealthiest of captains owned chronometers. This
-instrument is now considered indispensable in
-navigation, but at that time it was a new invention,
-very rare and costly. Upon a certain
-voyage from England to Rio Janeiro, in South
-America, the old captain could remember the
-following odd method of navigation: The ship
-was steered by compass to the southward and
-westward, more or less, until the skipper's
-antique quadrant showed that they had about
-reached the latitude of Rio. Then they swung
-her on a course due west by compass, and away
-she went for Rio, relying on the lookout man forward
-to keep the ship from running ashore. For
-after a certain lapse of time, being ignorant of the
-longitude, they could not know whether they
-would "raise" the land within an hour or in six
-weeks. We are glad of an opportunity to put
-this story on record, for the time is not far distant
-when there will be no man left among the living
-who can remember how ships were taken across
-the seas in the good old days before chronometers.</p>
-
-<p><span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_4" id="Page_4">[4]</a></span></p>
-
-<p>Anyone who has ever been a passenger on a
-great transatlantic liner of to-day knows what an
-important, imposing personage is the brass-bound
-skipper. A very different creature is he on the
-deck of his ship from the modest seafaring man we
-meet on land, clad for the time being in his shore-going
-togs. But the captain's dignity is not all
-brass buttons and gold braid. He has behind
-him the powerful support of a deep, delightful
-mystery. He it is who "takes the sun" at
-noon, and finds out the ship's path at sea. And
-in truth, regarded merely as a scientific experiment,
-the guiding of a vessel across the unmarked
-trackless ocean has few equals within the whole
-range of human knowledge. It is our purpose
-here to explain quite briefly the manner in which
-this seeming impossibility is accomplished. We
-shall not be able to go sufficiently into details to
-enable him who reads to run and navigate a magnificent
-steamer. But we hope to diminish somewhat
-that small part of the captain's vast dignity
-which depends upon his mysterious operations
-with the sextant.</p>
-
-<p>To begin, then, with the sextant itself. It is<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_5" id="Page_5">[5]</a></span>
-nothing but an instrument with which we can
-measure how high up the sun is in the sky. Now,
-everyone knows that the sun slowly climbs the
-sky in the morning, reaches its greatest height at
-noon, and then slowly sinks again in the afternoon.
-The captain simply begins to watch the
-sun through the sextant shortly before noon,
-and keeps at it until he discovers that the sun is
-just beginning to descend. That is the instant of
-noon on the ship. The captain quickly glances
-at the chronometer, or calls out "noon" to an
-officer who is near that instrument. And so the
-error of the chronometer becomes known then
-and there without any further astronomical calculations
-whatever. Navigators can also find the
-chronometer error by sextant observations when
-the sun is a long way from noon. The methods
-of doing this are somewhat less simple than for
-the noon observation; they belong to the details
-of navigation, into which we cannot enter here.</p>
-
-<p>Incidentally, the captain also notes with the
-sextant how high the sun was in the sky at the
-noon observation. He has in his mysterious
-"chart-room" some printed astronomical tables,<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_6" id="Page_6">[6]</a></span>
-which tell him in what terrestrial latitude the sun
-will have precisely that height on that particular
-day of the year. Thus the terrestrial latitude becomes
-known easily enough, and if only the captain
-could get his longitude too, he would know
-just where his ship was that day at noon.</p>
-
-<p>We have seen that the sextant observations
-furnish the error of the chronometer according to
-ship's time. In other words, the captain is in
-possession of the correct local time in the place
-where the ship actually is. Now, if he also had
-the correct time at that moment of some well-known
-place on shore, he would know the difference
-in time between that place on shore and the
-ship. But every traveller by land or sea is aware
-that there are always differences of time between
-different places on the earth. If a watch be
-right on leaving New York, for instance, it will
-be much too fast on arriving at Chicago or San
-Francisco; the farther you go the larger becomes
-the error of your watch. In fact, if you could
-find out how much your watch had gone into
-error, you would in a sense know how far east or
-west you had travelled.</p>
-
-<p><span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_7" id="Page_7">[7]</a></span></p>
-
-<p>Now the captain's chronometer is set to correct
-"Greenwich time" on shore before the ship
-leaves port. His observations having then told
-him how much this is wrong on that particular
-day, and in that particular spot where the ship is,
-he knows at once just how far he has travelled
-east or west from Greenwich. In other words,
-he knows his "longitude from Greenwich," for
-longitude is nothing more than distance from
-Greenwich in an east-and-west direction, just as
-latitude is only distance from the equator measured
-in a north-and-south direction. Greenwich
-observatory is usually selected as the beginning
-of things for measuring longitudes, because it is
-almost the oldest of existing astronomical establishments,
-and belongs to the most prominent
-maritime nation, England.</p>
-
-<p>One of the most interesting bits of astronomical
-history was enacted in connection with this
-matter of longitude. From what has been said,
-it is clear that the ship's longitude will be obtained
-correctly only if the chronometer has kept
-exact time since the departure of the ship from
-port. Even a very small error of the chronom<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_8" id="Page_8">[8]</a></span>eter
-will throw out the longitude a good many
-miles, and we can understand readily that it must
-be difficult in the extreme to construct a mechanical
-contrivance capable of keeping exact time
-when subjected to the rolling and pitching of a
-vessel at sea.</p>
-
-<p>It was as recently as the year 1736 that the
-first instrument capable of keeping anything like
-accurate time at sea was successfully completed.
-It was the work of an English watchmaker
-named John Harrison, and is one of the few
-great improvements in matters scientific which
-the world owes to a desire for winning a money
-prize. It appears that in 1714 a committee was
-appointed by the House of Commons, with no
-less a person than Sir Isaac Newton himself as
-one of its members, to consider the desirability
-of offering governmental encouragement for the
-invention of some means of finding the longitude
-at sea. Finally, the British Government offered
-a reward of $50,000 for an instrument which
-would find the longitude within sixty miles;
-$75,000, if within forty miles, and $100,000, if
-within thirty miles. Harrison's chronometer was<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_9" id="Page_9">[9]</a></span>
-finished in 1736, but he did not receive the final
-payment of his prize until 1764.</p>
-
-<p>We shall not enter into a detailed account of
-the vexatious delays and official procedures to
-which he was forced to submit during those
-twenty-eight long years. It is a matter of satisfaction
-that Harrison lived to receive the money
-which he had earned. He had the genius to
-plan and master intricate mechanical details, but
-perhaps he lacked in some degree the ability of
-tongue and pen to bring them home to others.
-This may be the reason he is so little known,
-though it was his fortune to contribute so large
-and essential a part to the perfection of modern
-navigation. Let us hope this brief mention may
-serve to recall his memory from oblivion even for
-a fleeting moment; that we may not have written
-in vain of that longitude to which his life was
-given.</p>
-
-
-<hr class="chap" />
-<p><span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_10" id="Page_10">[10]</a></span></p>
-
-<h2><a name="THE_PLEIADES" id="THE_PLEIADES"></a><a href="#CONTENTS">THE PLEIADES</a></h2>
-
-
-<p>Famed in legend; sung by early minstrels of
-Persia and Hindustan;</p>
-
-<p class="pfs80">
-"&mdash;like a swarm of fire-flies tangled in a silver braid";<br />
-</p>
-
-<p class="noindent">yonder distant misty little cloud of Pleiades has
-always won and held the imagination of men.
-But it was not only for the inspiration of poets,
-for quickening fancy into song, that the seven
-daughters of Atlas were fixed upon the firmament.
-The problems presented by this group of
-stars to the unobtrusive scientific investigator are
-among the most interesting known to astronomy.
-Their solution is still very incomplete, but what
-we have already learned may be counted justly
-among the richest spoils brought back by science
-from the stored treasure-house of Nature's
-secrets.</p>
-
-<p>The true student of astronomy is animated by
-no mere vulgar curiosity to pry into things hidden.
-If he seeks the concealed springs that<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_11" id="Page_11">[11]</a></span>
-move the complex visible mechanism of the
-heavens, he does so because his imagination is
-roused by the grandeur of what he sees; and
-deep down within him stirs the true love of the
-artist for his art. For it is indeed a fine art, that
-science of astronomy.</p>
-
-<p>It can have been no mere chance that has
-massed the Pleiades from among their fellow
-stars. Men of ordinary eyesight see but a half-dozen
-distinct objects in the cluster; those of
-acuter vision can count fourteen; but it is not
-until we apply the space-penetrating power of
-the telescope that we realize the extraordinary
-scale upon which the system of the Pleiades is
-constructed. With the Paris instrument Wolf in
-1876 catalogued 625 stars in the group; and the
-searching photographic survey of Henry in 1887
-revealed no less than 2,326 distinct stars within
-and near the filmy gauze of nebulous matter always
-so conspicuous a feature of the Pleiades.</p>
-
-<p>The means at our disposal for the study of
-stellar distances are but feeble. Only in the case
-of a very small number of stars have we been
-able to obtain even so much as an approximate<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_12" id="Page_12">[12]</a></span>
-estimate of distance. The most powerful observational
-machinery, though directed by the tried
-skill of experience, has not sufficed to sound the
-profounder depths of space. The Pleiad stars
-are among those for which no measurement of
-distance has yet been made, so that we do not
-know whether they are all equally far away from
-us. We see them projected on the dark background
-of the celestial vault; but we cannot tell
-from actual measurement whether they are all
-situated near the same point in space. It may be
-that some are immeasurably closer to us than are
-the great mass of their companions; possibly we
-look through the cluster at others far behind it,
-clinging, as it were, to the very fringe of the visible
-universe.</p>
-
-<p>Farther on we shall find evidence that something
-like this really is the case. But under no
-circumstances is it reasonable to suppose that the
-whole body of stars can be strung out at all sorts
-of distances near a straight line pointing in the
-direction of the visible cluster. Such a distribution
-may perhaps remain among the possibilities,
-so long as we cannot measure directly the actual<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_13" id="Page_13">[13]</a></span>
-distances of the individual stars. But science
-never accepts a mere possibility against which we
-can marshal strong circumstantial evidence. We
-may conclude on general principles that the
-gathering of these many objects into a single
-close assemblage denotes community of origin
-and interests.</p>
-
-<p>The Pleiades then really belong to one another.
-What is the nature of their mutual tie?
-What is their mystery, and can we solve it?
-The most obvious theory is, of course, suggested
-by what we know to be true within our own
-solar system. We owe to Newton the beautiful
-conception of gravitation, that unique law by
-means of which astronomers have been enabled
-to reduce to perfect order the seeming
-tangle of planetary evolutions. The law really
-amounts, in effect, to this: All objects suspended
-within the vacancy of space attract or pull one
-another. How they can do this without a visible
-connecting link between them is a mystery
-which may always remain unsolved. But mystery
-as it is, we must accept it as an ascertained
-fact. It is this pull of gravitation that holds to<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_14" id="Page_14">[14]</a></span>gether
-the sun and planets, forcing them all to
-follow out their due and proper paths, and so to
-continue throughout an unbroken cycle until the
-great survivor, Time, shall be no more.</p>
-
-<p>This same gravitational attraction must be at
-work among the Pleiades. They, too, like ourselves,
-must have bounds and orbits set and
-interwoven, revolutions and gyrations far more
-complex than the solar system knows. The
-visual discovery of such motion of rotation
-among the Pleiades may be called one of the
-pressing problems of astronomy to-day. We
-feel sure that the time is ripe, and that the discovery
-is actually being made at the present moment:
-for a generation of men is not too great a
-period to call a moment, when we have to deal
-with cosmic time.</p>
-
-<p>It is indeed the lack of observations extending
-through sufficient centuries that stays our hand
-from grasping the coveted result. The Pleiades
-are so far from us that we cannot be sure of
-changes among them. Magnitudes are always
-relative. It matters not how large the actual
-movements may be; if they are extremely small<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_15" id="Page_15">[15]</a></span>
-in comparison with our distance, they must
-shrink to nothingness in our eyes. Trembling
-on the verge of invisibility, elusive, they are in
-that borderland where science as yet but feels her
-way, though certain that the way is there.</p>
-
-<p>The foundations of exact modern knowledge
-of the group were laid by Bessel about 1840.
-With the modesty characteristic of the great, he
-says quite simply that he has made a number of
-measures of the Pleiades, thinking that the time
-may come when astronomers will be able to find
-some evidence of motion. In this unassuming
-way he prefaces what is still the classic model of
-precision and thoroughness in work of this kind.
-Bessel cleared the ground for a study of inter-stellar
-motion within the close star-clusters; and
-it is probable that only by such study may we
-hope to demonstrate the universality of the law
-of gravitation in cosmic space.</p>
-
-<p>Bessel's acuteness in forecasting the direction
-of coming research was amply verified by the
-work of Elkin in 1885 at Yale College. Provided
-with a more modern instrument, but similar
-to Bessel's, Elkin was able to repeat his<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_16" id="Page_16">[16]</a></span>
-observations with a slight increase of precision.
-Motions in the interval of forty-five years, sufficiently
-great to hint at coming possibilities, were
-shown conclusively to exist. Six stars at all
-events have been fairly excluded from the group
-on account of their peculiar motions shown by
-Elkin's research. It is possible that they are
-merely seen in the background through the interstices
-of the cluster itself, or they may be suspended
-between us and the Pleiades, in either
-case having no real connection with the group.
-Finally, these observations make it reasonably
-certain that many of the remaining mass of stars
-really constitute a unit aggregation in space.
-Astronomers of a coming generation will again
-repeat the Besselian work. At present we have
-been able to use his method only for the separation
-from the true Pleiades of chance stars that
-happen to lie in the same direction. Let us hope
-that man shall exist long enough upon this earth
-to see the clustered stars themselves begin and
-carry out such gyrations as gravitation imposes.</p>
-
-<p>These will doubtless be of a kind not even
-suggested by the lesser complexities of our solar<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_17" id="Page_17">[17]</a></span>
-system. For the most wonderful thing of all
-about the Pleiades seems to point to an intricacy
-of structure whose details may be destined to
-shake the confidence of the profoundest mathematician.
-There is an extraordinary nebulous
-condensation that seems to pervade the entire
-space occupied by the stellar constituents of the
-group. The stars are swimming in a veritable
-sea of luminous cloud. There are filmy tenuous
-places, and again condensing whirls of material
-doubtless still in the gaseous or plastic stage.
-Most noticeable of all are certain almost straight
-lines of nebula that connect series of stars. In
-one case, shown upon a photograph made by
-Henry at Paris, six stars are strung out upon
-such a hazy line. We might give play to fancy,
-and see in this the result of some vast eruption
-of gaseous matter that has already begun to
-solidify here and there into stellar nuclei. But
-sound science gives not too great freedom to
-mere speculative theories. Her duty has been
-found in quiet research, and her greatest rewards
-have flowed from imaginative speculation, only
-when tempered by pure reason.</p>
-
-
-<hr class="chap" />
-<p><span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_18" id="Page_18">[18]</a></span></p>
-
-<h2><a name="THE_POLE-STAR" id="THE_POLE-STAR"></a><a href="#CONTENTS">THE POLE-STAR</a></h2>
-
-
-<p>One of the most brilliant observations of the
-last few years is Campbell's recent discovery of
-the triple character of this star. Centuries and
-centuries ago, when astronomy, that venerable
-ancient among the sciences, was but an infant,
-the pole-star must have been considered the very
-oldest of observed heavenly bodies. In the beginning
-it was the only sure guide of the navigator
-at night, just as to this day it is the foundation-stone
-for all observational stellar astronomy
-of precision. There has never been a time in
-the history of astronomy when the pole-star
-might not have been called the most frequently
-measured object in the sky of night. So it is
-indeed strange that we should find out something
-altogether new about it after all these ages
-of study.</p>
-
-<p>But the importance of the discovery rests
-upon a surer foundation than this. The method<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_19" id="Page_19">[19]</a></span>
-by which it has been made is almost a new one
-in the science. A generation ago, men thought
-the "perfect science," for so we love to call
-astronomy, could advance only by increasing a
-little the exact precision of observation. The
-citadel of perfect truth might be more closely invested;
-the forces of science might push forward
-step by step; the machinery of research might
-be strengthened, but that a new engine of investigation
-would be discovered capable of penetrating
-where no telescope can ever reach, this, indeed,
-seemed far beyond the liveliest hope of
-science. Even the discoverer of the spectroscope
-could never have dreamed of its possibilities,
-could never have foreseen its successes, its
-triumphs.</p>
-
-<p>The very name of this instrument suggests
-mystery to the popular mind. It is set down at
-once among the things too difficult, too intricate,
-too abstruse to understand. Yet in its essentials
-there is nothing about the spectroscope that cannot
-be made clear in a few words. Even the
-modern "undulatory theory" of light itself is
-terrible only in the length of its name. Any<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_20" id="Page_20">[20]</a></span>one
-who has seen the waves of ocean roll, roll,
-and ever again roll in upon the shore, can form a
-very good notion of how light moves. 'Tis just
-such a series of rolling waves; started perhaps
-from some brilliant constellation far out upon the
-confining bounds of the visible universe, or perhaps
-coming from a humble light upon the student's
-table; yet it is never anything but a
-succession of rolling waves. Only, unlike the
-waves of the sea, light waves are all excessively
-small. We should call one whose length was a
-twenty-thousandth of an inch a big one!</p>
-
-<p>Now the human eye possesses the property of
-receiving and understanding these little waves.
-The process is an unconscious one. Let but a
-set of these tiny waves roll up, as it were, out of
-the vast ocean of space and impinge upon the eye,
-and all the phenomena of light and color become
-what we call "visible." We see the light.</p>
-
-<p>And how does all this find an application in
-astronomy? Not to enter too much into technical
-details, we may say that the spectroscope is an instrument
-which enables us to measure the length
-of these light waves, though their length is so<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_21" id="Page_21">[21]</a></span>
-exceedingly small. The day has indeed gone by
-when that which poets love to call the Book of
-Nature was printed in type that could be read
-by the eye unaided. Telescope, microscope, and
-spectroscope are essential now to him who would
-penetrate any of Nature's secrets. But measurements
-with a telescope, like eye observations, are
-limited strictly to determining the directions in
-which we see the heavenly bodies. Ever since
-the beginning of things, when old Hipparchus and
-Ulugh Beg made the first rude but successful attempts
-to catalogue the stars, the eye and telescope
-have been able to measure only such directions.
-We aim the telescope at a star, and record the
-direction in which it was pointed. Distances in
-astronomy can never be measured directly. All
-that we know of them has been obtained by calculations
-based upon the Newtonian law of gravitation
-and observations of directions.</p>
-
-<p>Now the spectroscope seems to offer a sort of
-exception to this rule. Suppose we can measure
-the wave-lengths of the light sent us from a star.
-Suppose again that the star is itself moving swiftly
-toward us through space, while continually set<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_22" id="Page_22">[22]</a></span>ting
-in motion the waves of light that are ultimately
-to reach the waiting astronomer. Evidently
-the light waves will be crowded together
-somewhat on account of the star's motion. More
-waves per second will reach us than would be received
-from a star at rest. It is as though the
-light waves were compressed or shortened a little.
-And if the star is leaving us, instead of coming
-nearer, opposite effects will occur. We have then
-but to compare spectroscopically starlight with
-some artificial source of light in the observatory in
-order to find out whether the star is approaching
-us or receding from us. And by a simple process
-of calculation this stellar motion can be obtained
-in miles per second. Thus we can now actually
-measure directly, in a certain sense, linear speed
-in stellar space, though we are still without the
-means of getting directly at stellar distances.</p>
-
-<p>But the most wonderful thing of all about these
-spectroscopic measures is the fact that it makes
-no difference whatever how far away is the star
-under observation. What we learn through the
-spectroscope comes from a study of the waves
-themselves, and it is of no consequence how far<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_23" id="Page_23">[23]</a></span>
-they have travelled, or how long they have been
-a-coming. For it must not be supposed that
-these waves consume no time in passing from a
-distant star to our own solar system. It is true
-that they move exceeding fast; certainly 180,000
-miles per second may be called rapid motion.
-But if this cosmic velocity of light is tremendous,
-so also are cosmic distances correspondingly vast.
-Light needs to move quickly coming from a star,
-for even at the rate of motion we have mentioned
-it requires many years to reach us from some of
-the more distant constellations. It has been well
-said that an observer on some far-away star, if
-endowed with the power to see at any distance,
-however great, might at this moment be looking
-on the Crusaders proceeding from Europe against
-the Saracen at Jerusalem. For it is quite possible
-that not until now has the light which would
-make the earth visible had time to reach him.
-Yet distant as such an observer might be, light
-from the star on which he stood could be measured
-in the spectroscope, and would infallibly tell
-us whether the earth and star are approaching in
-space or gradually drawing farther asunder.</p>
-
-<p><span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_24" id="Page_24">[24]</a></span></p>
-
-<p>The pole-star is not one of the more distant
-stellar systems. We do not know how far it is
-from us very exactly, but certainly not less than
-forty or fifty years are necessary for its light to
-reach us. The star might have gone out of existence
-twenty years ago, and we not yet know
-of it, for we would still be receiving the light
-which began its long journey to us about 1850 or
-1860. But no matter what may be its distance,
-Campbell found by careful observations, made in
-the latter part of 1896, that the pole-star was then
-approaching the earth at the rate of about twelve
-miles per second. So far there was nothing especially
-remarkable. But in August and September
-of the present year twenty-six careful determinations
-were made, and these showed that now the
-rate of approach varied between about five and
-nine miles per second. More astonishing still,
-there was a uniform period in the changes of
-velocity. In about four days the rate of motion
-changed from about five to nine miles and back
-again. And this variation kept on with great
-regularity. Every successive period of four days
-saw a complete cycle of velocity change forward<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_25" id="Page_25">[25]</a></span>
-and back between the same limits. There can be
-but one reasonable explanation. This star must
-be a double, or "binary" star. The two components,
-under the influence of powerful mutual
-gravitational attraction, must be revolving in a
-mighty orbit. Yet this vast orbit, as a whole, with
-the two great stars in it, must be approaching our
-part of the universe all the time. For the spectroscope
-shows the velocity of approach to increase
-and diminish, indeed, but it is always present.
-Here, then, is this great stellar system, having a
-four-day revolution of its own, and yet swinging
-rapidly through space in our direction. Nor is
-this all. One of the component stars must be
-nearly or quite dark; else its presence would infallibly
-be detected by our instruments.</p>
-
-<p>And now we come to the most astonishing
-thing of all. How comes it that the average
-rate of approach of the "four-day system," as a
-whole, changed between 1896 and 1899? In
-1896 only this velocity of the whole system was
-determined, the four-day period remaining undiscovered
-until the more numerous observations of
-<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_26" id="Page_26">[26]</a></span>1899. But even without considering the four-day
-period, the changing velocity of the entire
-system offers one of those problems that exact
-science can treat only by the help of the imagination.
-There must be some other great centre of
-attraction, some cosmic giant, holding the visible
-double pole-star under its control. Thus, that
-which we see, and call the pole-star, is in reality
-threading its path about the third and greatest
-member of the system, itself situated in space, we
-know not where.</p>
-
-<p><span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_27" id="Page_27">[27]</a></span></p>
-
-<div class="figcenter">
-<a name="P_26" id="P_26"></a>
-<br />
-<img src="images/i_026fp.jpg" width="600" alt="" />
-<div class="caption">
-Spiral Nebula in Constellation Leo.<br />
-
-<span class="fs80">Photographed by Keeler, February 24, 1900.<br />
-Exposure, three hours, fifty minutes.</span></div>
-</div>
-
-
-<hr class="chap" />
-<h2><a name="NEBULAE" id="NEBULAE"></a><a href="#CONTENTS">NEBULÆ</a></h2>
-
-
-<p>Scattered about here and there among the
-stars are certain patches of faint luminosity called
-by astronomers Nebulæ. These "little clouds"
-of filmy light are among the most fascinating of
-all the kaleidoscopic phenomena of the heavens;
-for it needs but a glance at one of them to give
-the impression that here before us is the stuff of
-which worlds are made. All our knowledge of
-Nature leads us to expect in her finished work
-the result of a series of gradual processes of development.
-Highly organized phenomena such
-as those existing in our solar system did not
-spring into perfection in an instant. Influential
-forces, easy to imagine, but difficult to define,
-must have directed the slow, sure transformation
-of elemental matter into sun and planets, things
-and men. Therefore a study of those forces
-and of their probable action upon nebular
-material has always exerted a strong attraction<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_28" id="Page_28">[28]</a></span>
-upon the acutest thinkers among men of exact
-science.</p>
-
-<p>Our knowledge of the nebulæ is of two kinds&mdash;that
-which has been ascertained from observation
-as to their appearance, size, distribution, and distance;
-and that which is based upon hypotheses
-and theoretical reasoning about the condensation
-of stellar systems out of nebular masses. It so
-happens that our observational material has received
-a very important addition quite recently
-through the application of photography to the
-delineation of nebulæ, and this we shall describe
-farther on.</p>
-
-<p>Two nebulæ only are visible to the unaided
-eye. The brighter of these is in the constellation
-Andromeda; it is of oval or elliptical shape, and
-has a distinct central condensation or nucleus.
-Upon a photograph by Roberts it appears to
-have several concentric rings surrounding the
-nebula proper, and gives the general impression
-of a flat round disk foreshortened into an oval
-shape on account of the observer's position not
-being square to the surface of the disk. Very
-recent photographs of this nebula, made with the
-<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_29" id="Page_29">[29]</a></span>three-foot reflecting telescope of the Lick Observatory,
-bring out the fact that it is really spiral
-in form, and that the outlying nebulous rings are
-only parts of the spires in a great cosmic whorl.</p>
-
-<div class="figcenter">
-<a name="P_28" id="P_28"></a>
-<br />
-<img src="images/i_028fp.jpg" width="500" alt="" />
-<div class="caption">
-Nebula in Andromeda.<br />
-
-<span class="fs80">Lower object in the photograph is a Comet.<br />
-Photographed by Barnard, November 21, 1892.</span></div>
-</div>
-
-<p>This Andromeda nebula is the one in which
-the temporary star of 1885 appeared. It blazed
-up quite suddenly near the apparent centre of the
-nebula, and continued in view for six months,
-fading finally beyond the reach of our most
-powerful telescopes. There can be little doubt
-that the star was actually in the nebula, and not
-merely seen through it, though in reality situated
-in the extreme outlying part of space at a distance
-immeasurably greater than that separating us from
-the nebula itself. Such an accidental superposition
-of nebula and star might even be due to
-sudden incandescence of a new star between us
-and the nebula. In such a case we should see
-the star projected upon the surface of the nebula,
-so that the superposition would be identical with
-that actually observed. Therefore, while it is,
-indeed, possible that the star may have been either
-far behind the nebula or in front of it, we must
-accept as more probable the supposition that<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_30" id="Page_30">[30]</a></span>
-there was a real connection between the two. In
-that case there is little doubt that we have actually
-observed one of those cataclysms that mark
-successive steps of cosmic evolution. We have
-no thoroughly satisfactory theory to account for
-such an explosive catastrophe within the body of
-the nebula itself.</p>
-
-<p>The other naked-eye nebula is in the constellation
-Orion. In the telescope it is a more striking
-object, perhaps, than the Andromeda nebula;
-for it has no well-defined geometrical form, but
-consists of an immense odd-shaped mass of light
-enclosing and surrounding a number of stars. It
-is unquestionably of a very complicated structure,
-and is, therefore, less easily studied and explained
-than the nebulæ of simpler form. There is no
-doubt that the Orion nebula is composed of luminous
-gas, and is not merely a cluster of small
-stars too numerous and too near together to be
-separated from each other, even in our most
-powerful telescopes. It was, indeed, supposed,
-until about forty years ago, that all the nebulæ
-are simply irresolvable star-clusters; but we now
-have indisputable evidence, derived from the<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_31" id="Page_31">[31]</a></span>
-spectroscope, that many nebulæ are composed of
-true gases, similar to those with which we experiment
-in chemical laboratories. This spectroscopic
-proof of the gaseous character of nebulæ is
-one of the most important discoveries contributed
-by that instrument to our small stock of
-facts concerning the structure of the sidereal universe.</p>
-
-<p>Coming now to the smaller nebulæ, we find a
-great diversity of form and appearance. Some
-are ring-shaped, perhaps having a less brilliant
-nebulosity within the ring. Many show a central
-condensation of disk-like appearance (planetary
-nebulæ), or have simply a star at the centre
-(nebulous stars). Altogether about ten thousand
-such objects have been catalogued by successive
-generations of astronomers since the invention of
-the telescope, and most of these have been reported
-as oval in form. Now we have already
-referred to the important addition to our knowledge
-of the nebulæ obtained by recent photographic
-observations; and this addition consists in
-the discovery that most of these oval nebulæ are
-in reality spirals. Indeed, it appears that the spiral<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_32" id="Page_32">[32]</a></span>
-type is the normal type, and that nebulæ of irregular
-or other forms are exceptions to the general
-rule. Even the great Andromeda nebula, as
-we have seen, is now recognized as a spiral.</p>
-
-<p>The instrument with which its convolute
-structure was discovered is a three-foot reflecting
-telescope, made by Common of England, and now
-mounted at the Lick Observatory, in California.
-The late Professor Keeler devoted much of his
-time to photographing nebulæ during the last year
-or two. He was able to establish the important
-fact just mentioned, that most nebulæ formerly
-thought to be mere ovals, turn out to be spiral
-when brought under the more searching scrutiny
-of the photographic plate applied at the focus of
-a telescope of great size, and with an exposure to
-the feeble nebular light extending through three
-or four consecutive hours.</p>
-
-<p>Many of the spirals have more than a single
-volute. It is as though one were to attach a
-number of very flexible rods to an axle, like
-spokes of a wheel without a rim and then revolve
-the axle rapidly. The flexible rods would bend
-under the rapid rotation, and form a series of<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_33" id="Page_33">[33]</a></span>
-spiral curves not unlike many of these nebulæ.
-Indeed, it is impossible to escape the conviction
-that these great celestial whorls are whirling
-around an axis. And it is most important in
-the study of the growth of worlds, to recognize
-that the type specimen is a revolving spiral.
-Therefore, the rotating flattened globe of incandescent
-matter postulated by Laplace's nebular
-hypothesis would make of our solar system an
-exceptional world, and not a type of stellar evolution
-in general.</p>
-
-<p>Keeler's photographs have taught us one thing
-more. Scarcely is there a single one of his negatives
-that does not show nebulæ previously uncatalogued.
-It is estimated that if this process of
-photography could be extended so as to cover the
-entire sky, the whole number of nebulæ would
-add up to the stupendous total of 120,000; and
-of these the great majority would be spiral.</p>
-
-<p>When we approach the question of the distribution
-of nebulæ in different parts of the sky, as
-shown by their catalogued positions, we are met
-by a curious fact. It appears that the region in
-the neighborhood of the Milky Way is espe<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_34" id="Page_34">[34]</a></span>cially
-poor in nebulæ, whereas these objects seem
-to cluster in much larger numbers about those
-points in the sky that are farthest from the
-Milky Way. But we know that the Milky
-Way is richer in stars than any other part of the
-sky, since it is, in fact, made up of stellar bodies
-clustered so closely that it is wellnigh impossible
-to see between them in the denser portions.
-Now, it cannot be the result of chance that the
-stars should tend to congregate in the Milky
-Way, while the nebulæ tend to seek a position as
-far from it as possible. Whatever may be the
-cause, we must conclude that the sidereal system,
-as we see it, is in general constructed upon a single
-plan, and does not consist of a series of universes
-scattered at random throughout space. If
-we are to suppose that nebulæ turn into stars as
-a result of condensation or any other change,
-then it is not astonishing to find a minimum of
-nebulæ where there is a maximum of stars, since
-the nebulæ will have been consumed, as it were,
-in the formation of the stars.</p>
-
-<div class="figcenter">
-<a name="P_34" id="P_34"></a>
-<br />
-<img src="images/i_034fp.jpg" width="500" alt="" />
-<div class="caption">
-The "Dumb-Bell" Nebula.<br />
-
-<span class="fs80">Photographed by Keeler, July 31, 1899.<br />
-Exposure, three hours.</span></div>
-</div>
-
-<p>It is never advisable to push philosophical
-speculation very far when supported by too slender
-<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_35" id="Page_35">[35]</a></span>a basis of fact. But if we are to regard the
-visible universe as made up on the whole of a
-single system of bodies, we may well ask one or
-two questions to be answered by speculative theory.
-We have said the stars are not uniformly
-distributed in space. Their concentration in the
-Milky Way, forming a narrow band dividing the
-sky into two very nearly equal parts, must be
-due to their being actually massed in a thin disk
-or ring of space within which our solar system is
-also situated. This thin disk projected upon the
-sky would then appear as the narrow star-band
-of the Milky Way. Now, suppose this disk has
-an axis perpendicular to itself, and let us imagine
-a rotation of the whole sidereal system about
-that axis. Then the fact that the visible nebulæ
-are congregated far from the Milky Way
-means that they are actually near the imaginary
-axis.</p>
-
-<p>Possibly the diminished velocity of motion
-near the axis may have something to do with
-the presence of the nebulæ there. Possibly the
-nebulæ themselves have axes perpendicular to
-the plane of the Milky Way. If so, we should<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_36" id="Page_36">[36]</a></span>
-see the spiral nebulæ near the Milky Way edgewise,
-and those far from it without foreshortening.
-Thus, the paucity of nebulæ near the
-Milky Way may be due in part to the increased
-difficulty of seeing them when looked at edgewise.
-Indeed, there is no limit to the possibilities
-of hypothetical reasoning about the nebular
-structure of our universe; unfortunately, the
-whole question must be placed for the present
-among those intensely interesting cosmic problems
-awaiting elucidation, let us hope, in this
-new century.</p>
-
-
-<hr class="chap" />
-<p><span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_37" id="Page_37">[37]</a></span></p>
-
-<h2><a name="TEMPORARY_STARS" id="TEMPORARY_STARS"></a><a href="#CONTENTS">TEMPORARY STARS</a></h2>
-
-
-<p>Nothing can be more erroneous than to suppose
-that the stellar multitude has continued unchanged
-throughout all generations of men.
-"Eternal fires" poets have called the stars; yet
-they burn like any little conflagration on the
-earth; now flashing with energy, brilliant, incandescent,
-and again sinking into the dull glow of
-smouldering half-burned ashes. It is even probable
-that space contains many darkened orbs, stars
-that may have risen in constellations to adorn
-the skies of prehistoric time&mdash;now cold, unseen,
-unknown. So far from dealing with an unvarying
-universe, it is safe to say that sidereal
-astronomy can advance only by the discovery of
-change. Observational science watches with untiring
-industry, and night hides few celestial events
-from the ardent scrutiny of astronomers. Old
-theories are tested and newer ones often perfected
-by the detection of some slight and previously<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_38" id="Page_38">[38]</a></span>
-unsuspected alteration upon the face of the sky.
-The interpretation of such changes is the most
-difficult task of science; it has taxed the acutest
-intellects among men throughout all time.</p>
-
-<p>If, then, changes can be seen among the stars,
-what are we to think of the most important change
-of all, the blazing into life of a new stellar system?
-Fifteen times since men began to write their
-records of the skies has the birth of a star been
-seen. Surely we may use this term when we
-speak of the sudden appearance of a brilliant luminary
-where nothing visible existed before. But
-we shall see further on that scientific considerations
-make it highly probable that the phenomenon
-in question does not really involve the creation
-of new matter. It is old material becoming
-suddenly luminous for some hidden reason. In
-fact, whenever a new object of great brilliancy has
-been discovered, it has been found to lose its light
-again quite soon, ending either in total extinction
-or at least in comparative darkness. It is for this
-reason that the name "temporary star" has been
-applied to cases of this kind.</p>
-
-<p>The first authenticated instance dates from the<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_39" id="Page_39">[39]</a></span>
-year 134 <span class="smcap">B.C.</span>, when a new star appeared in the
-constellation Scorpio. It was this star that led
-Hipparchus to construct his stellar catalogue, the
-first ever made. It occurred to him, of course,
-that there could be but one way to make sure in
-the future that any given object discovered in the
-sky was new; it was necessary to make a complete
-list of everything visible in his day. Later
-astronomers need then only compare Hipparchus's
-catalogue with the heavens from time to
-time in order to find out whether anything unknown
-had appeared. This work of Hipparchus
-became the foundation of sidereal study, and led
-to most important discoveries of various kinds.</p>
-
-<p>But no records remain concerning his new star
-except the bare fact of its appearance in Scorpio.
-Hipparchus's published works are all lost. We
-do not even know the exact place of his birth,
-and as for those two dates of entry and exit that
-history attaches to great names&mdash;we have them
-not. Yet he was easily the first astronomer of
-antiquity, one of the first of all time; and we
-know of him only from the writings of Ptolemy,
-who lived three hundred years after him.</p>
-
-<p><span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_40" id="Page_40">[40]</a></span></p>
-
-<p>More than five centuries elapsed before another
-temporary star was entered in the records of
-astronomy. This happened in the year 389 <span class="fs70">A.D.</span>,
-when a star appeared in Aquila; and of this one
-also we know nothing further. But about twelve
-centuries later, in November, 1572, a new and
-brilliant object was found in the constellation
-Cassiopeia. It is known as Tycho's star, since it
-was the means of winning for astronomy a man
-who will always take high rank in her annals,
-Tycho Brahe, of Denmark. When he first saw
-this star, it was already very bright, equalling even
-Venus at her best; and he continued a careful
-series of observations for sixteen months, when it
-faded finally from his view. The position of the
-new star was measured with reference to other stars
-in the constellation Cassiopeia, and the results of
-Tycho's observations were finally published by
-him in the year 1573. It appears that much urging
-on the part of friends was necessary to induce
-him to consent to this publication, not because of
-a modest reluctance to rush into print, but for the
-reason that he considered it undignified for a nobleman
-of Denmark to be the author of a book!</p>
-
-<p><span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_41" id="Page_41">[41]</a></span></p>
-
-<p>An important question in cosmic astronomy is
-opened by Tycho's star. Did it really disappear
-from the heavens when he saw it no more, or had
-its lustre simply been reduced below the visual
-power of the unaided eye? Unfortunately,
-Tycho's observations of the star's position in the
-constellation were necessarily crude. He possessed
-no instruments of precision such as we now
-have at our disposal, and so his work gives us
-only a rather rough approximation of the true
-place of the star. A small circle might be imagined
-on the sky of a size comparable with the
-possible errors of Tycho's observations. We
-could then say with certainty that his star must
-have been situated somewhere within that little
-circle, but it is impossible to know exactly where.</p>
-
-<p>It happens that our modern telescopes reveal
-the existence of several faint stars within the
-space covered by such a circle. Any one of these
-would have been too small for Tycho to see, and,
-therefore, any one of them may be his once brilliant
-luminary reduced to a state of permanent or temporary
-semi-darkness. These considerations are,
-indeed, of great importance in explaining the<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_42" id="Page_42">[42]</a></span>
-phenomena of temporary stars. If Tycho had
-been able to leave us a more exact determination
-of his star's place in the sky, and even if our most
-powerful instruments could not show anything in
-that place to-day, we might nevertheless theorize
-on the supposition that the object still exists, but
-has reached a condition almost entirely dark.</p>
-
-<p>Indeed, the latest theory classes temporary stars
-among those known as variable. For many stars
-are known to undergo quite decided changes in
-brilliancy; possibly inconstancy of light is the rule
-rather than the exception. But while such changes,
-when they exist, are too small to be perceptible
-in most cases, there is certainly a large number of
-observable variables, subject to easily measurable
-alterations of light. Astronomers prefer to see in
-the phenomena of temporary stars simple cases of
-variation in which the increase of light is sudden,
-and followed by a gradual diminution. Possibly
-there is then a long period of comparative or even
-complete darkness, to be followed as before by a
-sudden blazing up and extinction. No temporary
-star, however, has been observed to reappear in the
-same celestial place where once had glowed its<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_43" id="Page_43">[43]</a></span>
-sudden outburst. But cases are not wanting
-where incandescence has been both preceded and
-followed by a continued existence, visible though
-not brilliant.</p>
-
-<p>For such cases as these it is necessary to come
-down to modern records. We cannot be sure
-that some faint star has been temporarily brilliant,
-unless we actually see the conflagration itself, or
-are able to make the identity of the object's precise
-location in the sky before and after the event
-perfectly certain by the aid of modern instruments
-of precision. But no one has ever seen
-the smouldering fires break out. Temporary
-stars have always been first noticed only after
-having been active for hours if not for days. So
-we must perforce fall back on instrumental identification
-by determinations of the star's exact
-position upon the celestial vault.</p>
-
-<p>Some time between May 10th and 12th in the
-year 1866 the ninth star in the list of known
-"temporaries" appeared. It possessed very
-great light-giving power, being surpassed in brilliancy
-by only about a score of stars in all the
-heavens. It retained a maximum luminosity only<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_44" id="Page_44">[44]</a></span>
-three or four days, and in less than two months
-had diminished to a point somewhere between the
-ninth and tenth "magnitudes." In other words,
-from a conspicuous star, visible to the naked eye,
-it had passed beyond the power of anything less
-than a good telescope. Fortunately, we had excellent
-star-catalogues before 1866. These were
-at once searched, and it was possible to settle
-quite definitely that a star of about the ninth or
-tenth magnitude had really existed before 1866
-at precisely the same point occupied by the new
-one. Needless to say, observations were made of
-the new star itself, and afterward compared with
-later observations of the faint one that still occupies
-its place. These render quite certain the
-identity of the temporary bright star with the
-faint ones that preceded and followed it.</p>
-
-<p>Such results, on the one hand, offer an excellent
-vindication of the painstaking labor expended
-on the construction of star-catalogues, and, on the
-other, serve to elucidate the mystery of temporary
-stars. Nothing can be more plausible than
-to explain by analogy those cases in which no
-previous or subsequent existence has been ob<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_45" id="Page_45">[45]</a></span>served.
-It is merely necessary to suppose that,
-instead of varying from the ninth or tenth magnitude,
-other temporary objects have begun and
-ended with the twentieth; for the twentieth magnitude
-would be beyond the power of our best
-instruments.</p>
-
-<p>Nor is the star of 1866 an isolated instance.
-Ten years later, in 1876, a temporary star blazed
-up to about the second magnitude, and returned
-to invisibility, so far as the naked eye is concerned,
-within a month, having retained its greatest brilliancy
-only one or two days. This star is still
-visible as a tiny point of light, estimated to be of
-the fifteenth magnitude. Whether it existed
-prior to its sudden outburst can never be known,
-because we do not possess catalogues including
-the generality of stars as faint as this one must
-have been. But at all events, the continued existence
-of the object helps to place the temporary
-stars in the class of variables.</p>
-
-<p>The next star, already mentioned under "nebula,"
-was first seen in 1885. It was in one respect
-the most remarkable of all, for it appeared
-almost in the centre of the great nebula in the<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_46" id="Page_46">[46]</a></span>
-constellation Andromeda. It was never very
-bright, reaching only the sixth magnitude or
-thereabouts, was observed during a period of only
-six months, and at the end of that time had faded
-beyond the reach of our most powerful glasses.
-It is a most impressive fact that this event occurred
-within the nebula. Whatever may be the
-nature of the explosive catastrophe to which the
-temporary stars owe their origin, we can now say
-with certainty that not even those vast elemental
-luminous clouds men call nebulæ are free from
-danger.</p>
-
-<p>The last outburst on our records was first noticed
-February 22, 1901. The star appeared in
-the constellation Perseus, and soon reached the
-first magnitude, surpassing almost every other
-star in the sky. It has been especially remarkable
-in that it has become surrounded by a nebulous
-mass in which are several bright condensations
-or nuclei; and these seem to be in very
-rapid motion. The star is still under observation
-(January, 1902).</p>
-
-
-<hr class="chap" />
-<p><span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_47" id="Page_47">[47]</a></span></p>
-
-<h2><a name="GALILEO" id="GALILEO"></a><a href="#CONTENTS">GALILEO</a></h2>
-
-
-<p>Among the figures that stand out sharply
-upon the dim background of old-time science,
-there is none that excites a keener interest than
-Galileo. Most people know him only as a distinguished
-man of learning; one who carried on
-a vigorous controversy with the Church on matters
-scientific. It requires some little study,
-some careful reading between the lines of astronomical
-history, to gain acquaintance with the
-man himself. He had a brilliant, incisive wit;
-was a genuine humorist; knew well and loved
-the amusing side of things; and could not often
-forego a sarcastic pleasantry, or deny himself the
-pleasure of argument. Yet it is more than
-doubtful if he ever intended impertinence, or
-gave willingly any cause of quarrel to the
-Church.</p>
-
-<p>His acute understanding must have seen that
-there exists no real conflict between science and<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_48" id="Page_48">[48]</a></span>
-religion; for time, in passing, has made common
-knowledge of this truth, as it has of many things
-once hidden. When we consider events that occurred
-three centuries ago, it is easy to replace
-excited argument with cool judgment; to remember
-that those were days of violence and
-cruelty; that public ignorance was of a density
-difficult to imagine to-day; and that it was universally
-considered the duty of the Church to
-assume an authoritative attitude upon many
-questions with which she is not now required to
-concern herself in the least. Charlatans, unbalanced
-theorists, purveyors of scientific marvels,
-were all liable to be passed upon definitely by
-the Church, not in a spirit of impertinent interference,
-but simply as part of her regular duties.</p>
-
-<p>If the Church's judgment in such matters was
-sometimes erroneous; if her interference now
-and again was cruel, the cause must be sought in
-the manners and customs of the time, when persecution
-rioted in company with ignorance, and
-violence was the law. Perhaps even to-day it
-would not be amiss to have a modern scientific
-board pass authoritatively upon novel discov<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_49" id="Page_49">[49]</a></span>eries
-and inventions, so as to protect the public
-against impostors as the Church tried to do of
-old.</p>
-
-<p>Galileo was born at Pisa in 1564, and his long
-life lasted until 1642, the very year of Newton's
-birth. His most important scientific discoveries
-may be summed up in a few words; he was the
-first to use a telescope for examining the heavenly
-bodies; he discovered mountains on the
-moon; the satellites of Jupiter; the peculiar
-appearance of Saturn which Huygens afterward
-explained as a ring surrounding the ball of the
-planet; and, finally, he found black spots on the
-sun's disk. These discoveries, together with his
-remarkable researches in mechanical science, constitute
-Galileo's claim to immortality as an investigator.
-But, as we have said, it is not our
-intention to consider his work as a series of scientific
-discoveries. We shall take a more interesting
-point of view, and deal with him rather as
-a human being who had contracted the habit of
-making scientific researches.</p>
-
-<p>What must have been his feelings when he
-first found with his "new" telescope the satel<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_50" id="Page_50">[50]</a></span>lites
-of Jupiter? They were seen on the night
-of January 7, 1610. He had already viewed the
-planet through his earlier and less powerful
-glass, and was aware that it possessed a round
-disk like the moon, only smaller. Now he saw
-also three objects that he took to be little stars
-near the planet. But on the following night, as
-he says, "drawn by what fate I know not," the
-tube was again turned upon the planet. The
-three small stars had changed their positions, and
-were now all situated to the west of Jupiter,
-whereas on the previous night two had been on
-the eastern side. He could not explain this
-phenomenon, but he recognized that there was
-something peculiar at work. Long afterward, in
-one of his later works, translated into quaint old
-English by Salusbury, he declared that "one sole
-experiment sufficeth to batter to the ground a
-thousand probable Arguments." This was already
-the guiding principle of his scientific activity,
-a principle of incomparable importance, and
-generally credited to Bacon. Needless to say,
-Jupiter was now examined every night.</p>
-
-<p>The 9th was cloudy, but on the 10th he again<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_51" id="Page_51">[51]</a></span>
-saw his little stars, their number now reduced to
-two. He guessed that the third was behind the
-planet's disk. The position of the two visible
-ones was altogether different from either of the
-previous observations. On the 11th he became
-sure that what he saw was really a series of satellites
-accompanying Jupiter on his journey
-through space, and at the same time revolving
-around him. On the 12th, at 3 <span class="fs70">A.M.</span>, he actually
-saw one of the small objects emerge from
-behind the planet; and on the 13th he finally
-saw four satellites. Two hundred and eighty-two
-years were destined to pass away before any
-human eye should see a fifth. It was Barnard in
-1892 who followed Galileo.</p>
-
-<p>To understand the effect of this discovery
-upon Galileo requires a person who has himself
-watched the stars, not, as a dilettante, seeking
-recreation or amusement, but with that deep reverence
-that comes only to him who feels&mdash;nay,
-knows&mdash;that in the moment of observation just
-passed he too has added his mite to the great
-fund of human knowledge. Galileo's mummied
-forefinger still points toward the stars from its<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_52" id="Page_52">[52]</a></span>
-little pedestal of wood in the <i lang="it" xml:lang="it">Museo</i> at Florence,
-a sign to all men that he is unforgotten. But
-Galileo knew on that 11th of January, 1610, that
-the memory of him would never fade; that the
-very music of the spheres would thenceforward
-be attuned to a truer note, if any would but
-hearken to the Jovian harmony. For he recognized
-at once that the visible revolution of these
-moons around Jupiter, while that planet was
-himself visibly travelling through space, must
-deal its death-blow to the old Ptolemaic system
-of the universe. Here was a great planet, the
-centre of a system of satellites, and yet not
-the centre of the universe. Surely, then, the
-earth, too, might be a mere planet like Jupiter,
-and not the supposed motionless centre of all
-things.</p>
-
-<p>The satellite discovery was published in 1610
-in a little book called "Sidereus Nuncius," usually
-translated "The Sidereal Messenger." It seems
-to us, however, that the word "messenger" is
-not strong enough; surely in Papal Italy a <i lang="la" xml:lang="la">nuncius</i>
-was more than a mere messenger. He was
-clothed with the very highest authority, and we<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_53" id="Page_53">[53]</a></span>
-think it probable that Galileo's choice of this
-word in the title of his book means that he
-claimed for himself similar authority in science.
-At all events, the book made him at once a great
-reputation and numerous enemies.</p>
-
-<p>But it was not until 1616 that the Holy Office
-(Inquisition) issued an edict ordering Galileo to
-abandon his opinion that the earth moved, and at
-the same time placed Copernicus's <cite lang="la" xml:lang="la">De Revolutionibus</cite>
-and two other books advocating that doctrine
-on the "Index Librorum Prohibitorum,"
-or list of books forbidden by the Church. These
-volumes remained in subsequent editions of the
-"Index" down to 1821, but they no longer
-appear in the edition in force to-day.</p>
-
-<p>Galileo's most characteristic work is entitled
-the "Dialogue on the Two Chief Systems of the
-World." It was not published until 1632,
-although the idea of the book was conceived
-many years earlier. In it he gave full play to his
-extraordinary powers as a true humorist, a <i lang="fr" xml:lang="fr">fine
-lame</i> among controversialists, and a genuine
-man of science, valuing naked truth above all
-other things. As may be imagined, it was no<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_54" id="Page_54">[54]</a></span>
-small matter to obtain the authorities' consent to
-this publication. Galileo was already known to
-hold heretical opinions, and it was suspected that
-he had not laid them aside when commanded to
-do so by the edict of 1616. But perhaps Galileo's
-introduction to the "Dialogue" secured the
-censor's <i lang="la" xml:lang="la">imprimatur</i>; it is even suspected that
-the Roman authorities helped in the preparation
-of this introduction. Fortunately, we have a delightful
-contemporary translation into English,
-by Thomas Salusbury, printed at London by
-Leybourne in 1661. We have already quoted
-from this translation, and now add from the same
-work part of Galileo's masterly preface to the
-"Dialogue":</p>
-
-<p>"Judicious reader, there was published some
-years since in <em>Rome</em> a salutiferous Edict, that, for
-the obviating of the dangerous Scandals of the
-Present Age, imposed a reasonable Silence upon
-the Pythagorean (Copernican) opinion of the
-Mobility of the Earth. There want not such
-as unadvisedly affirm, that the Decree was not
-the production of a sober Scrutiny, but of an
-ill-formed passion; and one may hear some<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_55" id="Page_55">[55]</a></span>
-mutter that Consultors altogether ignorant of
-Astronomical observations ought not to clipp
-the wings of speculative wits with rash prohibitions."</p>
-
-<p>Galileo first states his own views, and then
-pretends that he will oppose them. He goes on
-to say that he believes in the earth's immobility,
-and takes "the contrary only for a mathematical
-<i lang="it" xml:lang="it">Capriccio</i>," as he calls it; something to be considered,
-because possessing an academical interest,
-but on no account having a real existence. Of
-course any one (even a censor) ought to be able
-to see that it is the Capriccio, and not its opposite,
-that Galileo really advocates. Three persons
-appear in the "Dialogue": Salviati, who believes
-in the Copernican system; Simplicio, of
-suggestive name, who thinks the earth cannot
-move; and, finally, Sagredus, a neutral gentleman
-of humorous propensities, who usually begins
-by opposing Salviati, but ends by being convinced.
-He then helps to punish poor Simplicio,
-who is one of those persons apparently incapable
-of comprehending a reasonable argument. Here
-is an interesting specimen of the "Dialogue"<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_56" id="Page_56">[56]</a></span>
-taken from Salusbury's translation: Salviati refers
-to the argument, then well known, that the earth
-cannot rotate on its axis, "because of the impossibility
-of its moving long without wearinesse."
-Sagredus replies: "There are some kinds of
-animals which refresh themselves after wearinesse
-by rowling on the earth; and that therefore there
-is no need to fear that the Terrestrial Globe
-should tire, nay, it may be reasonably affirmed
-that it enjoyeth a perpetual and most tranquil repose,
-keeping itself in an eternal rowling." Salviati's
-comment on this sally is, "You are too
-tart and satyrical, Sagredus."</p>
-
-<p>There is no doubt that the "Dialogue" finished
-the Ptolemaic theory, and made that of
-Copernicus the only possible one. At all events,
-it brought about the well-known attack upon
-Galileo from the authorities of the Holy Office.
-We shall not recount the often-told tale of his
-recantation. He was convicted (very rightly) of
-being a Copernican, and was forced to abjure that
-doctrine. Galileo's life may be summed up as
-one of those through which the world has been
-made richer. A clean-cutting analytic wit, never<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_57" id="Page_57">[57]</a></span>
-becoming dull: heated again and again in the
-fierce blaze of controversy, it was allowed to cool
-only that it might acquire a finer temper, to
-pierce with fatal certainty the smallest imperfections
-in the armor of his adversaries.</p>
-
-
-<hr class="chap" />
-<p><span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_58" id="Page_58">[58]</a></span></p>
-
-<h2><a name="THE_PLANET_OF_1898" id="THE_PLANET_OF_1898"></a><a href="#CONTENTS">THE PLANET OF 1898</a></h2>
-
-
-<p>The discovery of a new and important planet
-usually receives more immediate popular attention
-and applause than any other astronomical
-event. Philosophers are fond of referring to our
-solar system as a mere atom among the countless
-universes that seem to be suspended within the
-profound depths of space. They are wont to
-point out that this solar system, small and insignificant
-as a whole in comparison with many
-of the stellar worlds, is, nevertheless, made up of
-a large number of constituent planets; and these
-in turn are often accompanied with still smaller
-satellites, or moons. Thus does Nature provide
-worlds within worlds, and it is not surprising
-that public attention should be at once attracted
-by any new member of our sun's own special
-family of planets. The ancients were acquainted
-with only five of the bodies now counted as
-planets, viz.: Mercury, Venus, Mars, Jupiter,<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_59" id="Page_59">[59]</a></span>
-and Saturn. The dates of their discovery are
-lost in antiquity. To these Uranus was added
-in 1781 by a brilliant effort of the elder Herschel.
-We are told that intense popular excitement
-followed the announcement of Herschel's first
-observation: he was knighted and otherwise
-honored by the English King, and was enabled
-to lay a secure foundation for the future distinguished
-astronomical reputation of his family.</p>
-
-<p>Herschel's discovery quickened the restless
-activity of astronomers. Persistent efforts were
-made to sift the heavens more and more closely,
-with the strengthened hope of adding still further
-to our planetary knowledge. An association
-of twenty-four enthusiastic German astronomers
-was formed for the express purpose of hunting
-planets. But it fell to the lot of an Italian,
-Piazzi, of Palermo, to find the first of that
-series of small bodies now known as the asteroids
-or minor planets. He made the discovery at the
-very beginning of our century, January 1, 1801.</p>
-
-<p>But news travelled slowly in those days, and it
-was not until nearly April that the German observers
-heard from Piazzi. In the meantime, he had<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_60" id="Page_60">[60]</a></span>
-himself been prevented by illness from continuing
-his observations. Unfortunately, the planet
-had by this time moved so near the sun, on account
-of its own motions and those of the earth,
-that it could no longer be observed. The bright
-light of the sun made observations of the new
-body impossible; and it was feared that, owing
-to lack of knowledge of the planet's orbit, astronomers
-would be unable to trace it. So there
-seemed, indeed, to be danger of an almost irreparable
-loss to science. But in scientific, as in
-other human emergencies, someone always appears
-at the proper moment. A very young
-mathematician at Göttingen, named Gauss, attacked
-the problem, and was able to devise a
-method of predicting the future course of the
-planet on the sky, using only the few observations
-made by Piazzi himself. Up to that time
-no one had attempted to compute a planetary
-orbit, unless he had at his disposal a series of
-observations extending throughout the whole
-period of the planet's revolution around the sun.
-But the Piazzi planet offered a new problem in
-astronomy. It had become imperatively neces<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_61" id="Page_61">[61]</a></span>sary
-to obtain an orbit from a few observations
-made at nearly the same date. Gauss's work was
-signally triumphant, for the planet was actually
-found in the position predicted by him, as soon
-as a change in the relative places of the planet
-and earth permitted suitable observations to be
-made.</p>
-
-<p>But after all, Piazzi's planet belongs to a class
-of quite small bodies, and is by no means as interesting
-as Herschel's discovery, Uranus. Yet
-even this must be relegated to second rank
-among planetary discoveries. On September 23,
-1846, the telescope of the Berlin Observatory
-was directed to a certain point on the sky for a
-very special reason. Galle, the astronomer of
-Berlin, had received a letter from Leverrier, of
-Paris, telling him that if he would look in a certain
-direction he would detect a new and large planet.</p>
-
-<p>Leverrier's information was based upon a mathematical
-calculation. Seated in his study, with
-no instruments but pen and paper, he had slowly
-figured out the history of a world as yet unseen.
-Tiny discrepancies existed in the observed
-motions of Herschel's planet Uranus. No man<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_62" id="Page_62">[62]</a></span>
-had explained their cause. To Leverrier's acute
-understanding they slowly shaped themselves
-into the possible effects of attraction emanating
-from some unknown planet exterior to Uranus.
-Was it conceivable that these slight tremulous
-imperfections in the motion of a planet could be
-explained in this way? Leverrier was able to
-say confidently, "Yes." But we may rest assured
-that Galle had but small hopes that upon
-his eye first, of all the myriad eyes of men, would
-fall a ray of the new planet's light. Careful
-and methodical, he would neglect no chance of
-advancing his beloved science. He would look.</p>
-
-<p>Only one who has himself often seen the morning's
-sunrise put an end to a night's observation
-of the stars can hope to appreciate what Galle's
-feelings must have been when he saw the planet.
-To his trained eye it was certainly recognizable
-at once. And then the good news was sent on
-to Paris. We can imagine Leverrier, the cool
-calculator, saying to himself: "Of course he
-found it. It was a mathematical certainty."
-Nevertheless, his satisfaction must have been
-of the keenest. No triumphs give a pleasure<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_63" id="Page_63">[63]</a></span>
-higher than those of the intellect. Let no one
-imagine that men who make researches in the
-domain of pure science are under-paid. They
-find their reward in pleasure that is beyond any
-price.</p>
-
-<p>The Leverrier planet was found to be the last
-of the so-called major planets, so far as we can
-say in the present state of science. It received
-the name Neptune. Observers have found no
-other member of the solar system comparable in
-size with such bodies as Uranus and Neptune.
-More than one eager mathematician has tried to
-repeat Leverrier's achievement, but the supposed
-planet was not found. It has been said that figures
-never lie; yet such is the case only when
-the computations are correctly made. People
-are prone to give to the work of careless or incompetent
-mathematicians the same degree of
-credence that is really due only to masters of the
-craft. It requires the test of time to affix to any
-man's work the stamp of true genius.</p>
-
-<p>While, then, we have found no more large
-planets, quite a group of companions to Piazzi's
-little one have been discovered. They are all<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_64" id="Page_64">[64]</a></span>
-small, probably never exceeding about 400 miles
-in diameter. All travel around the sun in orbits
-that lie wholly within that of Jupiter and are exterior
-to that of Mars. The introduction of astronomical
-photography has given a tremendous
-impetus to the discovery of these minor planets,
-as they are called. It is quite interesting to examine
-the photographic process by which such
-discoveries are made possible and even easy.
-The matter will not be difficult to understand if
-we remember that all the planets are continually
-changing their places among the other stars. For
-the planets travel around the sun at a comparatively
-small distance. The great majority of the
-stars, on the contrary, are separated from the sun
-by an almost immeasurable space. As a result,
-they do not seem to move at all among themselves,
-and so we call them fixed stars: they may,
-indeed, be in motion, but their great distance prevents
-our detecting it in a short period of time.</p>
-
-<p>Now, stellar photographs are made in much
-the same way as ordinary portraits. Only, instead
-of using a simple camera, the astronomer
-exposes his photographic plate at the eye-end of<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_65" id="Page_65">[65]</a></span>
-a telescope. The sensitive surface of the plate is
-substituted for the human eye. We then find
-on the picture a little dot corresponding to every
-star within the photographed region of the sky.
-But, as everyone knows, the turning of the
-earth on its axis makes the whole heavens, including
-the sun, moon, and stars, rise and set
-every day. So the stars, when we photograph
-them, are sure to be either climbing up in the
-eastern sky or else slowly creeping down in the
-western. And that makes astronomical photography
-very different from ordinary portrait work.</p>
-
-<p>The stars correspond to the sitter, but they
-don't sit still. For this reason it is necessary to
-connect the telescope with a mechanical contrivance
-which makes it turn round like the hour-hand
-of an ordinary clock. The arrangement is
-so adjusted that the telescope, once aimed at the
-proper object in the sky, will move so as to remain
-pointed exactly the same during the whole
-time of the photographic exposure. Thus, while
-the light of any star is acting on the plate, such
-action will be continuous at a single point.
-Consequently, the finished picture will show the<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_66" id="Page_66">[66]</a></span>
-star as a little dot; while without this arrangement,
-the star would trail out into a line instead
-of a dot. Now we have seen that the
-planets are all moving slowly among the fixed
-stars. So if we make a star photograph in a part
-of the sky where a planet happens to be, the
-planet will make a short line on the plate;
-whereas, if the planet remained quite unmoved
-relatively to the stars it would give a dot like
-the star dots. The presence of a line, therefore,
-at once indicates a planet.</p>
-
-<p>This method of planet-hunting has proved
-most useful. More than 400 small planets similar
-to Piazzi's have been found, though never
-another one like Uranus and Neptune. As
-we have said, all these little bodies lie between
-Mars and Jupiter. They evidently belong to a
-group or family, and many astronomers have
-been led to believe that they are but fragments
-of a former large planet.</p>
-
-<p>In August, 1898, however, one was found by
-Witt, of Berlin, which will probably occupy a
-very prominent place in the annals of astronomy.
-For this planet goes well within the orbit of<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_67" id="Page_67">[67]</a></span>
-Mars, and this will bring it at times very close
-to the earth. In fact, when the motions of the
-new planet and the earth combine to bring them
-to their positions of greatest proximity, the new
-planet will approach us closer than any other
-celestial body except our own moon. Witt
-named his new planet Eros. Its size, though
-small, may prove to be sufficient to bring it within
-the possibilities of naked-eye observation at the
-time of closest approach to the earth.</p>
-
-<p>To astronomers the great importance of this
-new planet is due to the following circumstance:
-For certain reasons too technical to be stated
-here in detail, the distance from the earth to any
-planet can be determined with a degree of precision
-which is greatest for planets that are near
-us. Thus in time we shall learn the distance of
-Eros more accurately than we know any other
-celestial distance. From this, by a process of
-calculation, the solar distance from the earth is
-determinable. But the distance from earth to
-sun is the fundamental astronomical unit of measure;
-so that Witt's discovery, through its effect
-on the unit of measure, will doubtless influence<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_68" id="Page_68">[68]</a></span>
-every part of the science of astronomy. Here
-we have once more a striking instance of the
-reward sure to overtake the diligent worker in
-science&mdash;a whole generation of men will doubtless
-pass away before we shall have exhausted
-the scientific advantages to be drawn from Witt's
-remarkable observation of 1898.</p>
-
-
-<hr class="chap" />
-<p><span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_69" id="Page_69">[69]</a></span></p>
-
-<h2><a name="HOW_TO_MAKE_A_SUN-DIAL" id="HOW_TO_MAKE_A_SUN-DIAL"></a><a href="#CONTENTS">HOW TO MAKE A SUN-DIAL</a><a name="FNanchor_A_1" id="FNanchor_A_1"></a><a href="#Footnote_A_1" class="fnanchor">[A]</a></h2>
-
-
-<p>Long before clocks and watches had been invented,
-people began to measure time with sun-dials.
-Nowadays, when almost everyone has a
-watch in his pocket, and can have a clock, too,
-on the mantel-piece of every room in the house,
-the sun-dial has ceased to be needed in ordinary
-life. But it is still just as interesting as ever to
-anyone who would like to have the means of
-getting time direct from the sun, the great hour-hand
-or timekeeper of the sky. Any person
-who is handy with tools can make a sun-dial
-quite easily, by following the directions given
-below.</p>
-
-<p>In the first place, you must know that the
-sun-dial gives the time by means of the sun's
-shadow. If you stick a walking-cane up in the
-sand on a bright, sunshiny day, the cane has a<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_70" id="Page_70">[70]</a></span>
-long shadow that looks like a dark line on the
-ground. Now if you watch this shadow carefully,
-you will see that it does not stay in the
-same place all day. Slowly but surely, as the
-sun climbs up in the sky, the shadow creeps
-around the cane. You can see quite easily that
-if the cane were fastened in a board floor, and if
-we could mark on the floor the places where the
-shadow was at different hours of the day, we
-could make the shadow tell us the time just like
-the hour-hand of a clock. A sun-dial is just
-such an arrangement as this, and I will show you
-how to mark the shadow places exactly, so as to
-tell the right time without any trouble whenever
-the sun shines.</p>
-
-<p>If you were to watch very carefully such an
-arrangement as a cane standing in a board floor,
-you would not find the creeping shadow in just
-the same place at the same time every day. If
-you marked the place of the shadow at exactly
-ten o'clock by your watch some morning, and
-then went back another day at ten, you would
-not find the shadow on the old mark. It would
-not get very far from it in a day or two, but in a<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_71" id="Page_71">[71]</a></span>
-month or so it would be quite a distance away.
-Now, of course, a sun-dial would be of no use if
-it did not tell the time correctly every day; and
-in fact, it is not easy to make a dial when the
-shadow is cast by a stick standing straight up.
-But we can get over this difficulty very well by
-letting the shadow be cast by a stick that leans
-over toward the floor just the right amount, as I
-will explain in a moment. Of course, we should
-not really use the floor for our sun-dial. It is
-much better to mark out the hour-lines, as they
-are called, on a smooth piece of ordinary white
-board, and then, after the dial is finished, it can
-be screwed down to a piazza floor or railing, or it
-can be fastened on a window-sill. It ought to
-be put in a place where the sun can get at it
-most of the time, because, of course, you cannot
-use the sun-dial when the sun is not shining on
-it. If the dial is set on a window-sill (of a city
-house, for instance) you must choose a south
-window if you can, so as to get the sun nearly all
-day. If you have to take an east window, you
-can use the dial in the morning only, and in a
-west window only in the afternoon. Sometimes<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_72" id="Page_72">[72]</a></span>
-it is best not to try to fasten the dial to its
-support with screws, but just to mark its place,
-and then set it out whenever you want to use
-it. For if the dial is made of wood, and not
-painted, it might be injured by rain or snow
-in bad weather if left out on a window-sill or
-piazza.</p>
-
-<div class="figcenter">
-<a name="FIG_1" id="FIG_1"></a>
-<img src="images/i_072.jpg" width="600" alt="" />
-<div class="caption">
-Fig. 1.</div>
-</div>
-
-<p>It is not quite easy to fasten a little stick to a
-board so that it will lean over just right. So it
-is better not to use a stick or a cane in the way
-I have described, but instead to use a piece of
-board cut to just the right shape.</p>
-
-<p>Fig. 1 shows what a sun-dial should look like.<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_73" id="Page_73">[73]</a></span>
-The lines to show the shadow's place at the different
-hours of the day will be marked on the
-board ABCD, and this will
-be put flat on the window-sill
-or piazza floor. The three-cornered
-piece of board <em>abc</em>
-is fastened to the bottom-board
-ABCD by screws going
-through ABCD from underneath. The edge <em>ab</em>
-of the three-cornered board <em>abc</em> then takes the
-place of the leaning stick or cane, and the time is
-marked by the shadow cast by the edge <em>ab</em>. Of
-course, it is important that this edge should be
-straight and perfectly flat and even. If you are
-handy with tools, you can make it quite easily,
-but if not, you can mark the right shape on a
-piece of paper very carefully, and take it to a
-carpenter, who can cut the board according to
-the pattern you have marked on the paper.</p>
-
-<div class="figright">
-<a name="FIG_2" id="FIG_2"></a>
-<img src="images/i_073.jpg" width="200" alt="" />
-<div class="caption">
-Fig. 2.</div>
-</div>
-
-<p>Now I must tell you how to draw the shape
-of the three-cornered board <em>abc</em>. Fig. 2 shows
-how it is done. The side <em>ac</em> should always be
-just five inches long. The side <em>bc</em> is drawn at
-right angles to <em>ac</em>, which you can do with an or<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_74" id="Page_74">[74]</a></span>dinary
-carpenter's square. The length of <em>bc</em> depends
-on the place for which the dial is made.
-The following table gives the length of <em>bc</em> for
-various places in the United States, and, after you
-have marked out the length of <em>bc</em>, it is only
-necessary to complete the three-cornered piece by
-drawing the side <em>ab</em> from <em>a</em> to <em>b</em>.</p>
-
-<div class="clear"><a name="TABLE_1" id="TABLE_1"></a></div>
-<p class="p2 pfs80"><span class="smcap">Table Showing the Length of the Side</span> <em>bc</em>.</p>
-
-<div class="center fs80">
-<br />
-<table border="0" cellpadding="2" cellspacing="0" width="95%" summary="">
-<tr><td class="tdlbt" colspan="7"></td></tr>
-<tr><td class="tdlx" rowspan="2">Place.</td><td></td><td class="tdc"><em>b c</em></td><td class="tdlbl tdlbr wd1"></td><td class="tdlx" rowspan="2">Place.</td><td></td><td class="tdc"><em>b c</em></td></tr>
-<tr><td class="tdc wd10 pad1" colspan="2">Inches.</td><td class="tdlbl tdlbr"></td><td class="tdc wd10 pad1" colspan="2">Inches.</td></tr>
-<tr><td class="tdlbt" colspan="3"></td><td class="tdlbl tdlbr"></td><td class="tdlbt" colspan="3"></td></tr>
-<tr><td class="tdl">Albany</td><td class="tdl wd1">4</td><td class="tdc">11-16</td><td class="tdlbl tdlbr"></td><td class="tdl">New York</td><td class="tdl wd1">4</td><td class="tdc">3-8</td></tr>
-<tr><td class="tdl">Baltimore</td><td class="tdl">4</td><td class="tdc">1-16</td><td class="tdlbl tdlbr"></td><td class="tdl">Omaha</td><td class="tdl">4</td><td class="tdc">3-8</td></tr>
-<tr><td class="tdl">Boston</td><td class="tdl">4</td><td class="tdc">1-2</td><td class="tdlbl tdlbr"></td><td class="tdl">Philadelphia</td><td class="tdl">4</td><td class="tdc">3-16</td></tr>
-<tr><td class="tdl">Buffalo</td><td class="tdl">4</td><td class="tdc">11-16</td><td class="tdlbl tdlbr"></td><td class="tdl">Pittsburg</td><td class="tdl">4</td><td class="tdc">3-8</td></tr>
-<tr><td class="tdl">Charleston</td><td class="tdl">3</td><td class="tdc">1-4</td><td class="tdlbl tdlbr"></td><td class="tdl">Portland, Me</td><td class="tdl">4</td><td class="tdc">13-16</td></tr>
-<tr><td class="tdl">Chicago</td><td class="tdl">4</td><td class="tdc">1-2</td><td class="tdlbl tdlbr"></td><td class="tdl">Richmond</td><td class="tdl">3</td><td class="tdc">15-16</td></tr>
-<tr><td class="tdl">Cincinnati</td><td class="tdl">4</td><td class="tdc">1-16</td><td class="tdlbl tdlbr"></td><td class="tdl">Rochester</td><td class="tdl">4</td><td class="tdc">11-16</td></tr>
-<tr><td class="tdl">Cleveland</td><td class="tdl">4</td><td class="tdc">1-2</td><td class="tdlbl tdlbr"></td><td class="tdl">San Diego</td><td class="tdl">3</td><td class="tdc">1-4</td></tr>
-<tr><td class="tdl">Denver</td><td class="tdl">4</td><td class="tdc">3-16</td><td class="tdlbl tdlbr"></td><td class="tdl">San Francisco</td><td class="tdl">3</td><td class="tdc">15-16</td></tr>
-<tr><td class="tdl">Detroit</td><td class="tdl">4</td><td class="tdc">1-2</td><td class="tdlbl tdlbr"></td><td class="tdl">Savannah</td><td class="tdl">3</td><td class="tdc">1-8</td></tr>
-<tr><td class="tdl">Indianapolis</td><td class="tdl">4</td><td class="tdc">1-16</td><td class="tdlbl tdlbr"></td><td class="tdl">St. Louis</td><td class="tdl">3</td><td class="tdc">15-16</td></tr>
-<tr><td class="tdl">Kansas City</td><td class="tdl">3</td><td class="tdc">15-16</td><td class="tdlbl tdlbr"></td><td class="tdl">St. Paul</td><td class="tdl">5</td></tr>
-<tr><td class="tdl">Louisville</td><td class="tdl">3</td><td class="tdc">15-16</td><td class="tdlbl tdlbr"></td><td class="tdl">Seattle</td><td class="tdl">5</td><td class="tdc">9-16</td></tr>
-<tr><td class="tdl">Milwaukee</td><td class="tdl">3</td><td class="tdc">11-16</td><td class="tdlbl tdlbr"></td><td class="tdl">Washington, D. C.</td><td class="tdl">4</td><td class="tdc">1-16</td></tr>
-<tr><td class="tdl">New Orleans</td><td class="tdl">2</td><td class="tdc">7-8</td><td class="tdlbl tdlbr"></td></tr>
-<tr><td class="tdlbt" colspan="7"></td></tr>
-</table><br /></div>
-
-<p>If you wish to make a dial for a place not given
-in the table, it will be near enough to use the distance
-<em>bc</em> as given for the place nearest to you.
-But in selecting the nearest place from the table,
-please remember to take that one of the cities
-mentioned which is nearest to you in a north-and-south<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_75" id="Page_75">[75]</a></span>
-direction. It does not matter how far away
-the place is in an east-and-west direction. So, instead
-of taking the place that is nearest to you on
-the map in a straight line, take the place to which
-you could travel by going principally east or west,
-and very little north or south. The figure drawn
-is about the right shape for New York. The
-board used for the three-cornered piece should be
-about one-half inch thick. But if you are making
-a window-sill dial, you may prefer to have it
-smaller than I have described. You can easily
-have it half as big by making all the sizes and
-lines in half-inches where the table calls for
-inches.</p>
-
-<p>After you have marked out the dimensions for
-the three-cornered piece that is to throw the
-shadow, you can prepare the dial itself, with the
-lines that mark the place of the shadow for every
-hour of the day. This you can do in the manner
-shown in Fig. 3. Just as in the case of the three-cornered
-piece, you can draw the dial with a pencil
-directly on a smooth piece of white board, about
-three-quarters of an inch thick, or you can mark
-it out on a paper pattern and transfer it afterward<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_76" id="Page_76">[76]</a></span>
-to the board. Perhaps it will be as well to begin
-by drawing on paper, as any mistakes can then
-be corrected before you commence to mark your
-wood.</p>
-
-<div class="figcenter">
-<a name="FIG_3" id="FIG_3"></a>
-<img src="images/i_076.jpg" width="600" alt="" />
-<div class="caption">
-Fig. 3.</div>
-</div>
-
-<p>In the first place you must draw a couple of
-lines MN and M′N′, eight inches long, and just
-far enough apart to fit the edge of your three-cornered
-shadow-piece. You will remember I
-told you to make that one-half inch thick, so
-your two lines will also be one-half inch apart.
-Now draw the two lines NO and N′O′ square<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_77" id="Page_77">[77]</a></span>
-with MN and M′N′, and make the distances
-NO and N′O′ just five inches each. The lines
-OK, O′K′, and the other lines forming the outer
-border of the dial, are then drawn just as shown,
-OK and O′K′ being just eight inches long, the
-same as MN and M′N′. The lower lines in
-the figure, which are not very important, are to
-complete the squares. You must mark the lines
-NO and N′O′ with the figures VI, these being
-the lines reached by the shadow at six o'clock in
-the morning and evening. The points where the
-VII, VIII, and other hour-lines cut the lines
-OK, O′K′, MK, and M′K′ can be found from
-the table on <a href="#Page_78">page 78</a>.</p>
-
-<p>In using the table you will notice that the line
-IX falls sometimes on one side of the corner K,
-and sometimes on the other. Thus for Albany
-the line passes seven and seven-sixteenth inches
-from O, while for Charleston it passes four and
-three-eighth inches from M. For Baltimore it
-passes exactly through the corner K.</p>
-
-<p><span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_78" id="Page_78">[78]</a></span></p>
-
-<div><a name="TABLE_2" id="TABLE_2"></a></div>
-<p class="p2 pfs80"><span class="smcap">Table Showing How to Mark the Hour-lines.</span></p>
-
-<div class="center fs80">
-<br />
-<table border="0" cellpadding="4" cellspacing="0" width="95%" summary="">
-<tr><td class="tdlbt" colspan="8"></td></tr>
-<tr><td class="tdc" rowspan="3">Place.</td><td class="tdcbl tdpp" colspan="3">Distance from O to the line marked</td>
- <td class="tdlbl tdlbr"></td><td class="tdc tdpp" colspan="3">Distance from M to the line marked</td></tr>
-<tr><td class="tdlbt" colspan="3"></td><td class="tdlbl tdlbr"></td><td class="tdlbt" colspan="3"></td></tr>
-<tr><td class="tdcbl tdpp">VII.</td><td class="tdcbl tdpp">VIII.</td><td class="tdcbl tdpp">IX.</td>
- <td class="tdlbl tdlbr"></td><td class="tdc tdpp">IX.</td><td class="tdcbl tdpp">X.</td><td class="tdcbl tdpp">XI.</td></tr>
-<tr><td class="tdlbt" colspan="4"></td><td class="tdlbl tdlbr"></td><td class="tdlbt" colspan="3"></td></tr>
-<tr><td class="tdl"></td><td class="tdlbl">Inches.</td><td class="tdlbl">Inches.</td><td class="tdlbl">Inches.</td>
- <td class="tdlbl tdlbr"></td><td class="tdl">Inches.</td><td class="tdlbl">Inches.</td><td class="tdlbl">Inches.</td></tr>
-<tr><td class="tdl">Albany</td><td class="tdlbl">1 &nbsp;15-16</td><td class="tdlbl">4 &nbsp;3-16</td><td class="tdlbl">7 &nbsp;7-16</td>
- <td class="tdlbl tdlbr wd1"></td><td class="tdl"></td><td class="tdlbl">3 &nbsp;1-16</td><td class="tdlbl">1 &nbsp;7-16</td></tr>
-<tr><td class="tdl">Baltimore</td><td class="tdlbl">2 &nbsp;&nbsp;1-8</td><td class="tdlbl">4 11-16</td><td class="tdlbl">8</td>
- <td class="tdlbl tdlbr"></td><td class="tdl"></td><td class="tdlbl">2 &nbsp;7-8</td><td class="tdlbl">1 &nbsp;7-16</td></tr>
-<tr><td class="tdl">Boston</td><td class="tdlbl">2</td><td class="tdlbl">4 &nbsp;5-16</td><td class="tdlbl">7 &nbsp;7-16</td>
- <td class="tdlbl tdlbr"></td><td class="tdl"></td><td class="tdlbl">3 &nbsp;1-16</td><td class="tdlbl">1 &nbsp;7-16</td></tr>
-<tr><td class="tdl">Buffalo</td><td class="tdlbl">1 &nbsp;15-16</td><td class="tdlbl">4 &nbsp;3-16</td><td class="tdlbl">7 &nbsp;7-16</td>
- <td class="tdlbl tdlbr"></td><td class="tdl"></td><td class="tdlbl">3 &nbsp;1-16</td><td class="tdlbl">1 &nbsp;7-16</td></tr>
-<tr><td class="tdl">Charleston</td><td class="tdlbl">2 &nbsp;&nbsp;7-16</td><td class="tdlbl">5 &nbsp;3-8</td><td class="tdlbl"></td>
- <td class="tdlbl tdlbr"></td><td class="tdl">4 &nbsp;3-8</td><td class="tdlbl">2 &nbsp;1-2</td><td class="tdlbl">1 &nbsp;1-8</td></tr>
-<tr><td class="tdl">Chicago</td><td class="tdlbl">2</td><td class="tdlbl">4 &nbsp;5-16</td><td class="tdlbl">7 &nbsp;7-16</td>
- <td class="tdlbl tdlbr"></td><td class="tdl"></td><td class="tdlbl">3 &nbsp;1-16</td><td class="tdlbl">1 &nbsp;7-16</td></tr>
-<tr><td class="tdl">Cincinnati</td><td class="tdlbl">2 &nbsp;&nbsp;1-8</td><td class="tdlbl">4 11-16</td><td class="tdlbl">8</td>
- <td class="tdlbl tdlbr"></td><td class="tdl"></td><td class="tdlbl">2 &nbsp;7-8</td><td class="tdlbl">1 &nbsp;7-16</td></tr>
-<tr><td class="tdl">Cleveland</td><td class="tdlbl">2</td><td class="tdlbl">4 &nbsp;5-16</td><td class="tdlbl">7 &nbsp;7-16</td>
- <td class="tdlbl tdlbr"></td><td class="tdl">&nbsp;&nbsp;&mdash;</td><td class="tdlbl">3 &nbsp;1-16</td><td class="tdlbl">1 &nbsp;7-16</td></tr>
-<tr><td class="tdl">Denver</td><td class="tdlbl">2 &nbsp;&nbsp;1-8</td><td class="tdlbl">4 &nbsp;1-2</td><td class="tdlbl">7 11-16</td>
- <td class="tdlbl tdlbr"></td><td class="tdl"></td><td class="tdlbl">2 &nbsp;7-8</td><td class="tdlbl">1 &nbsp;7-16</td></tr>
-<tr><td class="tdl">Detroit</td><td class="tdlbl">2</td><td class="tdlbl">4 &nbsp;5-16</td><td class="tdlbl">7 &nbsp;7-16</td>
- <td class="tdlbl tdlbr"></td><td class="tdl"></td><td class="tdlbl">3 &nbsp;1-16</td><td class="tdlbl">1 &nbsp;7-16</td></tr>
-<tr><td class="tdl">Indianapolis</td><td class="tdlbl">2 &nbsp;&nbsp;1-8</td><td class="tdlbl">4 11-16</td><td class="tdlbl">8</td>
- <td class="tdlbl tdlbr"></td><td class="tdl"></td><td class="tdlbl">2 &nbsp;7-8</td><td class="tdlbl">1 &nbsp;7-16</td></tr>
-<tr><td class="tdl">Kansas City</td><td class="tdlbl">2 &nbsp;&nbsp;1-4</td><td class="tdlbl">4 11-16</td><td class="tdlbl">8</td>
- <td class="tdlbl tdlbr"></td><td class="tdl"></td><td class="tdlbl">2 &nbsp;7-8</td><td class="tdlbl">1 &nbsp;5-16</td></tr>
-<tr><td class="tdl">Louisville</td><td class="tdlbl">2 &nbsp;&nbsp;1-4</td><td class="tdlbl">4 11-16</td><td class="tdlbl">8</td>
- <td class="tdlbl tdlbr"></td><td class="tdl"></td><td class="tdlbl">2 &nbsp;7-8</td><td class="tdlbl">1 &nbsp;5-16</td></tr>
-<tr><td class="tdl">Milwaukee</td><td class="tdlbl">1 &nbsp;15-16</td><td class="tdlbl">4 &nbsp;3-16</td><td class="tdlbl">7 &nbsp;7-16</td>
- <td class="tdlbl tdlbr"></td><td class="tdl"></td><td class="tdlbl">3 &nbsp;1-16</td><td class="tdlbl">1 &nbsp;7-16</td></tr>
-<tr><td class="tdl">New Orleans</td><td class="tdlbl">2 &nbsp;11-16</td><td class="tdlbl">5 &nbsp;3-4</td><td class="tdlbl"></td>
- <td class="tdlbl tdlbr"></td><td class="tdl">4 &nbsp;1-16</td><td class="tdlbl">2 &nbsp;5-16</td><td class="tdlbl">1 &nbsp;1-8</td></tr>
-<tr><td class="tdl">New York</td><td class="tdlbl">2</td><td class="tdlbl">4 &nbsp;5-16</td><td class="tdlbl">7 11-16</td>
- <td class="tdlbl tdlbr"></td><td class="tdl"></td><td class="tdlbl">3 &nbsp;1-16</td><td class="tdlbl">1 &nbsp;7-16</td></tr>
-<tr><td class="tdl">Omaha</td><td class="tdlbl">2</td><td class="tdlbl">4 &nbsp;5-16</td><td class="tdlbl">7 11-16</td>
- <td class="tdlbl tdlbr"></td><td class="tdl"></td><td class="tdlbl">3 &nbsp;1-16</td><td class="tdlbl">1 &nbsp;7-16</td></tr>
-<tr><td class="tdl">Philadelphia</td><td class="tdlbl">2 &nbsp;&nbsp;1-8</td><td class="tdlbl">4 &nbsp;1-2</td><td class="tdlbl">7 11-16</td>
- <td class="tdlbl tdlbr"></td><td class="tdl"></td><td class="tdlbl">2 &nbsp;7-8</td><td class="tdlbl">1 &nbsp;7-16</td></tr>
-<tr><td class="tdl">Pittsburg</td><td class="tdlbl">2</td><td class="tdlbl">4 &nbsp;5-16</td><td class="tdlbl">7 11-16</td>
- <td class="tdlbl tdlbr"></td><td class="tdl"></td><td class="tdlbl">3 &nbsp;1-16</td><td class="tdlbl">1 &nbsp;7-16</td></tr>
-<tr><td class="tdl">Portland, Me</td><td class="tdlbl">1 &nbsp;15-16</td><td class="tdlbl">4 &nbsp;3-16</td><td class="tdlbl">7 &nbsp;1-8</td>
- <td class="tdlbl tdlbr"></td><td class="tdl"></td><td class="tdlbl">3 &nbsp;3-16</td><td class="tdlbl">1 &nbsp;1-2</td></tr>
-<tr><td class="tdl">Richmond</td><td class="tdlbl">2 &nbsp;&nbsp;1-4</td><td class="tdlbl">4 11-16</td><td class="tdlbl">8</td>
- <td class="tdlbl tdlbr"></td><td class="tdl"></td><td class="tdlbl">2 &nbsp;7-8</td><td class="tdlbl">1 &nbsp;5-16</td></tr>
-<tr><td class="tdl">Rochester</td><td class="tdlbl">1 &nbsp;15-16</td><td class="tdlbl">4 &nbsp;3-16</td><td class="tdlbl">7 &nbsp;7-16</td>
- <td class="tdlbl tdlbr"></td><td class="tdl"></td><td class="tdlbl">3 &nbsp;1-16</td><td class="tdlbl">1 &nbsp;7-16</td></tr>
-<tr><td class="tdl">San Diego</td><td class="tdlbl">2 &nbsp;&nbsp;7-16</td><td class="tdlbl">5 &nbsp;3-8</td><td class="tdlbl"></td>
- <td class="tdlbl tdlbr"></td><td class="tdl">4 &nbsp;3-8</td><td class="tdlbl">2 &nbsp;1-2</td><td class="tdlbl">1 &nbsp;1-8</td></tr>
-<tr><td class="tdl">San Francisco</td><td class="tdlbl">2 &nbsp;&nbsp;1-4</td><td class="tdlbl">4 11-16</td><td class="tdlbl">8</td>
- <td class="tdlbl tdlbr"></td><td class="tdl"></td><td class="tdlbl">2 &nbsp;7-8</td><td class="tdlbl">1 &nbsp;5-16</td></tr>
-<tr><td class="tdl">Savannah</td><td class="tdlbl">2 &nbsp;&nbsp;9-16</td><td class="tdlbl">5 &nbsp;9-16</td><td class="tdlbl"></td>
- <td class="tdlbl tdlbr"></td><td class="tdl">4 &nbsp;1-4</td><td class="tdlbl">2 &nbsp;1-2</td><td class="tdlbl">1 &nbsp;1-8</td></tr>
-<tr><td class="tdl">St. Louis</td><td class="tdlbl">2 &nbsp;&nbsp;1-4</td><td class="tdlbl">4 11-16</td><td class="tdlbl">8</td>
- <td class="tdlbl tdlbr"></td><td class="tdl"></td><td class="tdlbl">2 &nbsp;7-8</td><td class="tdlbl">1 &nbsp;5-16</td></tr>
-<tr><td class="tdl">St. Paul</td><td class="tdlbl">1 &nbsp;15-16</td><td class="tdlbl">4 &nbsp;1-16</td><td class="tdlbl">7 &nbsp;1-8</td>
- <td class="tdlbl tdlbr"></td><td class="tdl"></td><td class="tdlbl">3 &nbsp;3-16</td><td class="tdlbl">1 &nbsp;1-2</td></tr>
-<tr><td class="tdl">Seattle</td><td class="tdlbl">1 &nbsp;13-16</td><td class="tdlbl">3 15-16</td><td class="tdlbl">6 &nbsp;5-8</td>
- <td class="tdlbl tdlbr"></td><td class="tdl"></td><td class="tdlbl">3 &nbsp;3-8</td><td class="tdlbl">1 &nbsp;1-2</td></tr>
-<tr><td class="tdl">Washington, D. C.</td><td class="tdlbl">2 &nbsp;&nbsp;1-8</td><td class="tdlbl">4 11-16</td><td class="tdlbl">8</td>
- <td class="tdlbl tdlbr"></td><td class="tdl"></td><td class="tdlbl">2 &nbsp;7-8</td><td class="tdlbl">1 &nbsp;7-16</td></tr>
-<tr><td class="tdlbt" colspan="8"></td></tr>
-</table><br /></div>
-
-<p>The distance for the line marked V from O′ is
-just the same as the distance from O to VII.
-Similarly, IV corresponds to VIII, III to IX,
-II to X, and I to XI. The number XII is
-marked at MM′ as shown. If you desire to add
-lines (not shown in Fig. 3 to avoid confusion) for
-hours earlier than six in the morning, it is merely
-necessary to mark off a distance on the line KO,
-below the point O, and equal to the distance from
-O to VII. This will give the point where the<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_79" id="Page_79">[79]</a></span>
-5 <span class="fs70">A.M.</span> shadow line drawn from N cuts the line
-KO. A corresponding line for 7 <span class="fs70">P.M.</span> can be
-drawn from N′ on the other side of the figure.</p>
-
-<p>After you have marked out the dial very carefully,
-you must fasten the three-cornered shadow-piece
-to it in such a way that the whole instrument
-will look like <a href="#FIG_1">Fig. 1</a>. The edge <em>ac</em> (Fig.
-2) goes on NM (Fig. 3). The point <em>a</em> (Fig. 2)
-must come exactly on N (Fig. 3); and as the
-lines NM (Fig. 3) and N′M′ (Fig. 3) have been
-made just the right distance apart to fit the
-thickness of the three-cornered piece <em>abc</em> (Fig.
-2), everything will go together just right. The
-point <em>c</em> (Fig. 2) will not quite reach to M (Fig. 3),
-but will be on the line NM (Fig. 3) at a distance
-of three inches from M. The two pieces of
-wood will be fastened together with three screws
-going through the bottom-board ABCD (Figs.
-1 and 3) and into the edge <em>ac</em> (Fig. 2) of the
-three-cornered piece. The whole instrument will
-then look something like <a href="#FIG_1">Fig. 1</a>.</p>
-
-<p>After you have got your sun-dial put together,
-you need only set it in the sun in a level place,
-on a piazza or window-sill, and turn it round<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_80" id="Page_80">[80]</a></span>
-until it tells the right time by the shadow. You
-can get your local time from a watch near enough
-for setting up the dial. Once the dial is set right
-you can screw it down or mark its position, and
-it will continue to give correct solar time every
-day in the year.</p>
-
-<p>If you wish to adjust the dial very closely,
-you must go out some fine day and note the error
-of the dial by a watch at about ten in the
-morning, and at noon, and again at about two in
-the afternoon. If the error is the same each time,
-the dial is rightly set. If not, you must try, by
-turning the dial slightly, to get it so placed that
-your three errors will be nearly the same. When
-you have got them as nearly alike as you can, the
-dial will be sufficiently near right. The solar or
-dial time may, however, differ somewhat from
-ordinary watch time, but the difference will never
-be great enough to matter, when we remember
-that sun-dials are only rough timekeepers after
-all, and useful principally for amusement.</p>
-
-
-<div class="footnotes"><h3>FOOTNOTE:</h3>
-
-<div class="footnote">
-
-<p><a name="Footnote_A_1" id="Footnote_A_1"></a><a href="#FNanchor_A_1"><span class="label">[A]</span></a> This chapter is especially intended for boys and girls and others who like
-to make things with carpenters' tools.</p></div></div>
-
-
-<hr class="chap" />
-<p><span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_81" id="Page_81">[81]</a></span></p>
-
-<h2><a name="PHOTOGRAPHY_IN_ASTRONOMY" id="PHOTOGRAPHY_IN_ASTRONOMY"></a><a href="#CONTENTS">PHOTOGRAPHY IN ASTRONOMY</a></h2>
-
-
-<p>New highways of science have been monumented
-now and again by the masterful efforts of
-genius, working single-handed; but more often
-it is slow-moving time that ripens discovery, and,
-at the proper moment, opens some new path to
-men whose intellectual power is but willingness
-to learn. So the annals of astronomical photography
-do not recount the achievements of extraordinary
-genius. It would have been strange,
-indeed, if the discovery of photography had not
-been followed by its application to astronomy.</p>
-
-<p>The whole range of chemical science contains
-no experiment of greater inherent interest than
-the development of a photographic plate. Let
-but the smallest ray of light fall upon its
-strangely sensitive surface, and some subtle invisible
-change takes place. It is then merely necessary
-to plunge the plate into a properly prepared
-chemical bath, and the gradual process of<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_82" id="Page_82">[82]</a></span>
-developing the picture begins. Slowly, very
-slowly, the colorless surface darkens wherever
-light has touched it. Let us imagine that the
-exposure has been made with an ordinary lens
-and camera, and that it is a landscape seeming to
-grow beneath the experimenter's eyes. At first
-only the most conspicuous objects make their
-appearance. But gradually the process extends,
-until finally every tiny detail is reproduced with
-marvellous fidelity to the original. The photographic
-plate, when developed in this way, is
-called a "negative." For in Nature luminous
-points, or sources of light, are bright, while the
-developing negative turns dark wherever light
-has acted. Thus the negative, while true to Nature,
-reproduces everything in a reversed way;
-bright things are dark, and shadows appear light.
-For ordinary purposes, therefore, the negative has
-to be replaced by a new photograph made by copying
-it again photographically. In this way it is
-again reversed, giving us a picture corresponding
-correctly to the facts as seen. Such a copy from
-a negative is what is ordinarily called a photograph;
-technically, it is known as a "positive."</p>
-
-<p><span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_83" id="Page_83">[83]</a></span></p>
-
-<p>One of the remarkable things about the sensitive
-plate is its complete indifference to the distance
-from which the light comes. It is ready
-to yield obediently to the ray of some distant
-star that may have journeyed, as it were, from
-the very vanishing point of space, or to the
-bright glow of an electric light upon the photographer's
-table. This quality makes its use especially
-advantageous in astronomy, since we can
-gain knowledge of remote stars only by a study
-of the light they send us. In such study the
-photographic plate possesses a supreme advantage
-over the human eye. If the conditions of
-weather and atmosphere are favorable, an observer
-looking through an ordinary telescope
-will see nearly as much at the first glance as he
-will ever see. Attentive and continued study will
-enable him to fix details upon his memory, and
-to record them by means of drawings and diagrams.
-Occasional moments of especially undisturbed
-atmospheric conditions will allow him
-to glimpse faint objects seldom visible. But on
-the whole, telescopic astronomers add little to
-their harvest by continued husbandry in the<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_84" id="Page_84">[84]</a></span>
-same field of stars. Photography is different.
-The effect of light upon the sensitive surface of
-the plate is strictly cumulative. If a given star
-can bring about a certain result when it has been
-allowed to act upon the plate for one minute,
-then in two or three minutes it will accomplish
-much more. Perhaps a single minute's exposure
-would have produced a mark scarcely perceptible
-upon the developed negative. In that case,
-three or four minutes would give us a perfectly
-well defined black image of the star.</p>
-
-<div class="figcenter">
-<a name="P_84" id="P_84"></a>
-<br />
-<img src="images/i_084fp.jpg" width="500" alt="" />
-<div class="caption">
-Star-Field in Constellation Monoceros.<br />
-<span class="fs80">Photographed by Barnard, February 1, 1894.<br />
-Exposure, three hours.</span></div>
-</div>
-
-<p>Thus, by lengthening the exposure we can
-make the fainter stars impress themselves upon
-the plate. If their light is not able to produce
-the desired effect in minutes, we can let its action
-accumulate for hours. In this manner it becomes
-possible and easy to photograph objects
-so faint that they have never been seen, even
-with our most powerful telescopes. This
-achievement ranks high among those which
-make astronomy appeal so strongly to the imagination.
-Scientific men are not given to fancies;
-nor should they be. But the first long-exposure
-photograph must have been an exciting thing.
-<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_85" id="Page_85">[85]</a></span>After coming from the observatory, the chemical
-development was, of course, made in a dark
-room, so that no additional light might harm the
-plate until the process was complete. Carrying
-it out then into the light, that early experimenter
-cannot but have felt a thrill of triumph;
-for his hand held a true picture of dim stars to
-the eye unlighted, lifted into view as if by magic.</p>
-
-<p>Plates have been thus exposed as long as
-twenty-five hours, and the manner of doing it is
-very interesting. Of course, it is impossible to
-carry on the work continuously for so long a
-period, since the beginning of daylight would
-surely ruin the photograph. In fact, the astronomer
-must stop before even the faintest streak of
-dawn begins to redden the eastern sky. Moreover,
-making astronomical negatives requires excessively
-close attention, and this it is impossible
-to give continuously during more than a few
-hours. But the exposure of a single plate can be
-extended over several nights without difficulty.
-It is merely necessary to close the plate-holder
-with a "light-tight" cover when the first night's
-work is finished. To begin further exposure of<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_86" id="Page_86">[86]</a></span>
-the same plate on another night, we simply aim
-the photographic telescope at precisely the same
-point of the sky as before. The light-tight
-plate-holder being again opened, the exposure
-can go on as if there had been no interruption.</p>
-
-<p>Astronomers have invented a most ingenious
-device for making sure that the telescope's aim
-can be brought back again to the same point with
-great exactness. This is a very important matter;
-for the slightest disturbance of the plate before
-the second or subsequent portions of the exposure
-would ruin everything. Instead of a very
-complete single picture, we should have two partial
-ones mixed up together in inextricable confusion.</p>
-
-<p>To prevent this, photographic telescopes are
-made double, not altogether unlike an opera-glass.
-One of the tubes is arranged for photography
-proper, while the other is fitted with lenses suitable
-for an ordinary visual telescope. The two tubes
-are made parallel. Thus the astronomer, by looking
-through the visual glass, can watch objects in
-the heavens even while they are being photographed.
-The visual half of the instrument is
-provided with a pair of very fine cross-wires mov<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_87" id="Page_87">[87]</a></span>able
-at will in the field of view. These can be
-made to bisect some little star exactly, before beginning
-the first night's work. Afterward, everything
-about the instrument having been left unchanged,
-the astronomer can always assure himself
-of coming back to precisely the same point of the
-sky, by so adjusting the instrument that the same
-little star is again bisected.</p>
-
-<p>It must not be supposed, however, that the
-entire instrument remains unmoved, even during
-the whole of a single night's exposure. For in
-that case, the apparent motion of the stars as they
-rise or set in the sky would speedily carry them
-out of the telescope's field of view. Consequently,
-this motion has to be counteracted by shifting
-the telescope so as to follow the stars. This
-can be accomplished accurately and automatically
-by means of clock-work mechanism. Such contrivances
-have already been applied in the past to
-visual telescopes, because even then they facilitated
-the observer's work. They save him the
-trouble of turning his instrument every few minutes,
-and allow him to give his undivided attention
-to the actual business of observation.</p>
-
-<p><span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_88" id="Page_88">[88]</a></span></p>
-
-<p>For photographic purposes the telescope needs
-to "follow" the stars far more accurately than in
-the older kind of observing with the eye. Nor is
-it possible to make a clock that will drive the instrument
-satisfactorily and quite automatically.
-But by means of the second or visual telescope,
-astronomers can always ascertain whether the
-clock is working correctly at any given moment.
-It requires only a glance at the little star bisected
-by the cross-wires, and, if there has been the
-slightest imperfection in the following by clock-work,
-the star will no longer be cut exactly by
-the wires.</p>
-
-<p>The astronomer can at once correct any error
-by putting in operation a very ingenious mechanical
-device sometimes called a "mouse-control."
-He need only touch an electric button,
-and a signal is sent into the clock-work.
-Instantly there is a shifting of the mechanism.
-For one of the regular driving wheels is substituted,
-temporarily, another having an <em>extra tooth</em>.
-This makes the clock run a little faster so long
-as the electric current passes. In a similar way,
-by means of another button, the clock can be<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_89" id="Page_89">[89]</a></span>
-made to run slower temporarily. Thus by
-watching the cross-wires continuously, and manipulating
-his two electric buttons, the photographic
-astronomer can compel his telescope to
-follow exactly the object under observation, and
-he can make certain of obtaining a perfect negative.</p>
-
-<p>These long-exposure plates are intended especially
-for what may be called descriptive astronomy.
-With them, as we have seen, advantage is
-taken of cumulative light-effects on the sensitive
-plate, and the telescope's light-gathering and
-space-penetrating powers are vastly increased.
-We are enabled to carry our researches far beyond
-the confines of the old visible universe.
-Extremely faint objects can be recorded, even
-down to their minutest details, with a fidelity unknown
-to older visual methods. But at present
-we intend to consider principally applications
-of photography in the astronomy of measurement,
-rather than the descriptive branch of our
-subject. Instead of describing pictures made
-simply to see what certain objects look like in
-the sky, we shall consider negatives intended for<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_90" id="Page_90">[90]</a></span>
-precise measurement, with all that the word precision
-implies in celestial science.</p>
-
-<p>Taking up first the photography of stars, we
-must begin by mentioning the work of Rutherfurd
-at New York. More than thirty years ago
-he had so far perfected methods of stellar photography
-that he was able to secure excellent
-pictures of stars as faint as the ninth magnitude.
-In those days the modern process of dry-plate
-photography had not been invented. To-day,
-plates exposed in the photographic telescope are
-made of glass covered with a perfectly dry film
-of sensitized gelatine. But in the old wet-plate
-process the sensitive film was first wetted with a
-chemical solution; and this solution could not be
-allowed to dry during the exposure. Consequently,
-Rutherfurd was limited to exposures a
-few minutes in length, while nowadays, as we
-have said, their duration can be prolonged at will.</p>
-
-<p>When we add to this the fact that the old
-plates were far less sensitive to light than those
-now available, it is easy to see what were the difficulties
-in the way of photographing faint stars
-in Rutherfurd's time. Nor did he possess the<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_91" id="Page_91">[91]</a></span>
-modern ingenious device of a combined visual
-and photographic instrument. He had no electric
-controlling apparatus. In fact, the younger
-generation of astronomers can form no adequate
-idea of the patience and personal skill Rutherfurd
-must have had at his command. For he
-certainly did produce negatives that are but little
-inferior to the best that can be made to-day.
-His only limitation was that he could not
-obtain images of stars much below the ninth
-magnitude.</p>
-
-<p>To understand just what is meant here by the
-ninth magnitude, it is necessary to go back in imagination
-to the time of Hipparchus, the father
-of sidereal astronomy. (See <a href="#Page_39">page 39</a>.) He
-adopted the convenient plan of dividing all the
-stars visible to the naked eye (of course, he had
-no telescope) into six classes, according to their
-brilliancy. The faintest visible stars were put in
-the sixth class, and all the others were assigned
-somewhat arbitrarily to one or the other of the
-brighter classes.</p>
-
-<p>Modern astronomers have devised a more scientific
-system, which has been made to conform<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_92" id="Page_92">[92]</a></span>
-very nearly to that of Hipparchus, just as it has
-come down to us through the ages. We have
-adopted a certain arbitrary degree of luminosity
-as the standard "first-magnitude"; compared with
-sunlight, this may be represented roughly by a
-fraction of which the numerator is 1, and the denominator
-about eighty thousand millions. The
-standard second-magnitude star is one whose
-light, compared with a first-magnitude, may be
-represented approximately by the fraction ⅖.
-The third magnitude, in turn, may be compared
-with the second by the same fraction ⅖; and so
-the classification is extended to magnitudes below
-those visible to the unaided eye. Each magnitude
-compares with the one above it, as the light
-of two candles would compare with the light of
-five.</p>
-
-<p>Rutherfurd did not stop with mere photographs.
-He realized very clearly the obvious
-truth that by making a picture of the sky we
-simply change the scene of our operations.
-Upon the photograph we can measure that which
-we might have studied directly in the heavens;
-but so long as they remain unmeasured, celestial<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_93" id="Page_93">[93]</a></span>
-pictures have a potential value only. Locked
-within them may lie hidden some secret of our
-universe. But it will not come forth unsought.
-Patient effort must precede discovery, in photography,
-as elsewhere in science. There is no
-royal road. Rutherfurd devised an elaborate
-measuring-machine in which his photographs
-could be examined under the microscope with
-the most minute exactness. With this machine
-he measured a large number of his pictures; and
-it has been shown quite recently that the results
-obtained from them are comparable in accuracy
-with those coming from the most highly accredited
-methods of direct eye-observation.</p>
-
-<p>And photographs are far superior in ease of manipulation.
-Convenient day-observing under the
-microscope in a comfortable astronomical laboratory
-is substituted for all the discomforts of a
-midnight vigil under the stars. The work of
-measurement can proceed in all weathers, whereas
-formerly it was limited strictly to perfectly clear
-nights. Lastly, the negatives form a permanent
-record, to which we can always return to correct
-errors or re-examine doubtful points.</p>
-
-<p><span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_94" id="Page_94">[94]</a></span></p>
-
-<p>Rutherfurd's stellar work extended down to
-about 1877, and included especially parallax determinations
-and the photography of star-clusters.
-Each of these subjects is receiving close attention
-from later investigators, and, therefore, merits
-brief mention here. Stellar parallax is in one
-sense but another name for stellar distance. Its
-measurement has been one of the important
-problems of astronomy for centuries, ever since
-men recognized that the Copernican theory of
-our universe requires the determination of stellar
-distances for its complete demonstration.</p>
-
-<p>If the earth is swinging around the sun once a
-year in a mighty path or orbit, there must be
-changes of its position in space comparable in size
-with the orbit itself. And the stars ought to shift
-their apparent places on the sky to correspond
-with these changes in the terrestrial observer's
-position. The phenomenon is analogous to what
-occurs when we look out of a room, first through
-one window, and then through another. Any
-object on the opposite side of the street will be
-seen in a changed direction, on account of the
-observer's having shifted his position from one<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_95" id="Page_95">[95]</a></span>
-window to the other. If the object seemed to
-be due north when seen from the first window,
-it will, perhaps, appear a little east of north from
-the other. But this change of direction will be
-comparatively small, if the object under observation
-is very far away, in comparison with the distance
-between the two windows.</p>
-
-<p>This is what occurs with the stars. The earth's
-orbit, vast as it is, shrinks into almost absolute
-insignificance when compared with the profound
-distances by which we are sundered from even
-the nearest fixed stars. Consequently, the shifting
-of their positions is also very small&mdash;so
-small as to be near the extreme limit separating
-that which is measurable from that which is beyond
-human ken.</p>
-
-<p>Photography lends itself most readily to a
-study of this matter. Suppose a certain star is
-suspected of "having a parallax." In other
-words, we have reason to believe it near enough
-to admit of a successful measurement of distance.
-Perhaps it is a very bright star; and, other
-things being equal, it is probably fair to assume
-that brightness signifies nearness. And astrono<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_96" id="Page_96">[96]</a></span>mers
-have certain other indications of proximity
-that guide them in the selection of proper objects
-for investigation, though such evidence, of course,
-never takes the place of actual measurement.</p>
-
-<p>The star under examination is sure to have near
-it on the sky a number of stars so very small
-that we may safely take them to be immeasurably
-far away. The parallax star is among them,
-but not of them. We see it projected upon the
-background of the heavens, though it may in
-reality be quite near us, astronomically speaking.
-If this is really so, and the star, therefore, subject
-to the slight parallactic shifting already mentioned,
-we can detect it by noting the suspected
-star's position among the surrounding small
-stars. For these, being immeasurably remote,
-will remain unchanged, within the limits of our
-powers of observation, and thus serve as points
-of reference for marking the apparent shifting of
-the brighter star we are actually considering.</p>
-
-<p>We have merely to photograph the region at
-various seasons of the year. Careful examination
-of the photographs under the microscope
-will then enable us to measure the slightest dis<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_97" id="Page_97">[97]</a></span>placement
-of the parallax star. From these
-measures, by a process of calculation, astronomers
-can then obtain the star's distance. It will
-not become known in miles; we shall only ascertain
-how many times the distance between the
-earth and sun would have to be laid down like a
-measuring-rod, in order to cover the space separating
-us from the star: and the subsequent
-evaluation of this distance "earth to sun" in
-miles is another important problem in whose solution
-photography promises to be most useful.</p>
-
-<p>The above method of measuring stellar distance
-is, of course, subject to whatever slight uncertainty
-arises from the assumption that the small stars
-used for comparison are themselves beyond the
-possibility of parallactic shifting. But astronomy
-possesses no better method. Moreover,
-the number of small stars used in this way is, of
-course, much larger in photography than it ever
-can be in visual work. In the former process,
-all surrounding stars can be photographed at
-once; in the latter each star must be measured
-separately, and daylight soon intervenes to impose
-a limit on numbers. Usually only two can<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_98" id="Page_98">[98]</a></span>
-be used; so that here photography has a most
-important advantage. It minimizes the chance
-of our parallax being rendered erroneous, by the
-stars of comparison not being really infinitely
-remote. This might happen, perhaps, in the
-case of one or two; but with an average result
-from a large number we know it to be practically
-impossible.</p>
-
-<p>Cluster work is not altogether unlike "parallax
-hunting" in its preliminary stage of securing
-the photographic observations. The object is to
-obtain an absolutely faithful picture of a star
-group, just as it exists in the sky. We have
-every reason to suppose that a very large number
-of stars condensed into one small spot upon
-the heavens means something more than chance
-aggregation. The Pleiades group (<a href="#Page_10">page 10</a>) contains
-thousands of massive stars, doubtless held
-together by the force of their mutual gravitational
-attraction. If this be true, there must be
-complex orbital motion in the cluster; and, as
-time goes on, we should actually see the separate
-components change their relative positions,
-as it were, before our eyes. The details of such<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_99" id="Page_99">[99]</a></span>
-motion upon the great scale of cosmic space offer
-one of the many problems that make astronomy
-the grandest of human sciences.</p>
-
-<p>We have said that time must pass before we
-can see these things; there may be centuries of
-waiting. But one way exists to hurry on the
-perfection of our knowledge; we must increase
-the precision of observations. Motions that
-would need the growth of centuries to become
-visible to the older astronomical appliances,
-might yield in a few decades to more delicate
-observational processes. Here photography is
-most promising. Having once obtained a surpassingly
-accurate picture of a star-cluster, we
-can subject it easily to precise microscopic measurement.
-The same operations repeated at a
-later date will enable us to compare the two
-series of measures, and thus ascertain the motions
-that may have occurred in the interval.
-The Rutherfurd photographs furnish a veritable
-mine of information in researches of this kind;
-for they antedate all other celestial photographs
-of precision by at least a quarter-century, and
-bring just so much nearer the time when definite<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_100" id="Page_100">[100]</a></span>
-knowledge shall replace information based on
-reasoning from probabilities.</p>
-
-<p>Rutherfurd's methods showed the advantages
-of photography as applied to individual star-clusters.
-It required only the attention of some
-astronomer disposing of large observational facilities,
-and accustomed to operations upon a great
-scale, to apply similar methods throughout the
-whole heavens. In the year 1882 a bright
-comet was very conspicuous in the southern
-heavens. It was extensively observed from the
-southern hemisphere, and especially at the British
-Royal Observatory at the Cape of Good Hope.</p>
-
-<p>Gill, director of that institution, conceived the
-idea that this comet might be bright enough
-to photograph. At that time, comet photography
-had been attempted but little, if at all, and it
-was by no means sure that the experiment would
-be successful. Nor was Gill well acquainted with
-the work of Rutherfurd; for the best results of
-that astronomer had lain dormant many years.
-He was one of those men with whom personal
-modesty amounts to a fault. Loath to put himself
-forward in any way, and disliking to rush<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_101" id="Page_101">[101]</a></span>
-into print, Rutherfurd had given but little publicity
-to his work. This peculiarity has, doubtless,
-delayed his just reputation; but he will lose
-nothing in the end from a brief postponement.
-Gill must, however, be credited with more penetration
-than would be his due if Rutherfurd had
-made it possible for others to know that he had
-anticipated many of the newer ideas.</p>
-
-<p>However this may be, the comet was photographed
-with the help of a local portrait photographer
-named Allis. When Gill and Allis fastened
-a simple portrait camera belonging to the
-latter upon the tube of one of the Cape telescopes,
-and pointed it at the great comet, they
-little thought the experiment would lead to one
-of the greatest astronomical works ever attempted
-by men. Yet this was destined to occur.
-The negative they obtained showed an
-excellent picture of the comet; but what was
-more important for the future of sidereal astronomy,
-it was also quite thickly dotted with little
-black points corresponding to stars. The extraordinary
-ease with which the whole heavens
-could be thus charted photographically was<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_102" id="Page_102">[102]</a></span>
-brought home to Gill as never before. It was
-this comet picture that interested him in the application
-of photography to star-charting; and
-without his interest the now famous astro-photographic
-catalogue of the heavens would probably
-never have been made.</p>
-
-<p>After considerable preliminary correspondence,
-a congress of astronomers was finally called to
-meet at Paris in 1887. Representatives of the
-principal observatories and civilized governments
-were present. They decided that the end of the
-nineteenth century should see the making of a
-great catalogue of all the stars in the sky, upon a
-scale of completeness and precision surpassing
-anything previously attempted. It is impossible
-to exaggerate the importance of such a work;
-for upon our star-catalogues depends ultimately
-the entire structure of astronomical science.</p>
-
-<p>The work was far too vast for the powers of
-any observatory alone. Therefore, the whole
-sky, from pole to pole, was divided into eighteen
-belts or zones of approximately equal area; and
-each of these was assigned to a single observatory
-to be photographed. A series of telescopes<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_103" id="Page_103">[103]</a></span>
-was specially constructed, so that every part of
-the work should be done with the same type of
-instrument. As far as possible, an attempt was
-made to secure uniformity of methods, and particularly
-a uniform scale of precision. To cover
-the entire sky upon the plan proposed no less
-than 44,108 negatives are required; and most
-of these have now been finished. The further
-measurement of the pictures and the drawing up
-of a vast printed star-catalogue are also well under
-way. One of the participating observatories,
-that at Potsdam, Germany, has published the first
-volume of its part of the catalogue. It is estimated
-that this observatory alone will require
-twenty quarto volumes to contain merely the
-final results of its work on the catalogue. Altogether
-not less than two million stars will find a
-place in this, our latest directory of the heavens.</p>
-
-<p>Such wholesale methods of attacking problems
-of observational astronomy are particularly characteristic
-of photography. The great catalogue
-is, perhaps, the best illustration of this tendency;
-but of scarcely smaller interest, though less important
-in reality, is the photographic method of<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_104" id="Page_104">[104]</a></span>
-dealing with minor planets. We have already
-said (<a href="#Page_63">page 63</a>) that in the space between the orbits
-of Mars and Jupiter several hundred small bodies
-are moving around the sun in ordinary planetary
-orbits. These bodies are called asteroids, or
-minor planets. The visual method of discovering
-unknown members of this group was painfully
-tedious; but photography has changed
-matters completely, and has added immensely
-to our knowledge of the asteroids.</p>
-
-<p>Wolf, of Heidelberg, first made use of the
-new process for minor-planet discovery. His
-method is sufficiently ingenious to deserve brief
-mention again. A photograph of a suitable region
-of the sky was made with an exposure lasting
-two or three hours. Throughout all this
-time the instrument was manipulated so as to
-follow the motion of the heavens in the way we
-have already explained, so that each star would
-appear on the negative as a small, round, black
-dot.</p>
-
-<p>But if a minor planet happened to be in the
-region covered by the plate, its photographic
-image would be very different. For the orbital<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_105" id="Page_105">[105]</a></span>
-motion of the planet about the sun would make
-it move a little among the stars even in the two
-or three hours during which the plate was exposed.
-This motion would be faithfully reproduced
-in the picture, so that the planet would
-appear as a short curved line rather than a well-defined
-dot like a star. Thus the presence of
-such a line-image infallibly denotes an asteroid.</p>
-
-<p>Subsequent calculations are necessary to ascertain
-whether the object is a planet already known
-or a genuine new discovery. Wolf, and others
-using his method in recent years, have made immense
-additions to our catalogue of asteroids.
-Indeed, the matter was beginning to lose interest
-on account of the frequency and sameness
-of these discoveries, when the astronomical world
-was startled by the finding of the Planet of 1898.
-(<a href="#Page_58">Page 58</a>.)</p>
-
-<p>On August 27, 1898, Witt, of Berlin, discovered
-the small body that bears the number
-"433" in the list of minor planets, and has received
-the name Eros. Its important peculiarity
-consists in the exceptional position of the
-orbit. While all the other asteroids are farther<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_106" id="Page_106">[106]</a></span>
-from the sun than Mars, and less distant than
-Jupiter, Eros can pass within the orbit of the
-former. At times, therefore, it will approach
-our earth more closely than any other permanent
-member of the solar system, excepting our own
-moon. So it is, in a sense, our nearest neighbor;
-and this fact alone makes it the most interesting
-of all the minor planets. The nineteenth
-century was opened by Piazzi's well-known discovery
-of the first of these bodies (<a href="#Page_59">page 59</a>); it
-is, therefore, fitting that we should find the most
-important one at its close. We are almost certain
-that it will be possible to make use of Eros
-to solve with unprecedented accuracy the most
-important problem in all astronomy. This is the
-determination of our earth's distance from the sun.
-When considering stellar parallax, we have seen
-how our observations enable us to measure some
-of the stars' distances in terms of the distance
-"earth to sun" as a unit. It is, indeed, the fundamental
-unit for all astronomical measures, and
-its exact evaluation has always been considered
-the basal problem of astronomy. Astronomers
-know it as the problem of Solar Parallax.</p>
-
-<p><span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_107" id="Page_107">[107]</a></span></p>
-
-<p>We shall not here enter into the somewhat
-intricate details of this subject, however interesting
-they may be. The problem offers difficulties
-somewhat analogous to those confronting
-a surveyor who has to determine the distance of
-some inaccessible terrestrial point. To do this,
-it is necessary first to measure a "base-line," as
-we call it. Then the measurement of angles
-with a theodolite will make it possible to deduce
-the required distance of the inaccessible point by
-a process of calculation. To insure accuracy,
-however, as every surveyor knows, the base-line
-must be made long enough; and this is precisely
-what is impossible in the case of the solar
-parallax.</p>
-
-<p>For we are necessarily limited to marking
-out our base-line on the earth; and the entire
-planet is too small to furnish one of really sufficient
-size. The best we can do is to use the distance
-between two observatories situated, as near
-as may be, on opposite sides of the earth. But
-even this base is wofully small. However, the
-smallness loses some of its harmful effect if we
-operate upon a planet that is comparatively near<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_108" id="Page_108">[108]</a></span>
-us. We can measure such a planet's distance
-more accurately than any other; and this being
-known, the solar distance can be computed by
-the aid of mathematical considerations based
-upon Newton's law of gravitation and observational
-determinations of the planetary orbital
-elements.</p>
-
-<p>Photography is by no means limited to investigations
-in the older departments of astronomical
-observation. Its powerful arm has been
-stretched out to grasp as well the newer instruments
-of spectroscopic study. Here the sensitive
-plate has been substituted for the human
-eye with even greater relative advantage. The
-accurate microscopic measurement of difficult
-lines in stellar spectra was indeed possible by
-older methods; but photography has made it
-comparatively easy; and, above all, has rendered
-practicable series of observations extensive
-enough in numbers to furnish statistical information
-of real value. Only in this way have we
-been able to determine whether the stars, in their
-varied and unknown orbits, are approaching us
-or moving farther away. Even the speed of this
-<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_109" id="Page_109">[109]</a></span>approach or recession has become measurable,
-and has been evaluated in the case of many individual
-stars. (See <a href="#Page_21">page 21</a>.)</p>
-
-<div class="figcenter">
-<a name="P_108" id="P_108"></a>
-<br />
-<img src="images/i_108fp.jpg" width="550" alt="" />
-<div class="caption">
-Solar Corona. Total Eclipse.<br />
-<span class="fs80">Photographed by Campbell, January 22, 1898; Jeur, India.</span></div>
-</div>
-
-<p>The subject of solar physics has become a veritable
-department of astronomy in the hands of
-photographic investigators. Ingenious spectro-photographic
-methods have been devised, whereby
-we have secured pictures of the sun from
-which we have learned much that must have
-remained forever unknown to older methods.</p>
-
-<p>Especially useful has photography proved itself
-in the observation of total solar eclipses. It is
-only when the sun's bright disk is completely
-obscured by the interposed moon that we can see
-the faintly luminous structure of the solar corona,
-that great appendage of our sun, whose
-exact nature is still unexplained. Only during
-the few minutes of total eclipse in each century
-can we look upon it; and keen is the interest of
-astronomers when those few minutes occur. But
-it is found that eye observations made in hurried
-excitement have comparatively little value.
-Half a dozen persons might make drawings of
-the corona during the same eclipse, yet they<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_110" id="Page_110">[110]</a></span>
-would differ so much from one another as to
-leave the true outline very much in doubt. But
-with photography we can obtain a really correct
-picture whose details can be studied and discussed
-subsequently at leisure.</p>
-
-<p>If we were asked to sum up in one word what
-photography has accomplished, we should say
-that observational astronomy has been revolutionized.
-There is to-day scarcely an instrument
-of precision in which the sensitive plate
-has not been substituted for the human eye;
-scarcely an inquiry possible to the older method
-which cannot now be undertaken upon a grander
-scale. Novel investigations formerly not even
-possible are now entirely practicable by photography;
-and the end is not yet. Valuable as are
-the achievements already consummated, photography
-is richest in its promise for the future.
-Astronomy has been called the "perfect science";
-it is safe to predict that the next generation
-will wonder that the knowledge we have
-to-day should ever have received so proud a
-title.</p>
-
-
-<hr class="chap" />
-<p><span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_111" id="Page_111">[111]</a></span></p>
-
-<h2><a name="TIME_STANDARDS_OF_THE" id="TIME_STANDARDS_OF_THE">TIME STANDARDS OF THE
-WORLD</a></h2>
-
-
-<p>The question is often asked, "What is the
-practical use of astronomy?" We know, of
-course, that men would profit greatly from a study
-of that science, even if it could not be turned to
-any immediate bread-and-butter use; for astronomy
-is essentially the science of big things, and it
-makes men bigger to fix their minds on problems
-that deal with vast distances and seemingly endless
-periods of time. No one can look upon the
-quietly shining stars without being impressed by
-the thought of how they burned&mdash;then as now&mdash;before
-he himself was born, and so shall continue
-after he has passed away&mdash;aye, even after his latest
-descendants shall have vanished from the
-earth. Of all the sciences, astronomy is at once
-the most beautiful poetically, and yet the one
-offering the grandest and most difficult problems
-to the intellect. A study of these problems has<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_112" id="Page_112">[112]</a></span>
-ever been a labor of love to the greatest minds;
-their solution has been counted justly among
-man's loftiest achievements.</p>
-
-<p>And yet of all the difficult and abstruse sciences,
-astronomy is, perhaps, the one that comes into the
-ordinary practical daily life of the people more
-definitely and frequently than any other. There
-exist at least three things we owe to astronomy
-that must be regarded as quite indispensable,
-from a purely practical point of view. In the first
-place, let us consider the maps in a work on geography.
-How many people ever think to ask
-how these maps are made? It is true that the
-ordinary processes of the surveyor would enable
-us to draw a map showing the outlines of a part of
-the earth's surface. Even the locations of towns
-and rivers might be marked in this way. But one
-of the most important things of all could not be
-added without the aid of astronomical observations.
-The latitude and longitude lines, which are
-essential to show the relation of the map to the
-rest of the earth, we owe to astronomy. The longitude
-lines, particularly, as we shall see farther on,
-play a most important part in the subject of time.</p>
-
-<p><span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_113" id="Page_113">[113]</a></span></p>
-
-<p>The second indispensable application of astronomy
-to ordinary business affairs relates to the
-subject of navigation. How do ships find their
-way across the ocean? There are no permanent
-marks on the sea, as there are on the land, by
-which the navigator can guide his course. Nevertheless,
-seamen know their path over the trackless
-ocean with a certainty as unerring as would
-be possible on shore; and it is all done by the
-help of astronomy. The navigator's observations
-of the sun are astronomical observations;
-the tables he uses in calculating his observations&mdash;the
-tables that tell him just where he is and in what
-direction he must go&mdash;are astronomical tables.
-Indeed, it is not too much to say that without
-astronomy there could be no safe ocean navigation.</p>
-
-<p>But the third application of astronomy is of
-still greater importance in our daily life&mdash;the furnishing
-of correct time standards for all sorts of
-purposes. It is to this practical use of astronomical
-science that we would direct particular attention.
-Few persons ever think of the complicated
-machinery that must be put in motion in
-order to set a clock. A man forgets some even<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_114" id="Page_114">[114]</a></span>ing
-to wind his watch at the accustomed hour.
-The next morning he finds it run down. It
-must be re-set. Most people simply go to the
-nearest clock, or ask some friend for the time, so
-as to start the watch correctly. More careful persons,
-perhaps, visit the jeweller's and take the
-time from his "regulator." But the regulator
-itself needs to be regulated. After all, it is nothing
-more than any other clock, except that greater
-care has been taken in the mechanical construction
-and arrangement of its various parts. Yet it is
-but a machine built by human hands, and, like
-all human works, it is necessarily imperfect. No
-matter how well it has been constructed, it will
-not run with perfectly rigid accuracy. Every day
-there will be a variation from the true time by a
-small amount, and in the course of days or weeks
-the accumulation of these successive small amounts
-will lead to a total of quite appreciable size.</p>
-
-<p>Just as the ordinary citizen looks to the jeweller's
-regulator to correct his watch, so the jeweller
-applies to the astronomer for the correction of his
-regulator. Ever since the dawn of astronomy, in
-the earliest ages of which we have any record, the<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_115" id="Page_115">[115]</a></span>
-principal duty of the astronomer has been the furnishing
-of accurate time to the people. We shall
-not here enter into a detailed account, however interesting
-it would be, of the gradual development
-by which the very perfect system at present in
-use has been reached; but shall content ourselves
-with a description of the methods now employed
-in nearly all the civilized countries of the world.</p>
-
-<p>In the first place, every observatory is, of course,
-provided with what is known as an astronomical
-clock. This instrument, from the astronomer's
-point of view, is something very different from
-the ordinary popular idea. To the average person
-an astronomical clock is a complicated and
-elaborate affair, giving the date, day of the week,
-phases of the moon, and other miscellaneous information.
-But in reality the astronomer wants
-none of these things. His one and only requirement
-is that the clock shall keep as near uniform
-time as may be possible to a machine constructed
-by human hands. No expense is spared in making
-the standard clock for an observatory. Real
-artists in mechanical construction&mdash;men who have
-attained a world-wide celebrity for delicate skill<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_116" id="Page_116">[116]</a></span>
-in fashioning the parts of a clock&mdash;such are the
-astronomer's clock-makers.</p>
-
-<p>To increase precision of motion in the train of
-wheels, it is necessary that the mechanism be as
-simple as possible. For this reason all complications
-of date, etc., are left out. We have even
-abandoned the usual convenient plan of having
-the hour and minute hands mounted at the same
-centre; for this kind of mounting makes necessary
-a slightly more intricate form of wheelwork.
-The astronomer's clock usually has the centres
-of the second hand, minute hand, and hour hand
-in a straight line, and equally distant from each
-other. Each hand has its own dial; all drawn,
-of course, upon the same clock-face.</p>
-
-<p>Even after such a clock has been made as accurately
-as possible, it will, nevertheless, not give
-the very best performance unless it is taken care
-of properly. It is necessary to mount it very
-firmly indeed. It should not be fastened to an
-ordinary wall, but a strong pier of masonry or
-brick must be built for it on a very solid foundation.
-Moreover, this pier is best placed underground
-in a cellar, so that the temperature of the<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_117" id="Page_117">[117]</a></span>
-clock can be kept nearly uniform all the year
-round; for we find that clocks do not run quite
-the same in hot weather as they do in cold.
-Makers have, indeed, tried to guard against this
-effect of temperature, by ingenious mechanical
-contrivances. But these are never quite perfect
-in their action, and it is best not to test them too
-severely by exposing the clock to sharp changes
-of heat and cold.</p>
-
-<p>Another thing affecting the going of fine
-clocks, strange as it may seem, is the variation of
-barometric pressure. There is a slight but noticeable
-difference in their running when the
-barometer is high and when it is low. To prevent
-this, some of our best clocks have been enclosed
-in air-tight cases, so that outside barometric
-changes may not be felt in the least by the clock
-itself.</p>
-
-<p>But even after all this has been accomplished,
-and the astronomer is in possession of a clock that
-may be called a masterpiece of mechanical construction,
-he is not any better off than was the
-jeweller with his regulator. After all, even the
-astronomical clock needs to be set, and its error<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_118" id="Page_118">[118]</a></span>
-must be determined from time to time. A
-final appeal must then be had to astronomical
-observations. The clock must be set by the
-stars and sun. For this purpose the astronomer
-uses an instrument called a "transit." This is
-simply a telescope of moderate size, possibly five
-or six feet long, and firmly attached to an axis at
-right angles to the tube of the telescope.</p>
-
-<p>This axis is supported horizontally in such a
-way that it points as nearly as may be exactly
-east and west. The telescope itself being square
-with the axis, always points in a north-and-south
-direction. It is possible to rotate the telescope
-about its axis so as to reach all parts of the sky
-that are directly north or south of the observatory.
-In the field of view of the telescope certain
-very fine threads are mounted so as to form
-a little cross. As the telescope is rotated this
-cross traces out, as it were, a great circle on the
-sky; and this great circle is called the astronomical
-meridian.</p>
-
-<p>Now we are in possession of certain star-tables,
-computed from the combined observations of
-astronomers in the last 150 years. These tables<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_119" id="Page_119">[119]</a></span>
-tell us the exact moment of time when any star
-is on the meridian. To discover, therefore,
-whether our clock is right on any given night, it
-is merely necessary to watch a star with the telescope,
-and note the exact instant by the clock
-when it reaches the little cross in the field of
-view. Knowing from the astronomical tables the
-time when the star ought to have been on the
-meridian, and having observed the clock time
-when it is actually there, the difference is, of
-course, the error of the clock. The result can
-be checked by observations of other stars, and
-the slight personal errors of observation can be
-rendered harmless by taking the mean from several
-stars. By an hour's work on a fine night it
-is possible to fix the clock error quite easily
-within the one-twentieth part of a second.</p>
-
-<p>We have not space to enter into the interesting
-details of the methods by which the astronomical
-transit is accurately set in the right
-position, and how any slight residual error in
-its setting can be eliminated from our results by
-certain processes of computation. It must suffice
-to say that practically all time determinations in<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_120" id="Page_120">[120]</a></span>
-the observatory depend substantially upon the
-procedure outlined above.</p>
-
-<p>The observatory clock having been once set
-right by observations of the sky, its error can be
-re-determined every few days quite easily. Thus
-even the small irregularities of its nearly perfect
-mechanism can be prevented from accumulating
-until they might reach a harmful magnitude.
-But we obtain in this way only a correct standard
-of time within the observatory itself. How can
-this be made available for the general public?
-The problem is quite simple with the aid of the
-electric telegraph. We shall give a brief account
-of the methods now in use in New York City,
-and these may be taken as essentially representative
-of those employed elsewhere.</p>
-
-<p>Every day, at noon precisely, an electric signal
-is sent out by the United States Naval Observatory
-in Washington. The signal is regulated by
-the standard clock of the observatory, of course
-taking account of star observations made on the
-next preceding fine night. This signal is received
-in the central New York office of the telegraph
-company, where it is used to keep correct<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_121" id="Page_121">[121]</a></span>
-a very fine clock, which may be called the time
-standard of the telegraph company. This clock,
-in turn, has automatic electric connections, by
-means of which it is made to send out signals
-over what are called "time wires" that go all
-over the city. Jewellers, and others who desire
-correct time, can arrange to have a small electric
-sounder in their offices connected with the time
-wires. Thus the ticks of the telegraph company's
-standard clock are repeated automatically
-in the jeweller's shop, and used for controlling
-the exactness of his regulator. This, in brief, is
-the method by which the astronomer's careful
-determination of correct time is transferred and
-distributed to the people at large.</p>
-
-<p>Having thus outlined the manner of obtaining
-and distributing correct time, we shall now consider
-the question of time differences between different
-places on the earth. This is a matter which many
-persons find most perplexing, and yet it is essentially
-quite simple in principle. Travellers, of course,
-are well acquainted with the fact that their watches
-often need to be reset when they arrive at their
-destination. Yet few ever stop to ask the cause.</p>
-
-<p><span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_122" id="Page_122">[122]</a></span></p>
-
-<p>Let us consider for a moment our method of
-measuring time. We go by the sun. If we leave
-out of account some small irregularities of the sun's
-motion that are of no consequence for our present
-purpose, we may lay down this fundamental principle:
-When the sun reaches its highest position
-in the sky it is twelve o'clock or noon.</p>
-
-<p>The sun, as everyone knows, rises each morning
-in the east, slowly goes up higher and higher
-in the sky, and at last begins to descend again
-toward the west. But it is clear that as the sun
-travels from east to west, it must pass over the
-eastern one of any two cities sooner than the
-western one. When it reaches its greatest height
-over a western city it has, therefore, already passed
-its greatest height over an eastern one. In other
-words, when it is noon, or twelve o'clock, in the
-western city, it is already after noon in the eastern
-city. This is the simple and evident cause of
-time differences in different parts of the country.
-Of any two places the eastern one always has later
-time than the western. When we consider the
-matter in this way there is not the slightest difficulty
-in understanding how time differences arise.<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_123" id="Page_123">[123]</a></span>
-They will, of course, be greatest for places that
-are very far apart in an east-and-west direction.
-And this brings us again to the subject of longitude,
-which, as we have already said, plays an
-important part in all questions relating to time;
-for longitude is used to measure the distance in
-an east-and-west direction between different parts
-of the earth.</p>
-
-<p>If we consider the earth as a large ball we can
-imagine a series of great circles drawn on its surface
-and passing directly from the North Pole to the
-South Pole. Such a circle could be drawn through
-any point on the earth. If we imagine a pair of
-them drawn through two cities, such as New York
-and London, the longitude difference of these two
-cities is defined as the angle at the North Pole between
-the two great circles in question. The size
-of this angle can be expressed in degrees. If we
-then wish to know the difference in time between
-New York and London in hours, we need only
-divide their longitude difference in degrees by the
-number 15. In this simple way we can get the
-time difference of any two places. We merely
-measure the longitude difference on a map, and<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_124" id="Page_124">[124]</a></span>
-then divide by 15 to get the time difference.
-These time differences can sometimes become
-quite large. Indeed, for two places differing 180
-degrees in longitude, the time difference will evidently
-be no less than twelve hours.</p>
-
-<p>Most civilized nations have agreed informally
-to adopt some one city as the fundamental point
-from which all longitudes are to be counted. Up
-to the present we have considered only longitude
-differences; but when we speak of the longitude
-of a city we mean its longitude difference from
-the place chosen by common consent as the origin
-for measuring longitudes. The town almost
-universally used for this purpose is Greenwich,
-near London, England. Here is situated the
-British Royal Observatory, one of the oldest and
-most important institutions of its kind in the
-world. The great longitude circle passing through
-the centre of the astronomical transit at the Greenwich
-observatory is the fundamental longitude
-circle of the earth. The longitude of any other
-town is then simply the angle at the pole between
-the longitude circle through that town and the
-fundamental Greenwich one here described.</p>
-
-<p><span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_125" id="Page_125">[125]</a></span></p>
-
-<p>Longitudes are counted both eastward and
-westward from Greenwich. Thus New York is
-in 74 degrees west longitude, while Berlin is in
-14 degrees east longitude. This has led to a
-rather curious state of affairs in those parts of the
-earth the longitudes of which are nearly 180
-degrees east or west. There are a number of
-islands in that part of the world, and if we imagine
-for a moment one whose longitude is just 180 degrees,
-we shall have the following remarkable result
-as to its time difference from Greenwich.</p>
-
-<p>We have seen that of any two places the eastern
-always has the later time. Now, since our imaginary
-island is exactly 180 degrees from Greenwich,
-we can consider it as being either 180 degrees
-east or 180 degrees west. But if we call it
-180 degrees east, its time will be twelve hours
-later than Greenwich, and if we call it 180 degrees
-west, its time will be twelve hours earlier than
-Greenwich. Evidently there will be a difference
-of just twenty-four hours, or one whole day, between
-these two possible ways of reckoning its
-time. This circumstance has actually led to considerable
-confusion in some of the islands of the<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_126" id="Page_126">[126]</a></span>
-Pacific Ocean. The navigators who discovered
-the various islands naturally gave them the date
-which they brought from Europe. And as some
-of these navigators sailed eastward, around the
-Cape of Good Hope, and others westward, around
-Cape Horn, the dates they gave to the several
-islands differed by just one day.</p>
-
-<p>The state of affairs at the present time has
-been adjusted by a sort of informal agreement.
-An arbitrary line has been drawn on the map
-near the 180th longitude circle, and it has been
-decided that the islands on the east side of this
-line shall count their longitudes west from Greenwich,
-and those west of the line shall count longitude
-east from Greenwich. Thus Samoa is
-nearly 180 degrees west of Greenwich, while the
-Fiji Islands are nearly 180 degrees east. Yet the
-islands are very near each other, though the arbitrary
-line passes between them. As a result,
-when it is Sunday in Samoa it is Monday in the
-Fiji Islands. The arbitrary line described here
-is sometimes called the International Date-Line.</p>
-
-<p>It does not pass very near the Philippine
-Islands, which are situated in about 120 degrees<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_127" id="Page_127">[127]</a></span>
-east longitude, and, therefore, use a time about
-eight hours later than Greenwich. New York,
-being about 74 degrees west of Greenwich, is
-about five hours earlier in time. Consequently,
-as we may remark in passing, Philippine time is
-about thirteen hours later than New York time.
-Thus, five o'clock, Sunday morning, May 1st,
-in Manila, would correspond to four o'clock,
-Saturday afternoon, April 30th, in New York.</p>
-
-<p>There is another kind of time which we shall explain
-briefly&mdash;the so-called "standard," or railroad
-time, which came into general use in the United
-States some few years ago, and has since been
-generally adopted throughout the world. It requires
-but a few moments' consideration to see
-that the accidental situation of the different large
-cities in any country will cause their local times
-to differ by odd numbers of hours, minutes, and
-seconds. Thus a great deal of inconvenience
-has been caused in the past. For instance, a
-train might leave New York at a certain hour by
-New York time. It would then arrive in Buffalo
-some hours later by New York time. But
-it would leave Buffalo by Buffalo time, which is<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_128" id="Page_128">[128]</a></span>
-quite different. Thus there would be a sort of
-jump in the time-table at Buffalo, and it would
-be a jump of an odd number of minutes.</p>
-
-<p>It would be different in different cities, and very
-hard to remember. Indeed, as each railway usually
-ran its trains by the time used in the principal
-city along its line, it might happen that three
-or four different railroad times would be used in
-a single city where several roads met. This has
-all been avoided by introducing the standard
-time system. According to this the whole country
-is divided into a series of time zones, fifteen
-degrees wide, and so arranged that the middle
-line of each zone falls at a point whose longitude
-from Greenwich is 60, 75, 90, 105, or 120 degrees.
-The times at these middle lines are,
-therefore, earlier than Greenwich time by an
-even number of hours. Thus, for instance, the
-75-degree line is just five even hours earlier than
-Greenwich time. All cities simply use the time
-of the nearest one of these special lines.</p>
-
-<p>This does not result in doing away with time
-differences altogether&mdash;that would, of course, be
-impossible in the nature of things&mdash;but for the<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_129" id="Page_129">[129]</a></span>
-complicated odd differences in hours and minutes,
-we have substituted the infinitely simpler series
-of differences in even hours. The traveller from
-Chicago to New York can reset his watch by
-putting it just one hour later on his arrival&mdash;the
-minute hand is kept unchanged, and no New
-York timepiece need be consulted to set the
-watch right on arriving. There can be no doubt
-that this standard-time system must be considered
-one of the most important contributions of
-astronomical science to the convenience of man.</p>
-
-<p>Its value has received the widest recognition,
-and its use has now extended to almost all civilized
-countries&mdash;France is the only nation of importance
-still remaining outside the time-zone
-system. In the following table we give the
-standard time of the various parts of the earth as
-compared with Greenwich, together with the date
-of adopting the new time system. It will be
-noticed that in certain cases even half-hours have
-been employed to separate the time-zones, instead
-of even hours as used in the United States.</p>
-
-<p><span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_130" id="Page_130">[130]</a></span></p>
-
-
-<p class="p2 pfs100">TABLE OF THE WORLD'S TIME STANDARDS</p>
-
-<div class="center">
-<br />
-<table border="0" cellpadding="4" cellspacing="0" width="95%" summary="">
-<tr><td class="tdlbt" colspan="4"></td></tr>
-<tr class="fs80"><td class="tdc">When it is Noon<br />at Greenwich<br />it is<br />&nbsp;</td><td class="tdlbl pad6"><br />In</td>
- <td class="tdlbl tdlbr wd1"></td><td class="tdc">Date of Adopting<br />Standard Time<br />System.<br />&nbsp;</td></tr>
-<tr><td class="tdlbt" colspan="2"></td><td class="tdlbl tdlbr"></td><td class="tdlbt"></td></tr>
-<tr><td class="tdl pad3">Noon</td><td class="tdlbl pad4">Great Britain.</td><td class="tdlbl tdlbr"></td></tr>
-<tr><td class="tdl"></td><td class="tdlbl pad4">Belgium.</td><td class="tdlbl tdlbr"></td><td class="tdl">May, 1892.</td></tr>
-<tr><td class="tdl"></td><td class="tdlbl pad4">Holland.</td><td class="tdlbl tdlbr"></td><td class="tdl">May, 1892.</td></tr>
-<tr><td class="tdl"></td><td class="tdlbl pad4">Spain.</td><td class="tdlbl tdlbr"></td><td class="tdl">January, 1901.</td></tr>
-<tr><td class="tdl">&nbsp;1 <span class="fs70">P.M.</span></td><td class="tdlbl pad4">Germany.</td><td class="tdlbl tdlbr"></td><td class="tdl">April, 1893.</td></tr>
-<tr><td class="tdl"></td><td class="tdlbl pad4">Italy.</td><td class="tdlbl tdlbr"></td><td class="tdl">November, 1893.</td></tr>
-<tr><td class="tdl"></td><td class="tdlbl pad4">Denmark.</td><td class="tdlbl tdlbr"></td><td class="tdl">January, 1894.</td></tr>
-<tr><td class="tdl"></td><td class="tdlbl pad4">Switzerland.</td><td class="tdlbl tdlbr"></td><td class="tdl">June, 1894.</td></tr>
-<tr><td class="tdl"></td><td class="tdlbl pad4">Norway.</td><td class="tdlbl tdlbr"></td><td class="tdl">January, 1895.</td></tr>
-<tr><td class="tdl"></td><td class="tdlbl pad4">Austria (railways).</td><td class="tdlbl tdlbr"></td></tr>
-<tr><td class="tdl">&nbsp;1.30 <span class="fs70">P.M.</span></td><td class="tdlbl pad4">Cape Colony.</td><td class="tdlbl tdlbr"></td><td class="tdl">1892.</td></tr>
-<tr><td class="tdl"></td><td class="tdlbl pad4">Orange River Colony.</td><td class="tdlbl tdlbr"></td><td class="tdl">1892.</td></tr>
-<tr><td class="tdl"></td><td class="tdlbl pad4">Transvaal.</td><td class="tdlbl tdlbr"></td><td class="tdl">1892.</td></tr>
-<tr><td class="tdl">&nbsp;2 <span class="fs70">P.M.</span></td><td class="tdlbl pad4">Natal.</td><td class="tdlbl tdlbr"></td><td class="tdl">September, 1895.</td></tr>
-<tr><td class="tdl"></td><td class="tdlbl pad4">Turkey (railways).</td><td class="tdlbl tdlbr"></td></tr>
-<tr><td class="tdl"></td><td class="tdlbl pad4">Egypt.</td><td class="tdlbl tdlbr"></td><td class="tdl">October, 1900.</td></tr>
-<tr><td class="tdl">&nbsp;8 <span class="fs70">P.M.</span></td><td class="tdlbl pad4">West Australia.</td><td class="tdlbl tdlbr"></td><td class="tdl">February, 1895.</td></tr>
-<tr><td class="tdl">&nbsp;9 <span class="fs70">P.M.</span></td><td class="tdlbl pad4">Japan.</td><td class="tdlbl tdlbr"></td><td class="tdl">1896.</td></tr>
-<tr><td class="tdl">&nbsp;9.30 <span class="fs70">P.M.</span></td><td class="tdlbl pad4">South Australia.</td><td class="tdlbl tdlbr"></td><td class="tdl">May, 1899.</td></tr>
-<tr><td class="tdl">10 <span class="fs70">P.M.</span></td><td class="tdlbl pad4">Victoria.</td><td class="tdlbl tdlbr"></td><td class="tdl">February, 1895.</td></tr>
-<tr><td class="tdl"></td><td class="tdlbl pad4">New South Wales.</td><td class="tdlbl tdlbr"></td><td class="tdl">February, 1895.</td></tr>
-<tr><td class="tdl"></td><td class="tdlbl pad4">Queensland.</td><td class="tdlbl tdlbr"></td><td class="tdl">February, 1895.</td></tr>
-<tr><td class="tdl">11 <span class="fs70">P.M.</span></td><td class="tdlbl pad4">New Zealand.</td><td class="tdlbl tdlbr"></td></tr>
-<tr><td class="tdl">&nbsp;</td><td class="tdlbl pad4"></td><td class="tdlbl tdlbr"></td></tr>
-<tr><td class="tdlbt" colspan="4"></td></tr>
-</table><br /></div>
-
-<div class="center">
-<table border="0" cellpadding="4" cellspacing="0" width="80%" summary="">
-<tr><td class="tdl" colspan="7">In the United States and Canada it is</td></tr>
-<tr><td class="tdl pad3">4&nbsp;<span class="fs70">A.M.</span>&nbsp;by</td><td class="tdl" colspan="2">Pacific&nbsp;Time</td><td class="tdc">when</td><td class="tdc">it&nbsp;is</td><td class="tdc">Noon</td><td class="tdc">at</td><td class="tdc">Greenwich.</td></tr>
-<tr><td class="tdl pad3">5 <span class="fs70">A.M.</span> &nbsp;"</td><td class="tdl">Mountain</td><td class="tdc">"</td><td class="tdc">"</td><td class="tdc">"</td><td class="tdc">"</td><td class="tdc">"</td><td class="tdc">"</td></tr>
-<tr><td class="tdl pad3">6 <span class="fs70">A.M.</span> &nbsp;"</td><td class="tdl">Central</td><td class="tdc">"</td><td class="tdc">"</td><td class="tdc">"</td><td class="tdc">"</td><td class="tdc">"</td><td class="tdc">"</td></tr>
-<tr><td class="tdl pad3">7 <span class="fs70">A.M.</span> &nbsp;"</td><td class="tdl">Eastern</td><td class="tdc">"</td><td class="tdc">"</td><td class="tdc">"</td><td class="tdc">"</td><td class="tdc">"</td><td class="tdc">"</td></tr>
-<tr><td class="tdl pad3">8 <span class="fs70">A.M.</span> &nbsp;"</td><td class="tdl">Colonial</td><td class="tdc">"</td><td class="tdc">"</td><td class="tdc">"</td><td class="tdc">"</td><td class="tdc">"</td><td class="tdc">"</td></tr>
-</table><br /></div>
-
-
-<hr class="chap" />
-<p><span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_131" id="Page_131">[131]</a></span></p>
-
-<h2><a name="MOTIONS_OF_THE_EARTHS_POLE" id="MOTIONS_OF_THE_EARTHS_POLE"></a><a href="#CONTENTS">MOTIONS OF THE EARTH'S POLE</a></h2>
-
-
-<p>Students of geology have been puzzled for
-many years by traces remaining from the period
-when a large part of the earth was covered with a
-heavy cap of ice. These shreds of evidence all
-seem to point to the conclusion that the centre of
-the ice-covered region was quite far away from
-the present position of the north pole of the earth.
-If we are to regard the pole as very near the
-point of greatest cold, it becomes a matter of
-much interest to examine whether the pole has
-always occupied its present position, or whether
-it has been subject to slow changes of place upon
-the earth's surface. Therefore, the geologists
-have appealed to astronomers to discover whether
-they are in possession of any observational evidence
-tending to show that the pole is in motion.</p>
-
-<p>Now we may say at once that astronomical research
-has not as yet revealed the evidence thus
-expected. Astronomy has been unable to come<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_132" id="Page_132">[132]</a></span>
-to the rescue of geological theory. From about
-the year 1750, which saw the beginning of precise
-observation in the modern sense, down to very
-recent times, astronomers were compelled to deny
-the possibility of any appreciable motion of the
-pole. Observational processes, it is true, furnished
-slightly divergent pole positions from time
-to time. Yet these discrepancies were always so
-minute as to be indistinguishable from those slight
-personal errors that are ever inseparable from results
-obtained by the fallible human eye.</p>
-
-<p>But in the last few years improved methods of
-observation, coupled with extreme diligence in
-their application by astronomers generally, have
-brought to light a certain small motion of the
-pole which had never before been demonstrated
-in a reliable way. This motion, it is true, is not
-of the character demanded by geological theory,
-for the geologists had been led to expect a motion
-which would be continuous in the same direction,
-no matter how slow might be its annual amount;
-for the vast extent of geologic time would give
-even the slowest of motions an opportunity to
-produce large effects, provided its results could<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_133" id="Page_133">[133]</a></span>
-be continuously cumulative. Given time enough,
-and the pole might move anywhere on the earth,
-no matter how slow might be its tortoise speed.</p>
-
-<p>But the small motion we have discovered is
-neither cumulative nor continuous in one direction.
-It is what we call a periodic motion, the
-pole swinging now to one side, and now to the
-other, of its mean or average position. Thus
-this new discovery cannot be said to unravel the
-mysterious puzzle of the geologists. Yet it is
-not without the keenest interest, even from their
-point of view; for the proof of any form of
-motion in a pole previously supposed to be absolutely
-at rest may mean everything. No man
-can say what results will be revealed by the further
-observations now being continued with great
-diligence.</p>
-
-<p>In the first place, it is important to explain that
-any such motions as we have under consideration
-will show themselves to ordinary observational
-processes principally in the form of changes
-of terrestrial latitudes. Let us imagine a pair of
-straight lines passing through the centre of the
-earth and terminating, one at the observer's sta<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_134" id="Page_134">[134]</a></span>tion
-on the earth's surface, and the other at that
-point of the equator which is nearest the observer.
-Then, according to the ordinary definition of latitude,
-the angle between these two imaginary lines
-is called the latitude of the point of observation.
-Now we know, of course, that the equator is
-everywhere just 90 degrees from the pole. Consequently,
-if the pole is subject to any motion at
-all, the equator must also partake of the motion.</p>
-
-<p>Thus the angle between our two imaginary lines
-will be affected directly by polar movement, and
-the latitude obtained by astronomical observation
-will be subject to quite similar changes. To clear
-up the whole question, so far as this can be done
-by the gathering of observational evidence, it is
-only necessary to keep up a continual series of
-latitude determinations at several observatories.
-These determinations should show small variations
-similar in magnitude to the wabblings of the
-pole.</p>
-
-<p>Let us now consider for a moment what is
-meant by the axis of the earth. It has long been
-known that the planet has in general the shape of
-a ball or sphere. That this is so can be seen at<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_135" id="Page_135">[135]</a></span>
-once from the way ships at sea disappear at the
-horizon. As they go farther and farther from us,
-we first lose sight of the hull, and then slowly
-and gradually the spars and sails seem to sink
-down into the ocean. This proves that the
-earth's surface is curved. That it is more or less
-like a sphere is evident from the fact that it always
-casts a round shadow in eclipses. Sometimes the
-earth passes between the sun and eclipsed moon.
-Then we see the earth's black shadow projected
-on the moon, which would otherwise be quite
-bright. This shadow has been observed in a very
-large number of such eclipses, and it has always
-been found to have a circular edge.</p>
-
-<p>While, therefore, the earth is nearly a round
-ball, it must not be supposed that it is exactly
-spherical in form. We may disregard the small
-irregularities of its surface, for even the greatest
-mountains are insignificant in height when compared
-with the entire diameter of the earth itself.
-But even leaving these out of account, the earth is
-not perfectly spherical. We can describe it best
-as a flattened sphere. It is as though one were
-to press a round rubber ball between two smooth<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_136" id="Page_136">[136]</a></span>
-boards. It would be flattened at the top and
-bottom and bulged out in the middle. This is
-the shape of the earth. It is flattened at the
-poles and bulges out near the equator. The
-shortest straight line that can be drawn through
-the earth's centre and terminated by the flattened
-parts of its surface may be called the earth's axis
-of figure; and the two points where this axis
-meets the surface are called the poles of figure.</p>
-
-<p>But the earth has another axis, called the axis
-of rotation. This is the one about which the
-planet turns once in a day, giving rise to the well-known
-phenomena called the rising and setting of
-sun, moon, and stars. For these motions of the
-heavenly bodies are really only apparent ones,
-caused by an actual motion of the observer on
-the earth. The observer turns with the earth on
-its axis, and is thus carried past the sun and stars.</p>
-
-<p>This daily turning of the earth, then, takes
-place about the axis of rotation. Now, it so happens
-that all kinds of astronomical observations
-for the determination of latitude lead to values
-based on the rotation axis of the earth, and not
-on its axis of figure. We have seen how the<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_137" id="Page_137">[137]</a></span>
-earth's equator, from which we count our latitudes,
-is everywhere 90 degrees distant from the
-pole. But this pole is the pole of rotation, or
-the point at which the rotation axis pierces the
-earth's surface. It is not the pole of figure.</p>
-
-<p>It is clear that the latitude of any observatory
-will remain constant only if the pole of
-figure and the rotation pole maintain absolutely
-the same positions relatively one to the other.
-These two poles are actually very near together;
-indeed, it was supposed for a very long time that
-they were absolutely coincident, so that there could
-not be any variations of latitude. But it now
-appears that they are separated slightly.</p>
-
-<p>Strange to say, one of them is revolving
-about the other in a little curve. The pole of
-figure is travelling around the pole of rotation.
-The distance between them varies a little, never
-becoming greater than about fifty feet, and it
-takes about fourteen months to complete a revolution.
-There are some slight irregularities in
-the motion, but, in the main, it takes place in the
-manner here stated. In consequence of this rotation
-of the one pole about the other, the pole<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_138" id="Page_138">[138]</a></span>
-of figure is now on one side of the rotation pole
-and now on the opposite side, but it never travels
-continuously in one direction. Thus, as we have
-already seen, the sort of continuous motion required
-to explain the observed geological phenomena
-has not yet been found by astronomers.</p>
-
-<p>Observations for the study of latitude variations
-have been made very extensively within
-recent years both in Europe and the United
-States. It has been found practically most advantageous
-to carry out simultaneous series of
-observations at two observatories situated in
-widely different parts of the earth, but having
-very nearly the same latitude. It is then possible
-to employ the same stars for observation in
-both places, whereas it would be necessary to
-use different sets of stars if there were much
-difference in the latitudes.</p>
-
-<p>There is a special advantage in using the same
-stars in both places. We can then determine
-the small difference in latitude between the two
-participating observatories in a manner which will
-make it quite free from any uncertainty in our
-knowledge of the positions on the sky of the<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_139" id="Page_139">[139]</a></span>
-stars observed; for, strange as it may seem, our
-star-catalogues do not contain absolutely accurate
-numbers. Like all other data depending on
-fallible human observation, they are affected with
-small errors. But if we can determine simply
-the difference in latitude of the two observatories,
-we can discover from its variation the path in
-which the pole is moving. If, for instance, the
-observatories are separated by one-quarter the
-circumference of the globe, the pole will be moving
-directly toward one of them, when it is not
-changing its distance from the other one at all.</p>
-
-<p>This method was used for seven years with good
-effect at the observatories of Columbia University
-in New York, and the Royal Observatory at
-Naples, Italy. For obtaining its most complete
-advantages it is, of course, better to establish several
-observing stations on about the same parallel
-of latitude. This was done in 1899 by the International
-Geodetic Association. Two stations are in
-the United States, one in Japan, and one in Sicily.
-We can, therefore, hope confidently that our knowledge
-as to the puzzling problem of polar motion
-will soon receive very material advancement.</p>
-
-
-<hr class="chap" />
-<p><span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_140" id="Page_140">[140]</a></span></p>
-
-<h2><a name="SATURNS_RINGS" id="SATURNS_RINGS"></a><a href="#CONTENTS">SATURN'S RINGS</a></h2>
-
-
-<p>The death of James E. Keeler, Director of the
-Lick Observatory, in California (<a href="#Page_32">p. 32</a>), recalls
-to mind one of the most interesting and significant
-of later advances in astronomical science.
-Only seven years have elapsed since Keeler made
-the remarkable spectroscopic observations which
-gave for the first time an ocular demonstration of
-the true character of those mysterious luminous
-rings surrounding the brilliant planet Saturn.
-His results have not yet been made sufficiently
-accessible to the public at large, nor have they
-been generally valued at their true worth. We
-consider this work of Keeler's interesting, because
-the problem of the rings has been a classic
-one for many generations; and we have been
-particular, also, to call it significant, because it is
-pregnant with the possibilities of newer methods
-of spectroscopic research, applied in the older
-departments of observational astronomy.</p>
-
-<p><span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_141" id="Page_141">[141]</a></span></p>
-
-<p>The troubles of astronomers with the rings
-began with the invention of the telescope itself.
-They date back to 1610, when Galileo first
-turned his new instrument to the heavens (<a href="#Page_49">p. 49</a>).
-It may be imagined easily that the bright planet
-Saturn was among the very first objects scrutinized
-by him. His "powerful" instrument
-magnified only about thirty times, and was,
-doubtless, much inferior to our pocket telescopes
-of to-day. But it showed, at all events, that
-something was wrong with Saturn. Galileo put
-it, "<i lang="la" xml:lang="la">Ultimam planet am tergeminam observavi</i>"
-("I have observed the furthest planet to be
-triple").</p>
-
-<p>It is easy to understand now how Galileo's
-eyes deceived him. For a round luminous ball
-like Saturn, surrounded by a thin flat ring seen
-nearly edgewise, really looks as if it had two little
-attached appendages. Strange, indeed, it is
-to-day to read a scientific book so old that the
-planet Saturn could be called the "furthest"
-planet. But it was the outermost known in
-Galileo's day, and for nearly two centuries afterward.
-Not until 1781 did William Herschel<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_142" id="Page_142">[142]</a></span>
-discover Uranus (<a href="#Page_59">p. 59</a>); and Neptune was not
-disclosed by the marvellous mathematical perception
-of Le Verrier until 1846 (<a href="#Page_61">p. 61</a>).</p>
-
-<p>Galileo's further observations of Saturn bothered
-him more and more. The planet's behavior
-became much worse as time went on. "Has
-Saturn devoured his children, according to the
-old legend?" he inquired soon afterward; for
-the changed positions of earth and planet in the
-course of their motions around the sun in their
-respective orbits had become such that the ring
-was seen quite edgewise, and was, therefore, perfectly
-invisible to Galileo's "optic tube." The
-puzzle remained unsolved by Galileo; it was left
-for another great man to find the true answer.
-Huygens, in 1656, first announced that the ring
-<em>is</em> a ring.</p>
-
-<p>The manner in which this announcement was
-made is characteristic of the time; to-day it
-seems almost ludicrous. Huygens published a
-little pamphlet in 1656 called "<cite lang="la" xml:lang="la">De Saturni Luna
-Observatio Nova</cite>" or, "A New Observation of
-Saturn's Moon." He gave the explanation of
-what had been observed by himself and preced<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_143" id="Page_143">[143]</a></span>ing
-astronomers in the form of a puzzle, or
-"logogriph." Here is what he had to say of
-the phenomenon in question:</p>
-
-<p>"aaaaaaa ccccc d eeeee g h iiiiiii llll mm
-nnnnnnnnn oooo pp q rr s ttttt uuuuu."</p>
-
-<p>It was not until 1659, three years later, in a
-book entitled "<cite lang="la" xml:lang="la">Systema Saturnium</cite>," that Huygens
-rearranged the above letters in their proper
-order, giving the Latin sentence:</p>
-
-<p>"<i lang="la" xml:lang="la">Annulo cingitur, tenui plano, nusquam cohaerente,
-ad eclipticam inclinato.</i>" Translated
-into English, this sentence informs us that the
-planet "is girdled with a thin, flat ring, nowhere
-touching Saturn, and inclined to the ecliptic"!</p>
-
-<p>This was a perfectly correct and wonderfully
-sagacious explanation of those complex and exasperatingly
-puzzling phenomena that had been
-too difficult for no less a person than Galileo
-himself. It was an explanation that <em>explained</em>.
-The reason for its preliminary announcement in
-the above manner must have been the following:
-Huygens was probably not quite sure of his
-ground in 1656, while three years afterward he
-had become quite certain. By the publication of<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_144" id="Page_144">[144]</a></span>
-the logogriph of 1656 he secured for himself the
-credit of what he had done. If any other astronomer
-had published the true explanation
-after 1656, Huygens could have proved his
-claim to priority by rearranging the letters of his
-puzzle. On the other hand, if further researches
-showed him that he was wrong, he would never
-have made known the true meaning of his logogriph,
-and would thus have escaped the ignominy
-of making an erroneous explanation. Thus,
-the method of announcement was comparable
-in ingenuity with the Huygenian explanation
-itself.</p>
-
-<p>We are compelled to pass over briefly the entertaining
-history of subsequent observations of
-the ring, in order to explain the new work of
-Keeler and others. Cassini, about 1675,
-been able to show that the ring was double; that
-there are really two independent rings, with a
-distinct dark space between them. It was a case
-of wheels within wheels. To our own eminent
-countryman, W. C. Bond, of Cambridge, Mass.,
-we owe the further discovery (Harvard College
-Observatory, November, 1850) of the third<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_145" id="Page_145">[145]</a></span>
-ring. This is also concentric with the other two,
-and interior to them, but difficult to observe,
-because of its much smaller luminosity.</p>
-
-<p>It is almost transparent, and the brilliant light
-of the planet's central ball is capable of shining
-directly through it. For this reason the inner
-ring is called the "gauze" or "crape" ring. If
-we add to the above details the fact that our
-modern large telescopes show slight irregularities
-in the surface of the rings, especially when seen
-edgewise, we have a brief statement of all that
-the telescope has been able to reveal to us since
-Galileo's time.</p>
-
-<p>But of far greater interest than the mere fact
-of their existence is the important cosmic question
-as to the constitution, structure, and, above
-all, durability of the ring system. Astronomers
-often use the term "stability" with regard to
-celestial systems like the ring system of Saturn.
-By this they mean permanent durability. A
-system is stable if its various parts can continue
-in their present relationship to one another, without
-violating any of the known laws of astronomy.
-Whenever we study any collection of<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_146" id="Page_146">[146]</a></span>
-celestial objects, and endeavor to explain their
-motions and peculiarities, we always seek some
-explanation not inconsistent with the continued
-existence of the phenomena in question. For
-this there is, perhaps, no sufficient philosophical
-basis. Probably much of the great celestial procession
-is but a passing show, to be but for a
-moment in the endless vista of cosmic time.</p>
-
-<p>However this may be, we are bound to assume
-as a working theory that Saturn has always
-had these rings, and will always have them; and
-it is for us to find out how this is possible. The
-problem has been attacked mathematically by
-various astronomers, including Laplace; but no
-conclusive mathematical treatment was obtained
-until 1857, when <ins class="corr" title="Transcriber's Note&mdash;Original text: 'James Clark-Maxwell'">James Clerk Maxwell</ins> proved
-in a masterly manner that the rings could be
-neither solid nor liquid. He showed, indeed,
-that they would not last if they were continuous
-bodies like the planets. A big solid wheel
-would inevitably be torn asunder by any slight
-disturbance, and then precipitated upon the planet's
-surface. Therefore, the rings must be composed
-of an immense number of small detached<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_147" id="Page_147">[147]</a></span>
-particles, revolving around Saturn in separate
-orbits, like so many tiny satellites.</p>
-
-<p>This mathematical theory of the ring system
-being once established, astronomers were more
-eager than ever to obtain a visual confirmation
-of it. We had, indeed, a sort of analogy in
-the assemblage of so-called "minor planets"
-(<a href="#Page_64">p. 64</a>), which are known to be revolving around
-our sun in orbits situated between Mars and
-Jupiter. Some hundreds of these are known
-to exist, and probably there are countless others
-too small for us to see. Such a swarm of tiny
-particles of luminous matter would certainly
-give the impression of a continuous solid body,
-if seen from a distance comparable to that separating
-us from Saturn. But arguments founded
-on analogy are of comparatively little value.</p>
-
-<p>Astronomers need direct and conclusive telescopic
-evidence, and this was lacking until Keeler
-made his remarkable spectroscopic observation in
-1895. The spectroscope is a peculiar instrument,
-different in principle from any other used
-in astronomy; we study distant objects with it
-by analyzing the light they send us, rather than<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_148" id="Page_148">[148]</a></span>
-by examining and measuring the details of their
-visible surfaces. The reader will recall that according
-to the modern undulatory theory, light
-consists simply of a series of waves. Now, the
-nature of waves is very far from being understood
-in the popular mind. Most people, for
-instance, think that the waves of ocean consist of
-great masses of water rolling along the surface.</p>
-
-<p>This notion doubtless arises from the behavior
-of waves when they break upon the shore, forming
-what we call surf. When a wave meets
-with an immovable body like a sand beach, the
-wave is broken, and the water really does roll
-upon the beach. But this is an exceptional case.
-Farther away from the shore, where the waves
-are unimpeded, they consist simply of particles
-of water moving straight up and down. None
-of the water is carried by mere wave-action away
-from the point over which it was situated at first.</p>
-
-<p>Tides or other causes may move the water, but
-not simple wave-motion alone. That this is so
-can be proved easily. If a chip of wood be
-thrown overboard from a ship at sea it will be
-seen to rise and fall a long time on the waves,<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_149" id="Page_149">[149]</a></span>
-but it will not move. Similarly, wind-waves are
-often quite conspicuous on a field of grain; but
-they are caused by the individual grain particles
-moving up and down. The grain certainly cannot
-travel over the ground, since each particle is
-fast to its own stalk.</p>
-
-<p>But while the particles do not travel, the wave-disturbance
-does. At times it is transmitted to
-a considerable distance from the point where it
-was first set in motion. Thus, when a stone is
-dropped into still water, the disturbance (though
-not the water) travels in ever-widening circles,
-until at last it becomes too feeble for us to perceive.
-Light is just such a travelling wave-disturbance.
-Beginning, perhaps, in some distant
-star, it travels through space, and finally the
-wave impinges on our eyes like the ocean-wave
-breaking on a sand beach. Such a light-wave
-affects the eye in some mysterious way. We
-call it "seeing."</p>
-
-<p>The spectroscope (<a href="#Page_21">p. 21</a>) enables us to measure
-and count the waves reaching us each second
-from any source of light. No matter how far
-away the origin of stellar light may be, the spec<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_150" id="Page_150">[150]</a></span>troscope
-examines the character of that light, and
-tells us the number of waves set up every second.
-It is this characteristic of the instrument
-that has enabled us to make some of the most
-remarkable observations of modern times. If
-the distant star is approaching us in space, more
-light-waves per second will reach us than we
-should receive from the same star at rest. Thus
-if we find from the spectroscope that there are
-too many waves, we know that the star is coming
-nearer; and if there are too few, we can
-conclude with equal certainty that the star is
-receding.</p>
-
-<p>Keeler was able to apply the spectroscope in
-this way to the planet Saturn and to the ring
-system. The observations required dexterity
-and observational manipulative skill in a superlative
-degree. These Keeler had; and this work
-of his will always rank as a classic observation.
-He found by examining the light-waves from
-opposite sides of the planet that the luminous
-ball rotated; for one side was approaching us
-and the other receding. This observation was,
-of course, in accord with the known fact of Sat<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_151" id="Page_151">[151]</a></span>urn's
-rotation on his axis. With regard to the
-rings, Keeler showed in the same way the existence
-of an axial rotation, which appears not
-to have been satisfactorily proved before, strange
-as it may seem. But the crucial point established
-by his spectroscope was that the interior
-part of the rings rotates <em>faster</em> than the exterior.</p>
-
-<p>The velocity of rotation diminishes gradually
-from the inside to the outside. This fact is absolutely
-inconsistent with the motion of a solid
-ring; but it fits in admirably with the theory of
-a ring comprised of a vast assemblage of small
-separate particles. Thus, for the first time, astronomy
-comes into possession of an observational
-determination of the nature of Saturn's
-rings, and Galileo's puzzle is forever solved.</p>
-
-
-<hr class="chap" />
-<p><span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_152" id="Page_152">[152]</a></span></p>
-
-<h2><a name="THE_HELIOMETER" id="THE_HELIOMETER"></a><a href="#CONTENTS">THE HELIOMETER</a></h2>
-
-
-<p>Astronomical discoveries are always received
-by the public with keen interest. Every new
-fact read in the great open book of nature is written
-eagerly into the books of men. For there
-exists a strong curiosity to ascertain just how the
-greater world is built and governed; and it must
-be admitted that astronomers have been able to
-satisfy that curiosity with no small measure of
-success. But it is seldom that we hear of the
-means by which the latest and most refined
-astronomical observations are effected. Popular
-imagination pictures the astronomer, as he doubtless
-once was, an aged gentleman, usually having
-a long white beard, and spending entire nights
-staring at the sky through a telescope.</p>
-
-<p>But the facts to-day are very different. The
-working astronomer is an active man in the
-prime of life, often a young man. He wastes no
-time in star-gazing. His observations consist of<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_153" id="Page_153">[153]</a></span>
-exact measurements made in a precise, systematic,
-and almost business-like manner. A night's
-"watch" at the telescope is seldom allowed to
-exceed about three hours, since it is found that
-more continued exertions fatigue the eye and lead
-to less accurate results. To this, of course, there
-have been many notable exceptions, for endurance
-of sight, like any form of physical strength, differs
-greatly in different individuals. Astronomical research
-does not include "picking out" the constellations,
-and learning the Arabic names of individual
-stars. These things are not without
-interest; but they belong to astronomy's ancient
-history, and are of little value except to afford
-amusement and instruction to successive generations
-of amateurs.</p>
-
-<p>Among the instruments for carefully planned
-measurements of precision the heliometer probably
-takes first rank. It is at once the most
-exquisitely accurate in its results, and the most
-fatiguing to the observer, of all the varied apparatus
-employed by the astronomer. The principle
-upon which its construction depends is very
-peculiar, and applies to all telescopes, even or<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_154" id="Page_154">[154]</a></span>dinary
-ones for terrestrial purposes. If part of a
-telescope lens be covered up with the hand, it
-will still be possible to see through the instrument.
-The glass lens at the end of the tube
-farthest from the observer's eye helps to magnify
-distant objects and make them seem nearer by
-gathering to a single point, or focus, a greater
-amount of their light than could be brought
-together by the far smaller lens in the unaided
-eye.</p>
-
-<p>The telescope might very properly be likened
-to an enlarged eye, which can see more than we
-can, simply because it is bigger. If a telescope
-lens has a surface one hundred times as large as
-that of the lens in our eye, it will gather and bring
-to a focus one hundred times as much light from a
-distant object. Now, if any part of this telescope
-be covered, the remaining part will, nevertheless,
-gather and focus light just as though the whole
-lens were in action; only, there will be less light
-collected at the focus within the tube. The
-small lens at the telescope's eye-end is simply a
-magnifier to help our eye examine the image of
-any distant object formed at the focus by the<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_155" id="Page_155">[155]</a></span>
-large lens at the farther end of the instrument.
-For of this simple character is the operation of
-any telescope: the large glass lens at one end
-collects a distant planet's light, and brings it to a
-focus near the other end of the tube, where it
-forms a tiny picture of the planet, which, in
-turn, is examined with the little magnifier at
-the eye-end.</p>
-
-<p>Having arrived at the fundamental principle
-that part of a lens will act in a manner similar to
-a whole one, it is easy to explain the construction
-of a heliometer. An ordinary telescope lens is
-sawed in half by means of a thin round metal
-disk revolved rapidly by machinery, and fed continually
-with emery and water at its edge. The
-cutting effect of emery is sufficient to make such
-a disk enter glass much as an ordinary saw penetrates
-wood. The two "semi-lenses," as they
-are called, are then mounted separately in metal
-holders. These are attached to one end of the
-heliometer, called the "head," in such a way that
-the two semi-lenses can slide side by side upon
-metal guides. This head is then fastened to one
-end of a telescope tube mounted in the usual<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_156" id="Page_156">[156]</a></span>
-way. The "head" end of the instrument is
-turned toward the sky in observing, and at the
-eye-end is placed the usual little magnifier we
-have already described.</p>
-
-<p>The observer at the eye-end has control of
-certain rods by means of which he can push the
-semi-lenses on their slides in the head at the
-other end of the tube. Now, if he moves the
-semi-lenses so as to bring them side by side exactly,
-the whole arrangement will act like an ordinary
-telescope. For the semi-lenses will then
-fit together just as if the original glass had never
-been cut. But if the half-lenses are separated a
-little on their slides, each will act by itself. Being
-slightly separated, each will cover a different
-part of the sky. The whole affair acts as if the
-observer at the eye-end were looking through
-two telescopes at once. For each semi-lens acts
-independently, just as if it were a complete glass
-of only half the size.</p>
-
-<p>Now, suppose there were a couple of stars in
-the sky, one in the part covered by the first
-semi-lens, and one in the part covered by the
-second. The observer would, of course, see<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_157" id="Page_157">[157]</a></span>
-both stars at once upon looking into the little
-magnifier at the eye-end of the heliometer.</p>
-
-<p>We must remember that these stars will
-appear in the field of view simply as two tiny
-points of light. The astronomer, as we have
-said, is provided with a simple system of long
-rods, by means of which he can manipulate the
-semi-lenses while the observation is being made.
-If he slides them very slowly one way or the
-other, the two star-points in the field of view will
-be seen to approach each other. In this way
-they can at last be brought so near together that
-they will form but a single dot of light. Observation
-with the heliometer consists in thus bringing
-two star-images together, until at last they
-are superimposed one upon the other, and we see
-one image only. Means are provided by which
-it is then possible to measure the amount of
-separation of the two half-lenses. Evidently the
-farther asunder on the sky are the two stars
-under observation, the greater will be the separation
-of the semi-lenses necessary to make a single
-image of their light. Thus, measurement of the
-lenses' separation becomes a means of determin<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_158" id="Page_158">[158]</a></span>ing
-the separation of the stars themselves upon
-the sky.</p>
-
-<p>The two slides in the heliometer head are supplied
-with a pair of very delicate measures or
-"scales" usually made of silver. These can be
-examined from the eye-end of the instrument by
-looking through a long microscope provided for
-this special purpose. Thus an extremely precise
-value is obtained both of the separation of the
-sliders and of the distance on the sky between
-the stars under examination. Measures made in
-this way with the heliometer are counted the
-most precise of astronomical observations.</p>
-
-<p>Having thus described briefly the kind of observations
-obtained with the heliometer, we shall
-now touch upon their further utilization. We
-shall take as an example but one of their many
-uses&mdash;that one which astronomers consider the
-most important&mdash;the measurement of stellar distances.
-(See also <a href="#Page_94">p. 94.</a>)</p>
-
-<p>Even the nearest fixed star is almost inconceivably
-remote from us. And astronomers
-are imprisoned on this little earth; we cannot
-bridge the profound distance separating us from<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_159" id="Page_159">[159]</a></span>
-the stars, so as to use direct measurement with
-tape-line or surveyor's chain. We are forced to
-have recourse to some indirect method. Suppose
-a certain star is suspected, on account of its brightness,
-or for some other reason, of being near us
-in space, and so giving a favorable opportunity
-for a determination of distance. A couple of
-very faint stars are selected close by. These, on
-account of their faintness, the astronomer may
-regard as quite immeasurably far away. He then
-determines with his heliometer the exact position
-on the sky of the bright star with respect to the
-pair of faint ones. Half a year is then allowed
-to pass. During that time the earth has been
-swinging along in its annual path or orbit around
-the sun. Half a year will have sufficed to carry
-the observer on the earth to the other side of
-that path, and he is then 185,000,000 miles away
-from his position at the first observation.</p>
-
-<p>Another determination is made of the bright
-star's position as referred to the two faint ones.
-Now, if all these stars were equally distant, their
-relative positions at the second observation would
-be just the same as at the former one. But if, as<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_160" id="Page_160">[160]</a></span>
-is very probable, the bright star is very much
-nearer us than are the two faint ones, we shall
-obtain a different position from our second observation.
-For the change of 185,000,000 miles
-in the observer's location will, of course, affect
-the direction in which we see the near star, while
-it will leave the distant ones practically unchanged.
-Without entering into technical details, we may
-say that from a large number of observations of
-this kind, we can obtain the distance of the bright
-star by a process of calculation. The only essential
-is to have an instrument that can make
-the actual observations of position accurately
-enough; and in this respect the heliometer is still
-unexcelled.</p>
-
-
-<hr class="chap" />
-<p><span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_161" id="Page_161">[161]</a></span></p>
-
-<h2><a name="OCCULTATIONS" id="OCCULTATIONS"></a><a href="#CONTENTS">OCCULTATIONS</a></h2>
-
-
-<p>Scarcely anyone can have watched the sky
-without noticing how different is the behavior of
-our moon from that of any other object we can
-see. Of course, it has this in common with the
-sun and stars and planets, that it rises in the
-eastern horizon, slowly climbs the dome of the
-sky, and again goes down and sets in the west.
-This motion of the heavenly bodies is known to
-be an apparent one merely, and caused by the
-turning of our own earth upon its axis. A man
-standing upon the earth's surface can look up
-and see above him one-half the great celestial
-vault, gemmed with twinkling stars, and bearing,
-perhaps, within its ample curve one or two serenely
-shining planets and the lustrous moon.
-But at any given moment the observer can see
-nothing of the other half of the heavenly sphere.
-It is beneath his feet, and concealed by the solid
-bulk of the earth.</p>
-
-<p><span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_162" id="Page_162">[162]</a></span></p>
-
-<p>The earth, however, is turning on an axis,
-carrying the observer with it. And so it is continually
-presenting him to a new part of the sky.
-At any moment he sees but a single half-sphere;
-yet the very next instant it is no longer the same;
-a small portion has passed out of sight on one
-side by going down behind the turning earth,
-while a corresponding new section has come into
-view on the opposite side. It is this coming into
-view that we call the rising of a star; and the
-corresponding disappearance on the other side is
-called setting. Thus rising and setting are, of
-course, due entirely to a turning of the earth, and
-not at all to actual motions of the stars; and for
-this reason, all objects in the sky, without exception,
-must rise and set again. But the moon
-really has a motion of its own in addition to this
-apparent one caused by the earth's rotation.</p>
-
-<p>Somewhere in the dawn of time early watchers
-of the stars thought out those fancied constellations
-that survive even down to our own day.
-They placed the mighty lion, king of beasts,
-upon the face of night, and the great hunter, too,
-armed with club and dagger, to pursue him.<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_163" id="Page_163">[163]</a></span>
-Among these constellations the moon threads her
-destined way, night after night, so rapidly that
-the unaided eye can see that she is moving. It
-needs but little power of fancy's magic to recall
-from the dim past a picture of some aged astronomer
-graving upon his tablets the Records of
-the Moon. "To-night she is near the bright
-star in the eye of the Bull." And again: "To-night
-she rides full, and near to the heart of the
-Virgin."</p>
-
-<p>And why does the moon ride thus through the
-stars of night? Modern science has succeeded
-in disentangling the intricacies of her motion,
-until to-day only one or two of the very minutest
-details of that motion remain unexplained. But
-it has been a hard problem. Someone has well
-said that lunar theory should be likened to a
-lofty cliff upon whose side the intellectual giants
-among men can mark off their mental stature,
-but whose height no one of them may ever hope
-to scale.</p>
-
-<p>But for our present purpose it is unnecessary
-to pursue the subject of lunar motion into its
-abstruser details. To understand why the moon<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_164" id="Page_164">[164]</a></span>
-moves rapidly among the stars, it is sufficient to
-remember that she is whirling quickly round the
-earth, so as to complete her circuit in a little less
-than a month. We see her at all times projected
-upon the distant background of the sky on which
-are set the stellar points of light, as though intended
-for beacons to mark the course pursued
-by moon and planets. The stars themselves have
-no such motions as the moon; situated at a distance
-almost inconceivably great, they may, indeed,
-be travellers through empty space, yet their
-journeys shrink into insignificance as seen from
-distant earth. It requires the most delicate instruments
-of the astronomer to so magnify the
-tiny displacements of the stars on the celestial
-vault that they may be measured by human eyes.</p>
-
-<p>Let us again recur to our supposed observer
-watching the moon night after night, so as to
-record the stars closely approached by her. Why
-should he not some time or other be surprised
-by an approach so close as to amount apparently
-to actual contact? The moon covers quite
-a large surface on the sky, and when we remember
-the nearly countless numbers of the stars, it<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_165" id="Page_165">[165]</a></span>
-would, indeed, be strange if there were not some
-behind the moon as well as all around her.</p>
-
-<p>A moment's consideration shows that this must
-often be the case; and in fact, if the moon's advancing
-edge be scrutinized carefully through a
-telescope, small stars can be seen frequently to
-disappear behind it. This is a most interesting
-observation. At first we see the moon and star
-near each other in the telescope's field of view.
-But the distance between them lessens perceptibly,
-even quickly, until at last, with a startling
-suddenness, the star goes out of sight behind the
-moon. After a time, ranging from a few moments
-to, perhaps, more than an hour, the moon
-will pass, and we can see the star suddenly reappear
-from behind the other edge.</p>
-
-<p>These interesting observations, while not at all
-uncommon, can be made only very rarely by
-naked-eye astronomers. The reason is simple.
-The moon's light is so brilliant that it fairly overcomes
-the stars whenever they are at all near, except
-in the case of very bright ones. Small
-stars that can be followed quite easily up to the
-moon's edge in a good telescope, disappear from<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_166" id="Page_166">[166]</a></span>
-a naked-eye view while the moon is still a long
-distance away. But the number of very bright
-stars is comparatively small, so that it is quite unusual
-to find anyone not a professional astronomer
-who has actually seen one of these so-called
-"occultations." Moreover, most people are not
-informed in advance of the occurrence of an opportunity
-to make such observations, although
-they can be predicted quite easily by the aid of
-astronomical calculations. Sometimes we have
-occultations of planets, and these are the most interesting
-of all. When the moon passes between
-us and one of the larger planets, it is worth
-while to observe the phenomenon even without a
-telescope.</p>
-
-<p>Up to this point we have considered occultations
-chiefly as being of interest to the naked-eye
-astronomer. Yet occultations have a real scientific
-value. It is by their means that we can,
-perhaps, best measure the moon's size. By noting
-with a telescope the time of disappearance
-and reappearance of known stars, astronomers
-can bring the direct measurement of the moon's
-diameter within the range of their numerical cal<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_167" id="Page_167">[167]</a></span>culations.
-Sometimes the moon passes over a
-condensed cluster of stars like the Pleiades.
-The results obtainable on these occasions are
-valuable in a very high degree, and contribute
-largely to making precise our knowledge of the
-lunar diameter.</p>
-
-<p>There is another thing of scientific interest
-about occultations, though it has lost some of
-its importance in recent years. When such an
-event has been observed, the agreement of the
-predicted time with that actually recorded by the
-astronomer offers a most searching test of the
-correctness of our theory of lunar motion. We
-have already called attention to the great inherent
-difficulty of this theory. It is easy to see
-that by noting the exact instant of disappearance
-of a star at a place on the earth the latitude and
-longitude of which are known, we can both
-check our calculations and gather material for
-improving our theory. The same principle can
-be used also in the converse direction. Within
-the limits of precision imposed by the state of
-our knowledge of lunar theory, we can utilize
-occultations to help determine the position on the<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_168" id="Page_168">[168]</a></span>
-earth of places whose longitude is unknown. It
-is a very interesting bit of history that the first
-determination of the longitude of Washington
-was made by means of occultations, and that this
-early determination led to the founding of the
-United States Naval Observatory.</p>
-
-<p>On March 28, 1810, Mr. Pitkin, of Connecticut,
-reported to the House of Representatives
-on "laying a foundation for the establishment of
-a first meridian for the United States, by which
-a further dependence on Great Britain or any
-other foreign nation for such meridian may be
-entirely removed." This report was the result
-of a memorial presented by one William Lambert,
-who had deduced the longitude of the Capitol
-from an occultation observed October 20,
-1804. Various proceedings were had in Congress
-and in committee, until at last, in 1821,
-Lambert was appointed "to make astronomical
-observations by lunar occultations of fixed stars,
-solar eclipses, or any approved method adapted
-to ascertain the longitude of the Capitol from
-Greenwich." Lambert's reports were made in
-1822 and 1823, but ten years passed before the<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_169" id="Page_169">[169]</a></span>
-establishment of a formal Naval Observatory under
-Goldsborough, Wilkes, and Gilliss. But to
-Lambert belongs the honor of having marked
-out the first fundamental official meridian of
-longitude in the United States.</p>
-
-
-<hr class="chap" />
-<p><span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_170" id="Page_170">[170]</a></span></p>
-
-<h2><a name="MOUNTING_GREAT_TELESCOPES" id="MOUNTING_GREAT_TELESCOPES"></a><a href="#CONTENTS">MOUNTING GREAT TELESCOPES</a></h2>
-
-
-<p>There are many interesting practical things
-about an astronomical observatory with which
-the public seldom has an opportunity to become
-acquainted. Among these, perhaps, the details
-connected with setting up a great telescope take
-first rank. The writer happened to be present
-at the Cape of Good Hope Observatory when
-the photographic equatorial telescope was being
-mounted, and the operation of putting it in position
-may be taken as typical of similar processes
-elsewhere. (See also <a href="#Page_86">p. 86.</a>)</p>
-
-<div class="figcenter">
-<a name="P_170" id="P_170"></a>
-<br />
-<img src="images/i_170fp.jpg" width="500" alt="" />
-<div class="caption">
-Forty-Inch Telescope, Yerkes Observatory,<br />
-University of Chicago.</div>
-</div>
-
-<p>In the first place, it is necessary to explain
-what is meant by an "equatorial" telescope.
-One of the chief difficulties in making ordinary
-observations arises from the rising and setting of
-the stars. They are all apparently moving across
-the face of the sky, usually climbing up from the
-eastern horizon, only to go down again and set
-in the west. If, therefore, we wish to scrutinize
-<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_171" id="Page_171">[171]</a></span>any given object for a considerable time, we must
-move the telescope continuously so as to keep
-pace with the motion of the heavens. For this
-purpose, the tube must be attached to axles, so
-that it can be turned easily in any direction.
-The equatorial mounting is a device that permits
-the telescope to be thus aimed at any part of the
-sky, and at the same time facilitates greatly the
-operation of keeping it pointed correctly after a
-star has once been brought into the field of view.</p>
-
-<p>To understand the equatorial mounting it is
-necessary to remember that the rising and setting
-motions of the heavenly bodies are apparent ones
-only, and due in reality to the turning of the
-earth on its own axis. As the earth goes around,
-it carries observer, telescope, and observatory past
-the stars fixed upon the distant sky. Consequently,
-to keep a telescope pointed continuously
-at a given star, it is merely necessary to rotate it
-steadily backward upon a suitable axis just fast
-enough to neutralize exactly the turning of our
-earth.</p>
-
-<p>By a suitable axis for this purpose we mean
-one so mounted as to be exactly parallel to the<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_172" id="Page_172">[172]</a></span>
-earth's own axis of rotation. A little reflection
-shows how simply such an arrangement will
-work. All the heavenly bodies may be regarded,
-for practical purposes, as excessively remote
-in comparison with the dimensions of our
-earth. The entire planet shrinks into absolute
-insignificance when compared with the distances
-of the nearest objects brought under observation
-by astronomers. It follows that if we have our
-telescope attached to such a rotation-axis as we
-have described, it will be just the same for purposes
-of observation as though the telescope's
-axis were not only parallel to the earth's axis, but
-actually coincident with it. The two axes may
-be separated by a distance equal to that between
-the earth's surface and its centre; but, as we
-have said, this distance is insignificant so far as
-our present object is concerned.</p>
-
-<p>There is another way to arrive at the same
-result. We know that the stars in rising and
-setting all seem to revolve about the pole star,
-which itself seems to remain immovable. Consequently,
-if we mount our telescope so that it
-can turn about an axis pointing at the pole, we<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_173" id="Page_173">[173]</a></span>
-shall be able to neutralize the rotation of the stars
-by simply turning the telescope about the axis at
-the proper speed and in the right direction. Astronomical
-considerations teach us that an axis
-thus pointing at the pole will be parallel to the
-earth's own axis. Thus we arrive at the same
-fundamental principle for mounting an astronomical
-telescope from whichever point of view we
-consider the subject.</p>
-
-<p>Every large telescope is provided with such an
-axis of rotation; and for the reason stated it is
-called the "polar axis." The telescope itself is
-then called an "equatorial." The advantage of
-this method of mounting is very evident. Since
-we can follow the stars' motions by turning the
-telescope about one axis only, it becomes a very
-simple matter to accomplish this turning automatically
-by means of clock-work.</p>
-
-<p>The "following" of a star being thus provided
-for by the device of a polar axis, it is, of course,
-also necessary to supply some other motion so as
-to enable us to aim the tube at any point in the
-heavens. For it is obvious that if it were rigidly
-attached to the polar axis, we could, indeed, follow<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_174" id="Page_174">[174]</a></span>
-any star that happened to be in the field of view,
-but we could not change this field of view at will
-so as to observe other stars or planets. To accomplish
-this, the telescope is attached to the
-polar axis by means of a pivot. By turning the
-telescope around its polar axis, and also on this
-pivot, we can find any object in the heavens; and
-once found, we can leave to the polar axis and its
-automatic clock-work the task of keeping that
-object before the observer's eye.</p>
-
-<p>In setting up the Cape of Good Hope instrument
-the astronomers were obliged to do a large
-part of the work of adjustment personally. Far
-away from European instrument-makers, the parts
-of the mounting and telescope had to be "assembled,"
-or put together, by the astronomers of the
-Cape Observatory. A heavy pier of brick and
-masonry had been prepared in advance. Upon
-this was placed a massive iron base, intended to
-support the superstructure of polar axis and telescope.
-This base rested on three points, one of
-which could be screwed in and out, so as to tilt
-the whole affair a little forward or backward.
-By means of this screw we effected the final ad<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_175" id="Page_175">[175]</a></span>justment
-of the polar axis to exact parallelism
-with that of the earth. Other screws were provided
-with which the base could be twisted a little
-horizontally either to the right or left. Once set
-up in a position almost correct, it was easy to perfect
-the adjustment by the aid of these screws.</p>
-
-<p>Afterward the tube and lenses were put in
-place, and the clock properly attached inside the
-big cast-iron base. This clock-work looked more
-like a piece of heavy machinery than a delicate
-clock mechanism. But it had heavy work to do,
-carrying the massive telescope with its weighty
-lenses, and needed to be correspondingly strong.
-It had a driving-weight of about 2,000 pounds,
-and was so powerful that turning the telescope
-affected it no more than the hour-hand of an ordinary
-clock affects the mechanism within its case.</p>
-
-<p>The final test of the whole adjustment consisted
-in noting whether stars once brought into
-the telescopic field of view could be maintained
-there automatically by means of the clock. This
-object having been attained successfully, the instrument
-stood ready to be used in the routine
-business of the observatory.</p>
-
-<p><span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_176" id="Page_176">[176]</a></span></p>
-
-<p>Before leaving the subject of telescope-mountings,
-we must mention the giant instrument set
-up at the Paris Exposition of 1900. The project
-of having a <i lang="fr" xml:lang="fr">Grande Lunette</i> had been hailed by
-newspapers throughout the world and by the
-general public in their customary excitable way.
-It was tremendously over-advertised; exaggerated
-notions of the instrument's powers were
-spread abroad and eagerly credited; the moon
-was to be dragged down, as it were, from its
-customary place in the sky, so near that we
-should be able almost to touch its surface. As
-to the planets&mdash;free license was given to the journalistic
-imagination, and there was no effective
-limitation to the magnificence of astronomical
-discovery practically within our grasp, beyond
-the necessity for printed space demanded by sundry
-wars, pestilences, and other mundane trifles.</p>
-
-<div class="figcenter">
-<a name="P_176" id="P_176"></a>
-<br />
-<img src="images/i_176fp.jpg" width="650" alt="" />
-<div class="caption">
-Yerkes Observatory, University of Chicago.</div>
-</div>
-
-<p>Now, the present writer is very far from advocating
-a lessening of the attention devoted to astronomy.
-Rather would he magnify his office
-than diminish it. But let journalistic astronomy
-be as good an imitation of sober scientific truth
-as can be procured at space rates; let editors
-<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_177" id="Page_177">[177]</a></span>encourage the public to study those things in the
-science that are ennobling and cultivating to the
-mind; let there be an end to the frenzied effort
-to fabricate a highly colored account of alleged
-discoveries of yesterday, capable of masquerading
-to-day under heavy head-lines as News.</p>
-
-<p>The manner in which the big telescope came
-to be built is not without interest, and shows
-that enterprise is far from dead, even in the old
-countries. A stock company was organized&mdash;we
-should call it a corporation&mdash;under the
-name <i lang="fr" xml:lang="fr">Société de l'Optique</i>. It would appear that
-shares were regularly put on the market, and
-that a prospectus, more or less alluring, was
-widely distributed. We may say at once that the
-investing public did not respond with obtrusive
-alacrity; but at all events, the promoters' efforts
-received sufficient encouragement to enable them
-to begin active work. From the very first a
-vigorous attempt was made to utilize both the
-resources of genuine science and the devices of
-quasi-charlatanry. It was announced that the
-public were to be admitted to look through the
-big glass (apparently at so much an eye), and<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_178" id="Page_178">[178]</a></span>
-many, doubtless, expected that the man in the
-street would be able to make personal acquaintance
-with the man in the moon. A telescopic
-image of the sun was to be projected on a big
-screen, and exhibited to a concourse of spectators
-assembled in rising tiers of seats within a
-great amphitheatre. And when clouds or other
-circumstances should prevent observing the planets
-or scrutinizing the sun, a powerful stereopticon
-was to be used. Artificial pictures of the
-wonders of heaven were to be projected on the
-screen, and the public would never be disappointed.
-It was arranged that skilled talkers
-should be present to explain all marvels: and, in
-short, financial profit was to be combined with
-machinery for advancing scientific discovery.
-Astronomers the world over were "circularized,"
-asked to become shareholders, and, in default of
-that, to send lantern-slides or photographs of
-remarkable celestial objects for exhibition in the
-magic-lantern part of the show.</p>
-
-<p>The project thus brought to the attention of
-scientific men three years ago did not have an
-attractive air. It savored too much of charlatan<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_179" id="Page_179">[179]</a></span>ism.
-But it soon appeared that effective government
-sanction had been given to the enterprise;
-and, above all, that men of reputation
-were allowing the use of their names in connection
-with the affair. More important still, we
-learned that the actual construction had been
-undertaken by Gautier, of Paris, that finances
-were favorable, and that real work on parts of
-the instrument was to commence without delay.</p>
-
-<p>Gautier is a first-class instrument-builder; he
-has established his reputation by constructing successfully
-several telescopes of very large size, including
-the <em>equatorial coudé</em> of the Paris Observatory,
-a unique instrument of especial complexity.
-The present writer believes that, if sufficient time
-and money were available, the <i lang="fr" xml:lang="fr">Grande Lunette</i>
-would stand a reasonable chance of success in
-the hands of such a man. And by a reasonable
-chance, we mean that there is a large enough
-probability of genuine scientific discovery to
-justify the necessary financial outlay. But the
-project should be divorced from its "popular"
-features, and every kind of advertising and charlatanism
-excluded with rigor.</p>
-
-<p><span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_180" id="Page_180">[180]</a></span></p>
-
-<p>As planned originally, and actually constructed,
-the <i lang="fr" xml:lang="fr">Grande Lunette</i> presents interesting peculiarities,
-distinguishing it from other telescopes. Previous
-instruments have been built on the principle
-of universal mobility. It is possible to
-move them in all directions, and thus bring any
-desired star under observation, irrespective of its
-position in the sky. But this general mobility
-offers great difficulties in the case of large and
-ponderous telescopes. Delicacy of adjustment is
-almost destroyed when the object to be adjusted
-weighs several tons. And the excessive weight
-of telescopes is not due to unavoidably heavy
-lenses alone. It is essential that the tube be
-long; and great length involves appreciable
-thickness of material, if stiffness and solidity are
-to remain unsacrificed. Length in the tube is
-necessitated by certain peculiar optical defects of
-all lenses, into the nature of which we shall not
-enter at present. The consequences of these
-defects can be rendered harmless only if the instrument
-is so arranged that the observer's eye is
-far from the other end of the tube. The length
-of a good telescope should be at least twelve<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_181" id="Page_181">[181]</a></span>
-times the diameter of its large lens. If the relative
-length can be still further increased, so
-much the better; for then the optical defects
-can be further reduced.</p>
-
-<p>In the case of the Paris instrument a radical
-departure consists in making the tube of unprecedented
-length, 197 feet, with a lens diameter of
-49¼ inches. This great length, while favorable
-optically, precludes the possibility of making the
-instrument movable in the usual sense. In fact,
-the entire tube is attached to a fixed horizontal
-base, and no attempt is made to change its position.
-Outside the big lens, and disconnected
-altogether from the telescope proper, is mounted
-a smooth mirror, so arranged that it can be
-turned in any direction, and thus various parts of
-the sky examined by reflection in the telescope.</p>
-
-<p>While this method unquestionably has the advantage
-of leaving the optician quite free as to
-how long he will make his tube, it suffers from
-the compensating objection that a new optical
-surface is introduced into the combination, viz.,
-the mirror. Any slight unavoidable imperfection
-in the polishing of its surface will infallibly<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_182" id="Page_182">[182]</a></span>
-be reproduced on a magnified scale in the image
-of a distant star brought before the observer's
-eye.</p>
-
-<p>But it is not yet possible to pronounce definitely
-upon the merit of this form of instrument,
-since, as we have said, the maker has not been
-given time enough to try the idea to the complete
-satisfaction of scientific men. In the early
-part of August, 1900, when the informant of the
-present writer left Paris, after serving as a member
-of the international jury for judging instruments
-of precision at the Exposition, the condition
-of the <i lang="fr" xml:lang="fr">Grande Lunette</i> was as follows: Two
-sets of lenses had been contemplated, one intended
-for celestial photography, and the other to be
-used for ordinary visual observation. Only the
-photographic lenses had been completed, however,
-and for this reason the public could not be
-permitted to look through the instrument. The
-photographic lenses were in place in the tube, but
-at that time their condition was such that, though
-some photographs had been obtained, it was not
-thought advisable to submit them to the jury.
-Consequently, the <i lang="fr" xml:lang="fr">Lunette</i> did not receive a<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_183" id="Page_183">[183]</a></span>
-prize. Since that time various newspapers have
-reported wonderful results from the telescope;
-but, disregarding the fusillade from the sensational
-press, we may sum up the present state of
-affairs very briefly. Gautier is still experimenting;
-and, given sufficient time and money, he
-may succeed in producing what astronomers
-hope for&mdash;an instrument capable of advancing
-our knowledge, even if that advance be only a
-small one.</p>
-
-
-<hr class="chap" />
-<p><span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_184" id="Page_184">[184]</a></span></p>
-
-<h2><a name="THE_ASTRONOMERS_POLE" id="THE_ASTRONOMERS_POLE"></a><a href="#CONTENTS">THE ASTRONOMER'S POLE</a></h2>
-
-
-<p>The pole of the frozen North is not the only
-pole sought with determined effort by more than
-one generation of scientific men. Up in the sky
-astronomers have another pole which they are
-following up just as vigorously as ever Arctic explorer
-struggled toward the difficult goal of his terrestrial
-journeying. The celestial pole is, indeed,
-a fundamentally important thing in astronomical
-science, and the determination of its exact position
-upon the sky has always engaged the closest
-attention of astronomers. Quite recently new
-methods of research have been brought to bear,
-promising a degree of success not hitherto attained
-in the astronomers' pursuit of their pole.</p>
-
-<p>In the first place, we must explain what is
-meant by the celestial pole. We have already
-mentioned the poles of the earth (<a href="#Page_136">p. 136</a>). Our
-planet turns once daily upon an axis passing
-through its centre, and it is this rotation that<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_185" id="Page_185">[185]</a></span>
-causes all the so-called diurnal phenomena of the
-heavens. Rising and setting of sun, moon, and
-stars are simply results of this turning of the
-earth. Heavenly bodies do not really rise; it is
-merely the man on the earth who is turned round
-on an axis until he is brought into a position from
-which he can see them. The terrestrial poles are
-those two points on the earth's surface where it
-is pierced by the rotation axis of the planet.
-Now we can, if we choose, imagine this axis
-lengthened out indefinitely, further and further,
-until at last it reaches the great round vault of
-the sky. Here it will again pierce out two polar
-points; and these are the celestial poles.</p>
-
-<p>The whole thing is thus quite easy to understand.
-On the sky the poles are marked by
-the prolongation of the earth's axis, just as on
-the earth the poles are marked by the axis itself.
-And this explains at once why the stars seem
-nightly to revolve about the pole. If the observer
-is being turned round the earth's axis, of
-course it will appear to him as if the stars were
-rotating around the same axis in the opposite
-direction, just as houses and fields seem to fly<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_186" id="Page_186">[186]</a></span>
-past a person sitting in a railway train, unless he
-stops to remember that it is really himself who is
-in motion, and not the trees and houses.</p>
-
-<p>The existence of such a centre of daily motions
-among the stars once recognized, it becomes of
-interest to ascertain whether the centre itself always
-retains precisely the same position in the
-sky. It was discovered as early as the time of
-Hipparchus (<a href="#Page_39">p. 39</a>) that such is not the case,
-and that the celestial pole is subject to a slow
-motion among the stars on the sky. If a given
-star were to-day situated exactly at the pole, it
-would no longer be there after the lapse of a
-year's time; for the pole would have moved away
-from it.</p>
-
-<p>This motion of the pole is called precession.
-It means that certain forces are continually at
-work, compelling the earth's axis to change its
-position, so that the prolongation of that axis
-must pierce the sky at a point which moves as
-time goes on. These forces are produced by the
-gravitational attractions of the sun, moon, and
-planets upon the matter composing our earth.
-If the earth were perfectly spherical in shape,<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_187" id="Page_187">[187]</a></span>
-the attractions of the other heavenly bodies
-would not affect the direction of the earth's rotation-axis
-in the least. But the earth is not quite
-globular in form; it is flattened a little at the
-poles and bulges out somewhat at the equator.
-(See <a href="#Page_135">p. 135.</a>)</p>
-
-<p>This protuberant matter near the equator gives
-the other bodies in the solar system an opportunity
-to disturb the earth's rotation. The general
-effect of all these attractions is to make the
-celestial pole move upon the sky in a circle having
-a radius of about 23½ degrees; and it requires
-25,800 years to complete a circuit of this
-precessional cycle. One of the most striking consequences
-of this motion will be the change of the
-polar star. Just at present the bright star Polaris
-in the constellation of the Little Bear is very
-close to the pole. But after the lapse of sufficient
-ages the first-magnitude star Vega of the constellation
-Lyra will in its turn become Guardian of the
-Pole.</p>
-
-<p>It must not be supposed, however, that the
-motion of the pole proceeds quite uniformly, and
-in an exact circle; the varying positions of the<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_188" id="Page_188">[188]</a></span>
-heavenly bodies whose attractions cause the phenomena
-in question are such as to produce appreciable
-divergencies from exact circular motion.
-Sometimes the pole deviates a little to one side
-of the precessional circle, and sometimes it deviates
-on the other side. The final result is a
-sort of wavy line, half on one side and half on
-the other of an average circular curve. It takes
-only nineteen years to complete one of these little
-waves of polar motion, so that in the whole precessional
-cycle of 25,800 years there are about
-1,400 indentations. This disturbance of the polar
-motion is called by astronomers nutation.</p>
-
-<p>The first step in a study of polar motion is to
-devise a method of finding just where the pole is
-on any given date. If the astronomer can ascertain
-by observational processes just where the
-pole is among the stars at any moment, and can
-repeat his observations year after year and generation
-after generation, he will possess in time a
-complete chart of a small portion at least of the
-celestial pole's vast orbit. From this he can obtain
-necessary data for a study of the mathematical
-theory of attractions, and thus, perhaps, arrive at<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_189" id="Page_189">[189]</a></span>
-an explanation of the fundamental laws governing
-the universe in which we live.</p>
-
-<p>The instrument which has been used most extensively
-for the study of these problems is the
-transit (<a href="#Page_118">p. 118</a>) or the "meridian circle." This
-latter consists of a telescope firmly attached to a
-metallic axis about which it can turn. The axis
-itself rests on massive stone supports, and is so
-placed that it points as nearly as possible in an
-east-and-west direction. Consequently, when the
-telescope is turned about its axis, it will trace out
-on the sky a great circle (the meridian) which
-passes through the north and south points of the
-horizon and the point directly overhead. The
-instrument has also a metallic circle very firmly
-fastened to the telescope and its axis. Let into
-the surface of this circle is a silver disk upon
-which are engraved a series of lines or graduations
-by means of which it is <ins class="corr" title="Transcriber's Note&mdash;Original text: 'impossible to measure'">possible to measure</ins>
-angles.</p>
-
-<p>Observers with the meridian circle begin by
-noting the exact instant when any given star
-passes the centre of the field of view of the telescope.
-This centre is marked with a cross made<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_190" id="Page_190">[190]</a></span>
-by fastening into the focus some pieces of ordinary
-spider's web, which give a well-marked, delicate
-set of lines, even under the magnifying power
-of the telescope's eye-piece. In addition to thus
-noting the time when the star crosses the field
-of the telescope, the astronomer can measure by
-means of the circle, how high up it was in the sky
-at the instant when it was thus observed.</p>
-
-<p>If the telescope of the meridian circle be turned
-toward the north, and we observe stars close to
-the pole, it is possible to make two different observations
-of the same star. For the close polar
-stars revolve in such small circles around the pole
-of the heavens that we can observe them when
-they are on the meridian either above the pole or
-below it. Double observations of this class enable
-us to obtain the elevation of the pole above
-the horizon, and to fix its position with respect
-to the stars.</p>
-
-<p>Now, there is one very serious objection to
-this method. In order to secure the two necessary
-observations of the same star, it is essential
-to be stationed at the instrument at two moments
-of time separated by exactly twelve hours; and if<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_191" id="Page_191">[191]</a></span>
-one of the observations occurs in the night, the
-other corresponding observation will occur in
-daylight.</p>
-
-<p>It is a fact not generally known that the
-brighter stars can be seen with a telescope, even
-when the sun is quite high above the horizon.
-Unfortunately, however, there is only one star
-close to the pole which is bright enough to be
-thus observed in daylight&mdash;the polar star already
-mentioned under the name Polaris. The fact
-that we are thus limited to observations of a single
-star has made it difficult even for generations of
-astronomers to accumulate with the meridian circle
-a very large quantity of observational material
-suitable for the solution of our problem.</p>
-
-<p>The new method of observation to which we
-have referred above consists in an application of
-photography to the polar problem. If we aim
-at the pole a powerful photographic telescope,
-and expose a photographic plate throughout the
-entire night, we shall find that all stars coming
-within the range of the plate will mark out little
-circles or "trails" upon the developed negative.
-It is evident that as the stars revolve about the<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_192" id="Page_192">[192]</a></span>
-pole on the sky, tracing out their daily circular
-orbits, these same little circles must be reproduced
-faithfully upon the photographic plate.
-The only condition is that the stars shall be
-bright enough to make their light affect the sensitive
-gelatine surface.</p>
-
-<p>But even if observations of this kind are continued
-throughout all the hours of darkness, we
-do not obtain complete circles, but only those
-portions of circles traced out on the sky between
-sunset and sunrise. If the night is twelve hours
-in length, we get half-circles on the plate; if it is
-eighteen hours long, we get circles that lack only
-one-quarter of being complete. In other words,
-we get a series of circular arcs, one corresponding
-to each close polar star. There are no fewer than
-sixteen stars near enough to the pole to come
-within the range of a photographic plate, and
-bright enough to cause measurable impressions
-upon the sensitive surface. The fact that the
-circular arcs are not complete circles does not in
-the least prevent our using them for ascertaining
-the position of their common centre; and that
-centre is the pole. Moreover, as the arcs are<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_193" id="Page_193">[193]</a></span>
-distributed at all sorts of distances from the pole
-and in all directions, corresponding to the accidental
-positions of the stars on the sky, we have
-a state of affairs extremely favorable to the accurate
-determination of the pole's place among
-the stars by means of microscopic measurements
-of the plate.</p>
-
-<p>It will be perceived that this method is extremely
-simple, and, therefore, likely to be successful;
-though its simplicity is slightly impaired
-by the phenomenon known to astronomers as
-"atmospheric refraction." The rays of light
-coming down to our telescopes from a distant
-star must pass through the earth's atmosphere
-before they reach us; and in passing thus from
-the nothingness of outer space into the denser
-material of the air, they are bent out of their
-straight course. The phenomenon is analogous
-to what we see when we push a stick down
-through the surface of still water; we notice that
-the stick appears to be bent at the point where it
-pierces the surface of the water; and in just the
-same way the rays of light are bent when they
-pierce into the air. Fortunately, the mathemati<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_194" id="Page_194">[194]</a></span>cal
-theory of this atmospheric bending of light is
-well understood, so that it is possible to remove
-the effects of refraction from our results by a
-process of calculation. In other words, we can
-transform our photographic measures into what
-they would have been if no such thing as atmospheric
-refraction existed. This having been
-done, all the arcs on the plate should be exactly
-circular, and their common centre should be the
-position of the pole among the stars on the night
-when the photograph was made.</p>
-
-<p>It is possible to facilitate the removal of refraction
-effects very much by placing our photographic
-telescope at some point on the earth situated
-in a very high latitude. The elevation of
-the pole above the horizon is greatest in high
-latitudes. Indeed, if Arctic voyagers could ever
-reach the pole of the earth they would see the
-pole of the heavens directly overhead. Now,
-the higher up the pole is in the sky, the less will
-be the effects of atmospheric refraction; for the
-rays of light will then strike the atmosphere in a
-direction nearly perpendicular to its surface, which
-is favorable to diminishing the amount of bending.</p>
-
-<p><span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_195" id="Page_195">[195]</a></span></p>
-
-<p>There is also another very important advantage
-in placing the telescope in a high latitude;
-in the middle of winter the nights are very
-long there; if we could get within the Arctic.
-Circle itself, there would be nights when the
-hours of darkness would number twenty-four,
-and we could substitute complete circles for our
-broken arcs. This would, indeed, be most favorable
-from the astronomical point of view; but
-the essential condition of convenience for the observer
-renders an expedition to the frozen Arctic
-regions unadvisable.</p>
-
-<p>But it is at least possible to place the telescope
-as far north as is consistent with retaining
-it within the sphere of civilized influences. We
-can put it in that one of existing observatories on
-the earth which has the highest latitude; and
-this is the observatory of Helsingfors, in Finland,
-which belongs to a great university, is
-manned by competent astronomers, and has a
-latitude greater than 60 degrees.</p>
-
-<p>Dr. Anders Donner, Director of the Helsingfors
-Observatory, has at its disposal a fine photographic
-telescope, and with this some prelimi<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_196" id="Page_196">[196]</a></span>nary
-experimental "trail" photographs were made
-in 1895. These photographs were sent to Columbia
-University, New York, and were there
-measured under the writer's direction. Calculations
-based on these measures indicate that the
-method is promising in a very high degree; and
-it was, therefore, decided to construct a special
-photographic telescope better adapted to the particular
-needs of the problem in hand.</p>
-
-<p>The desirability of a new telescope arises from
-the fact that we wish the instrument to remain absolutely
-unmoved during all the successive hours
-of the photographic exposure. It is clear that
-if the telescope moves while the stars are tracing
-out their little trails on the plate, the circularity
-of the curves will be disturbed. Now, ordinary
-astronomical telescopes are always mounted upon
-very stable foundations, well adapted to making
-the telescope stand still; but the polar telescope
-which we wish to use in a research fundamental
-to the entire science of astronomy ought to possess
-immobility and stability of an order higher
-than that required for ordinary astronomical purposes.</p>
-
-<p><span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_197" id="Page_197">[197]</a></span></p>
-
-<p>It is a remarkable peculiarity of the instrument
-needed for the new trail photographs that
-it is never moved at all. Once pointed at the
-pole, it is ready for all the observations of successive
-generations of astronomers. It should
-have no machinery, no pivots, axes, circles,
-clocks, or other paraphernalia of the usual equatorial
-telescope. All we want is a very heavy
-stone pier, with a telescope tube firmly fastened
-to it throughout its entire length. The top of
-the pier having been cut to the proper angle of
-the pole's elevation, and the telescope cemented
-down, everything is complete from the instrumental
-side; and just such an instrument as
-this is now ready for use at Helsingfors.</p>
-
-<p>The late Miss Catharine Wolfe Bruce, of
-New York, was much interested in the writer's
-proposed polar investigations, and in October,
-1898, she contributed funds for the construction
-of the new telescope, and the Russian authorities
-have generously undertaken the expense of a
-building to hold the instrument and the granite
-foundation upon which it rests. Photographs
-are now being secured with the new instrument,<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_198" id="Page_198">[198]</a></span>
-and they will be sent to Columbia University,
-New York, for measurement and discussion. It
-is hoped that they will carry out the promise of
-the preliminary photographs made in 1895 with
-a less suitable telescope of the ordinary form.</p>
-
-
-<hr class="chap" />
-<p><span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_199" id="Page_199">[199]</a></span></p>
-
-<h2><a name="THE_MOON_HOAX" id="THE_MOON_HOAX"></a><a href="#CONTENTS">THE MOON HOAX</a></h2>
-
-
-<p>The public attitude toward matters scientific
-is one of the mysteries of our time. It can be
-described best by the single word, Credulity;
-simple, absolute credulity. Perfect confidence is
-the most remarkable characteristic of this unbelieving
-age. No charlatan, necromancer, or astrologer
-of three centuries ago commanded more
-respectful attention than does his successor of
-to-day.</p>
-
-<p>Any person can be a scientific authority; he
-has but to call himself by that title, and everyone
-will give him respectful attention. Numerous
-instances can be adduced from the experience
-of very recent years to show how true are these
-remarks. We have had the Keeley motor and
-the liquid-air power schemes for making something
-out of nothing. Extracting gold from sea-water
-has been duly heralded on scientific authority
-as an easy source of fabulous wealth for the<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_200" id="Page_200">[200]</a></span>
-million. Hard-headed business men not only
-believe in such things, but actually invest in them
-their most valued possession, capital. Venders
-of nostrums and proprietary medicines acquire
-wealth as if by magic, though it needs but a moment's
-reflection to realize that these persons cannot
-possibly be in possession of any drugs, or
-secret methods of compounding drugs, that are
-unknown to scientific chemists.</p>
-
-<p>If the world, then, will persistently intrust its
-health and wealth into the safe-keeping of charlatans,
-what can we expect when things supposedly
-of far less value are at stake? The famous Moon
-Hoax, as we now call it, is truly a classic piece of
-lying. Though it dates from as long ago as
-1835, it has never had an equal as a piece of
-"modern" journalism. Nothing could be more
-useful than to recall it to public attention at least
-once every decade; for it teaches an important
-lesson that needs to be iterated again and again.</p>
-
-<p>On November 13, 1833, Sir John Herschel
-embarked on the Mountstuart Elphinstone, bound
-for the Cape of Good Hope. He took with
-him a collection of astronomical instruments,<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_201" id="Page_201">[201]</a></span>
-with which he intended to study the heavens
-of the southern hemisphere, and thus extend
-his father's great work to the south polar stars.
-An earnest student of astronomy, he asked no
-better than to be left in peace to seek the truth
-in his own fashion. Little did he think that his
-expedition would be made the basis for a fabrication
-of alleged astronomical discoveries destined
-to startle a hemisphere. Yet that is precisely
-what happened. Some time about the middle of
-the year 1835 the New York <cite>Sun</cite> began the publication
-of certain articles, purporting to give an
-account of "Great Astronomical Discoveries,
-lately made by Sir John Herschel at the Cape of
-Good Hope." It was alleged that these articles
-were taken from a supplement to the Edinburgh
-<cite>Journal of Science</cite>; yet there is no doubt that
-they were manufactured entirely in the United
-States, and probably in New York.</p>
-
-<p>The hoax begins at once in a grandiloquent
-style, calculated to attract popular attention, and
-well fitted to the marvels about to be related.
-Here is an introductory remark, as a specimen:
-"It has been poetically said that the stars of<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_202" id="Page_202">[202]</a></span>
-heaven are the hereditary regalia of man as the
-intellectual sovereign of the animal creation. He
-may now fold the zodiac around him with a
-loftier consciousness of his mental supremacy."
-Then follows a circumstantial and highly plausible
-account of the manner in which early and exclusive
-information was obtained from the Cape.
-This was, of course, important in order to make
-people believe in the genuineness of the whole;
-but we pass at once to the more interesting account
-of Herschel's supposed instrument.</p>
-
-<p>Nothing could be more skilful than the way in
-which an air of truth is cast over the coming account
-of marvellous discoveries by explaining in
-detail the construction of the imaginary Herschelian
-instrument. Sir John is supposed to
-have had an interesting conversation in England
-"with Sir David Brewster, upon the merits of
-some ingenious suggestion by the latter, in his article
-on optics in the Edinburgh Encyclopædia
-(p. 644), for improvements in the Newtonian
-reflectors." The exact reference to a particular
-page is here quite delightful. After some further
-talk, "the conversation became directed to that<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_203" id="Page_203">[203]</a></span>
-all-invincible enemy, the paucity of light in powerful
-magnifiers. After a few moments' silent
-thought, Sir John diffidently inquired whether it
-would not be possible to effect a <em>transfusion of
-artificial light through the focal object of vision</em>!
-Sir David, somewhat startled at the originality of
-the idea, paused awhile, and then hesitatingly referred
-to the refrangibility of rays, and the angle
-of incidence.... Sir John continued,
-'Why cannot the illuminated microscope, say
-the hydro-oxygen, be applied to render distinct,
-and, if necessary, even to magnify the focal object?'
-Sir David sprang from his chair in an
-ecstasy of conviction, and leaping half-way to the
-ceiling, exclaimed, 'Thou art the man.' "This
-absurd imaginary conversation contains nothing
-but an assemblage of optical jargon, put together
-without the slightest intention of conveying any
-intelligible meaning to scientific people. Yet it
-was well adapted to deceive the public; and we
-should not be surprised if it would be credited
-by many newspaper readers to-day.</p>
-
-<p>The authors go on to explain how money was
-raised to build the new instrument, and then de<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_204" id="Page_204">[204]</a></span>scribe
-Herschers embarkation and the difficulties
-connected with transporting his gigantic machines
-to the place selected for the observing
-station. "Sir John accomplished the ascent to
-the plains by means of two relief teams of oxen,
-of eighteen each, in about four days, and, aided
-by several companies of Dutch boors [<em>sic</em>], proceeded
-at once to the erecting of his gigantic
-fabric." The place really selected by Herschel
-cannot be described better than in his own
-words, contained in a genuine letter dated January
-21, 1835: "A perfect paradise in rich and
-magnificent mountain scenery, sheltered from all
-winds.... I must reserve for my next all
-description of the gorgeous display of flowers
-which adorn this splendid country, as well as
-the astonishing brilliancy of the constellations."
-The author of the hoax could have had no
-knowledge of Herschers real location, as described
-in this letter.</p>
-
-<p>The present writer can bear witness to the
-correctness of Herschel's words. Feldhausen
-is truly an ideal secluded spot for astronomical
-study. A small obelisk under the sheer cliff of<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_205" id="Page_205">[205]</a></span>
-far-famed Table Mountain now marks the site
-of the great reflecting telescope. Here Herschel
-carried on his scrutiny of the Southern skies.
-He observed 1,202 double stars and 1,708
-nebulæ and clusters, of which only 439 were already
-known. He studied the famous Magellanic
-clouds, and made the first careful drawings
-of the "keyhole" nebula in the constellation
-Argo.</p>
-
-<p>Very recent researches of the present royal
-astronomer at the Cape have shown that changes
-of import have certainly taken place in this
-nebula since Herschel's time, when a sudden
-blazing up of the wonderful star Eta Argus
-was seen within the nebula. This object has,
-perhaps, undergone more remarkable changes of
-light than any other star in the heavens. It is
-as though there were some vast conflagration at
-work, now blazing into incandescence, and again
-sinking almost into invisibility. In 1843 Maclear
-estimated the brilliancy of Eta to be about
-equal to that of Sirius, the brightest star in the
-whole sky. Later it diminished in light, and
-cannot be seen to-day with the naked eye, though<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_206" id="Page_206">[206]</a></span>
-the latest telescopic observations indicate that it
-is again beginning to brighten.</p>
-
-<p>Such was Herschel's quiet study of his beloved
-science, in glaring contrast to the supposed discoveries
-of the "Hoax." Here are a few things
-alleged to have been seen on the moon. The
-first time the instrument was turned upon our satellite
-"the field of view was covered throughout
-its entire area with a beautifully distinct and even
-vivid representation of basaltic rock." There
-were forests, too, and water, "fairer shores never
-angels coasted on a tour of pleasure. A beach of
-brilliant white sand, girt with wild castellated
-rocks, apparently of green marble."</p>
-
-<p>There was animal life as well; "we beheld
-continuous herds of brown quadrupeds, having
-all the external characteristics of the bison,
-but more diminutive than any species of the
-bos genus in our natural history." There was
-a kind of beaver, that "carries its young in
-its arms like a human being," and lives in huts.
-"From the appearance of smoke in nearly all of
-them, there is no doubt of its (the beaver's) being
-acquainted with the use of fire." Finally, as<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_207" id="Page_207">[207]</a></span>
-was, of course, unavoidable, human creatures
-were discovered. "Whilst gazing in a perspective
-of about half a mile, we were thrilled with
-astonishment to perceive four successive flocks of
-large-winged creatures, wholly unlike any kind
-of birds, descend with a slow, even motion from
-the cliffs on the western side, and alight upon
-the plain.... Certainly they were like human
-beings, and their attitude in walking was
-both erect and dignified."</p>
-
-<p>We have not space to give more extended extracts
-from the hoax, but we think the above
-specimens will show how deceptive the whole
-thing was. The rare reprint from which we have
-extracted our quotations contains also some interesting
-"Opinions of the American Press Respecting
-the Foregoing Discovery." The <cite>Daily Advertiser</cite>
-said: "No article, we believe, has appeared
-for years, that will command so general a
-perusal and publication. Sir John has added a
-stock of knowledge to the present age that will
-immortalize his name and place it high on the
-page of science." The <cite>Mercantile Advertiser</cite>
-said: "Discoveries in the Moon.&mdash;We com<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_208" id="Page_208">[208]</a></span>mence
-to-day the publication of an interesting
-article which is stated to have been copied from
-the Edinburgh <cite>Journal of Science</cite>, and which made
-its first appearance here in a contemporary journal
-of this city. It appears to carry intrinsic evidence
-of being an authentic document." Many other
-similar extracts are given. The New York <cite>Evening
-Post</cite> did not fall into the trap. The <cite>Evening
-Post's</cite> remarks were as follows: "It is quite
-proper that the <em>Sun</em> should be the means of shedding
-so much light on the <em>Moon</em>. That there
-should be winged people in the moon does not
-strike us as more wonderful than the existence of
-such a race of beings on the earth; and that there
-does or did exist such a race rests on the evidence
-of that most veracious of voyagers and circumstantial
-of chroniclers, Peter Wilkins, whose celebrated
-work not only gives an account of the
-general appearance and habits of a most interesting
-tribe of flying Indians, but also of all those
-more delicate and engaging traits which the author
-was enabled to discover by reason of the conjugal
-relations he entered into with one of the females
-of the winged tribe."</p>
-
-<p><span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_209" id="Page_209">[209]</a></span></p>
-
-<p>We shall limit our extracts from the contemporary
-press to the few quotations here given,
-hoping that enough has been said to direct attention
-once more to that important subject, the
-Possibility of Being Deceived.</p>
-
-
-<hr class="chap" />
-<p><span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_210" id="Page_210">[210]</a></span></p>
-
-<h2><a name="THE_SUNS_DESTINATION" id="THE_SUNS_DESTINATION"></a><a href="#CONTENTS">THE SUN'S DESTINATION</a></h2>
-
-
-<p>Three generations of men have come and
-gone since the Marquis de Laplace stood before
-the Academy of France and gave his demonstration
-of the permanent stability of our solar system.
-There was one significant fault in Newton's
-superbly simple conception of an eternal
-law governing the world in which we live. The
-labors of mathematicians following him had
-shown that the planets must trace out paths in
-space whose form could be determined in advance
-with unerring certainty by the aid of
-Newton's law of gravitation. But they proved
-just as conclusively that these planetary orbits,
-as they are called, could not maintain indefinitely
-the same shapes or positions. Slow indeed might
-be the changes they were destined to undergo;
-slow, but sure, with that sureness belonging to
-celestial science alone. And so men asked:
-Has this magnificent solar system been built<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_211" id="Page_211">[211]</a></span>
-upon a scale so grand, been put in operation subject
-to a law sublime in its very simplicity, only
-to change and change until at length it shall lose
-every semblance of its former self, and end, perhaps,
-in chaos or extinction?</p>
-
-<p>Laplace was able to answer confidently, "No."
-Nor was his answer couched in the enthusiastic
-language of unbalanced theorists who work by
-the aid of imagination alone. Based upon the
-irrefragable logic of correct mathematical reasoning,
-and clad in the sober garb of mathematical
-formulæ, his results carried conviction to men of
-science the world over. So was it demonstrated
-that changes in our solar system are surely at
-work, and shall continue for nearly countless
-ages; yet just as surely will they be reversed at
-last, and the system will tend to return again to
-its original form and condition. The objection
-that the Newtonian law meant ultimate dissolution
-of the world was thus destroyed by Laplace.
-From that day forward the law of gravitation
-has been accepted as holding sway over all phenomena
-visible within our planetary world.</p>
-
-<p>The intricacies of our own solar system being<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_212" id="Page_212">[212]</a></span>
-thus illumined, the restless activity of the human
-intellect was stimulated to search beyond for new
-problems and new mysteries. Even more fascinating
-than the movements of our sun and
-planets are all those questions that relate to the
-clustered stellar congeries hanging suspended
-within the deep vault of night. Does the same
-law of gravitation cast its magic spell over that
-hazy cloud of Pleiades, binding them, like ourselves,
-with bonds indissoluble? Who shall answer,
-yes or no? We can only say that astronomers
-have as yet but stepped upon the threshold
-of the universe, and fixed the telescope's great
-eye upon that which is within.</p>
-
-<p>Let us then begin by reminding the reader
-what is meant by the Newtonian law of gravitation.
-It appears all things possess the remarkable
-property of attracting or pulling each other.
-Newton declared that all substances, solid, liquid,
-or even gaseous&mdash;from the massive cliff of
-rock down to the invisible air&mdash;all matter can
-no more help pulling than it can help existing.
-His law further formulates certain conditions
-governing the manner in which this gravitational<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_213" id="Page_213">[213]</a></span>
-attraction is exerted; but these are mere matters
-of detail; interest centres about the mysterious
-fact of attraction itself. How can one thing pull
-another with no connecting link through which
-the pull can act? Just here we touch the point
-that has never yet been explained. Nature withholds
-from science her ultimate secrets. They
-that have pondered longest, that have descended
-farthest of all men into the clear well of knowledge,
-have done so but to sound the depths beyond,
-never touching bottom.</p>
-
-<p>This inability of ours, to give a good physical
-explanation of gravitation, has led certain makers
-of paradoxes to doubt or even deny that there is
-any such thing. But, fortunately, we have a simple
-laboratory experiment that helps us. Unexplained
-it may ever remain, but that there
-can be attraction between physical objects connected
-by no visible link is proved by the behavior
-of an ordinary magnet. Place a small
-piece of steel or iron near a magnetized bar, and
-it will at once be so strongly attracted that it
-will actually fly to the magnet. Anyone who
-has seen this simple experiment can never again<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_214" id="Page_214">[214]</a></span>
-deny the possibility, at least, of the law of attraction
-as stated by Newton. Its possibility once
-admitted, the fact that it can predict the motions
-of all the planets, even down to their minutest
-details, transforms the possibility of its truth into
-a certainty as strong as any human certainty can
-ever be.</p>
-
-<p>But this demonstration of Newton's law is
-limited strictly to the solar system itself. We
-may, indeed, reason by analogy, and take for
-granted that a law which holds within our immediate
-neighborhood is extremely likely to be true
-also of the entire visible universe. But men of
-science are loath to reason thus; and hence the
-fascination of researches in cosmic astronomy.
-Analogy points out the path. The astronomer
-is not slow to follow; but he seeks ever to
-establish upon incontrovertible evidence those
-truths which at first only his daring imagination
-had led him to half suspect.</p>
-
-<p>If we are to extend the law of gravitation to
-the utmost, we must be careful to consider the
-law itself in its most complete form. A heavenly
-body like the sun is often said to govern the<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_215" id="Page_215">[215]</a></span>
-motions of its family of planets; but such a statement
-is not strictly accurate. The governing
-body is no despot; 'tis an abject slave of law and
-order, as much as the tiniest of attendant planets.
-The action of gravitation is mutual, and no
-cosmic body can attract another without being
-itself in turn subject to that other's gravitational
-action.</p>
-
-<p>If there were in our solar system but two bodies,
-sun and planet, we should find each one pursuing
-a path in space under the influence of the
-other's attraction. These two paths or orbits
-would be oval, and if the sun and planet were
-equally massive, the orbits would be exactly
-alike, both in shape and size. But if the sun
-were far larger than the planet, the orbits would
-still be similar in form, but the one traversed by
-the larger body would be small. For it is not
-reasonable to expect a little planet to keep the
-big sun moving with a velocity as great as that
-derived by itself from the attraction of the
-larger orb.</p>
-
-<p>Whenever the preponderance of the larger
-body is extremely great, its orbit will be corre<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_216" id="Page_216">[216]</a></span>spondingly
-insignificant in size. This is in fact
-the case with our own sun. So massive is it in
-comparison with the planets that the orbit is too
-small to reveal its actual existence without the
-aid of our most refined instruments. The path
-traced out by the sun's centre would not fill a
-space as large as the sun's own bulk. Nevertheless,
-true orbital motion is there.</p>
-
-<p>So we may conclude that as a necessary consequence
-of the law of gravitation every object
-within the solar system is in motion. To say
-that planets revolve about the sun is to neglect
-as unimportant the small orbit of the sun itself.
-This may be sufficiently accurate for ordinary
-purposes; but it is unquestionably necessary to
-neglect no factor, however small, if we propose
-to extend our reasoning to a consideration of the
-stellar universe. For we shall then have to deal
-with systems in which the planets are of a size
-comparable with the sun; and in such systems
-all the orbits will also be of comparatively equal
-importance.</p>
-
-<p>Mathematical analysis has derived another fact
-from discussion of the law of gravitation which,<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_217" id="Page_217">[217]</a></span>
-perhaps, transcends in simple grandeur everything
-we have as yet mentioned. It matters not
-how great may be the number of massive orbs
-threading their countless interlacing curved paths
-in space, there yet must be in every cosmic system
-one single point immovable. This point is
-called the Centre of Gravity. If it should so
-happen that in the beginning of things, some
-particle of matter were situated at this centre,
-then would that atom ever remain unmoved and
-imperturbable throughout all the successive vicissitudes
-of cosmic evolution. It is doubtful
-whether the mind of man can form a conception
-of anything grander than such an immovable
-atom within the mysterious intricacies of cosmic
-motion.</p>
-
-<p>But in general, we cannot suppose that the
-centres of gravity in the various stellar systems
-are really occupied by actual physical bodies.
-The centre may be a mere mathematical point in
-space, situated among the several bodies composing
-the system, but, nevertheless, endowed, in a
-certain sense, with the same remarkable property
-of relative immobility.</p>
-
-<p><span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_218" id="Page_218">[218]</a></span></p>
-
-<p>Having thus defined the centre of gravity in
-its relation to the constituent parts of any cosmic
-system, we can pass easily to its characteristic
-properties in connection with the inter-relation
-of stellar systems with one another. It can be
-proved mathematically that our solar system will
-pull upon distant stars just as though the sun
-and all the planets were concentrated into one
-vast sphere having its centre in the centre of
-gravity of the whole. It is this property of the
-centre of gravity which makes it pre-eminently
-important in cosmic researches. For, while we
-know that centre to be at rest relatively to all
-the planets in the system, it may, nevertheless,
-in its quality as a sort of concentrated essence of
-them all, be moving swiftly through space under
-the pull of distant stars. In that case, the attendant
-bodies will go with it&mdash;but they will
-pursue their evolutions within the system, all unconscious
-that the centre of gravity is carrying
-them on a far wider circuit.</p>
-
-<p>What is the nature of that circuit? This
-question has been for many years the subject of
-earnest study by the clearest minds among as<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_219" id="Page_219">[219]</a></span>tronomers.
-The greatest difficulty in the way is
-the comparatively brief period during which men
-have been able to make astronomical observations
-of precision. Space and time are two conceptions
-that transcend the powers of definition
-possessed by any man. But we can at least
-form a notion of how vast is the extent of time,
-if we remember that the period covered by man's
-written records is registered but as a single moment
-upon the great revolving dial of heaven's
-dome. One hundred and fifty years have
-elapsed since James Bradley built the foundations
-of modern sidereal astronomy upon his masterly
-series of observations at the Royal Observatory
-of Greenwich, in England. Yet so slowly
-do the movements of the stars unroll themselves
-upon the firmament, that even to this day no
-one of them has been seen by men to trace out
-more than an infinitesimal fraction of its destined
-path through the voids of space.</p>
-
-<p>Travellers upon a railroad cannot tell at any
-given moment whether they are moving in a
-straight line, or whether the train is turning
-upon some curve of huge size. The St. Goth<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_220" id="Page_220">[220]</a></span>ard
-railway has several so-called "corkscrew"
-tunnels, within which the rails make a complete
-turn in a spiral, the train finally emerging from
-the tunnel at a point almost vertically over the
-entrance. In this way the train is lifted to a
-higher level. Passengers are wont to amuse
-themselves while in these tunnels by watching
-the needle of an ordinary pocket-compass. This
-needle, of course, always points to the north;
-and as the train turns upon its curve, the needle
-will make a complete revolution. But the passenger
-could not know without the compass
-that the train was not moving in a perfectly
-straight line. Just so we passengers on the
-earth are unaware of the kind of path we are
-traversing, until, like the compass, the astronomer's
-instruments shall reveal to us the
-truth.</p>
-
-<p>But as we have seen, astronomical observations
-of precision have not as yet extended through a
-period of time corresponding to the few minutes
-during which the St. Gothard traveller watches
-the compass. We are still in the dark, and do
-not know as yet whether mankind shall last long<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_221" id="Page_221">[221]</a></span>
-enough upon the earth to see the compass needle
-make its revolution. We are compelled to believe
-that the motion in space of our sun is progressing
-upon a curved path; but so far as precise
-observations allow us to speak, we can but
-say that we have as yet moved through an infinitesimal
-element only of that mighty curve. However,
-we know the point upon the sky toward
-which this tiny element of our path is directed,
-and we have an approximate knowledge of the
-speed at which we move.</p>
-
-<p>More than a century ago Sir William Herschel
-was able to fix roughly what we call the apex of
-the sun's way in space, or the point among the
-stars toward which that way is for the moment
-directed. We say for the moment, but we mean
-that moment of which Bradley saw the beginning
-in 1750, and upon whose end no man of those
-now living shall ever look. Herschel found that
-a comparison of old stellar observations seemed
-to indicate that the stars in a certain part of the
-sky were opening out, as it were, and that the
-constellations in the opposite part of the heavens
-seemed to be drawing in, or becoming smaller.<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_222" id="Page_222">[222]</a></span>
-There can be but one reasonable explanation of
-this. We must be moving toward that part of
-the sky where the stars are separating. Just so a
-man watching a regiment of soldiers approaching,
-will see at first only a confused body of men;
-but as they come nearer, the individual soldiers
-will seem to separate, until at length each one is
-seen distinct from all the others.</p>
-
-<p>Herschel fixed the position of the apex at a
-point in the constellation Hercules. The most
-recent investigations of Newcomb and others
-have, on the whole, verified Herschel's conclusions.
-With the intuitive power of rare genius,
-Herschel had been able to sift truth out of error.
-The observational data at his disposal would now
-be called rude, but they disclosed to the scrutiny
-of his acute understanding the germ of truth that
-was in them. Later investigators have increased
-the precision of our knowledge, until we can now
-say that the present direction of the solar motion
-is known within very narrow limits. A tiny circle
-might be drawn on the sky, to which an astronomer
-might point his hand and say: "Yonder little
-circle contains the goal toward which the sun and<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_223" id="Page_223">[223]</a></span>
-planets are hastening to-day." Even the speed
-of this motion has been subjected to measurement,
-and found to be about ten miles per
-second.</p>
-
-<p>The objective point and the rate of motion
-thus stated, exact science holds her peace. Here
-genuine knowledge stops; and we can proceed
-further only by the aid of that imagination which
-men of science need to curb at every moment.
-But let no one think that the sun will ever
-reach the so-called apex. To do so would mean
-cosmic motion upon a straight line, while every
-consideration of celestial mechanics points to motion
-upon a curve. When shall we turn sufficiently
-upon that curve to detect its bending?
-'Tis a problem we must leave as a rich heritage
-to later generations that are to follow us. The
-visionary theorist's notion of a great central sun,
-controlling our own sun's way in space, must be
-dismissed as far too daring. But for such a central
-sun we may substitute a central centre of
-gravity belonging to a great system of which our
-sun is but an insignificant member. Then we
-reach a conception that has lost nothing in the<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_224" id="Page_224">[224]</a></span>
-grandeur of its simplicity, and is yet in accord
-with the probabilities of sober mechanical science.
-We cease to be a lonely world, and stretch out
-the bonds of a common relationship to yonder
-stars within the firmament.</p>
-
-
-<hr class="chap" />
-<p><span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_225" id="Page_225">[225]</a></span></p>
-
-<h2><a name="INDEX" id="INDEX"></a><a href="#CONTENTS">INDEX</a></h2>
-
-
-<div class="center fs90">
-<table border="0" cellpadding="4" cellspacing="0" width="95%" summary="">
-<tr><td class="tdl"></td><td class="tdr xs">PAGE</td></tr>
-<tr><td class="tdl">Airy, Astronomer Royal,</td><td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_1">1</a></td></tr>
-<tr><td class="tdl">Allis, photographs comet,</td><td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_101">101</a></td></tr>
-<tr><td class="tdl">Andromeda nebula,</td><td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_28">28</a></td></tr>
-<tr><td class="tdl pad4">temporary star,</td><td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_28">28</a>, <a href="#Page_29">29</a>, <a href="#Page_45">45</a></td></tr>
-<tr><td class="tdl">Apex, of solar motion, explained,</td><td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_221">221</a></td></tr>
-<tr><td class="tdl">Aquila, constellation, temporary star in,</td><td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_40">40</a></td></tr>
-<tr><td class="tdl">Arctic regions, position of pole in,</td><td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_194">194</a></td></tr>
-<tr><td class="tdl">Argo, constellation, variable star in,</td><td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_205">205</a></td></tr>
-<tr><td class="tdl">Association, international geodetic,</td><td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_139">139</a></td></tr>
-<tr><td class="tdl"><a name="AST" id="AST"></a>Asteroids, first discovery by Piazzi,</td><td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_59">59</a>, <a href="#Page_106">106</a></td></tr>
-<tr><td class="tdl pad4">discovery by photography,</td><td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_64">64</a></td></tr>
-<tr><td class="tdl pad4">group of,</td><td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_63">63</a></td></tr>
-<tr><td class="tdl pad4">photography of, invented by Wolf,</td><td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_104">104</a></td></tr>
-<tr><td class="tdl">Astronomer, royal,</td><td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_1">1</a></td></tr>
-<tr><td class="tdl pad4">working, description of,</td><td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_152">152</a></td></tr>
-<tr><td class="tdl smcap">Astronomer's Pole, the,</td><td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_184">184</a></td></tr>
-<tr><td class="tdl">Astronomy, journalistic,</td><td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_176">176</a></td></tr>
-<tr><td class="tdl pad4">practical uses of,</td><td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_112">112</a></td></tr>
-<tr><td class="tdl">Atmospheric refraction, explained,</td><td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_193">193</a></td></tr>
-<tr><td class="tdl">Axis, of figure of the earth,</td><td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_136">136</a></td></tr>
-<tr><td class="tdl pad4">of rotation of the earth,</td><td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_136">136</a></td></tr>
-<tr><td class="tdl pad4">polar, of telescope,</td><td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_173">173</a></td></tr>
-
-<tr><td class="tdl">&nbsp;</td></tr>
-<tr><td class="tdl">Barnard, discovers satellite of Jupiter,</td><td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_51">51</a></td></tr>
-<tr><td class="tdl">Bessel, measures Pleiades,</td><td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_15">15</a></td></tr>
-<tr><td class="tdl">Bond, discovers crape ring of Saturn,</td><td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_144">144</a></td></tr>
-<tr><td class="tdl">Bradley, observes at Greenwich,</td><td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_219">219</a></td></tr>
-<tr><td class="tdl">Brahe, Tycho, his temporary star,</td><td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_40">40</a></td></tr>
-<tr><td class="tdl">Bruce, endows polar photography,</td><td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_197">197</a></td></tr>
-
-<tr><td class="tdl">&nbsp;</td></tr>
-<tr><td class="tdl"><span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_226" id="Page_226">[226]</a></span>
- Campbell, observes Pole-star,</td><td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_18">18</a></td></tr>
-<tr><td class="tdl">Cape of Good Hope, observatory, photography at,</td><td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_101">101</a></td></tr>
-<tr><td class="tdl pad4">telescope,</td><td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_170">170</a>, <a href="#Page_174">174</a></td></tr>
-<tr><td class="tdl"><i lang="it" xml:lang="it">Capriccio</i>, Galileo's,</td><td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_55">55</a></td></tr>
-<tr><td class="tdl">Cassini, shows Saturn's rings to be double,</td><td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_144">144</a></td></tr>
-<tr><td class="tdl">Cassiopeia, temporary star in,</td><td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_40">40</a></td></tr>
-<tr><td class="tdl">Celestial pole,</td><td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_184">184</a></td></tr>
-<tr><td class="tdl">Central sun theory,</td><td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_223">223</a></td></tr>
-<tr><td class="tdl">Centre of gravity,</td><td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_217">217</a></td></tr>
-<tr><td class="tdl">Chart-room, on ship-board,</td><td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_5">5</a></td></tr>
-<tr><td class="tdl">Chronometer, invention of,</td><td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_8">8</a></td></tr>
-<tr><td class="tdl">Circle, meridian, explained,</td><td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_189">189</a></td></tr>
-<tr><td class="tdl">Clerk Maxwell, discusses Saturn's rings,</td><td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_146">146</a></td></tr>
-<tr><td class="tdl">Clock, affected by temperature,</td><td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_117">117</a></td></tr>
-<tr><td class="tdl pad4">affected by barometric pressure,</td><td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_117">117</a></td></tr>
-<tr><td class="tdl pad4">astronomical,</td><td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_115">115</a></td></tr>
-<tr><td class="tdl pad4">astronomical, how mounted,</td><td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_116">116</a></td></tr>
-<tr><td class="tdl pad4">astronomical, its dial,</td><td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_116">116</a></td></tr>
-<tr><td class="tdl pad4">error of, determined with transit,</td><td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_118">118</a></td></tr>
-<tr><td class="tdl pad4">jeweller's regulator,</td><td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_114">114</a></td></tr>
-<tr><td class="tdl pad4">of telescope,</td><td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_175">175</a></td></tr>
-<tr><td class="tdl">Clusters of stars, photography of,</td><td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_98">98</a></td></tr>
-<tr><td class="tdl">Columbia University Observatory, latitude observations,</td><td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_139">139</a></td></tr>
-<tr><td class="tdl pad4">polar photography,</td><td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_196">196</a></td></tr>
-<tr><td class="tdl">Common, his reflecting telescope,</td><td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_32">32</a></td></tr>
-<tr><td class="tdl">Confusion of dates, in Pacific Ocean,</td><td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_125">125</a></td></tr>
-<tr><td class="tdl">Congress of Astronomers, Paris, 1887,</td><td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_102">102</a></td></tr>
-<tr><td class="tdl">Constellations,</td><td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_162">162</a></td></tr>
-<tr><td class="tdl">Control, "mouse," for photography,</td><td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_88">88</a></td></tr>
-<tr><td class="tdl">Copernican theory of universe,</td><td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_53">53</a>, <a href="#Page_56">56</a></td></tr>
-<tr><td class="tdl pad4">demonstration,</td><td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_94">94</a></td></tr>
-<tr><td class="tdl">Corkscrew tunnels,</td><td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_220">220</a></td></tr>
-<tr><td class="tdl">Crape ring of Saturn,</td><td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_144">144</a></td></tr>
-<tr><td class="tdl">Cumulative effect, in photography,</td><td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_84">84</a></td></tr>
-
-<tr><td class="tdl">&nbsp;</td></tr>
-<tr><td class="tdl">Date, confusion of, in Pacific Ocean,</td><td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_125">125</a></td></tr>
-<tr><td class="tdl">Date-line, international, explained,</td><td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_126">126</a></td></tr>
-<tr><td class="tdl">Development of photograph,</td><td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_81">81</a></td></tr>
-<tr><td class="tdl"><span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_227" id="Page_227">[227]</a></span>
- Dial, of astronomical clock,</td><td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_116">116</a></td></tr>
-<tr><td class="tdl">"Dialogue" of Galileo,</td><td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_53">53</a></td></tr>
-<tr><td class="tdl">Differences of time, explained,</td><td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_121">121</a></td></tr>
-<tr><td class="tdl">Directions, telescopic measurement of,</td><td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_21">21</a></td></tr>
-<tr><td class="tdl">Directory of the heavens,</td><td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_103">103</a></td></tr>
-<tr><td class="tdl">Distance, of light-source in photography,</td><td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_83">83</a></td></tr>
-<tr><td class="tdl pad4">of stars,</td><td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_94">94</a>, <a href="#Page_106">106</a>, <a href="#Page_158">158</a></td></tr>
-<tr><td class="tdl pad4">of Sun,</td><td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_67">67</a>, <a href="#Page_97">97</a>, <a href="#Page_106">106</a></td></tr>
-<tr><td class="tdl">Donner, polar photography,</td><td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_195">195</a></td></tr>
-<tr><td class="tdl">Double telescopes, for photography,</td><td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_86">86</a></td></tr>
-
-<tr><td class="tdl">&nbsp;</td></tr>
-<tr><td class="tdl">Earth, motions of its pole,</td><td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_131">131</a></td></tr>
-<tr><td class="tdl pad4">rotation of,</td><td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_136">136</a>, <a href="#Page_162">162</a>, <a href="#Page_171">171</a>, <a href="#Page_184">184</a></td></tr>
-<tr><td class="tdl pad4">shape of,</td><td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_135">135</a></td></tr>
-<tr><td class="tdl">Eclipses, photography of,</td><td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_109">109</a></td></tr>
-<tr><td class="tdl">Elkin, measures Pleiades,</td><td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_15">15</a></td></tr>
-<tr><td class="tdl">Equatorial telescope, explained,</td><td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_170">170</a></td></tr>
-<tr><td class="tdl">Eros, discovered by Witt,</td><td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_66">66</a>, <a href="#Page_105">105</a></td></tr>
-<tr><td class="tdl pad4">its importance,</td><td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_67">67</a></td></tr>
-<tr><td class="tdl">Error of clock, determined by transit,</td><td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_118">118</a></td></tr>
-<tr><td class="tdl">Exposure, length of, in photography,</td><td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_84">84</a></td></tr>
-
-<tr><td class="tdl">&nbsp;</td></tr>
-<tr><td class="tdl">Feldhausen, Herschel's observatory near Capetown,</td><td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_204">204</a></td></tr>
-<tr><td class="tdl">Fiji Islands, their date,</td><td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_126">126</a></td></tr>
-<tr><td class="tdl">Fixed polar telescope,</td><td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_197">197</a></td></tr>
-<tr><td class="tdl">"Following" the stars,</td><td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_88">88</a>, <a href="#Page_173">173</a></td></tr>
-<tr><td class="tdl">Four-day cycle of pole-star,</td><td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_24">24</a></td></tr>
-<tr><td class="tdl">France, outside time-zone system,</td><td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_129">129</a></td></tr>
-<tr><td class="tdl">Fundamental longitude meridian,</td><td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_124">124</a></td></tr>
-
-<tr><td class="tdl">&nbsp;</td></tr>
-<tr><td class="tdl smcap">Galileo,</td><td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_47">47</a></td></tr>
-<tr><td class="tdl pad4">and the Church,</td><td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_48">48</a></td></tr>
-<tr><td class="tdl pad4">discoveries of,</td><td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_49">49</a></td></tr>
-<tr><td class="tdl pad4">observes Saturn,</td><td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_141">141</a></td></tr>
-<tr><td class="tdl">Galle, discovers Neptune,</td><td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_61">61</a></td></tr>
-<tr><td class="tdl">Gauss, computes first asteroid orbit,</td><td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_60">60</a></td></tr>
-<tr><td class="tdl">Gautier, Paris, constructs big telescope,</td><td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_179">179</a></td></tr>
-<tr><td class="tdl">Geodetic Association, international,</td><td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_139">139</a></td></tr>
-<tr><td class="tdl"><span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_228" id="Page_228">[228]</a></span>
- Geography, maps, astronomical side of,</td><td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_112">112</a></td></tr>
-<tr><td class="tdl">Geology, polar motion in,</td><td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_131">131</a></td></tr>
-<tr><td class="tdl">Gill, photographs comet,</td><td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_100">100</a></td></tr>
-<tr><td class="tdl">Gilliss, at Naval Observatory, Washington,</td><td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_169">169</a></td></tr>
-<tr><td class="tdl">Goldsborough, at Naval Observatory, Washington,</td><td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_169">169</a></td></tr>
-<tr><td class="tdl"><i lang="fr" xml:lang="fr">Grande Lunette</i>, Paris, 1900,</td><td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_176">176</a>, <a href="#Page_180">180</a></td></tr>
-<tr><td class="tdl">Gravitation,</td><td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_13">13</a></td></tr>
-<tr><td class="tdl pad4">in Pleiades,</td><td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_14">14</a>, <a href="#Page_212">212</a></td></tr>
-<tr><td class="tdl pad4">law of, Newton's,</td><td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_212">212</a></td></tr>
-<tr><td class="tdl">Gravity, centre of,</td><td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_217">217</a></td></tr>
-<tr><td class="tdl">Greenwich, origin of longitudes,</td><td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_7">7</a>, <a href="#Page_124">124</a></td></tr>
-<tr><td class="tdl pad4">time,</td><td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_7">7</a></td></tr>
-<tr><td class="tdl">Groombridge, English astronomer,</td><td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_1">1</a></td></tr>
-
-<tr><td class="tdl">&nbsp;</td></tr>
-<tr><td class="tdl">Harrison, inventor of chronometer,</td><td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_8">8</a></td></tr>
-<tr><td class="tdl">Head, of heliometer,</td><td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_156">156</a></td></tr>
-<tr><td class="tdl">Heidelberg, photography at,</td><td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_104">104</a></td></tr>
-<tr><td class="tdl smcap">Heliometer,</td><td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_152">152</a></td></tr>
-<tr><td class="tdl pad4">head of,</td><td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_156">156</a></td></tr>
-<tr><td class="tdl pad4">how used,</td><td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_157">157</a></td></tr>
-<tr><td class="tdl pad4">principle of,</td><td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_154">154</a></td></tr>
-<tr><td class="tdl pad4">scales of,</td><td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_158">158</a></td></tr>
-<tr><td class="tdl pad4">semi-lenses of,</td><td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_155">155</a></td></tr>
-<tr><td class="tdl">Helsingfors observatory, polar photography at,</td><td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_195">195</a></td></tr>
-<tr><td class="tdl">Henry, measures Pleiades,</td><td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_11">11</a>, <a href="#Page_17">17</a></td></tr>
-<tr><td class="tdl">Hercules, constellation, solar motion toward,</td><td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_222">222</a></td></tr>
-<tr><td class="tdl">Herschel, discovers apex of solar motion,</td><td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_221">221</a></td></tr>
-<tr><td class="tdl pad4">discovers Uranus,</td><td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_59">59</a>, <a href="#Page_141">141</a></td></tr>
-<tr><td class="tdl pad4">John, the moon hoax,</td><td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_200">200</a></td></tr>
-<tr><td class="tdl">Hipparchus, discovers precession,</td><td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_186">186</a></td></tr>
-<tr><td class="tdl pad4">early star-catalogue,</td><td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_21">21</a>, <a href="#Page_39">39</a></td></tr>
-<tr><td class="tdl pad4">invents star magnitudes,</td><td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_91">91</a></td></tr>
-<tr><td class="tdl">Huygens, announces rings of Saturn,</td><td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_142">142</a></td></tr>
-<tr><td class="tdl pad4">his logogriph,</td><td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_143">143</a></td></tr>
-
-<tr><td class="tdl">&nbsp;</td></tr>
-<tr><td class="tdl">Ice-cap, of Earth,</td><td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_131">131</a></td></tr>
-<tr><td class="tdl"><i lang="la" xml:lang="la">Index Librorum Prohibitorum</i>,</td><td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_53">53</a></td></tr>
-<tr><td class="tdl">International, date-line, explained,</td><td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_126">126</a></td></tr>
-<tr><td class="tdl pad4">geodetic association,</td><td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_139">139</a></td></tr>
-<tr><td class="tdl"><span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_229" id="Page_229">[229]</a></span>
- Inter-stellar motion, in clusters,</td><td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_98">98</a></td></tr>
-<tr><td class="tdl pad4">in Pleiades,</td><td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_14">14</a></td></tr>
-<tr><td class="tdl">Islands of Pacific, their longitude and time,</td><td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_125">125</a></td></tr>
-
-<tr><td class="tdl">&nbsp;</td></tr>
-<tr><td class="tdl">Japan, latitude station in,</td><td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_139">139</a></td></tr>
-<tr><td class="tdl">Jewellers' correct time,</td><td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_121">121</a></td></tr>
-<tr><td class="tdl">Journalistic astronomy,</td><td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_176">176</a></td></tr>
-<tr><td class="tdl">Jupiter's satellites, discovered by Galileo,</td><td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_50">50</a></td></tr>
-<tr><td class="tdl pad4">discovered by Barnard,</td><td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_51">51</a></td></tr>
-
-<tr><td class="tdl">&nbsp;</td></tr>
-<tr><td class="tdl">Keeler, observes Saturn's rings,</td><td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_140">140</a>, <a href="#Page_147">147</a>, <a href="#Page_150">150</a></td></tr>
-<tr><td class="tdl pad4">photographs nebulæ,</td><td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_32">32</a></td></tr>
-<tr><td class="tdl">"Keyhole" nebula,</td><td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_205">205</a></td></tr>
-
-<tr><td class="tdl">&nbsp;</td></tr>
-<tr><td class="tdl">Lambert, determines longitude of Washington,</td><td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_168">168</a></td></tr>
-<tr><td class="tdl">Laplace, discusses Saturn's rings,</td><td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_146">146</a></td></tr>
-<tr><td class="tdl pad4">nebular hypothesis,</td><td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_33">33</a></td></tr>
-<tr><td class="tdl pad4">stability of solar system,</td><td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_210">210</a></td></tr>
-<tr><td class="tdl">Latitude, changes of,</td><td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_133">133</a>, <a href="#Page_138">138</a></td></tr>
-<tr><td class="tdl pad4">definition of,</td><td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_134">134</a></td></tr>
-<tr><td class="tdl pad4">determining the,</td><td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_6">6</a></td></tr>
-<tr><td class="tdl">Leverrier, predicts discovery of Neptune,</td><td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_61">61</a>, <a href="#Page_142">142</a></td></tr>
-<tr><td class="tdl">Lick Observatory, Keeler's observations,</td><td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_140">140</a></td></tr>
-<tr><td class="tdl">Light, undulatory theory of,</td><td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_19">19</a>, <a href="#Page_148">148</a></td></tr>
-<tr><td class="tdl">Light-waves, measuring length of,</td><td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_20">20</a>, <a href="#Page_149">149</a></td></tr>
-<tr><td class="tdl">Logogriph, by Huygens,</td><td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_143">143</a></td></tr>
-<tr><td class="tdl">Long-exposure photography,</td><td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_85">85</a></td></tr>
-<tr><td class="tdl">Longitude, counted East and West,</td><td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_125">125</a></td></tr>
-<tr><td class="tdl pad4">determining,</td><td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_6">6</a></td></tr>
-<tr><td class="tdl pad4">determining by occultations,</td><td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_167">167</a></td></tr>
-<tr><td class="tdl pad4">effect on time differences,</td><td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_123">123</a></td></tr>
-<tr><td class="tdl pad4">explained,</td><td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_123">123</a></td></tr>
-<tr><td class="tdl pad4">of Washington, first determined,</td><td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_168">168</a></td></tr>
-
-<tr><td class="tdl">&nbsp;</td></tr>
-<tr><td class="tdl">Maclear, observes Eta Argus,</td><td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_205">205</a></td></tr>
-<tr><td class="tdl">Magnitudes, stellar,</td><td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_91">91</a></td></tr>
-<tr><td class="tdl">Manila, its time,</td><td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_127">127</a></td></tr>
-<tr><td class="tdl">Maps, astronomical side of,</td><td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_112">112</a></td></tr>
-<tr><td class="tdl"><span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_230" id="Page_230">[230]</a></span>
- Meridian circle, explained,</td><td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_189">189</a></td></tr>
-<tr><td class="tdl">Milky-way, poor in nebulæ,</td><td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_33">33</a></td></tr>
-<tr><td class="tdl">Minor Planets, see <a href="#AST">Asteroids.</a></td></tr>
-<tr><td class="tdl smcap">Moon, Hoax,</td><td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_199">199</a></td></tr>
-<tr><td class="tdl pad4">motion among stars,</td><td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_163">163</a></td></tr>
-<tr><td class="tdl pad4">mountains discovered by Galileo,</td><td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_49">49</a></td></tr>
-<tr><td class="tdl pad4">size of, measured,</td><td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_166">166</a></td></tr>
-<tr><td class="tdl">Motion of moon,</td><td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_163">163</a></td></tr>
-<tr><td class="tdl"><span class="smcap">Motions</span> of the <span class="smcap">Earth's</span> Pole,</td><td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_131">131</a></td></tr>
-<tr><td class="tdl smcap">Mounting Great Telescopes,</td><td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_170">170</a></td></tr>
-
-<tr><td class="tdl">&nbsp;</td></tr>
-<tr><td class="tdl">Naked-eye nebulæ,</td><td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_28">28</a></td></tr>
-<tr><td class="tdl">Naples, Royal Observatory, latitude observations,</td><td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_139">139</a></td></tr>
-<tr><td class="tdl">Naval Observatory, Washington, noon signal,</td><td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_120">120</a></td></tr>
-<tr><td class="tdl smcap">Navigation,</td><td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_1">1</a></td></tr>
-<tr><td class="tdl pad4">before chronometers,</td><td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_3">3</a></td></tr>
-<tr><td class="tdl pad4">use of astronomy in,</td><td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_113">113</a></td></tr>
-<tr><td class="tdl smcap">Nebulæ,</td><td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_27">27</a></td></tr>
-<tr><td class="tdl">Nebula, in Andromeda,</td><td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_28">28</a></td></tr>
-<tr><td class="tdl pad4">in Orion,</td><td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_30">30</a></td></tr>
-<tr><td class="tdl pad4">"keyhole",</td><td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_205">205</a></td></tr>
-<tr><td class="tdl">Nebular, hypothesis,</td><td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_33">33</a></td></tr>
-<tr><td class="tdl pad4">structure in Pleiades,</td><td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_17">17</a></td></tr>
-<tr><td class="tdl">Nebulous stars,</td><td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_31">31</a></td></tr>
-<tr><td class="tdl">Negative, and positive, in photography,</td><td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_82">82</a></td></tr>
-<tr><td class="tdl">Neptune, discovery predicted by Leverrier,</td><td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_61">61</a>, <a href="#Page_142">142</a></td></tr>
-<tr><td class="tdl pad4">discovery by Galle,</td><td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_61">61</a></td></tr>
-<tr><td class="tdl">Newcomb, fixes apex of solar motion,</td><td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_222">222</a></td></tr>
-<tr><td class="tdl">Newton, law of gravitation,</td><td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_212">212</a></td></tr>
-<tr><td class="tdl pad4">longitude commission,</td><td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_8">8</a></td></tr>
-<tr><td class="tdl">New York, its telegraphic time system,</td><td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_120">120</a></td></tr>
-<tr><td class="tdl">Noon Signal, Washington,</td><td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_120">120</a></td></tr>
-<tr><td class="tdl">Number, of nebulæ,</td><td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_31">31</a>, <a href="#Page_33">33</a></td></tr>
-<tr><td class="tdl pad4">of temporary stars,</td><td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_38">38</a></td></tr>
-<tr><td class="tdl">Nutation, explained,</td><td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_188">188</a></td></tr>
-
-<tr><td class="tdl">&nbsp;</td></tr>
-<tr><td class="tdl">Occultations,</td><td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_161">161</a></td></tr>
-<tr><td class="tdl pad4">explained,</td><td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_165">165</a></td></tr>
-<tr><td class="tdl"><span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_231" id="Page_231">[231]</a></span>
- Occultations, use of,</td><td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_166">166</a>, <a href="#Page_167">167</a></td></tr>
-<tr><td class="tdl">Orion nebula,</td><td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_30">30</a></td></tr>
-
-<tr><td class="tdl">&nbsp;</td></tr>
-<tr><td class="tdl">Pacific islands, their longitude and time,</td><td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_125">125</a></td></tr>
-<tr><td class="tdl">Parallax, solar,</td><td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_67">67</a>, <a href="#Page_106">106</a></td></tr>
-<tr><td class="tdl pad4">stellar,</td><td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_94">94</a>, <a href="#Page_106">106</a></td></tr>
-<tr><td class="tdl pad4">measured with heliometer,</td><td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_158">158</a></td></tr>
-<tr><td class="tdl">Paris, congress of astronomers, 1887,</td><td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_102">102</a></td></tr>
-<tr><td class="tdl pad4">exposition of 1900,</td><td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_176">176</a></td></tr>
-<tr><td class="tdl">Periodic motion of earth's pole,</td><td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_133">133</a></td></tr>
-<tr><td class="tdl">Perseus, constellation, temporary star in,</td><td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_46">46</a></td></tr>
-<tr><td class="tdl">Philippine Islands, their time,</td><td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_127">127</a></td></tr>
-<tr><td class="tdl">Photography, asteroid, invented by Wolf,</td><td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_104">104</a></td></tr>
-<tr><td class="tdl pad4">congress of astronomical,</td><td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_102">102</a></td></tr>
-<tr><td class="tdl pad4">cumulative effect of light,</td><td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_84">84</a></td></tr>
-<tr><td class="tdl pad4">distance of light-source,</td><td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_83">83</a></td></tr>
-<tr><td class="tdl pad4">double telescopes for,</td><td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_86">86</a></td></tr>
-<tr><td class="tdl pad4">general star-catalogue,</td><td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_102">102</a></td></tr>
-<tr><td class="tdl pad4 smcap">In Astronomy,</td><td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_81">81</a></td></tr>
-<tr><td class="tdl pad4">in discovery of asteroids,</td><td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_64">64</a>, <a href="#Page_104">104</a></td></tr>
-<tr><td class="tdl pad4">in solar physics,</td><td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_109">109</a></td></tr>
-<tr><td class="tdl pad4">in spectroscopy,</td><td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_108">108</a></td></tr>
-<tr><td class="tdl pad4">length of exposure,</td><td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_84">84</a></td></tr>
-<tr><td class="tdl pad4">measuring-machine, Rutherfurd,</td><td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_93">93</a></td></tr>
-<tr><td class="tdl pad4">motion of telescope for,</td><td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_87">87</a></td></tr>
-<tr><td class="tdl pad4">"mouse" control of telescope,</td><td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_88">88</a></td></tr>
-<tr><td class="tdl pad4">of eclipses,</td><td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_109">109</a></td></tr>
-<tr><td class="tdl pad4">of inter-stellar motion,</td><td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_99">99</a></td></tr>
-<tr><td class="tdl pad4">Paris congress, 1877,</td><td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_102">102</a></td></tr>
-<tr><td class="tdl pad4">polar,</td><td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_191">191</a></td></tr>
-<tr><td class="tdl pad4">Rutherfurd pioneer in,</td><td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_90">90</a></td></tr>
-<tr><td class="tdl pad4">star-clusters,</td><td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_98">98</a></td></tr>
-<tr><td class="tdl pad4">star-distances measured by,</td><td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_94">94</a></td></tr>
-<tr><td class="tdl pad4">summarized,</td><td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_110">110</a></td></tr>
-<tr><td class="tdl pad4">wholesale methods in,</td><td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_103">103</a></td></tr>
-<tr><td class="tdl">Piazzi, discovers first asteroid,</td><td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_59">59</a>, <a href="#Page_106">106</a></td></tr>
-<tr><td class="tdl">Pitkin, report to House of Representatives,</td><td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_168">168</a></td></tr>
-<tr><td class="tdl">Planetary nebulæ,</td><td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_31">31</a></td></tr>
-<tr><td class="tdl smcap"><span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_232" id="Page_232">[232]</a></span>
- Planet of 1898,</td><td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_58">58</a></td></tr>
-<tr><td class="tdl">Planetoids, see <a href="#AST">Asteroids.</a></td></tr>
-<tr><td class="tdl">Planets known to ancients,</td><td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_58">58</a></td></tr>
-<tr><td class="tdl smcap">Pleiades,</td><td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_10">10</a></td></tr>
-<tr><td class="tdl pad4">gravitation among,</td><td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_212">212</a></td></tr>
-<tr><td class="tdl pad4">motion among,</td><td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_14">14</a>, <a href="#Page_16">16</a>, <a href="#Page_98">98</a></td></tr>
-<tr><td class="tdl pad4">nebular structure,</td><td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_17">17</a></td></tr>
-<tr><td class="tdl pad4">number visible,</td><td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_11">11</a></td></tr>
-<tr><td class="tdl">Polar axis, of telescope,</td><td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_173">173</a></td></tr>
-<tr><td class="tdl">Polar photography,</td><td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_191">191</a></td></tr>
-<tr><td class="tdl pad4">at Helsingfors,</td><td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_195">195</a></td></tr>
-<tr><td class="tdl">Pole, celestial,</td><td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_184">184</a></td></tr>
-<tr><td class="tdl pad4">of the earth, motions of,</td><td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_131">131</a></td></tr>
-<tr><td class="tdl pad4 smcap">the Astronomer's,</td><td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_184">184</a></td></tr>
-<tr><td class="tdl smcap">Pole-Star,</td><td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_18">18</a></td></tr>
-<tr><td class="tdl pad4">as a binary,</td><td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_25">25</a></td></tr>
-<tr><td class="tdl pad4">as a triple,</td><td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_18">18</a>, <a href="#Page_26">26</a></td></tr>
-<tr><td class="tdl pad4">change of,</td><td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_187">187</a></td></tr>
-<tr><td class="tdl pad4">its four-day cycle,</td><td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_24">24</a></td></tr>
-<tr><td class="tdl pad4">motion toward us,</td><td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_24">24</a></td></tr>
-<tr><td class="tdl">Positive, and negative, in photography,</td><td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_82">82</a></td></tr>
-<tr><td class="tdl">Potsdam, observatory, photographic star-catalogue,</td><td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_103">103</a></td></tr>
-<tr><td class="tdl">Practical uses of astronomy,</td><td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_112">112</a></td></tr>
-<tr><td class="tdl">Precession, explained,</td><td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_186">186</a></td></tr>
-<tr><td class="tdl">Prize, for invention of chronometer,</td><td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_8">8</a></td></tr>
-<tr><td class="tdl">Ptolemaic theory of universe,</td><td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_56">56</a></td></tr>
-<tr><td class="tdl">Ptolemy, writes concerning Hipparchus,</td><td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_39">39</a></td></tr>
-
-<tr><td class="tdl">&nbsp;</td></tr>
-<tr><td class="tdl">Railroad time, explained,</td><td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_127">127</a></td></tr>
-<tr><td class="tdl">Refraction, atmospheric, explained,</td><td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_193">193</a></td></tr>
-<tr><td class="tdl">"Regulator," the jeweller's clock,</td><td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_114">114</a></td></tr>
-<tr><td class="tdl">Ring-nebulæ,</td><td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_31">31</a></td></tr>
-<tr><td class="tdl">Rings, of Saturn, see <a href="#SAT">Saturn's rings.</a></td></tr>
-<tr><td class="tdl">Roberts, Andromeda nebula,</td><td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_28">28</a></td></tr>
-<tr><td class="tdl">Rotation, of Earth,</td><td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_136">136</a>, <a href="#Page_162">162</a>, <a href="#Page_171">171</a>, <a href="#Page_184">184</a></td></tr>
-<tr><td class="tdl pad4">of Saturn,</td><td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_150">150</a></td></tr>
-<tr><td class="tdl">Royal Astronomer, his duties,</td><td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_2">2</a></td></tr>
-<tr><td class="tdl">Royal Observatory, Greenwich,</td><td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_124">124</a></td></tr>
-<tr><td class="tdl pad4"><span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_233" id="Page_233">[233]</a></span>
- Greenwich, Bradley's observations,</td><td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_219">219</a></td></tr>
-<tr><td class="tdl pad4">Naples, latitude observations,</td><td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_139">139</a></td></tr>
-<tr><td class="tdl">Rutherfurd, cluster photography,</td><td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_99">99</a></td></tr>
-<tr><td class="tdl pad4">invents photographic apparatus,</td><td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_93">93</a></td></tr>
-<tr><td class="tdl pad4">pioneer in photography,</td><td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_90">90</a></td></tr>
-<tr><td class="tdl pad4">stellar parallax,</td><td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_94">94</a></td></tr>
-
-<tr><td class="tdl">&nbsp;</td></tr>
-<tr><td class="tdl">Sagredus, character in Galileo's Dialogue,</td><td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_55">55</a></td></tr>
-<tr><td class="tdl">Salusbury, Galileo's translator,</td><td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_50">50</a>, <a href="#Page_54">54</a></td></tr>
-<tr><td class="tdl">Salviati, character in Galileo's Dialogue,</td><td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_55">55</a></td></tr>
-<tr><td class="tdl">Samoa, its date,</td><td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_126">126</a></td></tr>
-<tr><td class="tdl smcap"><a name="SAT" id="SAT"></a>Saturn's Rings,</td><td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_140">140</a></td></tr>
-<tr><td class="tdl pad4">analogy to planetoids,</td><td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_147">147</a></td></tr>
-<tr><td class="tdl pad4">announced by Huygens,</td><td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_142">142</a></td></tr>
-<tr><td class="tdl pad4">observed with spectroscope,</td><td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_147">147</a></td></tr>
-<tr><td class="tdl pad4">shown to be double by Cassini,</td><td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_144">144</a></td></tr>
-<tr><td class="tdl pad4">structure and stability,</td><td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_145">145</a></td></tr>
-<tr><td class="tdl">Scales, of heliometer,</td><td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_158">158</a></td></tr>
-<tr><td class="tdl">Scorpio, constellation, temporary star in,</td><td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_39">39</a></td></tr>
-<tr><td class="tdl">Semi-lenses of heliometer,</td><td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_155">155</a></td></tr>
-<tr><td class="tdl">Sextant, how used,</td><td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_4">4</a></td></tr>
-<tr><td class="tdl">Sicily, latitude station in,</td><td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_139">139</a></td></tr>
-<tr><td class="tdl"><i lang="la" xml:lang="la">Sidereus Nuncius</i>, published by Galileo,</td><td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_52">52</a></td></tr>
-<tr><td class="tdl">Simplicio, character in Galileo's Dialogue,</td><td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_55">55</a></td></tr>
-<tr><td class="tdl">Sirius, brightest star,</td><td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_205">205</a></td></tr>
-<tr><td class="tdl">Size of Moon, measured,</td><td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_166">166</a></td></tr>
-<tr><td class="tdl"><i lang="fr" xml:lang="fr">Société de l'Optique</i>,</td><td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_177">177</a></td></tr>
-<tr><td class="tdl">Solar parallax, see <a href="#SUN">Sun's distance.</a></td></tr>
-<tr><td class="tdl pad4">physics, by photography,</td><td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_109">109</a></td></tr>
-<tr><td class="tdl pad4">system, stability of,</td><td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_210">210</a></td></tr>
-<tr><td class="tdl">Spectroscope, its use explained,</td><td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_147">147</a></td></tr>
-<tr><td class="tdl pad4">used on pole-star,</td><td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_19">19</a></td></tr>
-<tr><td class="tdl pad4">to observe Saturn's rings,</td><td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_147">147</a></td></tr>
-<tr><td class="tdl">Spiral nebulæ,</td><td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_31">31</a></td></tr>
-<tr><td class="tdl">Stability, of Saturn's rings,</td><td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_145">145</a></td></tr>
-<tr><td class="tdl pad4">of Solar System,</td><td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_210">210</a></td></tr>
-<tr><td class="tdl">Standards, time, of the world,</td><td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_111">111</a></td></tr>
-<tr><td class="tdl pad4">table of,</td><td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_130">130</a></td></tr>
-<tr><td class="tdl"><span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_234" id="Page_234">[234]</a></span>
- "Standard" time, explained,</td><td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_127">127</a></td></tr>
-<tr><td class="tdl">Star-catalogue, general photographic,</td><td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_102">102</a></td></tr>
-<tr><td class="tdl">Star-clusters, photography of,</td><td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_98">98</a></td></tr>
-<tr><td class="tdl">Star-distances</td><td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_94">94</a>, <a href="#Page_106">106</a></td></tr>
-<tr><td class="tdl pad4">measured with heliometer,</td><td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_158">158</a></td></tr>
-<tr><td class="tdl pad4">Rutherfurd,</td><td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_94">94</a></td></tr>
-<tr><td class="tdl">Star magnitudes,</td><td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_91">91</a></td></tr>
-<tr><td class="tdl">Star-motion, toward us,</td><td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_21">21</a></td></tr>
-<tr><td class="tdl">Star-tables, astronomical,</td><td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_118">118</a></td></tr>
-<tr><td class="tdl">Stars, variable,</td><td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_42">42</a></td></tr>
-<tr><td class="tdl">St Gothard railway, tunnels,</td><td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_220">220</a></td></tr>
-<tr><td class="tdl">Sun, newspaper, the moon hoax,</td><td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_201">201</a></td></tr>
-<tr><td class="tdl smcap">Sun-Dial, How to Make a,</td><td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_69">69</a></td></tr>
-<tr><td class="tdl smcap"><a name="SUN" id="SUN"></a>Sun's, Destination,</td><td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_210">210</a></td></tr>
-<tr><td class="tdl pad4">distance, compared with star distance,</td><td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_97">97</a></td></tr>
-<tr><td class="tdl pad4">measured with Eros,</td><td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_67">67</a>, <a href="#Page_106">106</a></td></tr>
-<tr><td class="tdl pad4">motion, apex of,</td><td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_221">221</a></td></tr>
-<tr><td class="tdl">Sun-spots, discovered by Galileo,</td><td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_49">49</a></td></tr>
-<tr><td class="tdl"><i lang="la" xml:lang="la">Systema Saturnium</i>, Huygens,</td><td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_143">143</a></td></tr>
-
-<tr><td class="tdl">&nbsp;</td></tr>
-<tr><td class="tdl">Telescope, clock,</td><td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_175">175</a></td></tr>
-<tr><td class="tdl pad4">at Paris Exposition,</td><td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_176">176</a>, <a href="#Page_180">180</a></td></tr>
-<tr><td class="tdl pad4">double, for photography,</td><td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_86">86</a></td></tr>
-<tr><td class="tdl pad4">equatorial, explained,</td><td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_170">170</a></td></tr>
-<tr><td class="tdl pad4">first used by Galileo,</td><td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_49">49</a></td></tr>
-<tr><td class="tdl pad4">motion of,</td><td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_87">87</a></td></tr>
-<tr><td class="tdl pad4">mounting great,</td><td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_170">170</a></td></tr>
-<tr><td class="tdl pad4">unmoving, for polar photography,</td><td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_197">197</a></td></tr>
-<tr><td class="tdl smcap">Temporary Stars,</td><td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_37">37</a></td></tr>
-<tr><td class="tdl pad4">in Andromeda nebula,</td><td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_28">28</a>, <a href="#Page_29">29</a>, <a href="#Page_45">45</a></td></tr>
-<tr><td class="tdl pad4">in Aquila,</td><td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_40">40</a></td></tr>
-<tr><td class="tdl pad4">in Cassiopeia,</td><td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_40">40</a></td></tr>
-<tr><td class="tdl pad4">in Perseus,</td><td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_46">46</a></td></tr>
-<tr><td class="tdl pad4">in Scorpio,</td><td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_39">39</a></td></tr>
-<tr><td class="tdl pad4">their number,</td><td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_38">38</a></td></tr>
-<tr><td class="tdl pad4">theory of,</td><td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_42">42</a></td></tr>
-<tr><td class="tdl">Time, correct, determined astronomically,</td><td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_113">113</a></td></tr>
-<tr><td class="tdl pad4">differences between different places,</td><td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_121">121</a></td></tr>
-<tr><td class="tdl smcap"><span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_235" id="Page_235">[235]</a></span>
- Time Standards of the World,</td><td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_111">111</a></td></tr>
-<tr><td class="tdl pad4">standards of the World, table of,</td><td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_130">130</a></td></tr>
-<tr><td class="tdl pad4">system, in New York,</td><td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_120">120</a></td></tr>
-<tr><td class="tdl pad4">zones, explained,</td><td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_128">128</a></td></tr>
-<tr><td class="tdl">Trails, photographic,</td><td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_191">191</a></td></tr>
-<tr><td class="tdl">Transit, for determining clock error,</td><td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_118">118</a></td></tr>
-<tr><td class="tdl">Tycho Brahe, his temporary star,</td><td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_40">40</a></td></tr>
-
-<tr><td class="tdl">&nbsp;</td></tr>
-<tr><td class="tdl">Ulugh Beg, early star-catalogue,</td><td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_21">21</a></td></tr>
-<tr><td class="tdl">Undulatory theory, of light,</td><td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_19">19</a>, <a href="#Page_148">148</a></td></tr>
-<tr><td class="tdl">Universe, theories of,</td><td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_34">34</a>, <a href="#Page_53">53</a>, <a href="#Page_56">56</a></td></tr>
-<tr><td class="tdl">Uranus, discovered by Herschel,</td><td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_59">59</a>, <a href="#Page_142">142</a></td></tr>
-<tr><td class="tdl">Use of occultations,</td><td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_166">166</a>, <a href="#Page_167">167</a></td></tr>
-<tr><td class="tdl">Uses of astronomy, practical,</td><td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_112">112</a></td></tr>
-
-<tr><td class="tdl">&nbsp;</td></tr>
-<tr><td class="tdl">Variable stars,</td><td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_42">42</a></td></tr>
-<tr><td class="tdl pad4">in Argo,</td><td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_205">205</a></td></tr>
-<tr><td class="tdl">Vega, future pole-star,</td><td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_187">187</a></td></tr>
-<tr><td class="tdl">Visibility of stars, in day-time,</td><td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_191">191</a></td></tr>
-<tr><td class="tdl">Vision, phenomenon of,</td><td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_20">20</a>, <a href="#Page_149">149</a></td></tr>
-
-<tr><td class="tdl">&nbsp;</td></tr>
-<tr><td class="tdl">Washington, its longitude first determined,</td><td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_168">168</a></td></tr>
-<tr><td class="tdl">Waves, explained,</td><td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_148">148</a></td></tr>
-<tr><td class="tdl pad4">of light,</td><td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_20">20</a>, <a href="#Page_148">148</a></td></tr>
-<tr><td class="tdl">Wilkes, at Naval Observatory, Washington,</td><td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_169">169</a></td></tr>
-<tr><td class="tdl">Wilkins, imaginary voyage of,</td><td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_208">208</a></td></tr>
-<tr><td class="tdl">Witt, discovers Eros,</td><td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_66">66</a>, <a href="#Page_105">105</a></td></tr>
-<tr><td class="tdl">Wolf, M, invents asteroid photography,</td><td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_104">104</a></td></tr>
-<tr><td class="tdl pad4">measures Pleiades,</td><td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_11">11</a></td></tr>
-<tr><td class="tdl">World's time standards, table of,</td><td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_130">130</a></td></tr>
-
-<tr><td class="tdl">&nbsp;</td></tr>
-<tr><td class="tdl">Yale College, Pleiades measured at,</td><td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_15">15</a></td></tr>
-
-<tr><td class="tdl">&nbsp;</td></tr>
-<tr><td class="tdl">Zones, time, explained,</td><td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_128">128</a></td></tr>
-</table></div>
-
-
-<div class="transnote">
-<a name="TN" id="TN"></a>
-
-<p><strong>TRANSCRIBER'S NOTE</strong></p>
-
-<p>Fractions in the two tables on <a href="#TABLE_1">pg 74</a> and <a href="#TABLE_2">pg 78</a> are in the form "a b-c"
-in the original text, for example "2 7-16", and this form is retained
-in the etext. A few other basic fractions in the text
-such as ½ and ⅖ are displayed in this same form in the etext.</p>
-
-<p>There is only one Footnote in this book, with its anchor on <a href="#Page_69">pg 69</a>.
-It has been placed at the end of the chapter containing the anchor.</p>
-
-<p>Obvious typographical errors and punctuation errors have been
-corrected after careful comparison with other occurrences within
-the text and consultation of external sources.</p>
-
-<p>Except for those changes noted below, all misspellings in the text,
-and inconsistent or archaic usage, have been retained. For example,
-time zone, time-zone; Le Verrier, Leverrier; light wave, light-wave;
-intrust; wabbling; unexcelled; crape; monumented.</p>
-
-<p>
-<a href="#Page_146">Pg 146</a>, 'James Clark-Maxwell' replaced by 'James Clerk Maxwell'.<br />
-<a href="#Page_189">Pg 189</a>, 'impossible to measure' replaced by 'possible to measure'.<br />
-</p>
-</div>
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-<pre>
-
-
-
-
-
-End of Project Gutenberg's Practical Talks by an Astronomer, by Harold Jacoby
-
-*** END OF THIS PROJECT GUTENBERG EBOOK PRACTICAL TALKS BY AN ASTRONOMER ***
-
-***** This file should be named 53396-h.htm or 53396-h.zip *****
-This and all associated files of various formats will be found in:
- http://www.gutenberg.org/5/3/3/9/53396/
-
-Produced by Chris Curnow, John Campbell and the Online
-Distributed Proofreading Team at http://www.pgdp.net (This
-file was produced from images generously made available
-by The Internet Archive)
-
-
-Updated editions will replace the previous one--the old editions will
-be renamed.
-
-Creating the works from print editions not protected by U.S. copyright
-law means that no one owns a United States copyright in these works,
-so the Foundation (and you!) can copy and distribute it in the United
-States without permission and without paying copyright
-royalties. Special rules, set forth in the General Terms of Use part
-of this license, apply to copying and distributing Project
-Gutenberg-tm electronic works to protect the PROJECT GUTENBERG-tm
-concept and trademark. Project Gutenberg is a registered trademark,
-and may not be used if you charge for the eBooks, unless you receive
-specific permission. If you do not charge anything for copies of this
-eBook, complying with the rules is very easy. You may use this eBook
-for nearly any purpose such as creation of derivative works, reports,
-performances and research. They may be modified and printed and given
-away--you may do practically ANYTHING in the United States with eBooks
-not protected by U.S. copyright law. Redistribution is subject to the
-trademark license, especially commercial redistribution.
-
-START: FULL LICENSE
-
-THE FULL PROJECT GUTENBERG LICENSE
-PLEASE READ THIS BEFORE YOU DISTRIBUTE OR USE THIS WORK
-
-To protect the Project Gutenberg-tm mission of promoting the free
-distribution of electronic works, by using or distributing this work
-(or any other work associated in any way with the phrase "Project
-Gutenberg"), you agree to comply with all the terms of the Full
-Project Gutenberg-tm License available with this file or online at
-www.gutenberg.org/license.
-
-Section 1. General Terms of Use and Redistributing Project
-Gutenberg-tm electronic works
-
-1.A. By reading or using any part of this Project Gutenberg-tm
-electronic work, you indicate that you have read, understand, agree to
-and accept all the terms of this license and intellectual property
-(trademark/copyright) agreement. If you do not agree to abide by all
-the terms of this agreement, you must cease using and return or
-destroy all copies of Project Gutenberg-tm electronic works in your
-possession. If you paid a fee for obtaining a copy of or access to a
-Project Gutenberg-tm electronic work and you do not agree to be bound
-by the terms of this agreement, you may obtain a refund from the
-person or entity to whom you paid the fee as set forth in paragraph
-1.E.8.
-
-1.B. "Project Gutenberg" is a registered trademark. It may only be
-used on or associated in any way with an electronic work by people who
-agree to be bound by the terms of this agreement. There are a few
-things that you can do with most Project Gutenberg-tm electronic works
-even without complying with the full terms of this agreement. See
-paragraph 1.C below. There are a lot of things you can do with Project
-Gutenberg-tm electronic works if you follow the terms of this
-agreement and help preserve free future access to Project Gutenberg-tm
-electronic works. See paragraph 1.E below.
-
-1.C. The Project Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation ("the
-Foundation" or PGLAF), owns a compilation copyright in the collection
-of Project Gutenberg-tm electronic works. Nearly all the individual
-works in the collection are in the public domain in the United
-States. If an individual work is unprotected by copyright law in the
-United States and you are located in the United States, we do not
-claim a right to prevent you from copying, distributing, performing,
-displaying or creating derivative works based on the work as long as
-all references to Project Gutenberg are removed. Of course, we hope
-that you will support the Project Gutenberg-tm mission of promoting
-free access to electronic works by freely sharing Project Gutenberg-tm
-works in compliance with the terms of this agreement for keeping the
-Project Gutenberg-tm name associated with the work. You can easily
-comply with the terms of this agreement by keeping this work in the
-same format with its attached full Project Gutenberg-tm License when
-you share it without charge with others.
-
-1.D. The copyright laws of the place where you are located also govern
-what you can do with this work. Copyright laws in most countries are
-in a constant state of change. If you are outside the United States,
-check the laws of your country in addition to the terms of this
-agreement before downloading, copying, displaying, performing,
-distributing or creating derivative works based on this work or any
-other Project Gutenberg-tm work. The Foundation makes no
-representations concerning the copyright status of any work in any
-country outside the United States.
-
-1.E. Unless you have removed all references to Project Gutenberg:
-
-1.E.1. The following sentence, with active links to, or other
-immediate access to, the full Project Gutenberg-tm License must appear
-prominently whenever any copy of a Project Gutenberg-tm work (any work
-on which the phrase "Project Gutenberg" appears, or with which the
-phrase "Project Gutenberg" is associated) is accessed, displayed,
-performed, viewed, copied or distributed:
-
- This eBook is for the use of anyone anywhere in the United States and
- most other parts of the world at no cost and with almost no
- restrictions whatsoever. You may copy it, give it away or re-use it
- under the terms of the Project Gutenberg License included with this
- eBook or online at www.gutenberg.org. If you are not located in the
- United States, you'll have to check the laws of the country where you
- are located before using this ebook.
-
-1.E.2. If an individual Project Gutenberg-tm electronic work is
-derived from texts not protected by U.S. copyright law (does not
-contain a notice indicating that it is posted with permission of the
-copyright holder), the work can be copied and distributed to anyone in
-the United States without paying any fees or charges. If you are
-redistributing or providing access to a work with the phrase "Project
-Gutenberg" associated with or appearing on the work, you must comply
-either with the requirements of paragraphs 1.E.1 through 1.E.7 or
-obtain permission for the use of the work and the Project Gutenberg-tm
-trademark as set forth in paragraphs 1.E.8 or 1.E.9.
-
-1.E.3. If an individual Project Gutenberg-tm electronic work is posted
-with the permission of the copyright holder, your use and distribution
-must comply with both paragraphs 1.E.1 through 1.E.7 and any
-additional terms imposed by the copyright holder. Additional terms
-will be linked to the Project Gutenberg-tm License for all works
-posted with the permission of the copyright holder found at the
-beginning of this work.
-
-1.E.4. Do not unlink or detach or remove the full Project Gutenberg-tm
-License terms from this work, or any files containing a part of this
-work or any other work associated with Project Gutenberg-tm.
-
-1.E.5. Do not copy, display, perform, distribute or redistribute this
-electronic work, or any part of this electronic work, without
-prominently displaying the sentence set forth in paragraph 1.E.1 with
-active links or immediate access to the full terms of the Project
-Gutenberg-tm License.
-
-1.E.6. You may convert to and distribute this work in any binary,
-compressed, marked up, nonproprietary or proprietary form, including
-any word processing or hypertext form. However, if you provide access
-to or distribute copies of a Project Gutenberg-tm work in a format
-other than "Plain Vanilla ASCII" or other format used in the official
-version posted on the official Project Gutenberg-tm web site
-(www.gutenberg.org), you must, at no additional cost, fee or expense
-to the user, provide a copy, a means of exporting a copy, or a means
-of obtaining a copy upon request, of the work in its original "Plain
-Vanilla ASCII" or other form. Any alternate format must include the
-full Project Gutenberg-tm License as specified in paragraph 1.E.1.
-
-1.E.7. Do not charge a fee for access to, viewing, displaying,
-performing, copying or distributing any Project Gutenberg-tm works
-unless you comply with paragraph 1.E.8 or 1.E.9.
-
-1.E.8. You may charge a reasonable fee for copies of or providing
-access to or distributing Project Gutenberg-tm electronic works
-provided that
-
-* You pay a royalty fee of 20% of the gross profits you derive from
- the use of Project Gutenberg-tm works calculated using the method
- you already use to calculate your applicable taxes. The fee is owed
- to the owner of the Project Gutenberg-tm trademark, but he has
- agreed to donate royalties under this paragraph to the Project
- Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation. Royalty payments must be paid
- within 60 days following each date on which you prepare (or are
- legally required to prepare) your periodic tax returns. Royalty
- payments should be clearly marked as such and sent to the Project
- Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation at the address specified in
- Section 4, "Information about donations to the Project Gutenberg
- Literary Archive Foundation."
-
-* You provide a full refund of any money paid by a user who notifies
- you in writing (or by e-mail) within 30 days of receipt that s/he
- does not agree to the terms of the full Project Gutenberg-tm
- License. You must require such a user to return or destroy all
- copies of the works possessed in a physical medium and discontinue
- all use of and all access to other copies of Project Gutenberg-tm
- works.
-
-* You provide, in accordance with paragraph 1.F.3, a full refund of
- any money paid for a work or a replacement copy, if a defect in the
- electronic work is discovered and reported to you within 90 days of
- receipt of the work.
-
-* You comply with all other terms of this agreement for free
- distribution of Project Gutenberg-tm works.
-
-1.E.9. If you wish to charge a fee or distribute a Project
-Gutenberg-tm electronic work or group of works on different terms than
-are set forth in this agreement, you must obtain permission in writing
-from both the Project Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation and The
-Project Gutenberg Trademark LLC, the owner of the Project Gutenberg-tm
-trademark. Contact the Foundation as set forth in Section 3 below.
-
-1.F.
-
-1.F.1. Project Gutenberg volunteers and employees expend considerable
-effort to identify, do copyright research on, transcribe and proofread
-works not protected by U.S. copyright law in creating the Project
-Gutenberg-tm collection. Despite these efforts, Project Gutenberg-tm
-electronic works, and the medium on which they may be stored, may
-contain "Defects," such as, but not limited to, incomplete, inaccurate
-or corrupt data, transcription errors, a copyright or other
-intellectual property infringement, a defective or damaged disk or
-other medium, a computer virus, or computer codes that damage or
-cannot be read by your equipment.
-
-1.F.2. LIMITED WARRANTY, DISCLAIMER OF DAMAGES - Except for the "Right
-of Replacement or Refund" described in paragraph 1.F.3, the Project
-Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation, the owner of the Project
-Gutenberg-tm trademark, and any other party distributing a Project
-Gutenberg-tm electronic work under this agreement, disclaim all
-liability to you for damages, costs and expenses, including legal
-fees. YOU AGREE THAT YOU HAVE NO REMEDIES FOR NEGLIGENCE, STRICT
-LIABILITY, BREACH OF WARRANTY OR BREACH OF CONTRACT EXCEPT THOSE
-PROVIDED IN PARAGRAPH 1.F.3. YOU AGREE THAT THE FOUNDATION, THE
-TRADEMARK OWNER, AND ANY DISTRIBUTOR UNDER THIS AGREEMENT WILL NOT BE
-LIABLE TO YOU FOR ACTUAL, DIRECT, INDIRECT, CONSEQUENTIAL, PUNITIVE OR
-INCIDENTAL DAMAGES EVEN IF YOU GIVE NOTICE OF THE POSSIBILITY OF SUCH
-DAMAGE.
-
-1.F.3. LIMITED RIGHT OF REPLACEMENT OR REFUND - If you discover a
-defect in this electronic work within 90 days of receiving it, you can
-receive a refund of the money (if any) you paid for it by sending a
-written explanation to the person you received the work from. If you
-received the work on a physical medium, you must return the medium
-with your written explanation. The person or entity that provided you
-with the defective work may elect to provide a replacement copy in
-lieu of a refund. If you received the work electronically, the person
-or entity providing it to you may choose to give you a second
-opportunity to receive the work electronically in lieu of a refund. If
-the second copy is also defective, you may demand a refund in writing
-without further opportunities to fix the problem.
-
-1.F.4. Except for the limited right of replacement or refund set forth
-in paragraph 1.F.3, this work is provided to you 'AS-IS', WITH NO
-OTHER WARRANTIES OF ANY KIND, EXPRESS OR IMPLIED, INCLUDING BUT NOT
-LIMITED TO WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY OR FITNESS FOR ANY PURPOSE.
-
-1.F.5. Some states do not allow disclaimers of certain implied
-warranties or the exclusion or limitation of certain types of
-damages. If any disclaimer or limitation set forth in this agreement
-violates the law of the state applicable to this agreement, the
-agreement shall be interpreted to make the maximum disclaimer or
-limitation permitted by the applicable state law. The invalidity or
-unenforceability of any provision of this agreement shall not void the
-remaining provisions.
-
-1.F.6. INDEMNITY - You agree to indemnify and hold the Foundation, the
-trademark owner, any agent or employee of the Foundation, anyone
-providing copies of Project Gutenberg-tm electronic works in
-accordance with this agreement, and any volunteers associated with the
-production, promotion and distribution of Project Gutenberg-tm
-electronic works, harmless from all liability, costs and expenses,
-including legal fees, that arise directly or indirectly from any of
-the following which you do or cause to occur: (a) distribution of this
-or any Project Gutenberg-tm work, (b) alteration, modification, or
-additions or deletions to any Project Gutenberg-tm work, and (c) any
-Defect you cause.
-
-Section 2. Information about the Mission of Project Gutenberg-tm
-
-Project Gutenberg-tm is synonymous with the free distribution of
-electronic works in formats readable by the widest variety of
-computers including obsolete, old, middle-aged and new computers. It
-exists because of the efforts of hundreds of volunteers and donations
-from people in all walks of life.
-
-Volunteers and financial support to provide volunteers with the
-assistance they need are critical to reaching Project Gutenberg-tm's
-goals and ensuring that the Project Gutenberg-tm collection will
-remain freely available for generations to come. In 2001, the Project
-Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation was created to provide a secure
-and permanent future for Project Gutenberg-tm and future
-generations. To learn more about the Project Gutenberg Literary
-Archive Foundation and how your efforts and donations can help, see
-Sections 3 and 4 and the Foundation information page at
-www.gutenberg.org Section 3. Information about the Project Gutenberg
-Literary Archive Foundation
-
-The Project Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation is a non profit
-501(c)(3) educational corporation organized under the laws of the
-state of Mississippi and granted tax exempt status by the Internal
-Revenue Service. The Foundation's EIN or federal tax identification
-number is 64-6221541. Contributions to the Project Gutenberg Literary
-Archive Foundation are tax deductible to the full extent permitted by
-U.S. federal laws and your state's laws.
-
-The Foundation's principal office is in Fairbanks, Alaska, with the
-mailing address: PO Box 750175, Fairbanks, AK 99775, but its
-volunteers and employees are scattered throughout numerous
-locations. Its business office is located at 809 North 1500 West, Salt
-Lake City, UT 84116, (801) 596-1887. Email contact links and up to
-date contact information can be found at the Foundation's web site and
-official page at www.gutenberg.org/contact
-
-For additional contact information:
-
- Dr. Gregory B. Newby
- Chief Executive and Director
- gbnewby@pglaf.org
-
-Section 4. Information about Donations to the Project Gutenberg
-Literary Archive Foundation
-
-Project Gutenberg-tm depends upon and cannot survive without wide
-spread public support and donations to carry out its mission of
-increasing the number of public domain and licensed works that can be
-freely distributed in machine readable form accessible by the widest
-array of equipment including outdated equipment. Many small donations
-($1 to $5,000) are particularly important to maintaining tax exempt
-status with the IRS.
-
-The Foundation is committed to complying with the laws regulating
-charities and charitable donations in all 50 states of the United
-States. Compliance requirements are not uniform and it takes a
-considerable effort, much paperwork and many fees to meet and keep up
-with these requirements. We do not solicit donations in locations
-where we have not received written confirmation of compliance. To SEND
-DONATIONS or determine the status of compliance for any particular
-state visit www.gutenberg.org/donate
-
-While we cannot and do not solicit contributions from states where we
-have not met the solicitation requirements, we know of no prohibition
-against accepting unsolicited donations from donors in such states who
-approach us with offers to donate.
-
-International donations are gratefully accepted, but we cannot make
-any statements concerning tax treatment of donations received from
-outside the United States. U.S. laws alone swamp our small staff.
-
-Please check the Project Gutenberg Web pages for current donation
-methods and addresses. Donations are accepted in a number of other
-ways including checks, online payments and credit card donations. To
-donate, please visit: www.gutenberg.org/donate
-
-Section 5. General Information About Project Gutenberg-tm electronic works.
-
-Professor Michael S. Hart was the originator of the Project
-Gutenberg-tm concept of a library of electronic works that could be
-freely shared with anyone. For forty years, he produced and
-distributed Project Gutenberg-tm eBooks with only a loose network of
-volunteer support.
-
-Project Gutenberg-tm eBooks are often created from several printed
-editions, all of which are confirmed as not protected by copyright in
-the U.S. unless a copyright notice is included. Thus, we do not
-necessarily keep eBooks in compliance with any particular paper
-edition.
-
-Most people start at our Web site which has the main PG search
-facility: www.gutenberg.org
-
-This Web site includes information about Project Gutenberg-tm,
-including how to make donations to the Project Gutenberg Literary
-Archive Foundation, how to help produce our new eBooks, and how to
-subscribe to our email newsletter to hear about new eBooks.
-
-
-
-</pre>
-
-</body>
-</html>
diff --git a/old/53396-h/images/cover.jpg b/old/53396-h/images/cover.jpg
deleted file mode 100644
index 5c4c24b..0000000
--- a/old/53396-h/images/cover.jpg
+++ /dev/null
Binary files differ
diff --git a/old/53396-h/images/i_026fp.jpg b/old/53396-h/images/i_026fp.jpg
deleted file mode 100644
index b1f7aca..0000000
--- a/old/53396-h/images/i_026fp.jpg
+++ /dev/null
Binary files differ
diff --git a/old/53396-h/images/i_028fp.jpg b/old/53396-h/images/i_028fp.jpg
deleted file mode 100644
index 280455e..0000000
--- a/old/53396-h/images/i_028fp.jpg
+++ /dev/null
Binary files differ
diff --git a/old/53396-h/images/i_034fp.jpg b/old/53396-h/images/i_034fp.jpg
deleted file mode 100644
index 39eeabb..0000000
--- a/old/53396-h/images/i_034fp.jpg
+++ /dev/null
Binary files differ
diff --git a/old/53396-h/images/i_072.jpg b/old/53396-h/images/i_072.jpg
deleted file mode 100644
index fd8dcf7..0000000
--- a/old/53396-h/images/i_072.jpg
+++ /dev/null
Binary files differ
diff --git a/old/53396-h/images/i_073.jpg b/old/53396-h/images/i_073.jpg
deleted file mode 100644
index 3b519f3..0000000
--- a/old/53396-h/images/i_073.jpg
+++ /dev/null
Binary files differ
diff --git a/old/53396-h/images/i_076.jpg b/old/53396-h/images/i_076.jpg
deleted file mode 100644
index 846e271..0000000
--- a/old/53396-h/images/i_076.jpg
+++ /dev/null
Binary files differ
diff --git a/old/53396-h/images/i_084fp.jpg b/old/53396-h/images/i_084fp.jpg
deleted file mode 100644
index 4c9370d..0000000
--- a/old/53396-h/images/i_084fp.jpg
+++ /dev/null
Binary files differ
diff --git a/old/53396-h/images/i_108fp.jpg b/old/53396-h/images/i_108fp.jpg
deleted file mode 100644
index 07886fb..0000000
--- a/old/53396-h/images/i_108fp.jpg
+++ /dev/null
Binary files differ
diff --git a/old/53396-h/images/i_170fp.jpg b/old/53396-h/images/i_170fp.jpg
deleted file mode 100644
index a4bf9a8..0000000
--- a/old/53396-h/images/i_170fp.jpg
+++ /dev/null
Binary files differ
diff --git a/old/53396-h/images/i_176fp.jpg b/old/53396-h/images/i_176fp.jpg
deleted file mode 100644
index f0a065e..0000000
--- a/old/53396-h/images/i_176fp.jpg
+++ /dev/null
Binary files differ
diff --git a/old/53396-h/images/i_frontis.jpg b/old/53396-h/images/i_frontis.jpg
deleted file mode 100644
index 96d5ebe..0000000
--- a/old/53396-h/images/i_frontis.jpg
+++ /dev/null
Binary files differ